RF-2013.12.31-10K
Table of Contents


 
 
 
 
 
UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
WASHINGTON, DC 20549
FORM 10-K
ý
ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2013
OR
 ¨
TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
For the transition period from                     to                    
Commission File Number 001-34034
REGIONS FINANCIAL CORPORATION
(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)
Delaware
 
63-0589368
(State or other jurisdiction of
incorporation or organization)
 
(I.R.S. Employer
Identification No.)
1900 Fifth Avenue North, Birmingham, Alabama 35203
(Address of principal executive offices)
Registrant’s telephone number, including area code: (800) 734-4667
Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:
Title of each class
 
Name of each exchange on which registered
Common Stock, $.01 par value
 
New York Stock Exchange
Depositary Shares, each representing a 1/40th Interest in a Share of 6.375% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series A
 
New York Stock Exchange
Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act: None
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities
Act.    Yes  ý    No  ¨
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act.    Yes  ¨    No  ý
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days. Yes  ý    No  ¨
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files). Yes  ý    No  ¨
Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K.   ý
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.
 
 
Large accelerated filer  x
 
Accelerated filer ¨
 
 
 
 
Non-accelerated filer ¨ (Do not check if a smaller reporting company)
 
Smaller reporting company ¨
 
 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Act). Yes  ¨    No  ý

State the aggregate market value of the voting and non-voting common equity held by non-affiliates computed by reference to the price at which the common equity was last sold, or the average bid and asked price of such common equity, as of the last business day of the registrant’s most recently completed second fiscal quarter.
Common Stock, $.01 par value—$12,912,878,195 as of June 30, 2013.

Indicate the number of shares outstanding of each of the registrant’s classes of common stock, as of the latest practicable date.
Common Stock, $.01 par value—1,419,544,237 shares issued and outstanding as of February 13, 2014.

DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE
Portions of the proxy statement for the Annual Meeting to be held on April 24, 2014 are incorporated by reference into Part III.



Table of Contents


REGIONS FINANCIAL CORPORATION
FORM 10-K
INDEX
 

 
 
 
 
Page
PART I
 
 
 
 
Forward-Looking Statements
 
Item 1.
 
Business
 
Item 1A.
 
Risk Factors
 
Item 1B.
 
Unresolved Staff Comments
 
Item 2.
 
Properties
 
Item 3.
 
Legal Proceedings
 
Item 4.
 
Mine Safety Disclosures
 
 
 
 
 
 
PART II
 
 
 
 
Item 5.
 
Market for Registrant's Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities
 
Item 6.
 
Selected Financial Data
 
Item 7.
 
Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations
 
Item 7A.
 
Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk
 
Item 8.
 
Financial Statements and Supplementary Data
 
Item 9.
 
Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting on Accounting and Financial Disclosure
 
Item 9A.
 
Controls and Procedures
 
Item 9B.
 
Other Information
 
 
 
 
PART III
 
 
Item 10.
 
Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance
 
Item 11.
 
Executive Compensation
 
Item 12.
 
Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters
 
Item 13.
 
Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence
 
Item 14.
 
Principal Accounting Fees and Services
 
 
 
 
 
 
PART IV
 
 
Item 15.
 
Exhibits, Financial Statement Schedules
 
 
 
 
 
 
SIGNATURES
 

2

Table of Contents


PART I
Forward-Looking Statements

This Annual Report on Form 10-K, other periodic reports filed by Regions Financial Corporation under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, and any other written or oral statements made by us or on our behalf may include forward-looking statements as defined in the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995. The terms "Regions," "the Company", "we", "us" and "our" mean Regions Financial Corporation, a Delaware corporation and its subsidiaries, when appropriate. The words “anticipates,” “intends,” “plans,” “seeks,” “believes,” “estimates,” “expects,” “target,” “projects,” “outlook,” “forecast,” “will,” “may,” “could,” “should,” “can” and similar expressions often signify forward-looking statements. Forward-looking statements are not based on historical information, but rather are related to future operations, strategies, financial results or other developments. Forward-looking statements are based on management’s expectations as well as certain assumptions and estimates made by, and information available to, management at the time the statements are made. Those statements are based on general assumptions and are subject to various risks, uncertainties and other factors that may cause actual results to differ materially from the views, beliefs and projections expressed in such statements. These risks, uncertainties and other factors include, but are not limited to, the risks identified in Item 1A. “Risk Factors” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K and those described below:

Current and future economic and market conditions in the United States generally or in the communities we serve, including the effects of declines in property values, high unemployment rates and overall slowdowns in economic growth.
Possible changes in trade, monetary and fiscal policies of, and other activities undertaken by, governments, agencies, central banks and similar organizations.
The effects of a possible downgrade in the U.S. government’s sovereign credit rating or outlook.
Possible changes in market interest rates.
Any impairment of our goodwill or other intangibles, or any adjustment of valuation allowances on our deferred tax assets due to adverse changes in the economic environment, declining operations of the reporting unit, or other factors.
Possible changes in the creditworthiness of customers and the possible impairment of the collectability of loans.
Changes in the speed of loan prepayments, loan origination and sale volumes, charge-offs, loan loss provisions or actual loan losses.
Possible acceleration of prepayments on mortgage-backed securities due to low interest rates, and the related acceleration of premium amortization on those securities.
Our ability to effectively compete with other financial services companies, some of whom possess greater financial resources than we do and are subject to different regulatory standards than we are.
Loss of customer checking and savings account deposits as customers pursue other, higher-yield investments.
Our ability to develop and gain acceptance from current and prospective customers for new products and services in a timely manner.
Changes in laws and regulations affecting our businesses, including changes in the enforcement and interpretation of such laws and regulations by applicable governmental and self-regulatory agencies.
Our ability to obtain regulatory approval (as part of the CCAR process or otherwise) to take certain capital actions, including paying dividends and any plans to increase common stock dividends, repurchase common stock under current or future programs, or issue or redeem preferred stock or other regulatory capital instruments.
Our ability to comply with applicable capital and liquidity requirements (including the finalized Basel III capital standards), including our ability to generate capital internally or raise capital on favorable terms.
The costs and other effects (including reputational harm) of any adverse judicial, administrative, or arbitral rulings or proceedings, regulatory enforcement actions, or other legal actions to which we or any of our subsidiaries is a party.
Any decrease in the maximum permissible interchange fee that an issuer may receive for electronic debit transactions, or the expansion of options for merchants to use multiple unaffiliated payment networks for each transaction.
Our ability to manage fluctuations in the value of assets and liabilities and off-balance sheet exposure so as to maintain sufficient capital and liquidity to support our business.
Possible changes in consumer and business spending and saving habits and the related effect on our ability to increase assets and to attract deposits.
Any inaccurate or incomplete information provided to us by our customers or counterparties.
Inability of our framework to manage risks associated with our business, including operational risk and credit risk, to mitigate all risk or loss to us.
The inability of our internal disclosure controls and procedures to prevent or detect all errors or fraudulent acts.
The effects of geopolitical instability, including wars (whether declared or undeclared), conflicts and terrorist attacks.
The effects of man-made and natural disasters, including floods, droughts, tornadoes and hurricanes.
Our ability to keep pace with technological changes, including our ability to identify and address cyber-security risks such as data security breaches, "denial of service" attacks, "hacking" and identity theft.

3

Table of Contents


Possible downgrades in our credit ratings or outlook.
The effects of problems encountered by other financial institutions that adversely affect us or the banking industry generally.
The effects of the failure of any component of our business infrastructure which is provided by a third party.
Our ability to receive dividends from our subsidiaries.
Changes in accounting policies or procedures as may be required by the Financial Accounting Standards Board or other regulatory agencies.
The effects of any damage to our reputation resulting from developments related to any of the items identified above.
You should not place undue reliance on any forward-looking statements, which speak only as of the date made. We assume no obligation to update or revise any forward-looking statements that are made from time to time.


4

Table of Contents


Item 1. Business

Regions Financial Corporation is a financial holding company headquartered in Birmingham, Alabama, which operates in the South, Midwest and Texas. The terms "Regions," "the Company", "we", "us" and "our" mean Regions Financial Corporation, a Delaware corporation and its subsidiaries, when appropriate. Regions provides traditional commercial, retail and mortgage banking services, as well as other financial services in the fields of asset management, wealth management, securities brokerage, insurance and other specialty financing. At December 31, 2013, Regions had total consolidated assets of approximately $117.4 billion, total consolidated deposits of approximately $92.5 billion and total consolidated stockholders’ equity of approximately $15.8 billion.
Regions is a Delaware corporation and on July 1, 2004, became the successor by merger to Union Planters Corporation and the former Regions Financial Corporation. Its principal executive offices are located at 1900 Fifth Avenue North, Birmingham, Alabama 35203, and its telephone number at that address is (800) 734-4667.
Banking Operations
Regions conducts its banking operations through Regions Bank, an Alabama chartered commercial bank that is a member of the Federal Reserve System. At December 31, 2013, Regions operated 2,029 ATMs and 1,705 banking offices in Alabama, Arkansas, Florida, Georgia, Illinois, Indiana, Iowa, Kentucky, Louisiana, Mississippi, Missouri, North Carolina, South Carolina, Tennessee, Texas and Virginia.
The following chart reflects the distribution of branch locations in each of the states in which Regions conducts its banking operations.
 
 
 
 
Branches
Alabama
241

Arkansas
97

Florida
372

Georgia
137

Illinois
64

Indiana
63

Iowa
13

Kentucky
16

Louisiana
114

Mississippi
143

Missouri
67

North Carolina
6

South Carolina
30

Tennessee
258

Texas
82

Virginia
2

Total
1,705

Other Financial Services Operations
In addition to its banking operations, Regions provides additional financial services through the following subsidiaries:
Regions Insurance Group, Inc., a subsidiary of Regions Financial Corporation, is an insurance broker that offers insurance products through its subsidiaries Regions Insurance, Inc., headquartered in Birmingham, Alabama, and Regions Insurance Services, Inc., headquartered in Memphis, Tennessee. Through its insurance brokerage operations in Alabama, Arkansas, Georgia, Indiana, Louisiana, Mississippi, Missouri, South Carolina, Tennessee and Texas, Regions Insurance, Inc. offers insurance coverage for various lines of personal and commercial insurance, such as property, casualty, life, health and accident insurance. Regions Insurance Services, Inc. offers various insurance products, such as title, mortgage, crop, term life, accidental death and dismemberment, and environmental insurance, as well as debt cancellation products to customers of Regions. Regions Insurance Group, Inc. is one of the thirty largest insurance brokers in the United States based on annual revenues.

5

Table of Contents


Regions has several subsidiaries and affiliates that are agents or reinsurers of debt cancellation products and credit life insurance products relating to the activities of certain affiliates of Regions Bank.In addition, Regions Equipment Finance Corporation and Regions Commercial Equipment Finance, LLC, provide equipment financing products, focusing on commercial clients.
Regions Investment Services, Inc., a wholly-owned subsidiary of Regions Bank, offers investments and insurance products to Regions Bank customers, provided by licensed insurance agents. In addition, Regions Bank and Regions Investment Services, Inc. also maintain an agreement with Cetera Investment Services, LLC to offer securities, insurance, and advisory services to Regions Bank customers through dually employed financial consultants.
Acquisition Program
A substantial portion of the growth of Regions from its inception as a bank holding company in 1971 has been through the acquisition of other financial institutions, including commercial banks and thrift institutions, and the assets and deposits of those financial institutions. As part of its ongoing strategic plan, Regions periodically evaluates business combination opportunities. Any future business combination or series of business combinations that Regions might undertake may be material to Regions’ financial condition, in terms of assets acquired or liabilities assumed. Historically, business combinations in the financial services industry have typically involved the payment of a premium over book and market values of assets and liabilities acquired. This practice could result in dilution of book value and net income per share for the acquirer.
Segment Information
Reference is made to Note 22 “Business Segment Information” to the consolidated financial statements included under Item 8. of this Annual Report on Form 10-K for information required by this item.
Supervision and Regulation
Regions is subject to the extensive regulatory framework applicable to bank holding companies and their subsidiaries. This framework is intended primarily for the protection of depositors, the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation’s (“FDIC”) Deposit Insurance Fund (the “DIF”) and the banking system as a whole, and generally is not intended for the protection of stockholders or other investors. Described below are the material elements of selected laws and regulations applicable to Regions. These descriptions are not intended to be complete and are qualified in their entirety by reference to the full text of the statutes and regulations described. Changes in applicable law or regulation, and in their interpretation and application by regulatory agencies and other governmental authorities, cannot be predicted, but may have a material effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations.
Overview
Regions is registered with the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (the “Federal Reserve”) as a bank holding company and has elected to be treated as a financial holding company under the Bank Holding Company Act of 1956, as amended (“BHC Act”). As such, Regions and its subsidiaries are subject to the supervision, examination and reporting requirements of the BHC Act and the regulations of the Federal Reserve.
Generally, the BHC Act provides for “umbrella” regulation of financial holding companies by the Federal Reserve and functional regulation of holding company subsidiaries by applicable regulatory agencies. The BHC Act, however, requires the Federal Reserve to examine any subsidiary of a bank holding company, other than a depository institution, engaged in activities permissible for a depository institution. The Federal Reserve is also granted the authority, in certain circumstances, to require reports of, examine and adopt rules applicable to any holding company subsidiary.
In general, the BHC Act limits the activities permissible for bank holding companies. Bank holding companies electing to be treated as financial holding companies, however, may engage in additional activities under the BHC Act as described below under “-Permissible Activities under the BHC Act.” For a bank holding company to be eligible to elect financial holding company status, all of its subsidiary insured depository institutions must be well-capitalized and well-managed as described below under “-Regulatory Remedies Under the FDIA” and must have received at least a satisfactory rating on such institution’s most recent examination under the Community Reinvestment Act of 1977 (the “CRA”). The bank holding company itself must also be well-capitalized and well-managed in order to be eligible to elect financial holding company status. If a financial holding company fails to continue to meet any of the prerequisites for financial holding company status after engaging in activities not permissible for bank holding companies that have not elected to be treated as financial holding companies, the company must enter into an agreement with the Federal Reserve to comply with all applicable capital and management requirements. If the company does not return to compliance within 180 days, the Federal Reserve may order the company to divest its subsidiary banks or the company may be required to discontinue or divest investments in companies engaged in activities permissible only for a bank holding company electing to be treated as a financial holding company.

6

Table of Contents


Regions is also subject to the disclosure and regulatory requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, as administered by the Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”). Regions’ common stock and depository shares each representing a 1/40th interest in a share of its 6.375% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series A, are each listed on the New York Stock Exchange (“NYSE”). Consequently, Regions is also subject to NYSE’s rules for listed companies.
Regions Bank is a member of the FDIC, and, as such, its deposits are insured by the FDIC to the extent provided by law. Regions Bank is an Alabama state-chartered bank and a member of the Federal Reserve System. It is generally subject to supervision and examination by both the Federal Reserve and the Alabama Banking Department. The Federal Reserve and the Alabama Banking Department regularly examine the operations of Regions Bank and are given authority to approve or disapprove mergers, acquisitions, consolidations, the establishment of branches and similar corporate actions. The federal and state banking regulators also have the power to prevent the continuance or development of unsafe or unsound banking practices or other violations of law. Regions Bank is subject to numerous statutes and regulations that affect its business activities and operations, including various consumer protection laws and regulations. Regions Bank and its affiliates are also subject to supervision, regulation, and examination and enforcement by the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau (the “CFPB”) with respect to consumer protection laws and regulations. Some of Regions’ non-bank subsidiaries are also subject to regulation by various federal and state agencies.
Permissible Activities under the BHC Act
In general, the BHC Act limits the activities permissible for bank holding companies to the business of banking, managing or controlling banks and such other activities as the Federal Reserve has determined to be so closely related to banking as to be properly incident thereto. A bank holding company electing to be treated as a financial holding company, like Regions, may also engage in a range of activities that are (i) financial in nature or incidental to such financial activity or (ii) complementary to a financial activity and that do not pose a substantial risk to the safety and soundness of a depository institution or to the financial system generally. These activities include securities dealing, underwriting and market making, insurance underwriting and agency activities, merchant banking and insurance company portfolio investments.
The BHC Act does not place territorial restrictions on permissible non-banking activities of bank holding companies. The Federal Reserve has the power to order any bank holding company or its subsidiaries to terminate any activity or to terminate its ownership or control of any subsidiary when the Federal Reserve has reasonable grounds to believe that continuation of such activity or such ownership or control constitutes a serious risk to the financial soundness, safety or stability of any bank subsidiary of the bank holding company.
Volcker Rule. The Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act (the “Dodd-Frank Act”) prohibits banks and their affiliates from engaging in proprietary trading and investing in and sponsoring hedge funds and private equity funds. The statutory provision is commonly called the “Volcker Rule.” In December 2013, federal regulators adopted final rules to implement the Volcker Rule. The final rules also require that large bank holding companies, such as Regions, design and implement compliance programs to ensure adherence to the Volcker Rule’s prohibitions. Development and monitoring of the required compliance program may require the expenditure of resources and management attention. We are continuing to evaluate the effects of the final rules, but we do not currently anticipate that the Volcker Rule will have a material effect on our operations.
Enhanced Supervision and Prudential Standards
The recent financial crisis led to the adoption and revision of numerous laws and regulations applicable to financial institutions operating in the United States. In particular, the Dodd-Frank Act, enacted in July 2010, significantly restructures the financial regulatory regime in the United States and provides for enhanced supervision and prudential standards for, among other things, bank holding companies like Regions that have total consolidated assets of $50 billion or more. Among other changes, the Dodd-Frank Act created a new systemic risk oversight body, the Financial Stability Oversight Council (“FSOC”) to coordinate the efforts of the primary U.S. financial regulatory agencies (including the Federal Reserve, the FDIC and the SEC) in establishing regulations to address systemic financial stability concerns. The Dodd-Frank Act also directed the FSOC to make recommendations to the Federal Reserve regarding supervisory requirements and prudential standards applicable to systemically important financial institutions (which includes all bank holding companies with over $50 billion in assets, such as Regions), including capital, leverage, liquidity and risk-management requirements. The Dodd-Frank Act mandates that the requirements applicable to systemically important financial institutions be more stringent than those applicable to other financial companies. The Federal Reserve has discretionary authority to establish additional prudential standards, on its own or at the FSOC’s recommendation.
Stress Testing. As part of the enhanced prudential requirements applicable to systemically important financial institutions, the Federal Reserve conducts annual analyses of bank holding companies with at least $50 billion in assets to determine whether the companies have sufficient capital on a consolidated basis necessary to absorb losses in three economic and financial scenarios generated by the Federal Reserve: baseline, adverse and severely adverse scenarios. The Federal Reserve makes its methodologies and data for upcoming analyses available no later than November 15 of each year. Regions is also required to conduct its own semi-annual stress analysis (together with the Federal Reserve’s stress analysis, the “stress tests”) to assess the potential impact on Regions of the economic and financial conditions used as part of the Federal Reserve’s annual stress analysis. The Federal

7

Table of Contents


Reserve may also use, and require companies to use, additional components in the adverse and severely adverse scenarios or additional or more complex scenarios designed to capture salient risks to specific business groups. Regions Bank is also required to conduct annual stress testing using the same economic and financial scenarios as Regions and report the results to the Federal Reserve. A summary of results of the Federal Reserve’s analysis under the adverse and severely adverse stress scenarios will be publicly disclosed, and the bank holding companies subject to the rules, including Regions, must disclose a summary of the company-run severely adverse stress test results. Regions is required to include in its disclosure a summary of the severely adverse scenario stress test conducted by Regions Bank.
Comprehensive Capital Analysis and Review. U.S. bank holding companies with total consolidated assets of $50 billion or more, such as Regions, must submit annual capital plans for approval as part of the Federal Reserve’s comprehensive capital analysis and review process (“CCAR”). Covered bank holding companies may execute capital actions, such as paying dividends and repurchasing stock, only in accordance with a capital plan that has been reviewed and approved by the Federal Reserve (or any approved amendments to such plan). The CCAR process is intended to help ensure that these bank holding companies have robust, forward-looking capital planning processes that account for each company’s unique risks and that permit continued operations during times of economic and financial stress. Each of the bank holding companies participating in the CCAR process is also required to collect and report certain related data to the Federal Reserve on a quarterly basis to allow the Federal Reserve to monitor progress against the approved capital plans. Each capital plan must include a view of capital adequacy under the stress test scenarios described above. The Federal Reserve may object to a capital plan if the plan does not show that the covered bank holding company will maintain a Tier 1 common equity ratio (as defined under the Basel I framework) of at least 5% on a pro forma basis under expected and stressful conditions throughout the nine-quarter planning horizon covered by the capital plan. The CCAR rules, consistent with prior Federal Reserve guidance, also provide that capital plans contemplating dividend payout ratios exceeding 30% of after-tax net income will receive particularly close scrutiny.
In September 2013, the Federal Reserve issued an interim final rule amending its capital plan and stress test rules to clarify how bank holding companies with over $50 billion in total consolidated assets should incorporate the recently adopted Basel III Capital Rule (as defined below) for the 2014 CCAR process and the supervisory and company run stress tests. Under the Federal Reserve’s interim final rule, such bank holding companies must both (i) project its regulatory capital ratios and meet the required minimums under the Basel III Capital Rules for each quarter of the nine-quarter planning horizon in accordance with the minimum capital requirements that are in effect during that quarter, and subject to appropriate phase-ins/phase-outs under the new rules and (ii) continue to meet the minimum 5% Tier 1 common equity ratio as calculated under the previously generally applicable risk-based capital rules. Regions submitted its 2014 CCAR capital plan to the Federal Reserve on January 6, 2014.
Living Will Requirement. On December 19, 2013, we filed our initial plan for the rapid and orderly resolution under the Bankruptcy Code in the event of material distress or failure. Under rules adopted by the Federal Reserve and the FDIC pursuant to the Dodd-Frank Act, we are required to update this plan annually and may be required to update it upon the occurrence of material changes in our business, structure or operations. This resolution planning requirement may, as a practical matter, present additional constraints on our structure, operations and business strategy, and on transactions and business arrangements between our bank and non-bank subsidiaries, because we must consider the impact of these matters on our ability to prepare and submit a resolution plan that demonstrates that we may be resolved under the Bankruptcy Code in a rapid and orderly manner. Additionally, if the Federal Reserve and the FDIC determine that our plan is not credible and we do not cure the deficiencies, the Federal Reserve and the FDIC may impose more stringent capital, leverage or liquidity requirements or restrictions on growth, activities or operations of the Company.
Orderly Liquidation Authority. The Dodd-Frank Act creates the Orderly Liquidation Authority (“OLA”), a resolution regime for systemically important non-bank financial companies, including bank holding companies, under which the FDIC may be appointed receiver to liquidate such a company if the company is in danger of default and presents a systemic risk to U.S. financial stability. This determination must come from the Secretary of the U.S. Department of the Treasury ("U.S. Treasury") after supermajority recommendations by the Federal Reserve and the FDIC and consultation between the Secretary of the U.S. Treasury and the President of the United States, and after certain other conditions are met. OLA is similar to the FDIC resolution model for depository institutions, including granting very broad powers to the FDIC as receiver. Though creditors' rights under OLA were modified from the FDIC regime to reduce disparities in treatment between OLA and the Bankruptcy Code, substantial differences exist between the two regimes, including the ability of the FDIC to disregard the strict priority of creditor claims in some circumstances, the use of an administrative claims procedure to determine creditors claims (as opposed to the judicial procedure utilized in bankruptcy proceedings), and the ability of the FDIC to transfer claims to a “bridge” entity. The Dodd-Frank Act also established an Orderly Liquidation Fund that may provide liquidity to the receivership or a related “bridge” entity in an OLA liquidation proceeding. The Orderly Liquidation Fund would be funded through borrowings from the U.S. Treasury and repaid from the assets of the failed financial company and, if necessary, risk-based assessments made, first, on entities that received more in the OLA proceeding than they would have received in a Chapter 7 liquidation to the extent of such excess and, second, on bank holding companies with total consolidated assets of $50 billion or more, such as Regions, and on certain other non-bank financial companies. If an orderly liquidation is triggered, we could face assessments for the Orderly Liquidation Fund. It is not possible to determine the level of any such future assessments.

8

Table of Contents



The FDIC has developed a strategy under OLA, referred to as the “single point of entry” or “SPOE” strategy, under which the FDIC would resolve a failed financial holding company by transferring its assets (including shares of its operating subsidiaries) and, potentially, very limited liabilities to a “bridge” holding company; utilize the resources of the failed financial holding company to recapitalize the operating subsidiaries; and satisfy the claims of unsecured creditors of the failed financial holding company and other claimants in the receivership by delivering securities of one or more new financial companies that would emerge from the bridge holding company. Under this strategy, management of the failed financial holding company would be replaced and shareholders and creditors of the failed financial holding company would bear the losses resulting from the failure. The FDIC issued a notice in December 2013 describing some elements of the SPOE strategy, and seeking public comment to further develop the strategy.
U.S. Department of Treasury’s Assessment Fee Program.    The U.S. Treasury issued a rule implementing Section 155 of the Dodd-Frank Act to establish an assessment schedule for bank holding companies with total consolidated assets of $50 billion or more to cover expenses associated with the Office of Financial Research, the FSOC and implementation of OLA by the FDIC. We believe the assessment will not be material to our consolidated financial position, results of operations or cash flows.
Additional Proposed SIFI Rules. In December 2011, the Federal Reserve introduced a new proposal aimed at minimizing risks associated with systemically important financial institutions. The Federal Reserve’s proposal includes, among other things, risk-based capital and leverage requirements, liquidity requirements, stress tests, single-counterparty credit limits and overall risk management requirements, early remediation requirements and resolution planning and credit exposure reporting. The proposed rules would address a wide, diverse array of regulatory areas, each of which is highly complex. In some cases they would implement financial regulatory requirements being proposed for the first time, and in others overlap with other regulatory reforms. The proposed rules also address the Dodd-Frank Act’s early remediation requirements applicable to bank holding companies that have total consolidated assets of $50 billion or more. The proposed remediation rules are modeled after the prompt corrective action regime, described under “-Safety and Soundness Standards” below, but are designed to require action beginning in the earlier stages of a company’s financial distress by mandating action on the basis of arranged triggers, including capital and leverage, stress test results, liquidity, and risk management. On February 18, 2014, the Federal Reserve approved a final rule implementing its December 2011 proposal. Both the text and the full impact of the final rule on our business are still being analyzed.
Capital Requirements
Regions and Regions Bank are each required to comply with applicable capital adequacy standards established by the Federal Reserve. The current risk-based capital standards applicable to Regions and Regions Bank (the “general risk-based capital rules”) are based on the 1988 Capital Accord, known as Basel I, of the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision (the “Basel Committee”). However, the Federal Reserve has recently adopted rules establishing a new comprehensive capital framework for banks and bank holding companies.

General Risk-Based Capital Rules. The general risk-based capital rules are intended to make regulatory capital requirements sensitive to differences in credit and market risk profiles among banks and bank holding companies, to account for off-balance sheet exposure, and to minimize disincentives for holding liquid assets. Assets and off-balance sheet items are assigned to weighted risk categories. Capital is classified as Tier 1 (or core) capital or Tier 2 (or supplementary) capital depending on its characteristics. Under the general risk-based capital rules, Tier 1 capital includes common equity, retained earnings, qualifying noncumulative perpetual preferred stock (including related surplus), non-controlling interests in equity accounts of consolidated subsidiaries, and a limited amount of certain restricted core capital elements, less goodwill, most intangible assets and certain other assets, and Tier 2 capital includes qualifying subordinated debt, qualifying mandatorily convertible debt securities, perpetual preferred stock not included in the definition of Tier 1 capital, and a limited amount of the allowance for loan losses.
Under the general risk-based capital rules, Regions and Regions Bank are each required to maintain Tier 1 capital and Total capital (that is, the sum of Tier 1 and Tier 2 capital) equal to at least 4.0% and 8.0%, respectively, of total risk-weighted assets (including certain off-balance sheet items, such as standby letters of credit). The general risk-based capital rules also state that voting common stockholders’ equity should be the predominant element within Tier 1 capital, and that banks and bank holding companies should avoid over-reliance on non-common equity elements.

Advanced Approaches Risk-Based Capital Rules. In 2004, the Basel Committee published a new set of risk-based capital standards, known as Basel II, to revise Basel I. Basel II provides three approaches for setting capital standards for credit risk-“foundation” and “advanced” internal ratings-based approach tailored to individual institutions’ circumstances, and a standardized approach that bases risk-weighting on external credit assessments to a much greater extent than permitted in Basel I or the general risk-based capital rules. Basel II also sets capital requirements for operational risk and refines the existing capital requirements for market risk exposures. The federal bank regulators only adopted Basel II’s advanced approaches, and only for banking organizations having $250 billion or more in total consolidated assets or consolidated on-balance sheet foreign exposures

9

Table of Contents


of $10 billion or more. Regions and Regions Bank are not currently required to comply with the federal bank regulators’ rules implementing Basel II’s advanced approaches framework.

Basel III and the New Capital Rules. In July 2013, the federal bank regulators approved final rules (the “New Capital Rules”) implementing the Basel Committee’s December 2010 final capital framework for strengthening international capital standards, known as Basel III, as well as certain provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act. The New Capital Rules also substantially revise the risk-based capital requirements applicable to bank holding companies and their depository institution subsidiaries, including Regions and Regions Bank, as compared to the general risk-based capital rules. The New Capital Rules revise the components of capital and address other issues affecting the numerator in regulatory capital ratios. The New Capital Rules also address asset risk weights and other issues affecting the denominator in regulatory capital ratios and replace the existing general risk-weighting approach based on Basel I with a more risk-sensitive approach based, in part, on the standardized approach as part of Basel II. The New Capital Rules also implement the requirements of Section 939A of the Dodd-Frank Act to remove references to credit ratings from the federal bank regulators’ rules. The New Capital Rules are effective for Regions and Regions Bank on January 1, 2015 (subject to a phase-in period).

The New Capital Rules, among other things, (i) introduce a new capital measure called “Common Equity Tier 1” (“CET1”), (ii) specify that Tier 1 capital consists of CET1 and “Additional Tier 1 capital” instruments meeting certain revised requirements, (iii) define CET1 narrowly by requiring that most deductions/adjustments to regulatory capital measures be made to CET1 and not to the other components of capital, and (iv) expand the scope of the deductions/adjustments to capital as compared to existing regulations.

Under the New Capital Rules, the minimum capital ratios as of January 1, 2015 will be as follows:

4.5% CET1 to risk-weighted assets;

6.0% Tier 1 capital (that is, CET1 plus Additional Tier 1 capital) to risk-weighted assets; and

8.0% Total capital (that is, Tier 1 capital plus Tier 2 capital) to risk-weighted assets.

The New Capital Rules also introduce a new capital conservation buffer designed to absorb losses during periods of economic stress. The capital conservation buffer is composed entirely of CET1, on top of these minimum risk-weighted asset ratios. In addition, the New Capital Rules provide for a countercyclical capital buffer applicable only to certain covered institutions. We do not expect the countercyclical capital buffer to be applicable to Regions or Regions Bank. Banking institutions with a ratio of CET1 to risk-weighted assets above the minimum but below the capital conservation buffer (or below the combined capital conservation buffer and countercyclical capital buffer, when the latter is applied) will face constraints on dividends, equity repurchases and compensation based on the amount of the shortfall.

When fully phased-in on January 1, 2019, the New Capital Rules will require Regions and Regions Bank to maintain such additional capital conservation buffer of 2.5% of CET1, effectively resulting in minimum ratios of (i) CET1 to risk-weighted assets of at least 7%, (ii) Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets of at least 8.5%, and (iii) Total capital to risk-weighted assets of at least 10.5%. In addition, Regions is also subject to the Federal Reserve’s capital plan rule and supervisory CCAR program, pursuant to which our ability to make capital distributions and repurchase or redeem capital securities may be limited unless we are able to demonstrate our ability to meet applicable minimum capital ratios and currently a 5% minimum Tier 1 common equity ratio, as well as other requirements, over a nine quarter planning horizon under a “severely adverse” macroeconomic scenario generated yearly by the federal bank regulators. See “-Supervision and Regulation - Enhanced Supervision and Prudential Standards - Comprehensive Capital Analysis and Review” for more information on these topics.”

The New Capital Rules provide for a number of deductions from and adjustments to CET1. These include, for example, the requirement that mortgage servicing rights, certain deferred tax assets and significant investments in non-consolidated financial entities be deducted from CET1 to the extent that any one such category exceeds 10% of CET1 or all such items, in the aggregate, exceed 15% of CET1.

Implementation of the deductions and other adjustments to CET1 will begin on January 1, 2015 and will be phased-in over a 4-year period (beginning at 40% on January 1, 2015 and an additional 20% per year thereafter). The implementation of the capital conservation buffer will begin on January 1, 2016 at the 0.625% level and be phased in over a 4-year period (increasing by that amount on each subsequent January 1, until it reaches 2.5% on January 1, 2019).

The New Capital Rules prescribe a new standardized approach for risk weightings that expands the risk-weighting categories from the current four Basel I-derived categories (0%, 20%, 50% and 100%) to a much larger and more risk-sensitive

10

Table of Contents


number of categories, depending on the nature of the assets, generally ranging from 0% for U.S. government and agency securities, to 600% for certain equity exposures, and resulting in higher risk weights for a variety of asset classes.
In November 2011, the Basel Committee supplemented Basel III by issuing final provisions applying a new CET1 surcharge to certain global systemically important banks (“G-SIBs”). In a companion release addressing progress on a variety of financial regulatory reforms relating to global systemically important financial institutions, the Financial Stability Board released a list of 29 such institutions and indicated that it used the G-SIB surcharge methodology in creating the list. The Company was not included on either the original or revised lists of G-SIBs released in November 2012 and November 2013. Under Basel III, banks found to be G-SIBs will be subject to a progressive CET1 surcharge ranging from 1% to 3.5% over the Basel III 7% CET1 requirement. While the New Capital Rules did not address the adoption of the surcharge on G-SIBs, the federal bank regulators noted that they plan to implement this surcharge for institutions with $50 billion or more in total consolidated assets, or some subset of such institutions, consistent with the Basel Committee’s G-SIB surcharge proposal. Regions is not currently subject to this CET1 surcharge. However, it is possible that we may be subject to CET1 or other surcharges in the future.
Leverage Requirements. Bank holding companies and banks are also required to comply with minimum leverage ratio requirements. These requirements provide for a minimum ratio of Tier 1 capital to total consolidated quarterly average assets (as defined for regulatory purposes), net of the loan loss reserve, goodwill and certain other intangible assets (the “leverage ratio”), of 4.0% for all bank holding companies, with a lower 3.0% minimum for bank holding companies that meet certain specified criteria, including having the highest regulatory rating. The New Capital Rules remove the more permissive 3.0% leverage ratio currently available under the rules for certain highly rated banking organizations.
Liquidity Requirements. Historically, regulation and monitoring of bank and bank holding company liquidity has been addressed as a supervisory matter, both in the U.S. and internationally, without required formulaic measures. The Basel III final framework requires banks and bank holding companies to measure their liquidity against specific liquidity tests that, although similar in some respects to liquidity measures historically applied by banks and regulators for management and supervisory purposes, going forward will be required by regulation. One test, referred to as the liquidity coverage ratio (“LCR”), is designed to ensure that the banking entity maintains an adequate level of unencumbered high-quality liquid assets equal to the entity’s expected net cash outflow for a 30-day time horizon (or, if greater, 25 percent of its expected total cash outflow) under an acute liquidity stress scenario. The other, referred to as the net stable funding ratio (“NSFR”), is designed to promote more medium- and long-term funding of the assets and activities of banking entities over a one-year time horizon. These requirements will incentivize banking entities to increase their holdings of U.S. Treasury securities, Ginnie Mae securities, cash held at the Federal Reserve and other sovereign debt as a component of assets and increase the use of long-term debt as a funding source.
In October 2013, the federal banking agencies proposed rules implementing the LCR for advanced approaches institutions and a modified version of the LCR for bank holding companies with at least $50 billion in total consolidated assets that are not advanced approach institutions. Regions is not an advanced approaches institution and would only be required to comply with the modified LCR, which as currently written, among other differences from the LCR, only uses a 21-day time horizon for calculating the level of required high-quality liquid assets under a stress scenario. The proposed rule would be phased in over a two-year period beginning January 1, 2015, with 80% compliance required on January 1, 2015, 90% compliance on January 1, 2016 and 100% compliance on January 1, 2017. Additionally, while the proposed rules do not implement the NSFR, the Federal Reserve has stated its intent to adopt a version of the NSFR as well.
The Federal Reserve’s proposed heightened prudential requirements for bank holding companies with $50 billion or more of consolidated total assets also include enhanced liquidity standards, as discussed above under “-Enhanced Supervision and Prudential Standards.”
Safety and Soundness Standards
Guidelines adopted by the federal bank regulatory agencies pursuant to the Federal Deposit Insurance Act, as amended (the “FDIA”), establish general standards relating to internal controls and information systems, internal audit systems, loan documentation, credit underwriting, interest rate exposure, asset growth and compensation, fees and benefits. In general, these guidelines require, among other things, appropriate systems and practices to identify and manage the risk and exposures specified in the guidelines. Additionally, the agencies adopted regulations that authorize, but do not require, an agency to order an institution that has been given notice by an agency that it is not satisfying any of such safety and soundness standards to submit a compliance plan. If, after being so notified, an institution fails to submit an acceptable compliance plan or fails in any material respect to implement an acceptable compliance plan, the agency must issue an order directing action to correct the deficiency and may issue an order directing other actions of the types to which an undercapitalized institution is subject under the FDIA. See “-Regulatory Remedies under the FDIA” below. If an institution fails to comply with such an order, the agency may seek to enforce such order in judicial proceedings and to impose civil money penalties.

11

Table of Contents


Regulatory Remedies under the FDIA
The FDIA requires the federal banking agencies to take prompt corrective action in respect of depository institutions that do not meet specified capital requirements. The FDIA establishes five capital categories (“well-capitalized,” “adequately capitalized,” “undercapitalized,” “significantly undercapitalized” and “critically undercapitalized”), and the federal banking agencies must take certain mandatory supervisory actions, and are authorized to take other discretionary actions, with respect to institutions which are undercapitalized, significantly undercapitalized or critically undercapitalized. The severity of these mandatory and discretionary supervisory actions depends upon the capital category in which the institution is placed. Generally, subject to a narrow exception, the FDIA requires the banking regulator to appoint a receiver or conservator for an institution that is critically undercapitalized.
Currently, a depository institution generally is deemed to be well capitalized if it maintains a Tier 1 capital ratio of at least 6%, a total capital ratio of at least 10% and a Tier 1 leverage ratio of at least 5%. As of the phase-in of the Basel III Capital Rules on January 1, 2015, a depository institution will be deemed to be well capitalized if it maintains a CET1 capital ratio of at least 6.5%, a Tier 1 capital ratio of at least 8%, a total capital ratio of at least 10%, a Tier 1 leverage ratio of at least 5% and, for an advanced approaches depository institution, a supplementary leverage ratio of at least 3%. As of December 31, 2013, both Regions and Regions Bank were well capitalized with Tier 1 capital ratios of 11.68% and 12.46%, respectively, total capital ratios of 14.73% and 14.94%, respectively, and Tier 1 leverage ratios of 10.03% and 10.67%, respectively. As of December 31, 2013, Regions also had a CET1 ratio (non-GAAP) of 10.58% calculated as if the New Capital Rules were fully phased-in as of the calculation date. See Table 2 "GAAP to Non-GAAP Reconciliation" in Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations for more information. Regions Bank is not an advanced approaches institution.
An institution that is classified as well-capitalized based on its capital levels may be classified as adequately capitalized, and an institution that is adequately capitalized or undercapitalized based upon its capital levels may be treated as though it were undercapitalized or significantly undercapitalized, respectively, if the appropriate federal banking agency, after notice and opportunity for hearing, determines that an unsafe or unsound condition or an unsafe or unsound practice warrants such treatment.
An institution that is categorized as undercapitalized, significantly undercapitalized or critically undercapitalized is required to submit an acceptable capital restoration plan to its appropriate federal banking regulator. Under the FDIA, in order for the capital restoration plan to be accepted by the appropriate federal banking agency, a bank holding company must guarantee that a subsidiary depository institution will comply with its capital restoration plan, subject to certain limitations. The bank holding company must also provide appropriate assurances of performance. The obligation of a controlling bank holding company under the FDIA to fund a capital restoration plan is limited to the lesser of 5.0% of an undercapitalized subsidiary’s assets or the amount required to meet regulatory capital requirements. An undercapitalized institution is also generally prohibited from increasing its average total assets, making acquisitions, establishing any branches or engaging in any new line of business, except in accordance with an accepted capital restoration plan or with the approval of the FDIC. Institutions that are significantly undercapitalized or undercapitalized and either fail to submit an acceptable capital restoration plan or fail to implement an approved capital restoration plan may be subject to a number of requirements and restrictions, including orders to sell sufficient voting stock to become adequately capitalized, requirements to reduce total assets and cessation of receipt of deposits from correspondent banks. Critically undercapitalized depository institutions failing to submit or implement an acceptable capital restoration plan are subject to appointment of a receiver or conservator.
Payment of Dividends
Regions is a legal entity separate and distinct from its banking and other subsidiaries. The principal source of cash flow to Regions, including cash flow to pay dividends to its stockholders and principal and interest on any of its outstanding debt, is dividends from Regions Bank. There are statutory and regulatory limitations on the payment of dividends by Regions Bank to Regions, as well as by Regions to its stockholders.
If, in the opinion of a federal bank regulatory agency, an institution under its jurisdiction is engaged in or is about to engage in an unsafe or unsound practice (which, depending on the financial condition of the institution, could include the payment of dividends), such agency may require, after notice and hearing, that such institution cease and desist from such practice. The federal bank regulatory agencies have indicated that paying dividends that deplete an institution’s capital base to an inadequate level would be an unsafe and unsound banking practice. Under the FDIA, an insured institution may not pay a dividend if payment would cause it to become undercapitalized or if it already is undercapitalized. See “-Regulatory Remedies under the FDIA” above. Moreover, the Federal Reserve and the FDIC have issued policy statements stating that bank holding companies and insured banks should generally pay dividends only out of current operating earnings.
Payment of Dividends by Regions Bank.    Under the Federal Reserve’s Regulation H, Regions Bank may not, without approval of the Federal Reserve, declare or pay a dividend to Regions if the total of all dividends declared in a calendar year exceeds the total of (a) Regions Bank’s net income for that year and (b) its retained net income for the preceding two calendar years, less any required transfers to additional paid-in capital or to a fund for the retirement of preferred stock.

12

Table of Contents


Under Alabama law, Regions Bank may not pay a dividend in excess of 90% of its net earnings until the bank’s surplus is equal to at least 20% of capital. Regions Bank is also required by Alabama law to seek the approval of the Alabama Superintendent of Banking prior to the payment of dividends if the total of all dividends declared by Regions Bank in any calendar year will exceed the total of (a) Regions Bank’s net earnings for that year, plus (b) its retained net earnings for the preceding two years, less any required transfers to surplus. The statute defines net earnings as the remainder of all earnings from current operations plus actual recoveries on loans and investments and other assets, after deducting from the total thereof all current operating expenses, actual losses, accrued dividends on preferred stock, if any, and all federal, state and local taxes. Regions Bank cannot, without approval from the Federal Reserve and the Alabama Superintendent of Banking, declare or pay a dividend to Regions unless Regions Bank is able to satisfy the criteria discussed above.
Payment of Dividends by Regions. Regions’ payment of dividends is subject to the oversight of the Federal Reserve. In particular, the dividend policies and share repurchases of a large bank holding company, such as Regions, are reviewed by the Federal Reserve based on capital plans submitted as part of the CCAR process and stress tests as submitted by the bank holding company, and will be assessed against, among other things, the bank holding company’s ability to achieve the required capital ratios under the Basel III Capital Rules as they are phased in by U.S. regulators. See “-Enhanced Supervision and Prudential Standards” and “-Capital Requirements” above.
Support of Subsidiary Banks
Under longstanding Federal Reserve policy which has been codified by the Dodd-Frank Act, Regions is expected to act as a source of financial strength to, and to commit resources to support, its subsidiary bank. This support may be required at times when Regions may not be inclined to provide it. In addition, any capital loans by a bank holding company to its subsidiary bank are subordinate in right of payment to deposits and to certain other indebtedness of such subsidiary bank. In the event of a bank holding company’s bankruptcy, any commitment by the bank holding company to a federal bank regulatory agency to maintain the capital of a subsidiary bank will be assumed by the bankruptcy trustee and entitled to a priority of payment.
Transactions with Affiliates
There are various legal restrictions governing transactions between Regions and its non-bank subsidiaries, on the one hand, and Regions Bank and its subsidiaries, on the other hand, including the extent to which Regions and its non-bank subsidiaries may borrow or otherwise obtain funding from Regions Bank. In general, any “covered transaction” by Regions Bank (or its subsidiaries) with an affiliate that is an extension of credit must be secured by designated amounts of specified collateral and must be limited to (i) in the case of any single such affiliate, the aggregate amount of covered transactions of Regions Bank and its subsidiaries may not exceed 10% of the capital stock and surplus of Regions Bank, and (ii) in the case of all affiliates, the aggregate amount of covered transactions of Regions Bank and its subsidiaries may not exceed 20% of the capital stock and surplus of Regions Bank. Covered transactions are defined to include, among other things, a loan or extension of credit, as well as a purchase of securities issued by an affiliate, a purchase of assets (unless otherwise exempted by the Federal Reserve) from the affiliate, the acceptance of securities issued by the affiliate as collateral for a loan, derivatives transactions and securities lending transactions where the bank has credit exposure to an affiliate, and the issuance of a guarantee, acceptance or letter of credit on behalf of an affiliate. All covered transactions, including certain additional transactions (such as transactions with a third party in which an affiliate has a financial interest), must be conducted on market terms.
Deposit Insurance
Regions Bank accepts deposits, and those deposits have the benefit of FDIC insurance up to the applicable limits. Under the FDIA, insurance of deposits may be terminated by the FDIC upon a finding that the insured depository institution has engaged in unsafe and unsound practices, is in an unsafe or unsound condition to continue operations or has violated any applicable law, regulation, rule, order or condition imposed by a bank’s federal regulatory agency.

Deposit Insurance Assessments.    Regions Bank pays deposit insurance premiums to the FDIC based on an assessment rate established by the FDIC. FDIC assessment rates for large institutions are calculated based on one of two scorecards, one for most large institutions that have more than $10 billion in assets, such as Regions Bank, and another for “highly complex” institutions that have over $50 billion in assets and are fully owned by a parent with over $500 billion in assets. Each scorecard has a performance score and a loss-severity score that are combined to produce a total score, which is translated into an initial assessment rate. In calculating these scores, the FDIC utilizes the bank’s supervisory (“CAMELS”) ratings as well as forward-looking financial measures to assess an institution’s ability to withstand asset-related stress and funding-related stress. The FDIC has the ability to make discretionary adjustments to the total score, up or down, based upon significant risk factors that are not adequately captured in the scorecard. The total score is then translated to an initial base assessment rate on a non-linear, sharply-increasing scale. For large institutions, including Regions Bank, the initial base assessment rate ranges from 5 to 35 basis points on an annualized basis (basis points representing cents per $100). After the effect of potential base-rate adjustments, the total base assessment rate could range from 2.5 to 45 basis points on an annualized basis. The potential adjustments to an institution’s initial base assessment rate

13

Table of Contents


include (i) a potential decrease of up to 5 basis points for certain long-term unsecured debt (“unsecured debt adjustment”) and (ii) (except for well-capitalized institutions with a CAMELS rating of 1 or 2) a potential increase of up to 10 basis points for brokered deposits in excess of 10% of domestic deposits (“brokered deposit adjustment”). As the DIF reserve ratio grows, the rate schedule will be adjusted downward. Additionally, the rule includes a new adjustment for depository institution debt whereby an institution will pay an additional premium equal to 50 basis points on every dollar (above 3% of an institution’s Tier 1 capital) of long-term, unsecured debt held that was issued by another insured depository institution, excluding debt guaranteed under the FDIC’s Temporary Liquidity Guarantee Program. The deposit insurance assessment base is calculated based on the average of consolidated total assets less the average tangible equity of the insured depository institution during the assessment period. During 2013, Regions Bank’s FDIC insurance expense was $125 million, a $37 million decrease from fiscal year 2012.
The FDIA establishes a minimum ratio of deposit insurance reserves to estimated insured deposits, the designated reserve ratio (the “DRR”), of 1.15% prior to September 2020 and 1.35% thereafter. On December 20, 2010, the FDIC issued a final rule setting the DRR at 2%. The FDIC will, at least semi-annually, update its income and loss projections for the DIF and, if necessary, propose rules to further increase assessment rates. In addition, on January 12, 2010, the FDIC announced that it would seek public comment on whether banks with compensation plans that encourage risky behavior should be charged higher deposit assessment rates than such banks would otherwise be charged. Comments were due February 18, 2010. As of February 2014, no rule has been adopted.

We cannot predict whether, as a result of an adverse change in economic conditions or other reasons, the FDIC will increase deposit insurance assessment levels in the future. For more information, see the “Deposit Administrative Fees” section of Item 7. “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operation” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
FICO Assessments.    In addition, the Deposit Insurance Funds Act of 1996 authorized the Financing Corporation (“FICO”) to impose assessments on DIF applicable deposits in order to service the interest on FICO’s bond obligations from deposit insurance fund assessments. The amount assessed on individual institutions by FICO will be in addition to the amount, if any, paid for deposit insurance according to the FDIC’s risk-related assessment rate schedules. FICO assessment rates may be adjusted quarterly to reflect a change in assessment base. Regions Bank had a FICO assessment of approximately $7 million in FDIC deposit premiums in 2013, which was included in the $125 million in total FDIC insurance expense previously disclosed.
Acquisitions
The BHC Act requires every bank holding company to obtain the prior approval of the Federal Reserve before: (1) it may acquire direct or indirect ownership or control of any voting shares of any bank or savings and loan association, if after such acquisition, the bank holding company will directly or indirectly own or control 5% or more of the voting shares of the institution; (2) it or any of its subsidiaries, other than a bank, may acquire all or substantially all of the assets of any bank or savings and loan association; or (3) it may merge or consolidate with any other bank holding company. Bank holding companies with consolidated assets exceeding $50 billion must (i) obtain prior approval from the Federal Reserve before acquiring certain non-bank financial companies with assets exceeding $10 billion and (ii) provide prior written notice to the Federal Reserve before acquiring direct or indirect ownership or control of any voting shares of any company having consolidated assets of $10 billion or more. Bank holding companies seeking approval to complete an acquisition must be well-capitalized and well-managed.
The BHC Act further provides that the Federal Reserve may not approve any transaction that would result in a monopoly or would be in furtherance of any combination or conspiracy to monopolize or attempt to monopolize the business of banking in any section of the United States, or the effect of which may be substantially to lessen competition or to tend to create a monopoly in any section of the country, or that in any other manner would be in restraint of trade, unless the anticompetitive effects of the proposed transaction are clearly outweighed by the public interest in meeting the convenience and needs of the community to be served. The Federal Reserve is also required to consider the financial and managerial resources and future prospects of the bank holding companies and banks concerned and the convenience and needs of the community to be served. Consideration of financial resources generally focuses on capital adequacy, and consideration of convenience and needs issues includes the parties’ performance under the CRA, both of which are discussed below. The Federal Reserve must also take into account the institutions’ effectiveness in combating money laundering. In addition, pursuant to the Dodd-Frank Act, the BHC Act was amended to require the Federal Reserve to, when evaluating a proposed transaction, consider the extent to which the transaction would result in greater or more concentrated risks to the stability of the United States banking or financial system.
Depositor Preference
Under federal law, depositors and certain claims for administrative expenses and employee compensation against an insured depository institution would be afforded a priority over other general unsecured claims against such an institution in the “liquidation or other resolution” of such an institution by any receiver.

14

Table of Contents


Incentive Compensation
Guidelines adopted by the federal banking agencies pursuant to the FDIA prohibit excessive compensation as an unsafe and unsound practice and describe compensation as excessive when the amounts paid are unreasonable or disproportionate to the services performed by an executive officer, employee, director or principal stockholder.
In June 2010, the Federal Reserve issued comprehensive guidance on incentive compensation policies (the “Incentive Compensation Guidance”) intended to ensure that the incentive compensation policies of banking organizations do not undermine the safety and soundness of such organizations by encouraging excessive risk-taking. The Incentive Compensation Guidance, which covers all employees that have the ability to materially affect the risk profile of an organization, either individually or as part of a group, is based upon the key principles that a banking organization’s incentive compensation arrangements should (i) provide incentives that do not encourage risk-taking beyond the organization’s ability to effectively identify and manage risks, (ii) be compatible with effective internal controls and risk management, and (iii) be supported by strong corporate governance, including active and effective oversight by the organization’s board of directors. Any deficiencies in compensation practices that are identified may be incorporated into the organization’s supervisory ratings, which can affect its ability to make acquisitions or perform other actions. The Incentive Compensation Guidance provides that enforcement actions may be taken against a banking organization if its incentive compensation arrangements or related risk-management control or governance processes pose a risk to the organization’s safety and soundness and the organization is not taking prompt and effective measures to correct the deficiencies.
In April 2011, the Federal Reserve, other federal banking agencies and the Securities and Exchange Commission jointly published proposed rulemaking designed to implement provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act prohibiting incentive compensation arrangements that would encourage inappropriate risk taking at a covered institution, which includes a bank or bank holding company with $1 billion or more of assets, such as Regions and Regions Bank. The proposed rule (i) prohibits incentive-based compensation arrangements that encourage executive officers, employees, directors or principal shareholders to expose the institution to inappropriate risks by providing excessive compensation (based on the standards for excessive compensation adopted pursuant to the FDIA) and (ii) prohibits incentive-based compensation arrangements for executive officers, employees, directors or principal shareholders that could lead to a material financial loss for the institution. The proposed rule requires covered institutions to establish policies and procedures for monitoring and evaluating their compensation practices. Institutions with consolidated assets of $50 billion or more, such as Regions, are subject to additional restrictions on compensation arrangements for their executive officers and any other persons identified by the institution’s board of directors as having the ability to expose the institution to substantial losses. The comment period ended in May 2011, but final rules have not been adopted as of February 2014. These regulations may become effective before the end of 2014. If the regulations are adopted in the form initially proposed, they will impose limitations on the manner in which we may structure compensation for our executives.
The scope and content of the U.S. banking regulators’ policies on incentive compensation are continuing to develop. It cannot be determined at this time whether a final rule will be adopted and whether compliance with such a final rule will adversely affect the ability of Regions and its subsidiaries to hire, retain and motivate their key employees.
Consumer Protection Laws
Regions is subject to a number of federal and state consumer protection laws, including laws designed to protect borrowers and promote lending to various sectors of the economy and population. These laws include the Equal Credit Opportunity Act, the Fair Credit Reporting Act, the Truth in Lending Act, the Home Mortgage Disclosure Act, the Real Estate Settlement Procedures Act, and their respective state law counterparts.
The Dodd-Frank Act created a new, independent federal agency, the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau, which was granted broad rulemaking, supervisory and enforcement powers under various federal consumer financial protection laws, including the laws referenced above, fair lending laws and certain other statutes. The CFPB has examination and primary enforcement authority with respect to depository institutions with $10 billion or more in assets, their service providers and certain non-depository entities such as debt collectors and consumer reporting agencies. The CFPB has authority to prevent unfair, deceptive or abusive practices in connection with the offering of consumer financial products. The Dodd-Frank Act authorizes the CFPB to establish certain minimum standards for the origination of residential mortgages including a determination of the borrower’s ability to repay. In addition, the Dodd-Frank Act allows borrowers to raise certain defenses to foreclosure if they receive any loan other than a “qualified mortgage” as defined by the CFPB. The Dodd-Frank Act permits states to adopt consumer protection laws and standards that are more stringent than those adopted at the federal level and, in certain circumstances, permits state attorneys general to enforce compliance with both the state and federal laws and regulations.
The CFPB has finalized a number of significant rules which impact nearly every aspect of the lifecycle of a residential mortgage loan. These rules implement the Dodd-Frank Act amendments to the Equal Credit Opportunity Act, the Truth in Lending Act and the Real Estate Settlement Procedures Act. Among other things, the rules adopted by the CFPB require banks to: (i) develop and implement procedures to ensure compliance with a “reasonable ability to repay” test and identify whether a loan meets

15

Table of Contents


a new definition for a “qualified mortgage,” in which case a rebuttable presumption exists that the creditor extending the loan has satisfied the reasonable ability to repay test; (ii) implement new or revised disclosures, policies and procedures for originating and servicing mortgages including, but not limited to, pre-loan counseling, early intervention with delinquent borrowers and specific loss mitigation procedures for loans secured by a borrower's principal residence; (iii) comply with additional restrictions on mortgage loan originator hiring and compensation; (iv) comply with new disclosure requirements and standards for appraisals and certain financial products; and (v) maintain escrow accounts for higher-priced mortgage loans for a longer period of time. Regions is continuing to analyze the impact that such rules may have on its business.
Financial Privacy
The federal banking regulators have adopted rules that limit the ability of banks and other financial institutions to disclose non-public information about consumers to non-affiliated third parties. These limitations require disclosure of privacy policies to consumers and, in some circumstances, allow consumers to prevent disclosure of certain personal information to a non-affiliated third party. These regulations affect how consumer information is transmitted through diversified financial companies and conveyed to outside vendors. In addition, consumers may also prevent disclosure of certain information among affiliated companies that is assembled or used to determine eligibility for a product or service, such as that shown on consumer credit reports and asset and income information from applications. Consumers also have the option to direct banks and other financial institutions not to share information about transactions and experiences with affiliated companies for the purpose of marketing products or services.
Community Reinvestment Act ("CRA")
Regions Bank is subject to the provisions of the CRA. Under the terms of the CRA, Regions Bank has a continuing and affirmative obligation consistent with safe and sound operation to help meet the credit needs of its communities, including providing credit to individuals residing in low- and moderate-income neighborhoods. The CRA does not establish specific lending requirements or programs for financial institutions nor does it limit an institution’s discretion to develop the types of products and services that it believes are best suited to its particular community, consistent with the CRA. The CRA requires each appropriate federal bank regulatory agency, in connection with its examination of a depository institution, to assess such institution’s record in assessing and meeting the credit needs of the community served by that institution, including low- and moderate-income neighborhoods. The regulatory agency’s assessment of the institution’s record is made available to the public. The assessment also is part of the Federal Reserve’s consideration of applications to acquire, merge or consolidate with another banking institution or its holding company, to establish a new branch office that will accept deposits or to relocate an office. In the case of a bank holding company applying for approval to acquire a bank or other bank holding company, the Federal Reserve will assess the records of each subsidiary depository institution of the applicant bank holding company, and such records may be the basis for denying the application. Regions Bank received a “satisfactory” CRA rating in its most recent examination.
USA PATRIOT Act
A focus of governmental policy relating to financial institutions in recent years has been aimed at combating money laundering and terrorist financing. The USA PATRIOT Act of 2001 (the “USA PATRIOT Act”) broadened the application of anti-money laundering regulations to apply to additional types of financial institutions such as broker-dealers, investment advisors and insurance companies, and strengthened the ability of the U.S. Government to help prevent, detect and prosecute international money laundering and the financing of terrorism. The principal provisions of Title III of the USA PATRIOT Act require that regulated financial institutions, including state member banks: (i) establish an anti-money laundering program that includes training and audit components; (ii) comply with regulations regarding the verification of the identity of any person seeking to open an account; (iii) take additional required precautions with non-U.S. owned accounts; and (iv) perform certain verification and certification of money laundering risk for their foreign correspondent banking relationships. Failure of a financial institution to comply with the USA PATRIOT Act’s requirements could have serious legal and reputational consequences for the institution. Regions’ banking and insurance subsidiaries have augmented their systems and procedures to meet the requirements of these regulations and will continue to revise and update their policies, procedures and controls to reflect changes required by the USA PATRIOT Act and implementing regulations.
Office of Foreign Assets Control Regulation
The United States has imposed economic sanctions that affect transactions with designated foreign countries, nationals and others. These are typically known as the “OFAC” rules based on their administration by the U.S. Treasury Department Office of Foreign Assets Control (“OFAC”). The OFAC-administered sanctions targeting countries take many different forms. Generally, however, they contain one or more of the following elements: (i) restrictions on trade with or investment in a sanctioned country, including prohibitions against direct or indirect imports from and exports to a sanctioned country and prohibitions on U.S. persons engaging in financial transactions relating to, making investments in, or providing investment-related advice or assistance to, a sanctioned country; and (ii) a blocking of assets in which the government or specially designated nationals of the sanctioned country have an interest, by prohibiting transfers of property subject to U.S. jurisdiction (including property in the possession or

16

Table of Contents


control of U.S. persons). Blocked assets (e.g., property and bank deposits) cannot be paid out, withdrawn, set off or transferred in any manner without a license from OFAC. Failure to comply with these sanctions could have serious legal and reputational consequences.
Regulation of Insurers and Insurance Brokers
Regions’ operations in the areas of insurance brokerage and reinsurance of credit life insurance are subject to regulation and supervision by various state insurance regulatory authorities. Although the scope of regulation and form of supervision may vary from state to state, insurance laws generally grant broad discretion to regulatory authorities in adopting regulations and supervising regulated activities. This supervision generally includes the licensing of insurance brokers and agents and the regulation of the handling of customer funds held in a fiduciary capacity. Certain of Regions’ insurance company subsidiaries are subject to extensive regulatory supervision and to insurance laws and regulations requiring, among other things, maintenance of capital, record keeping, reporting and examinations.
Competition
All aspects of Regions’ business are highly competitive. Regions’ subsidiaries compete with other financial institutions located in the states in which they operate and other adjoining states, as well as large banks in major financial centers and other financial intermediaries, such as savings and loan associations, credit unions, Internet banks, finance companies, mutual funds, insurance companies, brokerage and investment banking firms, mortgage companies and financial service operations of major commercial and retail corporations. Regions expects competition to intensify among financial services companies due to the sustained low interest rate and ongoing low-growth economic environment. Also, as banks in Regions' footprint act to attain compliance with the LCR, there is a chance deposit pricing, particularly long-term time deposits could become even more competitive .     
Customers for banking services and other financial services offered by Regions’ subsidiaries are generally influenced by convenience, quality of service, personal contacts, price of services and availability of products. Although Regions’ position varies in different markets, Regions believes that its affiliates effectively compete with other financial services companies in their relevant market areas.
Employees
As of December 31, 2013, Regions and its subsidiaries had 24,255 employees.
Available Information
Regions maintains a website at www.regions.com. Regions makes available on its website free of charge its annual reports on Form 10-K, quarterly reports on Form 10-Q and current reports on Form 8-K, and amendments to those reports which are filed with or furnished to the SEC pursuant to Section 13(a) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934. These documents are made available on Regions’ website as soon as reasonably practicable after they are electronically filed with or furnished to the SEC. Also available on the website are Regions’ (i) Corporate Governance Principles, (ii) Code of Business Conduct and Ethics, (iii) Code of Ethics for Senior Financial Officers, and (iv) the charters of its Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee, Audit Committee, Compensation Committee and Risk Committee.


17

Table of Contents



Item 1A. Risk Factors

Risks Related to the Operation of Our Business
Our businesses have been, and may continue to be, adversely affected by conditions in the financial markets and economic conditions generally.
We provide traditional commercial, retail and mortgage banking services, as well as other financial services including asset management, wealth management, securities brokerage, insurance and other specialty financing. All of our businesses are materially affected by conditions in the financial markets and economic conditions generally or specifically in the Southeastern United States, the principal markets in which we conduct business. A worsening of, business and economic conditions generally or specifically in the principal markets in which we conduct business could have adverse effects on our business, including the following:

A decrease in the demand for, or the availability of, loans and other products and services offered by us;
A decrease in the value of our loans held for sale or other assets secured by consumer or commercial real estate;
An impairment of certain intangible assets, such as goodwill;
A decrease in interest income from variable rate loans, due to declines in interest rates; and
An increase in the number of clients and counterparties who become delinquent, file for protection under bankruptcy laws or default on their loans or other obligations to us, which could result in a higher level of nonperforming assets, net charge-offs, provisions for loan losses, and valuation adjustments on loans held for sale.
Overall, during the past several years, the general business environment has had an adverse effect on our business. Although the general business environment has shown some improvement, there can be no assurance that it will continue to improve. Since 2008, the federal government and the Federal Reserve have intervened in an unprecedented manner in an effort to provide stability and liquidity to the financial markets, including by implementing monetary policy measures designed to stabilize and stimulate the U.S. economy. There can be no assurance that the federal government and the Federal Reserve will continue to intervene or that the measures undertaken by the federal government and the Federal Reserve will result in continued improvement in the general business environment or in the business environments in the principal markets in which we do business. Additionally, the improvement of certain economic indicators, such as real estate asset values and rents and unemployment, may vary between geographic markets and in our principal markets may continue to lag behind improvement in the overall economy. These economic indicators typically affect certain industries, such as real estate and financial services, more significantly than other economic sectors. Furthermore, financial services companies with a substantial lending business, like ours, are dependent upon the ability of their borrowers to make debt service payments on loans. If economic conditions worsen or remain volatile, our business, financial condition and results of operations could be materially adversely affected.

Ineffective liquidity management could adversely affect our financial results and condition.
Effective liquidity management is essential for the operation of our business. We require sufficient liquidity to meet customer loan requests, customer deposit maturities/withdrawals, payments on our debt obligations as they come due and other cash commitments under both normal operating conditions and other unpredictable circumstances causing industry or general financial market stress. Our access to funding sources in amounts adequate to finance our activities on terms that are acceptable to us could be impaired by factors that affect us specifically or the financial services industry or economy generally. Factors that could detrimentally impact our access to liquidity sources include a downturn in the geographic markets in which our loans and operations are concentrated or difficult credit markets. Our access to deposits may also be affected by the liquidity needs of our depositors. In particular, a majority of our liabilities during 2013 were checking accounts and other liquid deposits, which are payable on demand or upon several days’ notice, while by comparison, a substantial majority of our assets were loans, which cannot be called or sold in the same time frame. Although we have historically been able to replace maturing deposits and advances as necessary, we might not be able to replace such funds in the future, especially if a large number of our depositors seek to withdraw their accounts, regardless of the reason. A failure to maintain adequate liquidity could materially and adversely affect our business, results of operations or financial condition.
Our operations are concentrated in the Southeastern United States, and adverse changes in the economic conditions in this region can adversely affect our financial results and condition.
Our operations are concentrated in the Southeastern United States, particularly in the states of Alabama, Arkansas, Georgia, Florida, Louisiana, Mississippi and Tennessee. As a result, local economic conditions in the Southeastern United States significantly affect the demand for the loans and other products we offer to our customers (including real estate, commercial and construction loans), the ability of borrowers to repay these loans and the value of the collateral securing these loans. Since 2008, the national real estate market has experienced a significant decline in value, and the value of real estate in the Southeastern United States in particular declined significantly more than real estate values in the United States as a whole. This decline has had an adverse impact on some of our borrowers and on the value of the collateral securing many of our loans. Although real estate in many geographies

18

Table of Contents


have begun to show signs of improvement, this recent decline and any further declines in the future may continue to affect borrowers and collateral values, which could adversely affect our currently performing loans, leading to future delinquencies or defaults and increases in our provision for loan losses. Further or continued adverse changes in these economic conditions could materially adversely affect our business, results of operations or financial condition.
Weather-related events and other natural disasters, as well as man-made disasters, could cause a disruption in our operations or other consequences that could have an adverse impact on financial results and condition.
A significant portion of our operations are located in the areas bordering the Gulf of Mexico and the Atlantic Ocean, regions that are susceptible to hurricanes, or in areas of the Southeastern United States that are susceptible to tornadoes and other severe weather events. Many areas in the Southeastern United States have also experienced severe droughts in recent years. Any of these or any other severe weather event could cause disruption to our operations and could have a material adverse effect on our overall business, results of operations or financial condition. While we maintain insurance covering many of these weather-related events, including coverage for lost profits and extra expense, there is no insurance against the disruption that a catastrophic earthquake, hurricane, tornado or other severe weather event could produce to the markets that we serve and the resulting adverse impact on our borrowers to timely repay their loans and the value of any collateral held by us. The severity and impact of future earthquakes, hurricanes, severe tornadoes, droughts, floods and other weather-related events are difficult to predict and may be exacerbated by global climate change. Man-made disasters and other events connected with the Gulf of Mexico or Atlantic Ocean, such as the 2010 Gulf oil spill, could have similar effects.

Further weakness in the residential real estate markets could adversely affect our performance.
As of December 31, 2013, consumer residential real estate loans represented approximately 31.4% of our total loan portfolio. This portion of our loan portfolio has been under pressure for several years as disruptions in the financial markets and the deterioration in housing markets and general economic conditions have caused a decline in home values, real estate market demand and the credit quality of borrowers. Any further declines in home values would adversely affect the value of collateral securing the residential real estate that we hold, as well as the volume of loan originations and the amount we realize on sale of real estate loans. These factors could result in higher delinquencies and greater charge-offs in future periods, which could materially adversely affect our business, financial condition or results of operations.
Further weakness in the commercial real estate markets could adversely affect our performance.
Facing continuing pressure from reduced asset values, high vacancy rates and reduced rents, the fundamentals within the commercial real estate sector remain weak. As of December 31, 2013, approximately 9.0% of our loan portfolio consisted of investor real estate loans. The properties securing income-producing investor real estate loans are typically not fully leased at the origination of the loan. The borrower’s ability to repay the loan is instead dependent upon additional leasing through the life of the loan or the borrower’s successful operation of a business. Weak economic conditions may impair a borrower’s business operations and typically slow the execution of new leases. Such economic conditions may also lead to existing lease turnover. As a result of these factors, vacancy rates for retail, office and industrial space may remain at elevated levels in 2014. High vacancy rates could result in rents falling further over the next several quarters. The combination of these factors could result in further deterioration in the fundamentals underlying the commercial real estate market and the deterioration in value of some of our loans. Any such deterioration could adversely affect the ability of our borrowers to repay the amounts due under their loans. As a result, our business, results of operations or financial condition may be materially adversely affected.
If we experience greater credit losses in our loan portfolios than anticipated, our earnings may be materially adversely affected.
As a lender, we are exposed to the risk that our customers will be unable to repay their loans according to their terms and that any collateral securing the payment of their loans may not be sufficient to assure repayment. Credit losses are inherent in the business of making loans and could have a material adverse effect on our operating results.
We make various assumptions and judgments about the collectability of our loan portfolio and provide an allowance for estimated credit losses based on a number of factors. Our management periodically determines the allowance for loan losses based on available information, including the quality of the loan portfolio, economic conditions, the value of the underlying collateral and the level of non-accrual loans. Increases in this allowance will result in an expense for the period, thereby reducing our reported net income. If, as a result of general economic conditions, there is a decrease in asset quality or growth in the loan portfolio, our management determines that additional increases in the allowance for loan losses are necessary, we may incur additional expenses which will reduce our net income, and our business, results of operations or financial condition may be materially adversely affected.
Although our management will establish an allowance for loan losses it believes is appropriate to absorb probable and reasonably estimable losses in our loan portfolio, this allowance may not be adequate. In particular, if a hurricane or other natural disaster were to occur in one of our principal markets or if economic conditions in those markets were to deteriorate unexpectedly,

19

Table of Contents


additional loan losses not incorporated in the existing allowance for loan losses may occur. Losses in excess of the existing allowance for loan losses will reduce our net income and could adversely affect our business, results of operations or financial condition, perhaps materially.
In addition, bank regulatory agencies will periodically review our allowance for loan losses and the value attributed to non-accrual loans and to real estate acquired through foreclosure. Such regulatory agencies may require us to adjust our determination of the value for these items. These adjustments could materially adversely affect our business, results of operations or financial condition.
Risks associated with home equity products where we are in a second lien position could materially adversely affect our performance.
Home equity products, particularly those where we are in a second lien position, and particularly those in certain geographic areas, may carry a higher risk of non-collection than other loans. Home equity lending includes both home equity loans and lines of credit. Of our $11.3 billion home equity portfolio at December 31, 2013, approximately $9.2 billion were home equity lines of credit and $2.1 billion were closed-end home equity loans (primarily originated as amortizing loans). This type of lending, which is secured by a first or second mortgage on the borrower’s residence, allows customers to borrow against the equity in their home. Real estate market values at the time of origination directly affect the amount of credit extended, and, in addition, past and future changes in these values impact the depth of potential losses. Second lien position lending carries higher credit risk because any decrease in real estate pricing may result in the value of the collateral being insufficient to cover the second lien after the first lien position has been satisfied. We have realized higher levels of charge-offs on second lien positions, particularly in the state of Florida, where real estate valuations have been depressed over the past several years. As of December 31, 2013, approximately $5.3 billion of our home equity lines and loans were in a second lien position (approximately $2.1 billion in Florida).
Industry competition may have an adverse effect on our success.
Our profitability depends on our ability to compete successfully. We operate in a highly competitive environment, and we expect competition to intensify due in part to the sustained low interest rate and ongoing low-growth economic environment. Certain of our competitors are larger and have more resources than we do, enabling them to be more aggressive than us in competing for loans and deposits. In our market areas, we face competition from other commercial banks, savings and loan associations, credit unions, Internet banks, finance companies, mutual funds, insurance companies, brokerage and investment banking firms, mortgage companies, and other financial intermediaries that offer similar services. Some of our non-bank competitors are not subject to the same extensive regulations we are and, therefore, may have greater flexibility in competing for business. Our ability to compete successfully depends on a number of factors, including customer convenience, quality of service, personal contacts, pricing and range of products. If we are unable to successfully compete for new customers and to retain our current customers, our business, financial condition or results of operations may also be adversely affected, perhaps materially. In particular, if we experience an outflow of deposits as a result of our customers seeking investments with higher yields or greater financial stability, or a desire to do business with our competitors, we may be forced to rely more heavily on borrowings and other sources of funding to operate our business and meet withdrawal demands, thereby adversely affecting our net interest margin.
Fluctuations in market interest rates may adversely affect our performance.
Our profitability depends to a large extent on our net interest income, which is the difference between the interest income received on interest-earning assets (primarily loans and investment securities) and the interest expense incurred in connection with interest-bearing liabilities (primarily deposits and borrowings). The level of net interest income is primarily a function of the average balance of interest-earning assets, the average balance of interest-bearing liabilities and the spread between the yield on such assets and the cost of such liabilities. These factors are influenced by both the pricing and mix of interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities which, in turn, are impacted by external factors such as the local economy, competition for loans and deposits, the monetary policy of the Federal Open Market Committee of the Federal Reserve System (the “FOMC”) and market interest rates.
The cost of our deposits and short-term wholesale borrowings is largely based on short-term interest rates, the level of which is influenced heavily by the FOMC’s actions. However, the yields generated by our loans and securities are typically driven by both short-term and longer-term interest rates. Longer-term rates are affected by multiple factors including the actions of the FOMC through such actions as quantitative easing ("QE"), and the market's expectations for future inflation, growth and other economic considerations. The level of net interest income is therefore influenced by movements in such interest rates and the pace at which such movements occur. Interest rate volatility can reduce unrealized gains or create unrealized losses in our portfolios. If the interest rates on our interest-bearing liabilities increase at a faster pace than the interest rates on our interest-earning assets, our net interest income may decline and, with it, a decline in our earnings may occur. Our net interest income and earnings would be similarly affected if the interest rates on our interest-earning assets declined at a faster pace than the interest rates on our interest-bearing liabilities. In particular, short-term interest rates are currently very low by historical standards, with many benchmark rates, such

20

Table of Contents


as the federal funds rate and the one- and three-month LIBOR near zero. These low rates have reduced our cost of funding which has caused our net interest margin to increase.
Our current one-year interest rate sensitivity position is moderately asset sensitive. As a result, an immediate or gradual decrease in rates over a twelve-month period would likely have a negative impact on twelve-month net interest income. An increasing interest rate environment, however, would increase debt service requirements for some of our borrowers and may adversely affect those borrowers’ ability to pay as contractually obligated and could result in additional delinquencies or charge-offs. Our results of operations and financial condition may be adversely affected as a result.
For a more detailed discussion of these risks and our management strategies for these risks, see the “Net Interest Income and Margin,” “Market Risk - Interest Rate Risk” and “Securities” sections of Item 7. “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operation” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
Certain of our credit ratings are below investment grade. Any future reductions in our credit ratings may increase our funding costs and place limitations on business activities related to providing credit support to customers.
Our long-term debt obligations are currently rated below investment grade by Moody’s Investor Services. The major rating agencies regularly evaluate us, and their ratings are based on a number of factors, including our financial strength and conditions affecting the financial services industry generally. In general, ratings agencies base their ratings on many quantitative and qualitative factors, including capital adequacy, liquidity, asset quality, business mix and level and quality of earnings, and we may not be able to maintain our current credit ratings. The ratings assigned to Regions and Regions Bank remain subject to change at any time, and it is possible that any ratings agency will take action to downgrade Regions, Regions Bank or both in the future. Additionally, ratings agencies may also make substantial changes to their ratings policies and practices which may affect our credit ratings. In the future, changes to existing ratings guidelines and new ratings guidelines may, among other things, adversely affect the ratings of our securities or other securities in which we have an economic interest.
Regions’ credit ratings can have negative consequences that can impact our ability to access the debt and capital markets, as well as reduce our profitability through increased costs on future debt issuances. Specifically, when Regions was downgraded below investment grade status, we became unable to reliably access the short-term unsecured funding markets, which caused us to hold more cash and liquid investments to meet our on-going cash needs. Such actions reduced our profitability as these liquid investments earned a lower return than other assets, such as loans. Regions’ liquidity policy requires that the holding company maintains cash sufficient to cover the greater of (i) 18 months of debt service and other cash needs or (ii) a minimum cash balance of $500 million. Although this policy helps protect us against the costs of unexpected adverse funding environments, we cannot guarantee that this policy will be sufficient. Future issuances of debt could cost Regions more in interest costs were such debt to be issued at our current debt rating. Any future downgrades would further increase the interest costs associated with potential future borrowings, the cost of which cannot be estimated due to the uncertainty of future issuances in terms of amount and priority and could further limit our access to the debt and capital markets.
Additionally, at the time Regions was downgraded to below investment grade, certain counterparty contracts were required to be renegotiated, resulting in additional collateral postings of approximately $200 million. Refer to Note 20, “Derivative Financial Instruments and Hedging Activities, Contingent Features” to the consolidated financial statements of this Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fair value of contracts subject to contingent credit features and the collateral postings associated with such contracts. Future downgrades could require Regions to post additional collateral. While the exact amount of additional collateral is unknown, it is reasonable to conclude that Regions may be required to post approximately an additional $200 million related to existing contracts with contingent credit features.
The value of our goodwill and other intangible assets may decline in the future.
As of December 31, 2013, we had $4.8 billion of goodwill and $295 million of other intangible assets. A significant decline in our expected future cash flows, a significant adverse change in the business climate, slower growth rates or a significant and sustained decline in the price of our common stock, any or all of which could be materially impacted by many of the risk factors discussed herein, may necessitate our taking charges in the future related to the impairment of our goodwill. Future regulatory actions could also have a material impact on assessments of goodwill for impairment. If the fair value of our net assets improves at a faster rate than the market value of our reporting units, or if we were to experience increases in book values of a reporting unit in excess of the increase in fair value of equity, we may also have to take charges related to the impairment of our goodwill. If we were to conclude that a future write-down of our goodwill is necessary, we would record the appropriate charge, which could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations.
Identifiable intangible assets other than goodwill consist of core deposit intangibles, purchased credit card relationship assets, mortgage servicing rights and customer relationship employment assets. Adverse events or circumstances could impact the recoverability of these intangible assets including loss of core deposits, significant losses of credit card accounts and/or balances,

21

Table of Contents


increased competition or adverse changes in the economy. To the extent these intangible assets are deemed unrecoverable, a non-cash impairment charge would be recorded, which could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations.
The value of our deferred tax assets could adversely affect our operating results and regulatory capital ratios.
As of December 31, 2013, Regions had approximately $612 million in net deferred tax assets. Our deferred tax assets are subject to an evaluation of whether it is more likely than not that they will be realized for financial statement purposes. In making this determination, we consider all positive and negative evidence available including the impact of recent operating results as well as potential carryback of tax to prior years’ taxable income, reversals of existing taxable temporary differences, tax planning strategies and projected earnings within the statutory tax loss carryover period. We have determined that the deferred tax assets are more likely than not to be realized at December 31, 2013 (except for $36 million related to state deferred tax assets for which we have established a valuation allowance). If we were to conclude that a significant portion of our deferred tax assets were not more likely than not to be realized, the required valuation allowance could adversely affect our financial position, results of operations and regulatory capital ratios. In addition, the value of our deferred tax assets could be adversely affected by a change in statutory tax rates.
Changes in the soundness of other financial institutions could adversely affect us.
Financial services companies are interrelated as a result of trading, clearing, counterparty or other relationships. We have exposure to many different industries and counterparties, and we routinely execute transactions with counterparties in the financial services industry, including brokers and dealers, commercial banks, investment banks, mutual and hedge funds, and other institutional clients. As a result, defaults by, or even mere speculation about, one or more financial services companies, or the financial services industry generally, may lead to market-wide liquidity problems and could lead to losses or defaults by us or by other institutions. Many of these transactions expose us to credit risk in the event of default of our counterparty or client. In addition, our credit risk may be exacerbated if the collateral held by us cannot be realized or is liquidated at prices not sufficient to recover the full amount of the loan or derivative exposure due us. Any such losses may materially and adversely affect our business, financial condition or results of operations.
Potential limitations on incentive compensation contained in proposed federal agency rulemaking may adversely affect our ability to attract and retain our highest performing employees.
In April 2011, the Federal Reserve, other federal banking agencies and the Securities and Exchange Commission jointly published proposed rules designed to implement provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act prohibiting incentive compensation arrangements that would encourage inappropriate risk taking at covered financial institutions, which includes a bank or bank holding company with $1 billion or more of assets, such as Regions and Regions Bank. It cannot be determined at this time whether or when a final rule will be adopted and whether compliance with such a final rule will substantially affect the manner in which we structure compensation for our executives and other employees. Depending on the nature and application of the final rules, we may not be able to successfully compete with certain financial institutions and other companies that are not subject to some or all of the rules to retain and attract executives and other high performing employees. If this were to occur, our business, financial condition and results of operations could be adversely affected, perhaps materially.
Maintaining or increasing market share may depend on market acceptance and regulatory approval of new products and services.
Our success depends, in part, on the ability to adapt products and services to evolving industry standards. There is increasing pressure to provide products and services at lower prices. This can reduce net interest income and noninterest income from fee-based products and services. In addition, the widespread adoption of new technologies could require us to make substantial capital expenditures to modify or adapt existing products and services or develop new products and services. We may not be successful in introducing new products and services in response to industry trends or developments in technology, or those new products may not achieve market acceptance. As a result, we could lose business, be forced to price products and services on less advantageous terms to retain or attract clients, or be subject to cost increases, and our business, financial condition or results of operations may be adversely affected.
We need to stay current on technological changes in order to compete and meet customer demands.
The financial services market, including banking services, is undergoing rapid changes with frequent introductions of new technology-driven products and services. In addition to better serving customers, the effective use of technology increases efficiency and may enable us to reduce costs. Our future success may depend, in part, on our ability to use technology to provide products and services that provide convenience to customers and to create additional efficiencies in our operations. Some of our competitors have substantially greater resources to invest in technological improvements than we currently have. We may not be able to effectively implement new technology-driven products and services or be successful in marketing these products and services to

22

Table of Contents


our customers. As a result, our ability to effectively compete to retain or acquire new business may be impaired, and our business, financial condition or results of operations, may be adversely affected.
We are subject to a variety of operational risks, including the risk of fraud or theft by employees, which may adversely affect our business and results of operations.
We are exposed to many types of operational risks, including liquidity risk, credit risk, market risk, interest rate risk, legal and compliance risk, strategic risk, information security risk, and reputational risk. We are also reliant upon our employees, and our operations are subject to the risk of fraud, theft or malfeasance by our employees. We have established processes and procedures intended to identify, measure, monitor, report and analyze these risks, however, there are inherent limitations to our risk management strategies as there may exist, or develop in the future, risks that we have not appropriately anticipated, monitored or identified. If our risk management framework proves ineffective, we could suffer unexpected losses, we may have to expend resources detecting and correcting the failure in our systems and we may be subject to potential claims from third parties and government agencies. We may also suffer severe reputational damage. Any of these consequences could adversely affect our business, financial condition or results of operations. In particular, the unauthorized disclosure, misappropriation, mishandling or misuse of personal, non-public, confidential or proprietary information of customers could result in significant regulatory consequences, reputational damage and financial loss.
Damage to our reputation could significantly harm our businesses.
Our ability to attract and retain customers and highly-skilled management and employees is impacted by our reputation. A negative public opinion of us and our business can result from any number of activities, actual, alleged or only widely-perceived, including our lending practices, corporate governance and regulatory compliance, acquisitions and actions taken by our regulators or by community organizations in response to these activities. Significant harm to our reputation could also arise as a result of litigation, employee misconduct or the activities of our customers, other participants in the financial services industry or our contractual counterparties, such as our service providers and vendors. Damage to our reputation could also adversely affect our credit ratings and access to the capital markets.
We are subject to a variety of systems failure and cyber-security risks that could adversely affect our business and financial performance.
Failure in or breach of our operational or security systems or infrastructure, or those of our third party vendors and other service providers, including as a result of cyber attacks, could disrupt our businesses or the businesses of our customers, result in the disclosure or misuse of confidential or proprietary information, damage our reputation, increase our costs and cause losses. As a large financial institution, we depend on our ability to process, record and monitor a large number of customer transactions on a continuous basis. As customer, public and regulatory expectations regarding operational and information security have increased, our operational systems and infrastructure must continue to be safeguarded and monitored for potential failures, disruptions and breakdowns. Our business, financial, accounting, data processing systems or other operating systems and facilities may stop operating properly or become disabled or damaged as a result of a number of factors, including events that are wholly or partially beyond our control. For example, there could be sudden increases in customer transaction volume; electrical or telecommunications outages; natural disasters such as earthquakes, tornadoes and hurricanes; disease pandemics; events arising from local or larger scale political or social matters, including terrorist acts; and, as described below, cyber attacks. Although we have business continuity plans and other safeguards in place, our business operations may be adversely affected by significant and widespread disruption to our physical infrastructure or operating systems that support our businesses and customers.
Information security risks for large financial institutions such as Regions have generally increased in recent years in part because of the proliferation of new technologies, the use of the Internet and telecommunications technologies (including mobile banking) to conduct financial transactions, and the increased sophistication and activities of organized crime, hackers, terrorists, nation-states, activists and other external parties. Third parties with whom we or our customers do business also present operational and information security risks to us, including from breakdowns, security breaches or failures of their own systems. As noted above, our operations rely on the secure processing, transmission and storage of confidential information in our computer systems and networks. In addition, to access our products and services, our customers may use personal smartphones, tablet PCs, and other mobile devices that are beyond our control systems. Although we believe that we have robust information security procedures and controls, our technologies, systems, networks and our customers’ devices may be the target of cyber attacks or information security breaches that could result in the unauthorized release, gathering, monitoring, misuse, loss or destruction of Regions’ or our customers’ confidential, proprietary and other information. Additionally, cyber attacks, such as denial of service attacks, hacking or terrorist activities, could disrupt Regions’ or our customers’ or other third parties’ business operations. For example, in recent months, denial of service attacks were launched against a number of large financial services institutions, including Regions. These events did not result in a breach of Regions’ client data, and account information remained secure; however, the attacks did adversely affect the performance of Regions Bank’s website, www.regions.com, and, in some instances, prevented customers from accessing Regions Bank’s secure websites for consumer and commercial applications. In all cases, the attacks primarily resulted in inconvenience; however, future cyber attacks could be more disruptive and damaging, and Regions may not be able to anticipate

23

Table of Contents


or prevent all such attacks. Additionally, as cyber threats continue to evolve, we may be required to expend significant additional resources to continue to modify or enhance our protective measures or to investigate and remediate any information security vulnerabilities. Disruptions or failures in the physical infrastructure or operating systems that support our businesses and customers, or cyber attacks or security breaches of the networks, systems or devices that our customers use to access our products and services, could result in customer attrition, regulatory fines, penalties or intervention, reputational damage, reimbursement or other compensation costs and/or additional compliance costs, any of which could materially adversely affect our business, results of operations or financial condition. For a more detailed discussion of these risks and specific occurrences, see the "Information Security Risk" section of "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations" of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
We rely on other companies to provide key components of our business infrastructure.
Third parties provide key components of our business operations such as data processing, recording and monitoring transactions, online banking interfaces and services, Internet connections and network access. While we have selected these third party vendors carefully, we do not control their actions. Any problems caused by these third parties, including those resulting from disruptions in services provided by a vendor, failure of a vendor to handle current or higher volumes, failure of a vendor to provide services for any reason, poor performance of services, failure to comply with applicable laws and regulations, or fraud or misconduct on the part of employees of any of our vendors, could adversely affect our ability to deliver products and services to our customers, our reputation and our ability to conduct our business. Financial or operational difficulties of a third party vendor could also hurt our operations if those difficulties interfere with the vendor’s ability to serve us. Replacing these third party vendors could also create significant delay and expense. Accordingly, use of such third parties creates an unavoidable inherent risk to our business operations.
We depend on the accuracy and completeness of information about clients and counterparties.
In deciding whether to extend credit or enter into other transactions with clients and counterparties, we may rely on information furnished by or on behalf of clients and counterparties, including financial statements and other financial information. We also may rely on representations of clients and counterparties as to the accuracy and completeness of that information and, with respect to financial statements, on reports of independent auditors if made available. If this information is inaccurate, we may be subject to regulatory action, reputational harm or other adverse effects with respect to the operation of our business, our financial condition and our results of operations.

We are exposed to risk of environmental liability when we take title to property.
In the course of our business, we may foreclose on and take title to real estate. As a result, we could be subject to environmental liabilities with respect to these properties. We may be held liable to a governmental entity or to third parties for property damage, personal injury, investigation and clean-up costs incurred by these parties in connection with environmental contamination or may be required to investigate or clean up hazardous or toxic substances or chemical releases at a property. The costs associated with investigation or remediation activities could be substantial. In addition, if we are the owner or former owner of a contaminated site, we may be subject to common law claims by third parties based on damages and costs resulting from environmental contamination emanating from the property. If we become subject to significant environmental liabilities, our business, financial condition or results of operations could be adversely affected.

We rely on the mortgage secondary market for some of our liquidity.
In 2013, we sold 62% of the mortgage loans we originated to the Federal National Mortgage Association, the Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation and the Government National Mortgage Association (collectively, the “Agencies”). We rely on the Agencies to purchase loans that meet their conforming loan requirements in order to reduce our credit risk and provide funding for additional loans we desire to originate. We cannot provide assurance that the Agencies will not materially limit their purchases of conforming loans due to capital constraints, a change in the criteria for conforming loans or other factors. Additionally, various proposals have been made to reform the U.S. residential mortgage finance market, including the role of the Agencies. The exact effects of any such reforms are not yet known, but may limit our ability to sell conforming loans to the Agencies. If we are unable to continue to sell conforming loans to the Agencies, our ability to fund, and thus originate, additional mortgage loans may be adversely affected, which would adversely affect our results of operations.

We are subject to a variety of risks in connection with any sale of loans we may conduct.
In connection with our sale of one or more loan portfolios, we may make certain representations and warranties to the purchaser concerning the loans sold and the procedures under which those loans have been originated and serviced. If any of these representations and warranties are incorrect, we may be required to indemnify the purchaser for any related losses, or we may be required to repurchase part or all of the effected loans. We may also be required to repurchase loans as a result of borrower fraud or in the event of early payment default by the borrower on a loan we have sold. If we are required to make any indemnity payments

24

Table of Contents


or repurchases and do not have a remedy available to us against a solvent counterparty, we may not be able to recover our losses resulting from these indemnity payments and repurchases. Consequently, our results of operations may be adversely affected.
In addition, we must report as held for sale any loans which we have undertaken to sell, whether or not a purchase agreement for the loans has been executed. We may therefore be unable to ultimately complete a sale for part or all of the loans we classify as held for sale. Management must exercise its judgment in determining when loans must be reclassified from held to maturity status to held for sale status under applicable accounting guidelines. Any failure to accurately report loans as held for sale could result in regulatory investigations and monetary penalties. Any of these actions could adversely affect our financial condition and results of operations. Reclassifying loans from held to maturity to held for sale also requires that the effected loans be marked to fair value. As a result, any loans classified as held for sale may be adversely affected by changes in interest rates and by changes in the borrower’s creditworthiness. We may be required to reduce the value of any loans we mark held for sale, which could adversely affect our results of operations.
A downgrade or potential downgrade of the U.S. Government’s sovereign credit rating by one or more credit ratings agencies could adversely affect our business.
In August 2011, Standard and Poor's lowered its long-term sovereign credit rating of the United States from AAA to AA+ and maintains a negative outlook on the rating. Although the other three major credit rating agencies did not downgrade their U.S. sovereign credit ratings, Fitch Ratings recently warned that it may cut its U.S. sovereign credit rating as a result of political brinksmanship over raising the U.S. debt ceiling. Future uncertainty over U.S. fiscal policy, including over tax increases and spending cuts as part of the budgetary process or over future raises of the U.S. debt ceiling, could result in a downgrade or a reduction in the outlook of the U.S. long-term sovereign credit rating by one or more credit ratings agencies. Any downgrade, or perceived future downgrade, in the U.S. sovereign credit rating or outlook could adversely affect global financial markets and economic conditions and may result in, among other things, increased volatility and illiquidity in the capital markets, declines in consumer confidence, increased unemployment levels and declines in the value of U.S. Treasury securities and securities guaranteed by the U.S. government. As a result, our business, liquidity, results of operations and financial conditions may be adversely affected. Additionally, the economic conditions resulting from any such downgrade or perceived future downgrade may significantly exacerbate the other risks we face.
Our reported financial results depend on management’s selection of accounting methods and certain assumptions and estimates.
Our accounting policies and assumptions are fundamental to our reported financial condition and results of operations. Our management must exercise judgment in selecting and applying many of these accounting policies and methods so they comply with generally accepted accounting principles and reflect management’s judgment of the most appropriate manner to report our financial condition and results. In some cases, management must select the accounting policy or method to apply from two or more alternatives, any of which may be reasonable under the circumstances, yet may result in us reporting materially different results than would have been reported under a different alternative.
Certain accounting policies are critical to presenting our reported financial condition and results of operations. They require management to make difficult, subjective or complex judgments about matters that are uncertain. Materially different amounts could be reported under different conditions or using different assumptions or estimates. The Company's critical accounting estimates include: the allowance for credit losses; fair value measurements; intangible assets; mortgage servicing rights; and income taxes. Because of the uncertainty of estimates involved in these matters, we may be required to do one or more of the following: significantly increase the allowance for credit losses and/or sustain credit losses that are significantly higher than the reserve provided; recognize significant impairment on our goodwill, other intangible assets or deferred tax asset balances; or significantly increase our accrued income taxes. Any of these actions could adversely affect our reported financial condition and results of operations.
Changes in our accounting policies or in accounting standards could materially affect how we report our financial results and condition.
From time to time, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (the “FASB”) and SEC change the financial accounting and reporting standards that govern the preparation of our financial statements. These changes can be difficult to predict and can materially impact how we record and report our financial condition and results of operations. In some cases, we could be required to apply a new or revised standard retroactively, resulting in us restating prior period financial statements. For example, on December 20, 2012, the FASB issued for public comment a Proposed Accounting Standards Update, Financial Instruments - Credit Losses (Subtopic 825-15), that would substantially change the accounting for credit losses on loans and other financial assets held by banks, financial institutions and other organizations. The proposal would remove the existing “probable” threshold in GAAP for recognizing credit losses and instead require affected reporting companies to reflect their estimate of credit losses on financial assets over the lifetime of each such asset, broadening the range of information that must be considered in measuring the allowance for expected credit losses. This proposal, if adopted as proposed, will likely have a negative impact, potentially materially, on

25

Table of Contents


Regions’ reported earnings and capital and could also have an impact on Regions Bank’s lending to the extent that higher reserves are required at the inception of a loan based on recent loan loss experience.

Risks Arising From the Legal and Regulatory Framework in which Our Business Operates
We are, and may in the future be, subject to litigation, investigations and governmental proceedings which may result in liabilities adversely affecting our financial condition, business or results of operations.
We and our subsidiaries are, and may in the future be, named as defendants in various class actions and other litigation, and may be the subject of subpoenas, reviews, requests for information, investigations, and formal and informal proceedings by government and self-regulatory agencies regarding our and their businesses and activities. For example, as discussed in Note 23 “Commitments, Contingencies and Guarantees”, Regions is working to resolve certain inquiries from its banking regulators. Any such matters may result in material adverse consequences to our results of operations, financial condition or ability to conduct our business, including adverse judgments, settlements, fines, penalties (including civil money penalties under applicable banking laws), injunctions, restrictions on our business activities or other relief. Our involvement in any such matters, even if the matters are ultimately determined in our favor, could also cause significant harm to our reputation and divert management attention from the operation of our business. Further, any settlement, consent order or adverse judgment in connection with any formal or informal proceeding or investigation by government or self-regulatory agencies may result in additional litigation, investigations or proceedings as other litigants and government or self-regulatory agencies (including the inquiries mentioned above) begin independent reviews of the same businesses or activities. Moreover, although Regions recorded a non-deductible charge of $58 million in the fourth quarter of 2013 in connection with the inquiries discussed above, there can be no assurance that a resolution will be reached or that any resolution will not exceed the recorded charge.
In addition, Regions is cooperating with an investigation by the U.S. Department of Housing and Urban Development’s Office of the Inspector General and the U.S. Department of Justice regarding our origination of mortgage loans insured by the Federal Housing Administration which is in the early stages. Other financial institutions who have been subject to similar investigations have settled with regulators on terms that included large monetary penalties, including, in some cases, civil money penalties under applicable banking laws. We cannot predict the outcome of this inquiry, however it is possible that we may be required to pay a monetary penalty which may adversely affect our results of operations. Additional inquiries will arise from time to time.
In addition, in recent years, a number of judicial decisions have upheld the right of borrowers to sue lending institutions on the basis of various evolving legal theories, collectively termed “lender liability.” Generally, lender liability is founded on the premise that a lender has either violated a duty, whether implied or contractual, of good faith and fair dealing owed to the borrower or has assumed a degree of control over the borrower resulting in the creation of a fiduciary duty owed to the borrower or its other creditors or shareholders. In the future, Regions could become subject to claims based on this or other evolving legal theories.
Additional information relating to our litigation, investigations and other proceedings is discussed in Note 23 “Commitments, Contingencies and Guarantees” to the consolidated financial statements of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
We may face significant claims for indemnification in connection with our sale of Morgan Keegan in 2012.
On January 11, 2012, Regions entered into a stock purchase agreement to sell Morgan Keegan and related affiliates to Raymond James Financial, Inc. (“Raymond James”). The transaction closed on April 2, 2012. In connection with the closing of the sale, Regions agreed to indemnify Raymond James for all litigation and certain other matters related to pre-closing activities of Morgan Keegan. Indemnifiable losses under the indemnification provision include legal and other expenses, such as costs for defense, judgments, settlements and awards associated with the resolution of litigation related to pre-closing activities. As of December 31, 2013 the carrying value of the indemnification obligation is approximately $260 million. This amount reflects an estimate of liability, and actual liabilities can potentially be higher than amounts reserved. The amount of liability that we may ultimately incur from indemnification claims may have an adverse impact, perhaps materially, on our results of operations.

26

Table of Contents


We are subject to extensive governmental regulation, which could have an adverse impact on our operations.
We are subject to extensive state and federal regulation, supervision and examination governing almost all aspects of our operations, which limits the businesses in which we may permissibly engage. The laws and regulations governing our business are intended primarily for the protection of our depositors, our customers, the financial system and the FDIC insurance fund, not our shareholders or other creditors. These laws and regulations govern a variety of matters, including certain debt obligations, changes in control, maintenance of adequate capital, and general business operations and financial condition (including permissible types, amounts and terms of loans and investments, the amount of reserves against deposits, restrictions on dividends, establishment of branch offices, and the maximum interest rate that may be charged by law). Further, we must obtain approval from our regulators before engaging in certain activities, and our regulators have the ability to compel us to, or restrict us from, taking certain actions entirely. There can be no assurance that any regulatory approvals we may require will be obtained, either in a timely manner or at all.
Since the recent financial crisis, financial institutions generally have been subjected to increased scrutiny from regulatory authorities. Recent changes to the legal and regulatory framework governing our operations, including the passage and continued implementation of the Dodd-Frank Act, have drastically revised the laws and regulations under which we operate. These changes may result in increased costs of doing business, decreased revenues and net income, and may reduce our ability to effectively compete to attract and retain customers. In general, bank regulators have increased their focus on consumer compliance, and we expect this focus to continue. Additional compliance requirements can be costly to implement, may require additional compliance personnel and may limit our ability to offer competitive products to our customers.
We are also subject to changes in federal and state law, as well as regulations and governmental policies, income tax laws and accounting principles. Regulations affecting banks and other financial institutions are undergoing continuous review and frequently change, and the ultimate effect of such changes cannot be predicted. Recent areas of legislative focus include housing finance reform, flood insurance and cyber security. Regulations and laws may be modified at any time, and new legislation may be enacted that will affect us, Regions Bank and our subsidiaries. Any changes in any federal and state law, as well as regulations and governmental policies, income tax laws and accounting principles, could affect us in substantial and unpredictable ways, including ways which may adversely affect our business, financial condition or results of operations. Failure to appropriately comply with any such laws, regulations or principles could result in sanctions by regulatory agencies, civil money penalties or damage to our reputation, all of which could adversely affect our business, financial condition or results of operations. Our regulatory position is discussed in greater detail in Note 13 “Regulatory Capital Requirements and Restrictions” in the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements in Item 8. of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
We may be subject to more stringent capital requirements.
Regions and Regions Bank are each subject to capital adequacy and liquidity guidelines and other regulatory requirements specifying minimum amounts and types of capital that must be maintained. From time to time, the regulators implement changes to these regulatory capital adequacy and liquidity guidelines. If we fail to meet these minimum capital and liquidity guidelines and other regulatory requirements, we or our subsidiaries may be restricted in the types of activities we may conduct and may be prohibited from taking certain capital actions, such as paying dividends and repurchasing or redeeming capital securities.
In particular, the capital requirements applicable to Regions and Regions Bank under the recently adopted New Capital Rules will begin to be phased-in starting in 2015. Once these new rules take effect, we will be required to satisfy additional, more stringent, capital adequacy and liquidity standards than we have in the past. We estimate that, had the New Capital Rules been fully phased in during the fourth quarter of 2013, Regions and Regions Bank would have exceeded the minimum requirements. This estimate could change in the future. Additionally, stress testing requirements may have the effect of requiring us to comply with the requirements of the New Capital Rules, or potentially even greater capital requirements, sooner than expected. While we expect to meet the requirements of the New Capital Rules, inclusive of the capital conservation buffer, as phased in by the Federal Reserve, we may fail to do so. In addition, these requirements could have a negative impact on our ability to lend, grow deposit balances, make acquisitions and make capital distributions in the form of increased dividends or share repurchases. Higher capital levels could also lower our return on equity.
We may also be required to satisfy even more stringent standards depending on the implementation of the liquidity guidelines and the additional capital surcharges being considered by the Federal Reserve. The ultimate impact on our business of any such heightened standards cannot be determined at this time and will depend on a number of factors, including implementation by the federal banking regulators.
For more information concerning our compliance with capital and liquidity requirements, see Note 13 “Regulatory Capital Requirements and Restrictions” in the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements which are included in Item 8. of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

27

Table of Contents


Rulemaking changes implemented by the CFPB will result in higher regulatory and compliance costs that may adversely affect our results of operations.
The Dodd-Frank Act created a new, independent federal agency, the CFPB, which was granted broad rulemaking, supervisory and enforcement powers under various federal consumer financial protection laws. The CFPB also has examination and primary enforcement authority with respect to depository institutions with $10 billion or more in assets, their service providers and certain non-depository entities such as debt collectors and consumer reporting agencies. Since its formation, the CFPB has finalized a number of significant rules that could have a significant impact on our business and the financial services industry more generally. In particular, the CFPB has adopted rules impacting nearly every aspect of the lifecycle of a residential mortgage loan as discussed in the “Supervision and Regulation” section of Item 1. “Business” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K above. The CFPB has also issued guidance which could radically reshape the automotive financing industry by subjecting indirect auto lenders to regulation as creditors under the Equal Credit Opportunity Act, which would make indirect auto lenders monitor and control certain credit policies and procedures undertaken by auto dealers. Compliance with the rules and policies adopted by the CFPB may limit the products we may permissibly offer to some or all of our customers, or limit the terms on which those products may be issued, or may adversely affect our ability to conduct our business as previously conducted (including our residential mortgage and indirect auto lending businesses in particular). We may also be required to add additional compliance personnel or incur other significant compliance-related expenses. Our business, results of operations or competitive position may be adversely affected as a result.
We may not be able to complete future acquisitions, may not be successful in realizing the benefits of any future acquisitions that are completed, or may choose not to pursue acquisition opportunities we might find beneficial.
A substantial part of our historical growth has been a result of acquisitions of other financial institutions, and we may, from time to time, evaluate and engage in the acquisition or divestiture of businesses (including their assets or liabilities, such as loans or deposits). We must generally satisfy a number of meaningful conditions prior to completing any such transaction, including in certain cases federal and state bank regulatory approvals. Bank regulators consider a number of factors when determining whether to approve a proposed transaction, including the ratings and compliance history of all institutions involved, the anti-money laundering and Bank Secrecy Act compliance history of all institutions involved, CRA examination results and the effect of the transaction on financial stability.
The process for obtaining required regulatory approvals has become substantially more difficult, time-consuming and unpredictable as a result of the financial crisis. We may fail to pursue, evaluate or complete strategic and competitively significant business opportunities as a result of our inability, or our perceived inability, to obtain required regulatory approvals in a timely manner or at all.
Assuming we are able to successfully complete one or more transactions, we may not be able to successfully integrate and realize the expected synergies from any completed transaction in a timely manner or at all. In particular, we may be charged by federal and state regulators with regulatory and compliance failures at an acquired business prior to the date of the acquisition, and these failures by the acquired company may have negative consequences for us, including the imposition of formal or informal enforcement actions. Completion and integration of any transaction may also divert management attention from other matters, result in additional costs and expenses, or adversely affect our relationships with our customers and employees, any of which may adversely affect our business or results of operations. Future acquisitions may also result in dilution of our current shareholders’ ownership interests or may require we incur additional indebtedness or use a substantial amount of our available cash and other liquid assets. As a result, our financial condition may be affected, and we may become more susceptible to economic conditions and competitive pressures.
Increases in FDIC insurance premiums may adversely affect our earnings.
Our deposits are insured by the FDIC up to legal limits and, accordingly, we are subject to FDIC deposit insurance assessments. We generally cannot control the amount of premiums we will be required to pay for FDIC insurance. High levels of bank failures over the past several years and increases in the statutory deposit insurance limits have increased resolution costs to the FDIC and put pressure on the Deposit Insurance Fund (“DIF”). In order to maintain a strong funding position and restore the reserve ratios of the DIF, the FDIC increased assessment rates on insured institutions, charged a special assessment to all insured institutions as of June 30, 2009, and required banks to prepay three years’ worth of premiums on December 30, 2009. If there are additional financial institution failures, we may be required to pay even higher FDIC premiums than the recently increased levels, or the FDIC may charge additional special assessments or require future prepayments. Further, the FDIC increased the DIF’s target reserve ratio to 2.0% of insured deposits following the Dodd-Frank Act’s elimination of the 1.5% cap on the DIF’s reserve ratio. Additional increases in our assessment rate may be required in the future to achieve this targeted reserve ratio. These increases in deposit assessments and any future increases, required prepayments or special assessments of FDIC insurance premiums may adversely affect our business, financial condition or results of operations.

28

Table of Contents


Unfavorable results from ongoing stress analyses may adversely affect our ability to retain customers or compete for new business opportunities.
The Federal Reserve conducts an annual stress analysis of Regions to evaluate our ability to absorb losses in three economic and financial scenarios generated by the Federal Reserve, including adverse and severely adverse economic and financial scenarios. The rules also require us to conduct our own semi-annual stress analysis to assess the potential impact on Regions of the scenarios used as part of the Federal Reserve’s annual stress analysis. A summary of the results of certain aspects of the Federal Reserve’s annual stress analysis is released publicly and contains bank holding company specific information and results. The rules also require us to disclose publicly a summary of the results of our semi-annual stress analyses, and Regions Banks’ annual stress analyses, under the severely adverse scenario.
Although the stress tests are not meant to assess our current condition, our customers may misinterpret and adversely react to, the results of these stress tests despite the strength of our financial condition. Any potential misinterpretations and adverse reactions could limit our ability to attract and retain customers or to effectively compete for new business opportunities. The inability to attract and retain customers or effectively compete for new business may have a material and adverse effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations.
Additionally, our regulators may require us to raise additional capital or take other actions, or may impose restrictions on our business, based on the results of the stress tests, including rejecting, or requiring revisions to, our annual capital plan submitted in connection with the Comprehensive Capital Analysis and Review. We may not be able to raise additional capital if required to do so, or may not be able to do so on terms which we believe are advantageous to Regions or its current shareholders. Any such capital raises, if required, may also be dilutive to our existing shareholders.
If an orderly liquidation of a systemically important bank holding company or non-bank financial company were triggered, we could face assessments for the Orderly Liquidation Fund.
The Dodd-Frank Act creates a new mechanism, the OLA, for liquidation of systemically important bank holding companies and non-bank financial companies. The OLA is administered by the FDIC and is based on the FDIC’s bank resolution model. The Secretary of the U.S. Treasury may trigger a liquidation under this authority only after consultation with the President of the United States and after receiving a recommendation from the boards of the FDIC and the Federal Reserve upon a two-thirds vote. Liquidation proceedings will be funded by the Orderly Liquidation Fund, which will borrow from the U.S. Treasury and impose risk-based assessments on covered financial companies. Risk-based assessments would be made, first, on entities that received more in the resolution than they would have received in the liquidation to the extent of such excess, and second, if necessary, on, among others, bank holding companies with total consolidated assets of $50 billion or more, such as Regions. Any such assessments may adversely affect our business, financial condition or results of operations.
Risks Related to Our Capital Stock
The market price of shares of our capital stock will fluctuate.
The market price of our capital stock could be subject to significant fluctuations due to a change in sentiment in the market regarding our operations or business prospects. Such risks may be affected by:

Our operating performance, financial condition and prospects, or the operating performance, financial condition and prospects of our competitors;
Operating results that vary from the expectations of management, securities analysts and investors;
Our creditworthiness;
Developments in our business or in the financial sector generally;
Regulatory changes affecting our industry generally or our business and operations;
The operating and securities price performance of companies that investors consider to be comparable to us;
Announcements of strategic developments, acquisitions and other material events by us or our competitors;
Expectations of or actual equity dilution;
Whether we declare or fail to declare dividends on our capital stock from time to time;
The ratings given to our securities by credit-rating agencies;
Changes in the credit, mortgage and real estate markets, including the markets for mortgage-related securities; and
Changes in global financial markets, global economies and general market conditions, such as interest or foreign exchange rates, stock, commodity, credit or asset valuations or volatility.
Stock markets in general (and our common stock in particular) have shown considerable volatility in the recent past. The market price of our capital stock, including our common stock and depositary shares representing fractional interests in our preferred stock, may continue to be subject to similar fluctuations unrelated to our operating performance or prospects. Increased volatility could result in a decline in the market price of our capital stock.

29

Table of Contents


Our capital stock is subordinate to our existing and future indebtedness.
Our capital stock, including our common stock and depositary shares representing fractional interests in our preferred stock, ranks junior to all of Regions’ existing and future indebtedness and Regions’ other non-equity claims with respect to assets available to satisfy claims against us, including claims in the event of our liquidation. As of December 31, 2013, Regions’ total liabilities were approximately $101.6 billion, and we may incur additional indebtedness in the future to increase our capital resources. Additionally, if our capital ratios or the capital ratios of Regions Bank fall below the required minimums, we or Regions Bank could be forced to raise additional capital by making additional offerings of debt securities, including medium-term notes, senior or subordinated notes or other applicable securities.
We are a holding company and depend on our subsidiaries for dividends, distributions and other payments.
We are a legal entity separate and distinct from our banking and other subsidiaries. Our principal source of cash flow, including cash flow to pay dividends to our stockholders and principal and interest on our outstanding debt, is dividends from Regions Bank. There are statutory and regulatory limitations on the payment of dividends by Regions Bank to us, as well as by us to our stockholders. Regulations of both the Federal Reserve and the State of Alabama affect the ability of Regions Bank to pay dividends and other distributions to us and to make loans to us. If Regions Bank is unable to make dividend payments to us and sufficient cash or liquidity is not otherwise available, we may not be able to make dividend payments to our common and preferred stockholders or principal and interest payments on our outstanding debt. See the “Stockholders’ Equity” section of Item 7. “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operation” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K. In addition, our right to participate in a distribution of assets upon a subsidiary’s liquidation or reorganization is subject to the prior claims of creditors of that subsidiary, except to the extent that any of our claims as a creditor of such subsidiary may be recognized. As a result, shares of our capital stock are effectively subordinated to all existing and future liabilities and obligations of our subsidiaries. At December 31, 2013, our subsidiaries’ total deposits and borrowings were approximately $97.3 billion.
We may not pay dividends on shares of our capital stock.
Holders of shares of our capital stock are only entitled to receive such dividends as our Board of Directors may declare out of funds legally available for such payments. Although we have historically declared cash dividends on our common stock, we are not required to do so and may reduce or eliminate our common stock dividend in the future. This could adversely affect the market price of our common stock. Furthermore, the terms of our outstanding preferred stock prohibit us from declaring or paying any dividends on any junior series of our capital stock, including our common stock, or from repurchasing, redeeming or acquiring such junior stock, unless we have declared and paid full dividends on our outstanding preferred stock for the most recently completed dividend period.
We are also subject to statutory and regulatory limitations on our ability to pay dividends on our capital stock. For example, it is the policy of the Federal Reserve that bank holding companies should generally pay dividends on common stock only out of earnings, and only if prospective earnings retention is consistent with the organization’s expected future needs, asset quality and financial condition. Moreover, the Federal Reserve will closely scrutinize any dividend payout ratios exceeding 30% of after-tax net income. Additionally, we are required to submit annual capital plans to the Federal Reserve for review and approval before we can take certain capital actions, including declaring and paying dividends and repurchasing or redeeming capital securities. If our capital plan or any amendment to our capital plan is not approved for any reason, our ability to declare and pay dividends on our capital stock may be limited. Further, if we are unable to satisfy the capital requirements applicable to us for any reason, we may be limited in our ability to declare and pay dividends on our capital stock.
Anti-takeover laws and certain agreements and charter provisions may adversely affect share value.
Certain provisions of state and federal law and our certificate of incorporation may make it more difficult for someone to acquire control of us without our Board of Directors’ approval. Under federal law, subject to certain exemptions, a person, entity or group must notify the federal banking agencies before acquiring control of a bank holding company. Acquisition of 10% or more of any class of voting stock of a bank holding company or state member bank, including shares of our common stock, creates a rebuttable presumption that the acquirer “controls” the bank holding company or state member bank. Also, as noted under the “Supervision and Regulation” section of Item 1. of this Annual Report on Form 10-K, a bank holding company must obtain the prior approval of the Federal Reserve before, among other things, acquiring direct or indirect ownership or control of more than 5% of the voting shares of any bank, including Regions Bank. There also are provisions in our certificate of incorporation that may be used to delay or block a takeover attempt. For example, holders of our Series A Preferred Stock have certain voting rights that could adversely affect share value. If and when dividends on the preferred stock have not been declared and paid for at least six quarterly dividend periods or their equivalent (whether or not consecutive), the authorized number of directors then constituting our Board of Directors will automatically be increased by two, and the preferred stockholders will be entitled to elect the two additional directors. Also, the affirmative vote or consent of the holders of at least two-thirds of all of the then-outstanding shares of the preferred stock is required to consummate a binding share-exchange or reclassification involving the preferred stock, or a merger or consolidation of Regions with or into another entity, unless certain requirements are met. These statutory provisions and

30

Table of Contents


provisions in our certificate of incorporation, including the rights of the holders of our Series A Preferred Stock, could result in Regions being less attractive to a potential acquirer.
We may need to raise additional debt or equity capital in the future, but may be unable to do so.
We may need to raise additional capital in the future to provide us with sufficient capital resources and liquidity to meet our commitments and other business purposes. Our ability to raise additional capital, if needed, will depend on, among other things, prevailing conditions in the capital markets, which are outside of our control, and our financial performance. The economic slowdown and loss of confidence in financial institutions over the past several years may increase our cost of funding and limit our access to some of our customary sources of capital, including inter-bank borrowings, repurchase agreements and borrowings from the discount window of the Federal Reserve. Additionally, some of our long-term debt securities are currently rated below investment grade by certain of the credit ratings agencies, which may also limit our ability to access the capital markets. We cannot assure you that capital will be available to us on acceptable terms or at all. Any occurrence that may limit our access to the capital markets, such as a decline in the confidence of debt purchasers, depositors of Regions Bank or counterparties participating in the capital markets, or a downgrade of our debt ratings, may adversely affect our capital costs and our ability to raise capital and, in turn, our liquidity. An inability to raise additional capital on acceptable terms when needed could have a materially adverse effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations.

Future issuances of additional equity securities could result in dilution of existing stockholders’ equity ownership.
We may determine from time to time to issue additional equity securities to raise additional capital, support growth, or to make acquisitions. Further, we may issue stock options or other stock grants to retain and motivate our employees. These issuances of our securities could dilute the voting and economic interests of our existing shareholders.


31

Table of Contents


Item 1B. Unresolved Staff Comments

None.

Item 2. Properties

Regions’ corporate headquarters occupy the main banking facility of Regions Bank, located at 1900 Fifth Avenue North, Birmingham, Alabama 35203.
At December 31, 2013, Regions Bank, Regions’ banking subsidiary, operated 1,705 banking offices. At December 31, 2013, there were no significant encumbrances on the offices, equipment and other operational facilities owned by Regions and its subsidiaries.
See Item 1. “Business” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K for a list of the states in which Regions Bank’s branches are located.

Item 3. Legal Proceedings
    
Information required by this item is set forth in Note 23 “Commitments, Contingencies and Guarantees” in the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements which are included in Item 8. of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
 
Item 4. Mine Safety Disclosures.

Not applicable.
Executive Officers of the Registrant
Information concerning the Executive Officers of Regions is set forth under Item 10. “Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.


32

Table of Contents


PART II
 
Item 5. Market For Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities

Regions’ common stock, par value $.01 per share, is listed for trading on the New York Stock Exchange under the symbol RF. Quarterly high and low sales prices of and cash dividends declared on Regions’ common stock are set forth in Table 28 “Quarterly Results of Operations” of “Management’s Discussion and Analysis”, which is included in Item 7. of this Annual Report on Form 10-K. As of February 13, 2014, there were 63,471 holders of record of Regions’ common stock (including participants in the Computershare Investment Plan for Regions Financial Corporation).
Restrictions on the ability of Regions Bank to transfer funds to Regions at December 31, 2013, are set forth in Note 13 “Regulatory Capital Requirements and Restrictions” to the consolidated financial statements, which are included in Item 8. of this Annual Report on Form 10-K. A discussion of certain limitations on the ability of Regions Bank to pay dividends to Regions and the ability of Regions to pay dividends on its common stock is set forth in Item 1. “Business” under the heading “Supervision and Regulation—Payment of Dividends” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
The following table presents information regarding issuer purchases of equity securities during the fourth quarter of 2013.
Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities
 
Period
Total Number of  Shares Purchased
 
Average Price Paid
 per Share
 
Total Number of
Shares
Purchased as
Part of
Publicly
Announced
Plans or Programs
 
Maximum
Approximate Dollar Value of
Shares that May
Yet Be Purchased Under Publicly Announced Plans or Programs
October 1—31, 2013

 
$

 

 
$
10,927,606

November 1—30, 2013

 
$

 

 
$
10,927,606

December 1—31, 2013

 
$

 

 
$
10,927,606

Total

 
$

 

 
$
10,927,606

On March 19, 2013, Regions' Board of Directors authorized, and Regions announced, a new $350 million common stock purchase plan, permitting repurchases from the beginning of the second quarter of 2013 through the end of the first quarter of 2014. As of December 31, 2013, Regions had repurchased approximately 36 million shares of common stock at a total cost of approximately $340 million.
Restrictions on Dividends and Repurchase of Stock
Holders of Regions common stock are only entitled to receive such dividends as Regions’ Board of Directors may declare out of funds legally available for such payments. Furthermore, holders of Regions common stock are subject to the prior dividend rights of any holders of Regions preferred stock then outstanding.
Regions understands the importance of returning capital to shareholders. Management will continue to execute the capital planning process, including evaluation of the amount of the common dividend, with the Board of Directors and in conjunction with the regulatory supervisors, subject to the Company’s results of operations. Also, Regions is a bank holding company, and its ability to declare and pay dividends is dependent on certain federal regulatory considerations, including the guidelines of the Federal Reserve regarding capital adequacy and dividends.
On November 1, 2012, Regions completed the sale of 20 million depositary shares each representing a 1/40th ownership interest in a share of its 6.375% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series A, par value $1.00 per share (“Series A Preferred Stock”), with a liquidation preference of $1,000 per share of Series A Preferred Stock (equivalent to $25 per depositary share). The terms of the Series A Preferred Stock prohibit Regions from declaring or paying any dividends on any junior series of its capital stock, including its common stock, or from repurchasing, redeeming or acquiring such junior stock, unless Regions has declared and paid full dividends on the Series A Preferred Stock for the most recently completed dividend period. The Series A Preferred Stock is redeemable at Regions’ option in whole or in part, from time to time, on any dividend payment date on or after December 15, 2017 or in whole, but not in part, at any time within 90 days following a regulatory capital treatment event (as defined in the certificate of designations establishing the Series A Preferred Stock).


33

Table of Contents


PERFORMANCE GRAPH
Set forth below is a graph comparing the yearly percentage change in the cumulative total return of Regions’ common stock against the cumulative total return of the S&P 500 Index and the S&P Banks Index for the past five years. This presentation assumes that the value of the investment in Regions’ common stock and in each index was $100 and that all dividends were reinvested.


 
 
 
Cumulative Total Return
 
12/31/2008
 
12/31/2009
 
12/31/2010
 
12/31/2011
 
12/31/2012
 
12/31/2013
Regions
$
100.00

 
$
68.58

 
$
91.26

 
$
56.52

 
$
94.29

 
$
132.21

S&P 500 Index
100.00

 
126.47

 
145.52

 
148.59

 
172.37

 
228.17

S&P Banks Index
100.00

 
93.27

 
112.95

 
101.67

 
126.57

 
179.78


Item 6. Selected Financial Data

The information required by Item 6. is set forth in Table 1 “Financial Highlights” of “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations”, which is included in Item 7. of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.


34

Table of Contents



Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations

Item 7A. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk

EXECUTIVE SUMMARY
Management believes the following sections summarize several of the most relevant matters necessary for an understanding of the financial aspects of Regions Financial Corporation’s (“Regions” or “the Company”) business, particularly regarding its 2013 results. Cross references to more detailed information regarding each topic within Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (“MD&A”) and the consolidated financial statements are included. This summary is intended to assist in understanding the information provided, but should be read in conjunction with the entire MD&A and consolidated financial statements, as well as the other sections of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
2013 Results
Regions reported net income available to common shareholders of $1.1 billion, or $0.77 per diluted share, in 2013 compared to net income available to common shareholders of $991 million, or $0.71 per diluted share, in 2012.
For 2013, net interest income (taxable-equivalent basis) from continuing operations totaled $3.3 billion compared to $3.4 billion in 2012. The net interest margin (taxable-equivalent basis) was 3.20 percent in 2013 and 3.11 percent in 2012. The decrease in net interest income (taxable-equivalent basis) was driven primarily by a decline in yields earned on earning assets that was only partially offset by a decline in rates paid on interest-bearing liabilities. The increase in net interest margin was primarily due to a reduction in earning assets and a 20 basis point decline in total funding costs.
The provision for loan losses totaled $138 million in 2013 compared to $213 million in 2012. Credit metrics, including net charge-offs and non-accrual, criticized and classified loan balances showed continued improving trends in 2013 compared to 2012. Net charge-offs totaled $716 million, or 0.96 percent of average loans, in 2013, compared to $1.0 billion, or 1.37 percent in 2012. Net charge-offs were lower across most major loan categories when comparing 2013 to the prior year, except for residential first mortgage loans which included $151 million in net charge-offs related to the transfer to held for sale of primarily accruing restructured mortgages near the end of 2013. Net charge-offs exceeded provision for loan losses for 2013 primarily due to the continued improving credit metrics, including lower levels of non-accrual loans and criticized and classified loans, as well as, problem loan resolutions, and a continuing mix shift in loans out of higher risk investor real estate and into lower risk commercial and industrial loans. The allowance for loan losses at December 31, 2013 was 1.80 percent of total loans, net of unearned income, compared to 2.59 percent at December 31, 2012. Total non-performing assets were $1.3 billion at December 31, 2013, compared to $1.9 billion at December 31, 2012.
Non-interest income from continuing operations for 2013 was $2.0 billion, compared to $2.1 billion for 2012. The decline from the prior year was driven primarily by a $127 million decrease in mortgage income. Mortgage loan production fell 18 percent from 2012 as consumer demand for mortgage loans slowed due to rising interest rates. See Table 5 "Non-Interest Income from Continuing Operations" for further details.
Total non-interest expense from continuing operations was $3.6 billion in 2013 and $3.5 billion in 2012. The 2013 period included a $58 million regulatory charge, $5 million in branch consolidation charges, and $61 million in loss on early extinguishment of debt. The 2012 period included $42 million in REIT investment early termination costs and $11 million in loss on early extinguishment of debt. See Table 6 "Non-Interest Expense from Continuing Operations" for further details.
A discussion of activity within discontinued operations is included at the end of "Operating Results" in the Management’s Discussion and Analysis section of this report.
For more information, refer to the following additional section within this Form 10-K:

"Operating Results" section of MD&A
Capital
Capital Actions
As part of its 2013 Comprehensive Capital Analysis and Review ("CCAR") submission, Regions' proposed capital plans included increasing its quarterly common stock dividend from $0.01 per share to $0.03 per share; executing up to $350 million in common share repurchases; and the execution of various liability management transactions including a tender offer for a portion

35

Table of Contents


of outstanding parent company senior notes, the issuance of new parent company senior notes, the redemption of certain preferred securities issued by Union Planters Preferred Funding Corporation ("Union Planters"), a subsidiary of Regions Bank, and the redemption of all of the Company’s remaining trust preferred securities. The Federal Reserve did not object to these plans.
Regions' Board of Directors declared the higher common stock dividend each quarter in 2013 beginning with the second quarter. Management expects to continue to execute the capital planning process, including evaluation of the amount of the common stock dividend, with the Board of Directors and in conjunction with regulatory supervisors, subject to the Company’s results of operations.
Regions’ Board of Directors also approved the share repurchase plan in March 2013. The share repurchase authority granted by the Board of Directors was available at the beginning of the second quarter of 2013 and will continue through the first quarter of 2014, but has been substantially executed. As of December 31, 2013, Regions had repurchased approximately 36 million shares of common stock at a total cost of approximately $340 million. These shares were immediately retired upon repurchase and therefore are not included in treasury stock.

In April 2013, Regions launched a tender offer for a portion of its outstanding 7.75% Senior Notes due 2014. Pursuant to the terms and conditions of the tender offer, Regions purchased $350 million aggregate principal amount of these notes. In April 2013, Regions also issued $750 million of 2.00% parent company senior notes due in 2018.

In June 2013, Regions redeemed $100 million in long-term debt consisting of preferred stock issued by Union Planters.

During the fourth quarter of 2012, Regions redeemed approximately $345 million in junior subordinated notes to affiliated trusts, which had contemporaneously issued trust preferred securities that Regions guaranteed (“trust preferred securities”). In the second and third quarters of 2013, Regions redeemed approximately $498 million and $3 million, respectively, representing all of its remaining outstanding trust preferred securities.

For more information refer to the following additional sections within this Form 10-K:

“Long-Term Borrowings” discussion in MD&A
“Stockholders’ Equity” discussion in MD&A
“Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements” discussion in MD&A
Note 2 “Variable Interest Entities” to the consolidated financial statements
Note 12 “Long-Term Borrowings” to the consolidated financial statements
Note 14 “Stockholders’ Equity and Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss)” to the consolidated financial statements
Regulatory Capital
Regions and Regions Bank are required to comply with applicable capital adequacy standards established by the Federal Reserve. Currently, under Basel I, the minimum guidelines to be considered well-capitalized for Tier I capital and Total capital are 6.0 percent and 10.0 percent, respectively. At December 31, 2013, Regions’ Tier 1 capital and Total capital ratios were 11.68 percent and 14.73 percent respectively. In addition, the Federal Reserve and banking regulators routinely supplement their assessment of capital adequacy based on a variation of Tier 1 capital, know as Tier 1 common equity. Although Federal banking regulators did not establish minimum guidelines to be considered well-capitalized under Basel I, the Tier 1 common equity ratio has been a key component in assessing capital adequacy under the CCAR process. At December 31, 2013, Regions’ Tier 1 common equity ratio (non-GAAP) was 11.21 percent.
In July 2013, Regions' and Regions Bank's primary federal regulator, the Federal Reserve, published final rules (the “Basel III Capital Rules”) establishing a new comprehensive capital framework for U.S. banking organizations. The Basel III Capital Rules substantially revise the risk-based capital requirements applicable to bank holding companies and depository institutions, including Regions and Regions Bank, compared to the current U.S. risk-based capital rules (Basel I). The Basel III Capital Rules define the components of capital and address other issues affecting the numerator in banking institutions' regulatory capital ratios. The Basel III Capital Rules also address risk weights and other issues affecting the denominator in banking institutions' regulatory capital ratios and replace the existing risk-weighting approach with a more risk-sensitive approach. The Basel III Capital Rules are expected to be effective for Regions and Regions Bank on January 1, 2015 (subject to a phase-in period).

The Basel III Capital Rules officially define the Tier 1 common equity ratio (referred to in the rule as “Common Equity Tier 1” (“CET1”). When fully phased in on January 1, 2019, the minimum ratio of CET1 to risk-weighted assets will be at least 4.5%, plus a 2.5% “capital conservation buffer” (which is added to the 4.5% CET1 ratio as that buffer is phased in, effectively

36

Table of Contents


resulting in a minimum ratio of CET1 to risk-weighted assets of at least 7.0% upon full implementation). Regions’ understanding of the framework is evolving and will likely change as analysis and discussions with regulators continue. Based on its current understanding, Regions estimates its CET1 ratio (non-GAAP) under Basel III at December 31, 2013 to be 10.58 percent . Similarly, Regions will be subject to the “modified” liquidity coverage ratio (“LCR”) updated by the Federal Reserve via their NPR (notice of proposed rule making) released in October 2013. Based on Regions’ current understanding and interpretation of the rules, full implementation is expected to be on a phased-in approach beginning in 2015 with full compliance to be reached in 2017. The Company anticipates being fully compliant with the LCR requirements upon finalization and implementation. However, should Regions’ cash position or investment mix change in the future, Regions’ ability to meet the liquidity coverage ratio may be impacted. The comment period on these proposed rules ended on January 31, 2014.

For more information refer to the following additional sections within this Form 10-K:

“Supervision and Regulation” discussion within Item 1. Business
Table 2 - “GAAP to Non-GAAP reconciliation”
Bank Regulatory Capital Requirements section of MD&A
Note 13 “Regulatory Capital Requirements and Restrictions” to the consolidated financial statements
Loan Portfolio and Credit
The Company grew total loans at December 31, 2013 by $614 million compared to year-end 2012. Loan growth was led by the commercial and industrial portfolio which increased $2.7 billion in 2013 and the indirect portfolio which grew $739 million in 2013. The combined growth of these two portfolios more than offset declines in commercial real estate, investor real estate, residential first mortgage and home equity loans. This was the first year the Company reported net loan growth since 2008. The economy has been and will be the primary factor which influences Regions’ loan portfolio. Beginning in 2012 and continuing in 2013, the economy began to modestly improve. The rate of economic growth improved in 2012, but over the first half of 2013 growth was impaired by increases in payroll tax rates, higher tax rates on investment income, and the implementation of the sequestration spending cuts by the federal government. Over the second half of 2013, however, the U.S. economy grew at a rate in excess of 3.0 percent and began 2014 with positive momentum. The commercial and consumer deleveraging that impacted the industry, particularly Regions, in recent years appears to be abating. The Company’s investor real estate portfolio, although down year-over-year, appears to be reaching an inflection point. The December 31, 2013 investor real estate portfolio compared to the year-end 2012 balances were down approximately $972 million, compared to a decline of $3.0 billion in 2012. The Company has experienced success and growth in its commercial and industrial loan portfolio as described above. Specialized lending areas, such as real estate corporate banking, asset based lending, healthcare and technology, have been the main contributors. This growth has helped to improve the Company’s loan mix away from its historical real estate focus. Total commercial real estate, investor real estate, residential first mortgage and home equity loans (all real estate based lending) comprised approximately 54 percent of total loans at December 31, 2013 compared to approximately 58 percent at December 31, 2012 and approximately 71 percent at December 31, 2008. Home equity and residential first mortgage loans declined $1.3 billion on an ending basis in 2013. This decrease was partially offset by growth in indirect lending and consumer credit cards. Indirect lending grew $739 million or 32 percent in 2013. Growth in indirect lending was primarily due to an increase in the number of dealer relationships. Growth in consumer credit cards was primarily due to an increase in the number of active credit card holders. Management’s expectation for 2014 loan growth is in the 3 percent to 5 percent range.
Credit quality metrics continued to improve in 2013. Total non-performing assets declined 32 percent to $1.3 billion in 2013 compared to 2012. Including troubled debt restructurings (“TDRs”) held for sale, total TDRs declined 23 percent to approximately $2.8 billion in 2013 compared to 2012. Total commercial and investor real estate criticized and classified loans declined approximately $1.5 billion or 33 percent in 2013 compared to 2012. These favorable trends contributed to a 31 percent decline in net charge-offs and a 35 percent decline in provision expense in 2013 compared to 2012. The allowance for loan losses to total loans decreased to 1.80 percent at December 31, 2013 compared to 2.59 percent at December 31, 2012. The coverage ratio of allowance for loan losses to non-performing loans was 1.24x at December 31, 2013 compared to 1.14x at December 31, 2012.
For more information, refer to the following additional sections within this Form 10-K:

“Allowance for Credit Losses” discussion within “Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates” in MD&A
“Provision for Loan Losses” discussion within the “Operating Results” section of MD&A
“Loans,” “Allowance for Credit Losses,” “Troubled Debt Restructurings” and “Non-performing Assets” discussions within the “Balance Sheet Analysis” section of MD&A
“Credit Risk” discussion within the “Risk Management” section of MD&A
Note 1 "Summary of Significant Accounting Policies" to the consolidated financial statements
Note 5 "Loans" to the consolidated financial statements

37

Table of Contents


Note 6 “Allowance for Credit Losses” to the consolidated financial statements
Net Interest Income, Margin and Interest Rate Risk
In 2013, the net interest margin expanded to 3.20 percent from 3.11 percent in 2012, largely due to a mix shift from time deposits to lower cost deposit products, resulting in deposit costs decreasing to 15 basis points in 2013 from 30 basis points in 2012. Also, contributing to the margin expansion were the liability management actions described in the Capital Actions discussion above. Taxable-equivalent net interest income decreased $34 million to $3.3 billion in 2013, due primarily to a decline in yields earned on earning assets that was only partially offset by a decline in rates paid on interest-bearing liabilities. Despite the continued improvements in deposit costs and mix, the margin and net interest income continue to be pressured by a sustained low interest rate, low growth environment. Reductions in average securities and loans were the main contributors to the decline in average earning assets and net interest income. The Company’s securities yield declined 17 basis points driven primarily by management’s strategic decision to reduce the size of the portfolio along with reinvestment of proceeds into lower yielding securities. Loan yields declined 16 basis points primarily due to new loan originations at lower rates, partially offset by a reduction in non-accrual loans. The Company did experience modest loan growth in 2013 on an ending basis, and management is optimistic for continued modest growth in 2014. If economic conditions and interest rates prevalent at year-end 2013 remain unchanged in 2014, and the Company achieves the 3 percent to 5 percent forecasted loan growth, management believes the net interest margin will remain relatively stable. Regions’ balance sheet is in a moderately asset sensitive position and should benefit from a rise in either long-term or short-term rates. If economic conditions were to improve more rapidly, thereby resulting in a rise in interest rates, both net interest income and the resulting net interest margin would respond favorably.
For more information, refer to the following additional sections within this Form 10-K:

“Net Interest Income and Margin” discussion within the “Operating Results” section of MD&A
“Interest Rate Risk” discussion within “Risk Management” section of MD&A
Liquidity
At the end of 2013, Regions Bank had over $3.6 billion in cash on deposit with the Federal Reserve, the loan-to-deposit ratio was 81 percent and cash and cash equivalents at the parent company totaled $1.2 billion. Regions revised its liquidity policy related to minimum holding company cash requirements during the fourth quarter of 2013. The new policy requires the holding company to maintain cash sufficient to cover the greater of (1) 18 months of debt service and other cash needs or (2) a minimum cash balance of $500 million. At December 31, 2013, the Company’s borrowing capacity with the Federal Reserve Discount Window was $22.2 billion based on available collateral. Borrowing capacity with the Federal Home Loan Bank (“FHLB”) was $9.6 billion based on available collateral at the same date. Additionally, the Company has approximately $10.5 billion of unencumbered liquid securities available for pledging or repurchase agreements. The Board of Directors has also approved a bank note program which would allow Regions Bank to issue up to $5 billion in aggregate principal amount of bank notes outstanding at any one time. As of December 31, 2013, no issues have been made under this program.
See the "Regulatory Capital" section above for a full discussion of the LCR.
For more information, refer to the following additional sections within this Form 10-K:

“Supervision and Regulation” discussion within Item 1. Business
“Short-Term Borrowings” discussion within the “Balance Sheet Analysis” section of MD&A
“Long-Term Borrowings” discussion within the “Balance Sheet Analysis” section of MD&A
“Regulatory Capital Requirements” discussion in MD&A
“Liquidity” discussion within the “Risk Management” section of MD&A
Note 11 “Short-Term Borrowings” to the consolidated financial statements
Note 12 “Long-Term Borrowings” to the consolidated financial statements

GENERAL
The following discussion and financial information is presented to aid in understanding Regions’ financial position and results of operations. The emphasis of this discussion will be on continuing operations for the years 2013, 2012 and 2011; in addition, financial information for prior years will also be presented when appropriate. Certain amounts in prior year presentations have been reclassified to conform to the current year presentation, except as otherwise noted.

38

Table of Contents


Regions’ profitability, like that of many other financial institutions, is dependent on its ability to generate revenue from net interest income and non-interest income sources. Net interest income is the difference between the interest income Regions receives on interest-earning assets, such as loans and securities, and the interest expense Regions pays on interest-bearing liabilities, principally deposits and borrowings. Regions’ net interest income is impacted by the size and mix of its balance sheet components and the interest rate spread between interest earned on its assets and interest paid on its liabilities. Non-interest income includes fees from service charges on deposit accounts, mortgage servicing and secondary marketing, investment management and trust activities, insurance activities, capital markets and other customer services which Regions provides. Results of operations are also affected by the provision for loan losses and non-interest expenses such as salaries and employee benefits, occupancy, professional fees, deposit administrative fees, other real estate owned and other operating expenses, as well as income taxes.
Economic conditions, competition, new legislation and related rules impacting regulation of the financial services industry and the monetary and fiscal policies of the Federal government significantly affect most, if not all, financial institutions, including Regions. Lending and deposit activities and fee income generation are influenced by levels of business spending and investment, consumer income, consumer spending and savings, capital market activities, and competition among financial institutions, as well as customer preferences, interest rate conditions and prevailing market rates on competing products in Regions’ market areas.
Regions’ business strategy has been and continues to be focused on providing a competitive mix of products and services, delivering quality customer service and maintaining a branch distribution network with offices in convenient locations.
Dispositions
On January 11, 2012, Regions entered into a stock purchase agreement to sell Morgan Keegan and related affiliates to Raymond James. The sale closed on April 2, 2012. Regions Investment Management, Inc. (formerly known as Morgan Asset Management, Inc.) and Regions Trust were not included in the sale. They are now included in the Wealth Management segment.
Results of operations for the entities sold are presented separately as discontinued operations for all periods presented on the consolidated statements of operations. Other expenses related to the transaction are also included in discontinued operations. Refer to Note 3 “Discontinued Operations” and Note 23 “Commitments, Contingencies, and Guarantees” for further details.
Business Segments
Regions provides traditional commercial, retail and mortgage banking services, as well as other financial services in the fields of asset management, trust, insurance and other specialty financing. Regions carries out its strategies and derives its profitability from the three reportable business segments: Business Services, Consumer Services, and Wealth Management, with the remainder split between Discontinued Operations and Other. During the third quarter of 2012, Regions reorganized its internal management structure and, accordingly, its segment reporting structure. Historically, Regions’ primary business segment was Banking/Treasury, representing the Company’s banking network (including the Consumer & Commercial Banking function along with the Treasury function). Other segments included Investment Banking/Brokerage/Trust and Insurance. During the second quarter of 2012, Regions consummated the sale of Morgan Keegan (the primary component of Investment Banking/Brokerage/Trust). Shortly thereafter, Regions announced organizational changes to better integrate and execute the Company’s strategic priorities across all business groups and geographies. As a result, Regions revised its reportable segments.
Business Services
The Business Services segment represents the Company’s commercial banking functions including commercial and industrial, commercial real estate and investor real estate lending. This segment also includes equipment lease financing. Business Services customers include corporate, middle market, small business and commercial real estate developers and investors. Corresponding deposit products related to these types of customers are included in this segment. In 2013, the Business Services reportable segment contributed $705 million of net income.
Consumer Services
The Consumer Services segment represents the Company’s branch network, including consumer banking products and services related to residential first mortgages, home equity lines and loans, indirect loans, consumer credit cards and other consumer loans, as well as the corresponding deposit relationships. These services are also provided through alternative channels such as the internet and telephone banking. In 2013, the Consumer Services reportable segment contributed $346 million of net income.

Wealth Management
The Wealth Management segment offers individuals, businesses, governmental institutions and non-profit entities a wide range of solutions to help protect, grow and transfer wealth. Offerings include credit related products, trust and investment

39

Table of Contents


management, asset management, retirement and savings solutions, estate planning and commercial insurance products. Wealth Management activities contributed $55 million of net income in 2013.
See Note 22 “Business Segment Information” to the consolidated financial statements for further information on Regions’ business segments.


40

Table of Contents


Table 1—Financial Highlights
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
2010
 
2009
 
(In millions, except per share data)
EARNINGS SUMMARY
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest income
$
3,646

 
$
3,903

 
$
4,252

 
$
4,637

 
$
5,277

Interest expense
384

 
603

 
842

 
1,248

 
1,984

Net interest income
3,262

 
3,300

 
3,410

 
3,389

 
3,293

Provision for loan losses
138

 
213

 
1,530

 
2,863

 
3,541

Net interest income (loss) after provision for loan losses
3,124

 
3,087

 
1,880

 
526

 
(248
)
Non-interest income
2,019

 
2,100

 
2,143

 
2,489

 
2,765

Non-interest expense
3,556

 
3,526

 
3,862

 
3,859

 
3,785

Income (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes
1,587

 
1,661

 
161

 
(844
)
 
(1,268
)
Income tax expense (benefit)
452

 
482

 
(28
)
 
(376
)
 
(194
)
Income (loss) from continuing operations
1,135

 
1,179

 
189

 
(468
)
 
(1,074
)
Income (loss) from discontinued operations before income taxes
(24
)
 
(99
)
 
(408
)
 
(41
)
 
66

Income tax expense (benefit)
(11
)
 
(40
)
 
(4
)
 
30

 
23

Income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of tax
(13
)
 
(59
)
 
(404
)
 
(71
)
 
43

Net income (loss)
$
1,122

 
$
1,120

 
$
(215
)
 
$
(539
)
 
$
(1,031
)
Income (loss) from continuing operations available to common shareholders
$
1,103

 
$
1,050

 
$
(25
)
 
$
(692
)
 
$
(1,304
)
Net income (loss) available to common shareholders
$
1,090

 
$
991

 
$
(429
)
 
$
(763
)
 
$
(1,261
)
Earnings (loss) per common share from continuing operations – basic
$
0.79

 
$
0.76

 
$
(0.02
)
 
$
(0.56
)
 
$
(1.32
)
Earnings (loss) per common share from continuing operations – diluted
0.78

 
0.76

 
(0.02
)
 
(0.56
)
 
(1.32
)
Earnings (loss) per common share – basic
0.78

 
0.72

 
(0.34
)
 
(0.62
)
 
(1.27
)
Earnings (loss) per common share – diluted
0.77

 
0.71

 
(0.34
)
 
(0.62
)
 
(1.27
)
Return on average tangible common stockholders’ equity (non-GAAP)(1)
10.80
%
 
10.69
%
 
(5.51
)%
 
(9.29
)%
 
(14.92
)%
Return on average assets from continuing operations (GAAP)
0.94

 
0.86

 
(0.02
)
 
(0.52
)
 
(0.93
)
BALANCE SHEET SUMMARY
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At year-end—Consolidated
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Loans, net of unearned income
$
74,609

 
$
73,995

 
$
77,594

 
$
82,864

 
$
90,674

Allowance for loan losses
(1,341
)
 
(1,919
)
 
(2,745
)
 
(3,185
)
 
(3,114
)
Assets
117,396

 
121,347

 
127,050

 
132,351

 
142,318

Deposits
92,453

 
95,474

 
95,627

 
94,614

 
98,680

Long-term debt
4,830

 
5,861

 
8,110

 
13,190

 
18,464

Stockholders’ equity
15,768

 
15,499

 
16,499

 
16,734

 
17,881

Average balances—Continuing Operations
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Loans, net of unearned income
$
74,924

 
$
76,035

 
$
80,673

 
$
86,660

 
$
94,523

Assets
117,805

 
122,182

 
126,719

 
132,720

 
139,468

Deposits
92,646

 
95,330

 
95,671

 
96,489

 
94,612

Long-term debt
5,206

 
6,694

 
11,240

 
15,489

 
18,501

Stockholders’ equity
15,502

 
15,035

 
15,350

 
15,916

 
16,224

SELECTED RATIOS
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Allowance for loan losses as a percentage of loans, net of unearned income
1.80
%
 
2.59
%
 
3.54
 %
 
3.84
 %
 
3.43
 %
Tier 1 capital
11.68

 
12.00

 
13.28

 
12.40

 
11.54

Tier 1 common risk-based ratio (non-GAAP) (1)
11.21

 
10.84

 
8.51

 
7.85

 
7.15

Total risk-based capital
14.73

 
15.38

 
16.99

 
16.35

 
15.78

Leverage
10.03

 
9.65

 
9.91

 
9.30

 
8.90

Tangible common stockholders’ equity to tangible assets
(non-GAAP) (1)
9.24

 
8.63

 
6.58

 
6.04

 
6.22

Adjusted efficiency ratio (non-GAAP) (1)
65.42

 
64.42

 
64.56

 
67.74

 
67.88


41

Table of Contents


 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
2010
 
2009
 
(In millions, except per share data)
COMMON STOCK DATA
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash dividends declared per common share
$
0.10

 
$
0.04

 
$
0.04

 
$
0.04

 
$
0.13

Stockholders’ common equity per share
11.12

 
10.63

 
10.39

 
10.63

 
11.97

Tangible common book value per share (non-GAAP)(1)
7.54

 
7.11

 
6.37

 
6.09

 
7.11

Market value at year-end
9.89

 
7.13

 
4.30

 
7.00

 
5.29

Market price range: (2)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
High
10.52

 
7.73

 
8.09

 
9.33

 
9.07

Low
7.13

 
4.21

 
2.82

 
5.12

 
2.35

Total trading volume
3,962

 
5,282

 
5,204

 
6,381

 
8,747

Dividend payout ratio
12.99

 
5.63

 
 NM
 
 NM
 
 NM
Shareholders of record at year-end (actual)
63,815

 
67,574

 
73,659

 
76,996

 
81,166

Weighted-average number of common shares outstanding
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Basic
1,395

 
1,381

 
1,258

 
1,227

 
989

Diluted
1,410

 
1,387

 
1,258

 
1,227

 
989

________
NM—Not meaningful
(1)
See Table 2 for GAAP to non-GAAP reconciliations.
(2)
High and low market prices are based on intraday sales prices.

NON-GAAP MEASURES
The table below presents computations of certain financial measures, which exclude certain significant items that are included in the financial results presented in accordance with GAAP. These non-GAAP financial measures include “fee income ratio”, “efficiency ratio”, “return on average tangible common stockholders’ equity”, average and end of period “tangible common stockholders’ equity”, “Tier 1 common equity”, and “Basel III Tier 1 common equity” and related ratios. Regions believes that expressing certain financial measures excluding these significant items provides a meaningful base for period-to-period comparisons, which management believes should assist investors in analyzing the operating results of the Company and predicting future performance. These non-GAAP financial measures are also used by management to assess the performance of Regions’ business because management does not consider the activities related to the adjustments to be indications of ongoing operations. Regions believes that presentation of these non-GAAP financial measures will permit investors to assess the performance of the Company on the same basis as that applied by management. Management and the Board of Directors utilize these non-GAAP financial measures as follows:

Preparation of Regions’ operating budgets
Monthly financial performance reporting
Monthly close-out reporting of consolidated results (management only)
Presentations to investors of Company performance
The adjusted efficiency ratio (non-GAAP), which is a measure of productivity, is generally calculated as non-interest expense divided by total revenue on a taxable-equivalent basis. The adjusted fee income ratio (non-GAAP) is generally calculated as non-interest income divided by total revenue. Management uses these ratios to monitor performance and believes these measures provide meaningful information to investors. Non-interest expense (GAAP) is presented excluding adjustments to arrive at adjusted non-interest expense (non-GAAP), which is the numerator for the adjusted efficiency ratio. Non-interest income (GAAP) is presented excluding adjustments to arrive at adjusted non-interest income (non-GAAP), which is the numerator for the adjusted fee income ratio. Net interest income on a taxable-equivalent basis (GAAP) and non-interest income (GAAP) are added together to arrive at total revenue (GAAP). Adjustments are made to arrive at adjusted total revenue (non-GAAP), which is the denominator for the adjusted fee income and adjusted efficiency ratios.
Tangible common stockholders’ equity ratios have become a focus of some investors in analyzing the capital position of the Company absent the effects of intangible assets and preferred stock. Traditionally, the Federal Reserve and other banking regulatory bodies have assessed a bank’s capital adequacy based on Tier 1 capital, the calculation of which is codified in federal banking regulations. In connection with the Federal Reserve’s CCAR process, these regulators are supplementing their assessment of the capital adequacy of a bank based on a variation of Tier 1 capital, known as Tier 1 common equity. Analysts and banking regulators have assessed Regions’ capital adequacy using the tangible common stockholders’ equity and/or the Tier 1 common equity measure. Because tangible common stockholders’ equity and Tier 1 common equity are not formally defined by GAAP, these measures are considered to be non-GAAP financial measures and other entities may calculate them differently than Regions’ disclosed calculations. Since analysts and banking regulators may assess Regions’ capital adequacy using tangible common stockholders’ equity and Tier

42

Table of Contents


1 common equity, Regions believes that it is useful to provide investors the ability to assess Regions’ capital adequacy on these same bases.
Tier 1 common equity is often expressed as a percentage of risk-weighted assets. Under the current risk-based capital framework, a bank’s balance sheet assets and credit equivalent amounts of off-balance sheet items are assigned to one of four broad risk categories. The aggregated dollar amount in each category is then multiplied by the risk weighting assigned to that category. The resulting weighted values from each of the four categories are added together and this sum is the risk-weighted assets total that comprises the denominator of certain risk-based capital ratios. Tier 1 capital is then divided by this denominator (risk-weighted assets) to determine the Tier 1 capital ratio. Adjustments are made to Tier 1 capital to arrive at Tier 1 common equity (non-GAAP). Tier 1 common equity is also divided by the risk-weighted assets to determine the Tier 1 common equity ratio (non-GAAP). The amounts disclosed as risk-weighted assets are calculated consistent with banking regulatory requirements.
Regions currently calculates its risk-based capital ratios under guidelines adopted by the Federal Reserve based on the 1988 Capital Accord (“Basel I”) of the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision (the “Basel Committee”). In December 2010, the Basel Committee released its final framework for Basel III, which will strengthen international capital and liquidity regulations. When fully phased-in, Basel III will increase capital requirements through higher minimum capital levels as well as through increases in risk-weights for certain exposures. Additionally, the final Basel III rules place greater emphasis on common equity. In July 2013, the Federal Reserve released final rules detailing the U.S. implementation of Basel III. Regions, as a non-advanced approaches bank, will begin transitioning to the Basel III framework in January 2015 subject to a phase-in period extending through January 2019. Regions is currently evaluating the impact of the final Basel III rules. Accordingly, the calculations provided below are estimates. Because the Basel III implementation regulations will not be fully phased-in until 2019, are not formally defined by GAAP, and because the calculations currently include the Company's interpretations of the requirements including informal feedback received through the regulatory process and are therefore likely to change as clarifying guidance becomes available, these measures are considered to be non-GAAP financial measures, and other entities may calculate them differently from Regions’ disclosed calculations. Since analysts and banking regulators may assess Regions’ capital adequacy using the Basel III framework, Regions believes that it is useful to provide investors information enabling them to assess Regions’ capital adequacy on the same basis.
Non-GAAP financial measures have inherent limitations, are not required to be uniformly applied and are not audited. Although these non-GAAP financial measures are frequently used by stakeholders in the evaluation of a company, they have limitations as analytical tools, and should not be considered in isolation, or as a substitute for analyses of results as reported under GAAP. In particular, a measure of earnings that excludes selected items does not represent the amount that effectively accrues directly to stockholders.

The following tables provide: 1) a reconciliation of non-interest expense from continuing operations (GAAP) to adjusted non-interest expense (non-GAAP), 2) a reconciliation of non-interest income from continuing operations (GAAP) to adjusted non-interest income (non-GAAP), 3) a computation of adjusted total revenue (non-GAAP), 4) a computation of the adjusted efficiency ratio (non-GAAP), 5) a computation of the adjusted fee income ratio (non-GAAP), 6) a reconciliation of average and ending stockholders’ equity (GAAP) to average and ending tangible common stockholders’ equity (non-GAAP) and calculations of related ratios (non-GAAP), 7) a reconciliation of stockholders’ equity (GAAP) to Tier 1 capital (regulatory) and to Tier 1 common equity (non-GAAP) and calculations of related ratios, and 8) a reconciliation of stockholders’ equity (GAAP) to Basel III Tier 1 common equity (non-GAAP) and calculation of the related ratio based on Regions’ current understanding of the Basel III requirements. The estimate at December 31, 2013 is based on the final rule released in July 2013 and the estimate at December 31, 2012 is based on the U.S. Notices of Proposed Rulemaking released in June 2012.


43

Table of Contents


Table 2—GAAP to Non-GAAP Reconciliation
 
 
Year Ended December 31
 
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
2010
 
2009
 
 
(In millions, except per share data)
INCOME (LOSS)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net income (loss) (GAAP)
 
$
1,122

 
$
1,120

 
$
(215
)
 
$
(539
)
 
$
(1,031
)
Preferred dividends and accretion (GAAP)
 
(32
)
 
(129
)
 
(214
)
 
(224
)
 
(230
)
Net income (loss) available to common shareholders (GAAP)
A
$
1,090

 
$
991

 
$
(429
)
 
$
(763
)
 
$
(1,261
)
FEE INCOME AND EFFICIENCY RATIOS
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Non-interest expense from continuing operations (GAAP)
 
$
3,556

 
$
3,526

 
$
3,862

 
$
3,859

 
$
3,785

Significant items:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Loss on early extinguishment of debt
 
(61
)
 
(11
)
 

 
(108
)
 

Goodwill impairment
 

 

 
(253
)
 

 

FDIC special assessment
 

 

 

 

 
(64
)
Regulatory charge(1)
 
(58
)
 

 

 
(75
)
 

Securities impairment, net
 

 
(2
)
 
(2
)
 
(2
)
 
(75
)
Branch consolidation and property and equipment charges
 
(5
)
 

 
(75
)
 
(8
)
 
(53
)
REIT investment early termination costs(2)
 

 
(42
)
 

 

 

Adjusted non-interest expense (non-GAAP)
B
$
3,432

 
$
3,471

 
$
3,532

 
$
3,666

 
$
3,593

Net interest income from continuing operations (GAAP)
 
$
3,262

 
$
3,300

 
$
3,410

 
$
3,389

 
$
3,293

Taxable-equivalent adjustment
 
54

 
50

 
35

 
32

 
32

Net interest income from continuing operations, taxable-equivalent basis
 
3,316

 
3,350

 
3,445

 
3,421

 
3,325

Non-interest income from continuing operations (GAAP)
 
2,019

 
2,100

 
2,143

 
2,489

 
2,765

Significant items:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities gains, net
 
(26
)
 
(48
)
 
(112
)
 
(394
)
 
(69
)
Visa-related gains
 

 

 

 

 
(80
)
Leveraged lease termination gains, net
 
(39
)
 
(14
)
 
(8
)
 
(78
)
 
(587
)
Gain on early extinguishment of debt
 

 

 

 

 
(61
)
Loss (gain) on sale of mortgage loans
 

 

 
3

 
(26
)
 

Gain on sale of other assets(3)
 
(24
)
 

 

 

 

Adjusted non-interest income (non-GAAP)
C
1,930

 
2,038

 
2,026

 
1,991

 
1,968

Adjusted total revenue (non-GAAP)
D
$
5,246

 
$
5,388

 
$
5,471

 
$
5,412

 
$
5,293

Adjusted efficiency ratio (non-GAAP)
B/D
65.42
%
 
64.42
%
 
64.56
 %
 
67.74
 %
 
67.88
 %
Adjusted fee income ratio (non-GAAP)
C/D
36.79
%
 
37.82
%
 
37.03
 %
 
36.79
 %
 
37.18
 %
RETURN ON AVERAGE TANGIBLE COMMON STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Average stockholders’ equity (GAAP)
 
$
15,504

 
$
15,246

 
$
16,927

 
$
17,444

 
$
17,773

Less:  Average intangible assets (GAAP)
 
5,136

 
5,210

 
5,965

 
6,003

 
6,122

Average deferred tax liability related to intangibles (GAAP)
 
(188
)
 
(195
)
 
(220
)
 
(255
)
 
(286
)
Average preferred equity (GAAP)
 
464

 
960

 
3,398

 
3,479

 
3,487

Average tangible common stockholders’ equity (non-GAAP)
E
$
10,092

 
$
9,271

 
$
7,784

 
$
8,217

 
$
8,450

Return on average tangible common stockholders’ equity (non-GAAP)
A/E
10.80
%
 
10.69
%
 
(5.51
)%
 
(9.29
)%
 
(14.92
)%


44

Table of Contents


 
 
Year Ended December 31
 
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
2010
 
2009
 
 
(In millions, except share data)
TANGIBLE COMMON RATIOS
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Ending stockholders’ equity (GAAP)
 
$
15,768

 
$
15,499

 
$
16,499

 
$
16,734

 
$
17,881

Less: Ending intangible assets (GAAP)
 
5,111

 
5,161

 
5,265

 
5,946

 
6,060

  Ending deferred tax liability related to intangibles (GAAP)
 
(188
)
 
(191
)
 
(200
)
 
(240
)
 
(269
)
  Ending preferred equity (GAAP)
 
450

 
482

 
3,419

 
3,380

 
3,602

Ending tangible common stockholders’ equity (non-GAAP)
F
$
10,395

 
$
10,047

 
$
8,015

 
$
7,648

 
$
8,488

Ending total assets (GAAP)
 
$
117,396

 
$
121,347

 
$
127,050

 
$
132,351

 
$
142,318

Less: Ending intangible assets (GAAP)
 
5,111

 
5,161

 
5,265

 
5,946

 
6,060

  Ending deferred tax liability related to intangibles (GAAP)
 
(188
)
 
(191
)
 
(200
)
 
(240
)
 
(269
)
Ending tangible assets (non-GAAP)
G
$
112,473

 
$
116,377

 
$
121,985

 
$
126,645

 
$
136,527

End of period shares outstanding
H
1,378

 
1,413

 
1,259

 
1,256

 
1,193

Tangible common stockholders’ equity to tangible assets (non-GAAP)
F/G
9.24
%
 
8.63
%
 
6.58
%
 
6.04
%
 
6.22
%
Tangible common book value per share (non-GAAP)
F/H
$
7.54

 
$
7.11

 
$
6.37

 
$
6.09

 
$
7.11

TIER 1 COMMON RISK-BASED RATIO
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Stockholders’ equity (GAAP)
 
$
15,768

 
$
15,499

 
$
16,499

 
$
16,734

 
$
17,881

Accumulated other comprehensive (income) loss
 
319

 
(65
)
 
69

 
260

 
(130
)
Non-qualifying goodwill and intangibles
 
(4,798
)
 
(4,826
)
 
(4,900
)
 
(5,706
)
 
(5,792
)
Disallowed deferred tax assets(4)
 

 
(35
)
 
(432
)
 
(424
)
 
(947
)
Disallowed servicing assets
 
(31
)
 
(33
)
 
(35
)
 
(27
)
 
(25
)
Qualifying non-controlling interests
 

 
93

 
92

 
92

 
91

Qualifying trust preferred securities
 

 
501

 
846

 
846

 
846

Tier 1 capital (regulatory)
 
11,258

 
11,134

 
12,139

 
11,775

 
11,924

Qualifying non-controlling interests
 

 
(93
)
 
(92
)
 
(92
)
 
(91
)
Qualifying trust preferred securities
 

 
(501
)
 
(846
)
 
(846
)
 
(846
)
Preferred stock
 
(450
)
 
(482
)
 
(3,419
)
 
(3,380
)
 
(3,602
)
Tier 1 common equity (non-GAAP)
I
$
10,808

 
$
10,058

 
$
7,782

 
$
7,457

 
$
7,385

Risk-weighted assets (regulatory)
J
$
96,416

 
$
92,811

 
$
91,449

 
$
94,966

 
$
103,330

Tier 1 common risk-based ratio (non-GAAP)
I/J
11.21
%
 
10.84
%
 
8.51
%
 
7.85
%
 
7.15
%
BASEL III TIER 1 COMMON RATIO(5)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Stockholders’ equity (GAAP)
 
$
15,768

 
$
15,499

 
 
 
 
 
 
Non-qualifying goodwill and intangibles(6)
 
(4,922
)
 
(4,968
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
Proposed Adjustments
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Adjustments, including other comprehensive income related to cash flow hedges, disallowed deferred tax assets, threshold deductions and other adjustments
 

 
(298
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
Final Rules Adjustments
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Adjustments, including all components of accumulated other comprehensive income, disallowed deferred tax assets, threshold deductions and other adjustments
 
130

 

 
 
 
 
 
 
Preferred stock
 
(450
)
 
(482
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
Basel III Tier 1 common equity (non-GAAP)
K
$
10,526

 
$
9,751

 
 
 
 
 
 
Basel III risk-weighted assets (non-GAAP)(7)
L
$
99,483

 
$
109,941

 
 
 
 
 
 
Basel III Tier 1 common ratio (non-GAAP)
K/L
10.58
%
 
8.87
%
 
 
 
 
 
 

45

Table of Contents



 _________
(1)
In the fourth quarter of 2013, Regions recorded a non-tax deductible charge of $58 million related to previously disclosed inquires from government authorities concerning matters from 2009. Regions is in discussions with banking supervisors to resolve their inquiries on these matters. In the second quarter of 2010, Regions recorded a $200 million charge to account for a probable, reasonably estimable loss related to a pending settlement of regulatory matters. $75 million of the regulatory charge related to continuing operations.
(2)
In the fourth quarter of 2012, Regions entered into an agreement with a third party investor in Regions Asset Management Company, Inc., pursuant to which the investment was fully redeemed. This resulted in extinguishing a $203 million liability, including accrued, unpaid interest, as well as incurring early termination costs of approximately $42 million on a pre-tax basis ($38 million after tax).
(3)
In the third quarter of 2013, Regions recorded a $24 million gain on sale of a non-core portion of a Wealth Management business.
(4)
Taxable income from the two previous tax years and one year of projected future taxable income may be applied in calculating deferred tax assets for regulatory capital purposes.
(5)
The 2013 estimate is based on the final rule released in July 2013. The 2012 estimate is based on the June 2012 U.S. Notices of Proposed Rulemaking.
(6)
Under Basel III, regulatory capital must be reduced by purchased credit card relationship intangible assets. These assets are partially allowed in Basel I capital.
(7)
Regions continues to develop systems and internal controls to precisely calculate risk-weighted assets as required by Basel III. The amount included above is a reasonable approximation, based on our understanding of the requirements.

CRITICAL ACCOUNTING ESTIMATES AND RELATED POLICIES
In preparing financial information, management is required to make significant estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets, liabilities, income and expenses for the periods shown. The accounting principles followed by Regions and the methods of applying these principles conform with accounting principles generally accepted in the U.S. and general banking practices. Estimates and assumptions most significant to Regions are related primarily to the allowance for credit losses, fair value measurements, intangible assets (goodwill and other identifiable intangible assets), mortgage servicing rights and income taxes, and are summarized in the following discussion and in the notes to the consolidated financial statements.
Allowance for Credit Losses
The allowance for credit losses (“allowance”) consists of two components: the allowance for loan and lease losses and the reserve for unfunded credit commitments. The allowance represents management’s estimate of probable credit losses inherent in the loan and credit commitment portfolios as of period end.
The allowance is sensitive to a variety of internal factors, such as modifications in the mix and level of loan balances outstanding, portfolio performance and assigned risk ratings, as well as external factors, such as the general health of the economy, as evidenced by changes in real estate demand and values, interest rates, unemployment rates, bankruptcy filings, fluctuations in the gross domestic product ("GDP"), and the effects of weather and natural disasters such as droughts and hurricanes. Management considers these variables and all available information when establishing the final level of the allowance. These variables and others have the ability to result in actual loan losses that differ from the originally estimated amounts.
Management’s estimate of the allowance for the commercial and investor real estate portfolio segments could be affected by estimates of losses inherent in various product types as a result of fluctuations in the general economy, developments within a particular industry, or changes in an individual’s credit due to factors particular to that credit, such as competition, management or business performance. For non-accrual commercial and investor real estate loans equal to or greater than $2.5 million, the allowance for loan losses is based on note-level evaluation considering the facts and circumstances specific to each borrower. For all other commercial and investor real estate loans, the allowance for loan losses is based on statistical models using a probability of default (“PD”) and a loss given default (“LGD”). Historical default information for similar loans is used as an input for the statistical model. A 5 percent increase in the PD for non-defaulted accounts and a 5 percent increase in the LGD for all accounts would result in an increase to estimated losses of approximately $69 million.
For residential real estate mortgages, home equity lending and other consumer-related loans, individual products are reviewed on a group basis or in loan pools (e.g., residential real estate mortgage pools). Losses can be affected by such factors as collateral value, loss severity, the economy and other uncontrollable factors. A 5 percent increase or decrease in the estimated loss rates on these loans would change estimated inherent losses by approximately $18 million.
The pro forma inherent loss analysis presented above demonstrates the sensitivity of the allowance to key assumptions. This sensitivity analysis does not reflect an expected outcome. A full discussion of these assumptions and other factors is included in

46

Table of Contents


the “Allowance for Credit Losses” section within the discussion of “Credit Risk”, found in a later section of this report, Note 1 “Summary of Significant Accounting Policies”, and Note 6 “Allowance for Credit Losses” to the consolidated financial statements.

Fair Value Measurements
A portion of the Company’s assets and liabilities is carried at fair value, with changes in fair value recorded either in earnings or accumulated other comprehensive income (loss). These include trading account securities, securities available for sale, mortgage loans held for sale, mortgage servicing rights and derivative assets and liabilities. From time to time, the estimation of fair value also affects other loans held for sale, which are recorded at the lower of cost or fair value. Fair value determination is also relevant for certain other assets such as foreclosed property and other real estate, which are recorded at the lower of the recorded investment in the loan/property or fair value, less estimated costs to sell the property. For example, the fair value of other real estate is determined based on recent appraisals by third parties and other market information, less estimated selling costs. Adjustments to the appraised value are made if management becomes aware of changes in the fair value of specific properties or property types. The determination of fair value also impacts certain other assets that are periodically evaluated for impairment using fair value estimates, including goodwill and other identifiable intangible assets.
Fair value is generally defined as the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability (an exit price) as opposed to the price that would be paid to acquire the asset or received to assume the liability (an entry price), in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date under current market conditions. While management uses judgment when determining the price at which willing market participants would transact when there has been a significant decrease in the volume or level of activity for the asset or liability in relation to “normal” market activity, management’s objective is to determine the point within the range of fair value estimates that is most representative of a sale to a third-party investor under current market conditions. The value to the Company if the asset or liability were held to maturity is not included in the fair value estimates.
A fair value measure should reflect the assumptions that market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability, including the assumptions about the risk inherent in a particular valuation technique, the effect of a restriction on the sale or use of an asset and the risk of nonperformance. Fair value is measured based on a variety of inputs the Company utilizes. Fair value may be based on quoted market prices for identical assets or liabilities traded in active markets (Level 1 valuations). If market prices are not available, quoted prices for identical or similar instruments in markets that are not active and model-based valuation techniques for which all significant assumptions are observable in the market are used (Level 2 valuations). Where observable market data is not available, the valuation is generated from model-based techniques that use significant assumptions not observable in the market, but observable based on Company-specific data (Level 3 valuations). These unobservable assumptions reflect the Company’s own estimates for assumptions that market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability. Valuation techniques typically include option pricing models, discounted cash flow models and similar techniques, but may also include the use of market prices of assets or liabilities that are not directly comparable to the subject asset or liability.
See Note 1 “Summary of Significant Accounting Policies” to the consolidated financial statements for a detailed discussion of determining fair value, including pricing validation processes.
Intangible Assets
Regions’ intangible assets consist primarily of the excess of cost over the fair value of net assets of acquired businesses (“goodwill”) and other identifiable intangible assets (primarily core deposit intangibles and purchased credit card relationships). Goodwill totaled $4.8 billion at both December 31, 2013 and 2012 and is allocated to each of Regions’ reportable segments (each a reporting unit: Business Services, Consumer Services, and Wealth Management). Refer to Note 22 “Business Segment Information” for discussion on Regions reorganization of its management reporting structure during the third quarter of 2012 and, accordingly, its segment reporting structure and goodwill reporting units. In connection with the reorganization, management reallocated goodwill to the new reporting units using a relative fair value approach. Goodwill is tested for impairment on an annual basis as of October 1 or more often if events and circumstances indicate impairment may exist (refer to Note 1 “Summary of Significant Accounting Policies” to the consolidated financial statements for further discussion).
A test of goodwill for impairment consists of two steps. In Step One, the fair value of the reporting unit is compared to its carrying amount, including goodwill. To the extent that the estimated fair value of the reporting unit exceeds the carrying value, impairment is not indicated and no further testing is required. Conversely, if the estimated fair value of the reporting unit is below its carrying amount, Step Two must be performed. Step Two consists of determining the implied estimated fair value of goodwill, which is the net difference between the valuation adjustments of assets and liabilities excluding goodwill and the valuation adjustment to equity (from Step One) of the reporting unit. The carrying value of equity for each reporting unit is determined from an allocation based upon risk weighted assets. Adverse changes in the economic environment, declining operations of the reporting unit, or other factors could result in a decline in the estimated implied fair value of goodwill. If the estimated implied fair value of goodwill is less than the carrying amount, a loss would be recognized to reduce the carrying amount to the estimated implied fair value.

47

Table of Contents



The estimated fair value of the reporting unit is determined using a blend of both income and market approaches. Within the income approach, which is the primary valuation approach, Regions utilizes the capital asset pricing model (“CAPM”) in order to derive the base discount rate. The inputs to the CAPM include the 20-year risk-free rate, 5-year beta for a select peer set specific to each reporting unit, and a market risk premium based on published data. Once the output of the CAPM is determined, a size premium is added (also based on a published source) as well as a company-specific risk premium for each reporting unit, which is an estimate determined by the Company and meant to compensate for the risk inherent in the future cash flow projections and inherent differences (such as business model and market perception of risk) between Regions and the peer set. Regions evaluates the appropriateness of the inputs to the CAPM at each test date. Company specific factors considered during recent evaluation periods include positive results of operations, improvement in asset quality and strong capital and liquidity positions.
In estimating future cash flows, a balance sheet as of the test date and statements of operations for the last twelve months of activity for each reporting unit is compiled. From that point, future balance sheets and statements of operations are projected based on the inputs. Cash flows are based on expected future capitalization requirements due to balance sheet growth and anticipated changes in regulatory capital requirements. The baseline cash flows utilized in all models correspond to the most recent internal forecasts and/or budgets. These internal forecasts range from 1 to 3 years and are based on inputs developed in the Company’s internal strategic and capital planning processes.
Regions uses the guideline public company method and the guideline transaction method as its market approaches. The public company method applies a value multiplier derived from each reporting unit’s peer group to a financial metric and an implied control premium to the respective reporting units. The control premium is evaluated and compared to similar financial services transactions considering the absolute and relative potential revenue synergies and cost savings. The guideline transaction method applies a value multiplier to a financial metric of the reporting unit based on comparable observed purchase transactions in the financial services industry for the reporting unit (where available).
Refer to Note 9 “Intangible Assets” for further discussion of these approaches and related assumptions. The fair values of assets and liabilities in Step Two, if applicable, are determined using an exit price concept. Refer to the discussion of fair value in Note 1 “Summary of Significant Accounting Policies” to the consolidated financial statements for discussions of the exit price concept and the determination of fair values of financial assets and liabilities.
The results of the calculations for the fourth quarter of 2013 indicated that the estimated fair values of the Business Services, Consumer Services and Wealth Management reporting units were $8.7 billion, $5.4 billion and $1.5 billion, respectively, which were greater than their carrying amounts of $8.6 billion, $5.2 billion and $1.3 billion, respectively. Therefore, the goodwill of each reporting unit was considered not impaired as of the testing date, and Step Two of the goodwill impairment test was not required.
The table below summarizes the discount rate used in the goodwill impairment test of each reporting unit for the fourth, third, second, and first quarters of 2013 and the fourth quarter of 2012:

Discount Rates 
 
Business
Services
 
Consumer
Services
 
Wealth
Management
Discount Rate:
 
 
 
 
 
Fourth quarter 2013
12
%
 
12
%
 
12
%
Third quarter 2013
12
%
 
12
%
 
12
%
Second quarter 2013
13
%
 
12
%
 
12
%
First quarter 2013
14
%
 
13
%
 
13
%
Fourth quarter 2012
14
%
 
13
%
 
13
%
Specific factors as of the date of filing the financial statements that could negatively impact the assumptions used in assessing goodwill for impairment include: a protracted decline in the Company’s market capitalization; disparities in the level of fair value changes in net assets (especially loans) compared to equity; increases in book values of equity of a reporting unit in excess of the increase in fair value of equity; adverse business trends resulting from litigation and/or regulatory actions; higher loan losses; lengthened forecasts of high unemployment levels; future increased minimum regulatory capital requirements above current thresholds (refer to Note 13 “Regulatory Capital Requirements and Restrictions” to the consolidated financial statements for a discussion of current minimum regulatory requirements); future federal rules and regulations (e.g., such as those resulting from the Dodd-Frank Act); and/or a protraction in the current low level of interest rates significantly beyond 2014.
For sensitivity analysis, a discount rate of 13 percent (an increase of one percentage point) for the Business Services, Consumer Services, and Wealth Management reporting units would result in estimated fair values of equity of $8.0 billion, $4.9 billion, and

48

Table of Contents


$1.3 billion, respectively. Wealth Management's estimated fair value of equity would exceed its carrying value and would not require Step Two procedures. Business Services' resulting fair value of equity would be $600 million less than its carrying value and likewise, Consumer Services' resulting fair value of equity would be $300 million less than its carrying value, which would require Step Two procedures for both reporting units. As part of the sensitivity analysis, Regions performed hypothetical Step Two procedures. In Step Two, the fair value of the reporting unit's assets, both tangible and intangible, and liabilities are determined using estimates of the amounts at which the assets (or liabilities) can be bought (or incurred) or sold (settled) in a taxable transaction between willing participants. The effects of the Step Two adjustments for Business Services and Consumer Services, which would have been primarily write-downs of assets to fair value, would have exceeded any reductions in the value of equity determined in Step One; accordingly the resulting implied goodwill would have exceeded the carrying amount of goodwill by approximately 72 percent for Business Services and by approximately 104 percent for Consumer Services, with no resulting impairment to either reporting unit.

Sensitivity calculations are hypothetical and should not be considered to be predictive of future performance. Changes in implied fair value based on adverse changes in assumptions generally cannot be extrapolated because the relationship of the change in assumption to the change in fair value may not be linear. Also, the effect of an adverse variation in a particular assumption on the implied fair value of goodwill is calculated without changing any other assumption, while in reality changes in one factor may result in changes in another which may either magnify or counteract the effect of the change.
Other material identifiable intangible assets, primarily core deposit intangibles and purchased credit card relationships, are reviewed at least annually (usually in the fourth quarter) for events or circumstances which could impact the recoverability of the intangible asset. These events could include loss of core deposits, significant losses of credit card accounts and/or balances, increased competition or adverse changes in the economy. To the extent an other identifiable intangible asset is deemed unrecoverable, an impairment loss would be recorded to reduce the carrying amount. These events or circumstances, if they occur, could be material to Regions’ operating results for any particular reporting period but the potential impact cannot be reasonably estimated.
Mortgage Servicing Rights
Regions estimates the fair value of its mortgage servicing rights in order to record them at fair value on the balance sheet. Although sales of mortgage servicing rights do occur, mortgage servicing rights do not trade in an active market with readily observable market prices and the exact terms and conditions of sales may not be readily available, and are therefore Level 3 valuations in the fair value hierarchy previously discussed in the “Fair Value Measurements” section. Specific characteristics of the underlying loans greatly impact the estimated value of the related mortgage servicing rights. As a result, Regions stratifies its mortgage servicing portfolio on the basis of certain risk characteristics, including loan type and contractual note rate, and values its mortgage servicing rights using discounted cash flow modeling techniques. These techniques require management to make estimates regarding future net servicing cash flows, taking into consideration historical and forecasted mortgage loan prepayment rates, discount rates, escrow balances and servicing costs. Changes in interest rates, prepayment speeds or other factors impact the fair value of mortgage servicing rights which impacts earnings. The carrying value of mortgage servicing rights was $297 million at December 31, 2013. Based on a hypothetical sensitivity analysis, Regions estimates that a reduction in primary mortgage market rates of 25 basis points and 50 basis points would reduce the December 31, 2013 fair value of mortgage servicing rights by approximately 4 percent ($12 million) and 9 percent ($26 million), respectively. Conversely, 25 basis point and 50 basis point increases in these rates would increase the December 31, 2013 fair value of mortgage servicing rights by approximately 4 percent ($11 million) and 7 percent ($20 million), respectively. Regions also estimates that an increase in servicing costs of approximately $10 per loan, or 18 percent, would result in a decline in the value of the mortgage servicing rights by approximately $10 million or 4 basis points.

The pro forma fair value analysis presented above demonstrates the sensitivity of fair values to hypothetical changes in primary mortgage rates. This sensitivity analysis does not reflect an expected outcome. Refer to the “Mortgage Servicing Rights” discussion in the “Balance Sheet” analysis section found later in this report.
Income Taxes
Accrued income taxes are reported as a component of either other assets or other liabilities, as appropriate, in the consolidated balance sheets and reflect management’s estimate of income taxes to be paid or received.
Deferred income taxes represent the amount of future income taxes to be paid or received and are accounted for using the asset and liability method. The net balance is reported in other assets in the consolidated balance sheets. The Company determines the realization of the deferred tax asset based upon an evaluation of the four possible sources of taxable income: 1) the future reversals of taxable temporary differences; 2) future taxable income exclusive of reversing temporary differences and carryforwards; 3) taxable income in prior carryback years; and 4) tax-planning strategies. In projecting future taxable income, the Company utilizes forecasted pre-tax earnings, adjusts for the estimated book-tax differences and incorporates assumptions, including the

49

Table of Contents


amounts of income allocable to taxing jurisdictions. These assumptions require significant judgment and are consistent with the plans and estimates the Company uses to manage the underlying businesses. The realization of the deferred tax assets could be reduced in the future if these estimates are significantly different than forecasted. For a detailed discussion of realization of deferred tax assets, refer to the “Income Taxes” section found later in this report.
The Company is subject to income tax in the U.S. and multiple state and local jurisdictions. The tax laws and regulations in each jurisdiction may be interpreted differently in certain situations, which could result in a range of outcomes. Thus, the Company is required to exercise judgment regarding the application of these tax laws and regulations. The Company will evaluate and recognize tax liabilities related to any tax uncertainties. Due to the complexity of some of these uncertainties, the ultimate resolution may result in a payment that is different from the current estimate of the tax liabilities.
The Company’s estimate of accrued income taxes, deferred income taxes and income tax expense can also change in any period as a result of new legislative or judicial guidance impacting tax positions, as well as changes in income tax rates. Any changes, if they occur, can be significant to the Company’s consolidated financial position, results of operations or cash flows.

OPERATING RESULTS
GENERAL
For 2013, Regions reported net income available to common shareholders of $1.1 billion, or $0.77 per diluted common share. In January 2012, Regions entered into an agreement to sell Morgan Keegan to Raymond James Financial, Inc. The results of the entities sold are presented as discontinued operations. Refer to Note 3 “Discontinued Operations” of the consolidated financial statements for additional information. Regions reported net income from continuing operations available to common shareholders of $1.1 billion, or $0.78 per diluted common share in 2013. Regions’ net loss from discontinued operations in 2013 was $13 million, or $(0.01) per diluted common share.
Regions’ 2013 results from continuing operations reflected a decline in its provision for loan losses resulting from continued improving credit metrics. Regions also experienced lower net interest income as a result of a decline in interest-earning asset levels combined with lower earning asset yields, as well as, lower non-interest income and slightly higher non-interest expenses.

NET INTEREST INCOME AND MARGIN
Net interest income (interest income less interest expense) is Regions’ principal source of income and is one of the most important elements of Regions’ ability to meet its overall performance goals. Net interest income on a taxable-equivalent basis decreased approximately $34 million, or 1 percent in 2013 from 2012, driven primarily by a decline in yields earned on earning assets that was only partially offset by a decline in rates paid on interest-bearing liabilities. The net interest margin increased to 3.20 percent in 2013 from 3.11 percent in 2012, reflecting a favorable mix shift in deposits out of higher-cost time deposits into lower-cost checking, savings and money market accounts, as well as improvements in the cost of non-deposit borrowings resulting primarily from the execution of liability management actions.
Comparing 2013 to 2012, average interest-earning asset yields were lower, decreasing 10 basis points. However, interest-bearing liability rates were also lower, declining by 27 basis points, more than offsetting the drop in interest-earning asset yields. As a result, the net interest rate spread increased 17 basis points to 3.03 percent in 2013 compared to 2.86 percent in 2012.
Monetary policy action pursued by the Federal Reserve, as well as a modest pace of economic recovery resulted in continued low levels of both long and short-term interest rates in 2013, both of which have influence on net interest margin and net interest income. Long-term rates are generally represented by the yield on the benchmark 10-year U.S. Treasury note, which slowly increased in 2013 from 1.78 percent at the beginning of the year, dropped to a low of 1.66 percent in May 2013 and then increased to a high of 3.04 percent at year-end. The average yield on the benchmark 10-year U.S. Treasury note was 2.35 percent in 2013. While being somewhat volatile during the year, long-term rates remained at historically low levels, which affected interest-earning asset yields through their impact on the behavior and pricing of both variable-rate and fixed-rate loans and securities. One way in which long-term interest rates affect asset yields is through their influence on prepayment activity. Low levels of long-term interest rates precipitate higher levels of prepayments, particularly within fixed-rate loan and securities portfolios, which has resulted in the replacement of these assets at lower rates of interest. Additionally, government programs such as the Home Affordable Refinance Program ("HARP") have influenced levels of prepayments among loans and securities in a similar fashion. The taxable investment securities portfolio, which contains significant residential fixed-rate exposure, decreased in yield from 2.55 percent in 2012 to 2.38 percent in 2013. The Company's loan pricing is also influenced by short-term rates such as the 30-day London Interbank Offering Rate ("LIBOR"), which on average was 19 basis points in 2013, compared to 24 basis points in 2012, and therefore had minimal impact on changes in the net interest margin as compared to 2012.

50

Table of Contents


The negative impact of low, long-term interest rates on the net interest margin was more than offset by improvements in liability costs. While the rates that most directly influence deposits costs (such as the Federal Reserve’s Rate of Interest on Excess Reserves and the Prime rate) both remained low and unchanged from the previous year-end level (at 0.25 percent and 3.25 percent, respectively), deposit costs were able to improve considerably, from 30 basis points in 2012 to 15 basis points in 2013. The improvement was due both to absolute improvements in cost of most deposit categories, but also to improvements in the mix of deposits from higher-cost time deposits to lower-cost checking and savings categories. For example, average time deposits declined from $16.5 billion, or 17.3 percent of total average deposits, in 2012 to $11.1 billion, or 12.0 percent of total average deposits in 2013. Meanwhile, average non-interest bearing customer deposits increased from $29.4 billion in 2012 to $29.6 billion in 2013. Net interest margin was also supported by a favorable shift of funding to customer deposits from more costly long-term borrowings. Average long-term borrowings declined to $5.2 billion in 2013 as compared to $6.7 billion in 2012, primarily due to the successful execution of liability management actions. See the "Long-Term Borrowings" section in Management's Discussion and Analysis and Note 12 to these consolidated financial statements for additional information related to these actions.


51

Table of Contents


Table 3 “Consolidated Average Daily Balances and Yield/Rate Analysis for Continuing Operations” presents a detail of net interest income (on a taxable-equivalent basis), the net interest margin, and the net interest spread.

Table 3—Consolidated Average Daily Balances and Yield/Rate Analysis for Continuing Operations 
 
Year Ended December 31
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
Average
Balance
 
Income/
Expense
 
Yield/
Rate
 
Average
Balance
 
Income/
Expense
 
Yield/
Rate
 
Average
Balance
 
Income/
Expense
 
Yield/
Rate
 
(Dollars in millions; yields on taxable-equivalent basis)
Assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest-earning assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Federal funds sold and securities purchased under agreements to resell
$

 
$

 
%
 
$

 
$

 
%
 
$
4

 
$

 
%
Trading account securities
114

 
3

 
2.24


134

 
3

 
2.24

 
166

 
4

 
2.41

Securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Taxable
25,349

 
603

 
2.38

 
26,667

 
681

 
2.55

 
24,586

 
758

 
3.08

Tax-exempt
6

 

 

 
17

 

 

 
31

 

 

Loans held for sale
864

 
29

 
3.41

 
1,150

 
33

 
2.87

 
1,131

 
35

 
3.09

Loans, net of unearned
 income(1)(2)
74,924

 
3,059

 
4.08

 
76,035

 
3,227

 
4.24

 
80,673

 
3,477

 
4.31

Other interest-earning assets
2,428

 
6

 
0.25

 
3,792

 
9

 
0.24

 
5,623

 
13

 
0.23

Total interest-earning assets
103,685

 
3,700

 
3.57

 
107,795

 
3,953

 
3.67

 
112,214

 
4,287

 
3.82

Allowance for loan losses
(1,680
)
 
 
 
 
 
(2,376
)
 
 
 
 
 
(3,114
)
 
 
 
 
Cash and due from banks
1,775

 
 
 
 
 
1,836

 
 
 
 
 
1,988

 
 
 
 
Other non-earning assets
14,025

 
 
 
 
 
14,927

 
 
 
 
 
15,631

 
 
 
 
 
$
117,805

 
 
 
 
 
$
122,182

 
 
 
 
 
$126,719
 
 
 
 
Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest-bearing liabilities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Savings accounts
$
6,051

 
6

 
0.09

 
$
5,589

 
4

 
0.07

 
$
5,062

 
5

 
0.10

Interest-bearing transaction accounts
19,873

 
19

 
0.10

 
19,419

 
23

 
0.12

 
15,613

 
27

 
0.17

Money market accounts
25,943

 
35

 
0.13

 
24,471

 
43

 
0.18

 
25,661

 
73

 
0.28

Time deposits
11,148

 
75

 
0.67

 
16,487

 
214

 
1.30

 
21,646

 
367

 
1.70

Total interest-bearing deposits(3)
63,015

 
135

 
0.21

 
65,966

 
284

 
0.43

 
67,982

 
472

 
0.69

Federal funds purchased and securities sold under agreements to repurchase
2,020

 
2

 
0.08

 
1,852

 
2

 
0.11

 
1,801

 
(1
)
 
(0.06)

Other short-term borrowings
219

 

 
0.19

 
251

 

 

 
186

 

 

Long-term borrowings
5,206

 
247

 
4.75

 
6,694

 
317

 
4.74

 
11,240

 
371

 
3.30

Total interest-bearing liabilities
70,460

 
384

 
0.54

 
74,763

 
603

 
0.81

 
81,209

 
842

 
1.04

Non-interest-bearing deposits(3)
29,631

 

 

 
29,364

 

 

 
27,689

 

 

Total funding sources
100,091

 
384

 
0.38

 
104,127

 
603

 
0.58

 
108,898

 
842

 
0.77

Net interest spread
 
 
 
 
3.03

 
 
 
 
 
2.86

 
 
 
 
 
2.78

Other liabilities
2,212

 
 
 
 
 
3,020

 
 
 
 
 
2,471

 
 
 
 
Stockholders’ equity
15,502

 
 
 
 
 
15,035

 
 
 
 
 
15,350

 
 
 
 
 
$
117,805

 
 
 
 
 
$
122,182

 
 
 
 
 
$126,719
 
 
 
 
Net interest income/margin on a taxable-equivalent basis from continuing operations(4)(5)
 
 
$
3,316

 
3.20
%
 
 
 
$
3,350

 
3.11
%
 
 
 
$
3,445

 
3.07
%

52

Table of Contents


_______
(1)
Loans, net of unearned income include non-accrual loans for all periods presented.
(2)
Interest income includes net loan fees of $75 million, $65 million and $50 million for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011, respectively.
(3)
Total deposit costs may be calculated by dividing total interest expense on deposits by the sum of interest-bearing deposits and non-interest-bearing deposits. The rates for total deposit costs equal 0.15%, 0.30% and 0.49% for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011 respectively.
(4)
The computation of taxable-equivalent net interest income is based on the statutory federal income tax rate of 35%, adjusted for applicable state income taxes net of the related federal tax benefit.
(5)
The table above does not include average interest-earning assets, average interest-bearing liabilities, interest income, or interest expense for discontinued operations (see Note 3 to the consolidated financial statements). If these assets, liabilities, and net interest income were included in the calculation, the consolidated net interest income and margin on a taxable equivalent basis would have been $3,356 million and 3.10% and $3,476 million and 3.05% for the years ended December 31, 2012 and 2011, respectively.

Table 4—Volume and Yield/Rate Variances from Continuing Operations
 
 
 
2013 Compared to 2012
 
2012 Compared to 2011
 
 
Change Due to
 
Change Due to
 
 
Volume
 
Yield/
Rate
 
Net
 
Volume
 
Yield/
Rate
 
Net
 
 
(Taxable-equivalent basis—in millions)
Interest income on:
 
 
Trading account securities
 
$

 
$

 
$

 
$
(1
)
 
$

 
$
(1
)
Securities-taxable
 
(33
)
 
(45
)
 
(78
)
 
61

 
(138
)
 
(77
)
Loans held for sale
 
(9
)
 
5

 
(4
)
 
1

 
(3
)
 
(2
)
Loans, including fees
 
(47
)
 
(121
)
 
(168
)
 
(198
)
 
(52
)
 
(250
)
Other interest-earning assets
 
(3
)
 

 
(3
)
 
(4
)
 

 
(4
)
Total interest-earning assets
 
(92
)
 
(161
)
 
(253
)
 
(141
)
 
(193
)
 
(334
)
Interest expense on:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Savings
 

 
2

 
2

 

 
(1
)
 
(1
)
Interest-bearing transaction
 
1

 
(5
)
 
(4
)
 
6

 
(10
)
 
(4
)
Money market
 
2

 
(10
)
 
(8
)
 
(3
)
 
(27
)
 
(30
)
Time deposits
 
(56
)
 
(83
)
 
(139
)
 
(77
)
 
(76
)
 
(153
)
Total interest-bearing deposits
 
(53
)
 
(96
)
 
(149
)
 
(74
)
 
(114
)
 
(188
)
Federal funds purchased and securities sold under agreements to repurchase
 

 

 

 

 
3

 
3

Long-term borrowings
 
(70
)
 

 
(70
)
 
(181
)
 
127

 
(54
)
Total interest-bearing liabilities
 
(123
)
 
(96
)
 
(219
)
 
(255
)
 
16

 
(239
)
Increase (decrease) in net interest income
 
$
31

 
$
(65
)
 
$
(34
)
 
$
114

 
$
(209
)
 
$
(95
)
______
Notes:
The change in interest not due solely to volume or yield/rate has been allocated to the volume column and yield/rate column in proportion to the relationship of the absolute dollar amounts of the change in each.
The computation of taxable-equivalent net interest income is based on the statutory federal income tax rate of 35%, adjusted for applicable state income taxes net of the related federal tax benefit.
The table above does not include average assets, average liabilities, interest income or interest expense for discontinued operations (see Note 3 to the consolidated financial statements).
The mix of interest-earning assets can also affect the interest rate spread. Regions’ primary types of interest-earning assets are loans and investment securities. Certain types of interest-earning assets have historically generated larger spreads; for example, loans typically generate larger spreads than other assets, such as securities, Federal funds sold or securities purchased under agreements to resell. The spread on loans remained depressed in 2013 due to the low interest rate environment and an elevated level of loans on non-accrual status. Average interest-earning assets at December 31, 2013 totaled $103.7 billion, a decrease of $4.1 billion as compared to the prior year.

53

Table of Contents


Average loans as a percentage of average interest-earning assets were 72 percent in 2013 and 71 percent in 2012. The remaining categories of interest-earning assets are shown in Table 3 “Consolidated Average Daily Balances and Yield/Rate Analysis for Continuing Operations”. The proportion of average interest-earning assets to average total assets, which was 88 percent in both 2013 and 2012, measures the effectiveness of management’s efforts to invest available funds into the most profitable interest-earning vehicles. This measure was consistent with the prior year as the overwhelming majority of the decline in total assets in 2013 was in interest-earning assets. Funding for Regions’ interest-earning assets comes from interest-bearing and non-interest-bearing sources. Another significant factor affecting the net interest margin is the percentage of interest-earning assets funded by interest-bearing liabilities. The percentage of average interest-earning assets funded by average interest-bearing liabilities was 68 percent in 2013 and 69 percent in 2012.
Table 4 “Volume and Yield/Rate Variances from Continuing Operations” provides additional information with which to analyze the changes in net interest income.

PROVISION FOR LOAN LOSSES
The provision for loan losses is used to maintain the allowance for loan losses at a level that in management’s judgment is appropriate to absorb probable losses inherent in the portfolio at the balance sheet date. During 2013, the provision for loan losses totaled $138 million and net charge-offs were $716 million. This compares to a provision for loan losses of $213 million and net charge-offs of $1.0 billion in 2012. Net charge-offs were lower across most major loan categories when comparing 2013 to the prior year, except for residential first mortgage loans which included $151 million of charge-offs related to the transfer of primarily accruing restructured residential mortgages to held for sale status near the end of 2013. Approximately $76 million of these mortgage related charge-offs were previously provided for in the allowance for loan and lease losses. See the "Loans Held For Sale" section for more information. Net charge-offs exceeded provision for loan losses for 2013 primarily due to the continued improving credit metrics, including lower levels of non-accrual loans and criticized and classified loans, as well as problem loan resolutions, and a continuing mix shift in loans out of higher risk investor real estate and into less risky commercial and industrial loans.
For further discussion and analysis of the total allowance for credit losses, see the “Risk Management” section found later in this report. See also Note 6 “Allowance for Credit Losses” to the consolidated financial statements.

NON-INTEREST INCOME
Non-interest income from continuing operations represents fees and income derived from sources other than interest-earning assets. Table 5 “Non-Interest Income from Continuing Operations” provides a detail of the components of non-interest income from continuing operations. Non-interest income decreased $81 million to $2.0 billion in 2013 compared to 2012. The decrease is primarily due to a decrease in mortgage income, offset by gain on sale of other assets and leveraged lease termination gains.


54

Table of Contents


Table 5—Non-Interest Income from Continuing Operations
 
Year Ended December 31
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
(In millions)
Service charges on deposit accounts
$
978

 
$
985

 
$
1,168

Mortgage income
236

 
363

 
220

Investment management and trust fee income
196

 
195

 
199

Insurance commissions and fees
114

 
109

 
106

Capital markets fee income and other
87

 
83

 
36

Bank-owned life insurance
82

 
81

 
83

Credit card/bank card income
75

 
85

 
65

Commercial credit fee income
65

 
68

 
80

Leveraged lease termination gains, net
39

 
14

 
8

Investment services fee income
34

 
27

 
28

Securities gains, net
26

 
48

 
112

Gain on sale of other assets
24

 

 

Net loss from affordable housing
(49
)
 
(49
)
 
(69
)
Other miscellaneous income
112

 
91

 
107

 
$
2,019

 
$
2,100

 
$
2,143


Service Charges on Deposit Accounts
Service charges on deposit accounts include non-sufficient fund fees, debit and interchange income, ATM fees and other service charges. Income from service charges on deposit accounts decreased $7 million or 1 percent in 2013 and totaled $978 million and $985 million in 2013 and 2012, respectively. The overall decline in 2013 compared to 2012 was primarily driven by policy changes negatively impacting non-sufficient fund fees as well as customer behavior changes and sensitivities to paying fees. These factors were partially offset by income from higher debit transactions resulting from account growth and continued migration from paper to electronic transactions.
Mortgage Income
Mortgage income is generated through the origination and servicing of mortgage loans for long-term investors and sales of mortgage loans in the secondary market. Mortgage income decreased $127 million or 35 percent to $236 million in 2013. The decrease was driven by lower mortgage production and the Company's decision to begin retaining 10 and 15-year residential first mortgage originations on its balance sheet beginning in the fourth quarter of 2012 as opposed to selling these originations in the secondary market. Mortgage loan production of $6.6 billion fell 18 percent from 2012 levels as consumer demand for mortgage loans slowed due to rising interest rates. An increase in the cost of hedging mortgage servicing rights also contributed to the decline in mortgage income.

At December 31, 2013, $28.5 billion of the mortgage servicing portfolio was serviced for third parties. At December 31, 2012, $26.2 billion of Regions’ servicing portfolio was serviced for third parties.

Credit Card/Bank Card Income
Credit card/bank card income decreased $10 million or 12 percent in 2013 as compared to 2012. Credit card income is derived from activity related to the Regions-branded credit card portfolio purchased from FIA Card Services in the second quarter of 2011 and subsequent originations. Bank card income relates to commercial purchasing cards. In the third quarter of 2012, the Company began recording credit card relationship reward costs as a reduction of credit card revenue, which resulted in the decrease period over period.
Leveraged Lease Termination Gains, Net
Regions terminated certain leveraged leases in 2013 and 2012 resulting in net gains of $39 million and $14 million, respectively. These termination gains were largely offset by increases in income tax expense.


55

Table of Contents


Securities Gains, Net
Regions reported net gains of $26 million from the sale of securities available for sale in 2013, as compared to net gains of $48 million in 2012. Lower security gains during 2013 were due to lower volumes of securities sales resulting from the Company’s asset/liability management process. Refer to the “Securities” section in the “Balance Sheet Analysis” for further discussion.

Gain on Sale of Other Assets
During the third quarter of 2013, the Company divested a non-core portion of a Wealth Management business which resulted in a pre-tax gain of $24 million.

Other Miscellaneous Income
Other miscellaneous income increased $21 million for 2013 as compared to 2012. This item includes fees from safe deposit boxes, check fees and income from assets held for employee benefit purposes.

NON-INTEREST EXPENSE
The following section contains a discussion of non-interest expense from continuing operations. The largest components of non-interest expense are salaries and employee benefits, net occupancy expense and furniture and equipment expense. Non-interest expense in 2013 increased $30 million from 2012. Non-interest expense in 2013 included a $58 million regulatory charge and $5 million of branch consolidation and property and equipment charges. Non-interest expense in 2012 included $42 million in REIT investment early termination costs. The increase in non-interest expense in 2013 included increases of $55 million in salaries and benefits, $50 million in loss on early extinguishment of debt and $24 million in outside services. These increases were offset by decreases of $55 million in amortization of core deposit intangible, $37 million in deposit administrative fees, and $36 million in other real estate owned expense. Table 6 “Non-Interest Expense from Continuing Operations” presents total non-interest expense for the years ended December 31:

Table 6—Non-Interest Expense from Continuing Operations
 
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
(In millions)
Salaries and employee benefits
$
1,818

 
$
1,763

 
$
1,604

Net occupancy expense
365

 
382

 
388

Furniture and equipment expense
280

 
261

 
275

Professional and legal expenses
132

 
114

 
175

Deposit administrative fee
125

 
162

 
217

Outside services
106

 
82

 
62

Marketing
98

 
87

 
62

Loss on early extinguishment of debt
61

 
11

 

Regulatory charge
58

 

 

Credit/checkcard expenses
41

 
64

 
50

Amortization of core deposit intangible
28

 
83

 
95

Other real estate owned expense
16

 
52

 
162

Branch consolidation and property and equipment charges
5

 

 
75

REIT investment early termination costs

 
42

 

Goodwill impairment expense

 

 
253

Provision (credit) for unfunded credit losses
(5
)
 
5

 
7

(Gain)/loss on loans held for sale, net
(30
)
 
(61
)
 
1

Other miscellaneous expenses
458

 
479

 
436

 
$
3,556

 
$
3,526

 
$
3,862



56

Table of Contents


Salaries and Employee Benefits
Salaries and employee benefits increased $55 million or 3 percent during 2013 as compared to 2012. The increase is primarily due to additional staffing in income producing areas, compliance and risk management during 2013 as well as incentive increases and annual merit increases, partially offset by decreased pension costs. Headcount increased from 23,427 at December 31, 2012 to 24,255 at December 31, 2013.

Net Occupancy Expense
Net occupancy expense includes rent, depreciation and amortization, utilities, maintenance, insurance, taxes, and other expenses of premises occupied by Regions and its affiliates. Net occupancy expense decreased $17 million or 4 percent in 2013, primarily due to lease downsizing efforts and favorable negotiation of vendor service contracts.

Furniture and Equipment Expense
Furniture and equipment expense increased by $19 million or 7 percent in 2013 primarily driven by higher depreciation due to system upgrades implemented during 2013.

Professional and Legal Expenses
Professional and legal expenses increased $18 million or 16 percent during 2013 as compared to 2012. The increase was primarily due to increased legal matters and related fees, as well as increased consulting charges attributable to regulatory and compliance projects.

Deposit Administrative Fee
Deposit administrative fees decreased $37 million or 23 percent during 2013 when compared to 2012. The decrease is related to lower asset balances, improved performance metrics and a reduction in higher risk loans, all of which impact the fee calculation.

Outside Services
Outside services increased $24 million or 29 percent during 2013 when compared to 2012. The increase was primarily due to expenses incurred related to assuming the servicing of the credit card portfolio during the third quarter of 2012, as well as fees related to an increase in the routine purchases of indirect loans from a third party.

Loss on Early Extinguishment of Debt
During 2013, the Company incurred $61 million in losses related to the early extinguishment of certain other long-term debt, the tender or redemption of certain senior debt securities and preferred stock, as well as the redemption of selected trust preferred securities. Approximately $29 million of the $61 million in losses are non-deductible for income tax purposes. The Company recognized an $11 million loss in 2012 related to the early redemption of trust preferred securities.

Regulatory Charge
Regions recorded a non-tax deductible charge of $58 million during the fourth quarter of 2013 related to previously disclosed inquiries from government authorities concerning matters from 2009. The Company is in discussions with banking supervisors to resolve their inquiries on these matters.

Credit/Checkcard Expenses
Credit/checkcard expenses decreased $23 million or 36 percent in 2013 when compared to 2012. In the third quarter of 2012, the Company began recording credit card relationship reward costs as a reduction of credit card revenue.

Amortization of Core Deposit Intangible
Amortization of core deposit intangible decreased $55 million or 66 percent for 2013 when compared to 2012. Regions' annual 2012 impairment test reflected an increase in the estimated life of Regions' core deposit intangibles, which resulted in a decrease in amortization beginning in 2013.

Other Real Estate Owned Expense
Other real estate owned (“OREO”) expense includes the cost of adjusting foreclosed properties to estimated fair value after these assets have been classified as OREO, net gains and losses on sales of properties, and other costs to maintain the property such as property taxes, security, and grounds maintenance. OREO expense decreased $36 million or 69 percent during 2013 as compared to 2012. The decline in expense was due to lower OREO balances and stabilizing real estate values. See the "Foreclosed Properties" section for additional information.

57

Table of Contents



Branch Consolidation and Property and Equipment Charges
Non-interest expense in 2013 included $5 million of branch consolidation charges related to lower of cost or market adjustments on owned branch property. The charges were driven by Regions' decision to consolidate 30 branches.

REIT Investment Early Termination Costs
On November 30, 2012, Regions entered into an agreement with a third party investor in Regions Asset Management Company, Inc., a real estate investment trust, pursuant to which the investment was fully redeemed. As a result, Regions incurred early termination costs of approximately $42 million.

(Gain)/Loss on Loans Held for Sale, Net
The Company recorded $31 million less in gains on loans held for sale for 2013 when compared to 2012. The decreased gains were due to lower balances of non-performing loans held for sale. See Table 20 "Non-Performing Loans Held For Sale" for an analysis.

Other Miscellaneous Expenses
Other miscellaneous expenses decreased $21 million for 2013 as compared to 2012. This item includes expenses for communications, postage, supplies and business development services.

INCOME TAXES
The Company’s income tax expense from continuing operations for 2013 was $452 million compared to an income tax expense of $482 million for the same period in 2012, resulting in effective tax rates of 28.5 percent and 29.0 percent, respectively.
The Company’s effective tax rate is affected by recurring items such as affordable housing tax credits, bank-owned life insurance and tax-exempt income, which are expected to be generally consistent in the near term. The effective tax rate is also affected by items that may occur in any given period but are not consistent from period to period, such as the termination of certain leveraged leases. Accordingly, future period effective tax rates may not be comparable to the current period.
At December 31, 2013, the Company reported a net deferred tax asset of $612 million, compared to $763 million at December 31, 2012. The decrease in the net deferred tax asset was primarily due to the continued reduction in the allowance for loan losses, the utilization of tax credit carryforwards and an increase in the deferred tax liability associated with lease financing, which were partially offset by an increase in the deferred tax asset for the unrealized losses on securities available for sale.
The Company continually assesses the realizability of its deferred tax assets based on an evaluative process that considers all available positive and negative evidence. As part of this evaluative process, the Company considers the following sources of taxable income: 1) the future reversals of taxable temporary differences; 2) future taxable income exclusive of reversing temporary differences and carryforwards; 3) taxable income in prior carryback years; and 4) tax-planning strategies. In making a conclusion, the Company has evaluated all available positive and negative evidence impacting these sources of taxable income. The primary sources of evidence impacting the Company's judgment regarding the realization of its deferred tax assets are summarized below.

History of earnings—In 2013, the Company has continued its positive earnings trend with positive earnings in 2013, 2012 and 2011 (excluding the impact of goodwill impairment in 2011), and is no longer in a three year cumulative loss position. The Company has utilized all federal net operating losses and in 2013, continued utilization of federal tax credit carryforwards. There is no history of significant tax carryforwards expiring unused.
Reversals of taxable temporary differences—The Company anticipates that future reversals of taxable temporary differences, including the accretion of taxable temporary differences related to leveraged leases acquired in a prior business combination, can absorb up to approximately $752 million of deferred tax assets.
Creation of future taxable income—The Company has projected future taxable income that will be sufficient to absorb the remaining deferred tax assets after the reversal of future taxable temporary differences.
Ability to implement tax-planning strategies—The Company has the ability to implement tax planning strategies such as asset sales to maximize the realization of deferred tax assets.
Based on this evaluative process, the Company has established a valuation allowance in the amount of $36 million at December 31, 2013 and $70 million at December 31, 2012 because the Company believes that a portion of the state net operating loss carryforwards and state tax credit carryforwards will not be utilized. The decrease of $34 million is principally due to the Company’s determination that certain state net operating loss carryforwards are more likely than not to be realized.

58

Table of Contents


The Company has determined there will not be a material impact on consolidated results of operations, cash flows or financial position resulting from the final regulations issued by the Internal Revenue Service regarding the deduction and capitalization of expenditures related to tangible property, which generally become effective in 2014.
See Note 1 “Summary of Significant Accounting Policies” and Note 19 “Income Taxes” to the consolidated financial statements for additional information about income taxes.

DISCONTINUED OPERATIONS
Morgan Keegan was sold on April 2, 2012. Regions' results from discontinued operations in 2013 was a loss of $13 million, compared to a loss of $59 million in 2012. For the year ended December 31, 2013, Regions reported a loss from discontinued operations of $(0.01) per diluted common share, compared to a loss from discontinued operations of $(0.04) per diluted common share for the year ended December 31, 2012. During 2013 and 2012, the loss from discontinued operations was primarily due to higher professional and legal expenses.
BALANCE SHEET ANALYSIS
At December 31, 2013, Regions reported total assets of $117.4 billion compared to $121.3 billion at the end of 2012, a decrease of approximately $4.0 billion or 3 percent. The decrease in total assets from year-end 2012 resulted primarily from a decrease in investment securities, as well as a decrease in other assets. Total investment securities declined approximately $3.4 billion, primarily related to management's strategic decision to reduce the size of the investment portfolio in the second quarter of 2013. Other assets declined between years primarily due to decreases in derivative assets, deferred income tax assets and prepaid expense balances.
Cash and Cash Equivalents
Cash and cash equivalents include cash and due from banks, interest-bearing deposits in other banks (including the Federal Reserve Bank), and Federal funds sold and securities purchased under agreements to resell (which have a life of 90 days or less). At December 31, 2013, these assets totaled $5.3 billion as compared to $5.5 billion at December 31, 2012. The year-over-year decrease was driven by a decrease in cash and due from banks.
Trading Account Securities
Trading account securities decreased approximately $5 million to $111 million at December 31, 2013. The trading account securities are primarily securities held in rabbi trusts related to deferred compensation plans. Trading account securities are carried at fair value with changes in fair value reflected in the consolidated statements of operations.

Securities
Regions utilizes the securities portfolio to manage liquidity, interest rate risk, and regulatory capital, as well as to take advantage of market conditions to generate a favorable return on investments without undue risk.
The “Market Risk-Interest Rate Risk” section, found later in this report, further explains Regions’ interest rate risk management practices. The weighted-average yield earned on securities, less equities, was 2.65 percent in 2013 and 2.57 percent in 2012. Table 7 “Securities” details the carrying values of securities, including both available for sale and held to maturity.

59

Table of Contents


Table 7—Securities
 
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
(In millions)
U.S. Treasury securities
$
57

 
$
54

 
$
102

Federal agency securities
425

 
555

 
150

Obligations of states and political subdivisions
5

 
9

 
36

Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
Residential agency
17,474

 
21,283

 
22,184

Residential non-agency
9

 
13

 
16

Commercial agency
1,154

 
725

 
326

Commercial non-agency
1,211

 
1,098

 
321

Corporate and other debt securities
2,827

 
2,835

 
537

Equity securities
676

 
682

 
815

 
$
23,838

 
$
27,254

 
$
24,487

Securities totaled $23.8 billion at December 31, 2013, a decrease of $3.4 billion from year-end 2012 levels. Regions maintains a highly rated securities portfolio consisting primarily of agency mortgage-backed securities. Throughout the recent economic cycle, financial institutions, including Regions, increased the size of their securities portfolio to offset the lack of loan growth in order to maintain an appropriate level of earning assets. However, Regions experienced $614 million in loan growth during 2013. This loan growth, combined with an outlook for continued moderate improvement in the economy and an eventual reduction in securities purchases by the Federal Reserve, led management to reduce the size of the investment portfolio during the second quarter of 2013. Total securities comprised approximately 23 percent and 25 percent of earning assets as of December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively. Additionally, approximately $2.4 billion in available for sale securities were transferred to held to maturity during the second quarter of 2013. These combined actions should allow Regions to continue to optimize its asset/liability profile while reducing future volatility related to other comprehensive income and the related impacts to tangible common equity.
Net unrealized gains and losses in the securities available for sale portfolio are included in stockholders’ equity as accumulated other comprehensive income or loss, net of tax. At December 31, 2013, securities available for sale included a net unrealized loss of $34 million, which represented the difference between the estimated fair value of these securities as of year-end and their amortized cost. The net unrealized loss represents $257 million in gross unrealized gains and $291 million in gross unrealized losses. Additionally, accumulated other comprehensive income included net pre-tax unrealized losses of $111 million related to the securities transferred to held to maturity at the date of the transfer. As of December 31, 2013, approximately $104 million of this pre-tax unrealized loss remains. At December 31, 2012, securities available for sale included a net unrealized gain of $701 million, comprised of $729 million in gross unrealized gains and $28 million in gross unrealized losses.
The Company reviews its securities portfolio on a regular basis to determine if there are any conditions indicating that a security has other-than-temporary impairment. Factors considered in this determination include the length of time and the extent to which the market value has been below cost, the credit standing of the issuer, Regions’ intent to sell and whether it is more likely than not that the Company will be required to sell the security.
Maturity Analysis—The average life of the securities portfolio (excluding equities) at December 31, 2013 was estimated to be 4.9 years, with a duration of approximately 3.9 years. These metrics compare with an estimated average life of 3.9 years, with a duration of approximately 2.7 years for the portfolio at December 31, 2012. Table 8 “Relative Contractual Maturities and Weighted-Average Yields for Securities” provides additional details.

60

Table of Contents


Table 8—Relative Contractual Maturities and Weighted-Average Yields for Securities
 
 
 
Securities Maturing as of December 31, 2013
 
 
Within One
Year
 
After One But
Within Five
Years
 
After Five But
Within Ten
Years
 
After Ten
Years
 
Total
 
 
(Dollars in millions)
Securities(1):
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
U.S. Treasury securities
 
$
10

 
$
41

 
$
5

 
$
1

 
$
57

Federal agency securities
 
3

 
20

 
402

 

 
425

Obligations of states and political subdivisions
 
1

 
2

 

 
2

 
5

Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 


Residential agency
 
2

 
202

 
1,240

 
16,030

 
17,474

Residential non-agency
 

 

 

 
9

 
9

Commercial agency
 

 
321

 
580

 
253

 
1,154

Commercial non-agency
 

 
180

 
276

 
755

 
1,211

Corporate and other debt securities
 
37

 
1,032

 
1,398

 
360

 
2,827

 
 
$
53

 
$
1,798

 
$
3,901

 
$
17,410

 
$
23,162

Weighted-average yield(2)
 
3.03
%
 
2.22
%
 
2.55
%
 
2.71
%
 
2.65
%
_________
(1)
Federal Reserve Bank stock, Federal Home Loan Bank stock, and equity stock of other corporations held by Regions are not included in the table.
(2)
The weighted-average yields are calculated on the basis of the yield to maturity based on the book value of each security. Weighted-average yields on tax-exempt obligations have been computed on a taxable-equivalent basis using a tax rate of 35%, adjusted for applicable state income taxes net of the related federal tax benefit. Average tax-exempt securities were maintained at such a small balance in 2013 that the taxable-equivalent adjustments for the calculation of yields amounted to zero for the year ended December 31, 2013. Yields on tax-exempt obligations have not been adjusted for the non-deductible portion of interest expense used to finance the purchase of tax-exempt obligations.

Portfolio Quality—Regions’ investment policy emphasizes credit quality and liquidity. Securities rated in the highest category by nationally recognized rating agencies and securities backed by the U.S. Government and government sponsored agencies, both on a direct and indirect basis, represented approximately 87 percent of the investment portfolio at December 31, 2013. All other securities rated below AAA, not backed by the U.S. Government or government sponsored agencies, or which are not rated represented approximately 13 percent of total securities at year-end 2013.
Loans Held For Sale
During the fourth quarter of 2013, Regions transferred certain primarily accruing residential first mortgage loans classified as troubled debt restructurings ("TDRs") to loans held for sale. The book value of these loans was approximately $686 million and they were transferred into loans held for sale at the estimated fair value of $535 million with the $151 million difference reflected as a charge-off. Approximately $76 million of the charge-off was previously recorded in the allowance for loan and lease losses. The estimate of fair value includes the perspective of a market participant, considering among other things, required investor returns which include liquidity discounts that are precluded from inclusion in the allowance for loan and lease losses.
At December 31, 2013, loans held for sale totaled $1.1 billion, consisting primarily of $963 million of residential real estate mortgage loans, including the recently transferred restructured loans, and $82 million of non-performing investor real estate loans. At December 31, 2012, loans held for sale totaled $1.4 billion, consisting primarily of $1.3 billion of residential real estate mortgage loans and $89 million of non-performing investor real estate loans. The level of residential real estate mortgage loans held for sale fluctuates depending on the timing of origination and sale to third parties.

Loans
GENERAL
Average loans, net of unearned income, represented 72 percent of average interest-earning assets for the year ended December 31, 2013, compared to 71 percent for the year ended December 31, 2012. Lending at Regions is generally organized along three portfolio segments: commercial loans (including commercial and industrial, and owner-occupied commercial real estate mortgage

61

Table of Contents


and construction loans), investor real estate loans (commercial real estate mortgage and construction loans) and consumer loans (residential first mortgage, home equity, indirect, consumer credit card and other consumer loans).
Regions manages loan growth with a focus on risk management and risk-adjusted return on capital. Strategic decisions to grow the commercial and industrial portfolios through the company's specialized lending groups and the indirect automobile lending portfolios were the primary contributors to the increase in loans in 2013. The increase was partially offset by continued decreases in commercial investor real estate mortgage, the transfer of residential mortgage TDRs to held for sale, and the lower demand for home equity products.
Table 9 illustrates a year-over-year comparison of loans, net of unearned income, by portfolio segment and class and Table 10 provides information on selected loan maturities.
Table 9—Loan Portfolio
 
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
2010
 
2009
 
(In millions, net of unearned income)
Commercial and industrial
$
29,413

 
$
26,674

 
$
24,522

 
$
22,540

 
$
21,547

Commercial real estate mortgage—owner-occupied
9,495

 
10,095

 
11,166

 
12,046

 
12,054

Commercial real estate construction—owner-occupied
310

 
302

 
337

 
470

 
751

Total commercial
39,218

 
37,071

 
36,025

 
35,056

 
34,352

Commercial investor real estate mortgage
5,318

 
6,808

 
9,702

 
13,621

 
16,109

Commercial investor real estate construction
1,432

 
914

 
1,025

 
2,287

 
5,591

Total investor real estate
6,750

 
7,722

 
10,727

 
15,908

 
21,700

Residential first mortgage
12,163

 
12,963

 
13,784

 
14,898

 
15,632

Home equity
11,294

 
11,800

 
13,021

 
14,226

 
15,381

Indirect
3,075

 
2,336

 
1,848

 
1,592

 
2,452

Consumer credit card
948

 
906

 
987

 

 

Other consumer
1,161

 
1,197

 
1,202

 
1,184

 
1,157

Total consumer
28,641

 
29,202

 
30,842

 
31,900

 
34,622

 
$
74,609

 
$
73,995

 
$
77,594

 
$
82,864

 
$
90,674


Table 10—Selected Loan Maturities
 
 
Loans Maturing as of December 31, 2013 (2)
 
 
Within
One Year
 
After One
But  Within
Five Years
 
After
Five
Years
 
Total
 
 
(In millions)
Commercial and industrial (1)
 
$
4,424

 
$
18,670

 
$
6,193

 
$
29,287

Commercial real estate mortgage—owner-occupied
 
1,198

 
4,799

 
3,498

 
9,495

Commercial real estate construction—owner occupied
 
26

 
127

 
157

 
310

Total commercial
 
5,648

 
23,596

 
9,848

 
39,092

Commercial investor real estate mortgage
 
2,036

 
2,776

 
506

 
5,318

Commercial investor real estate construction
 
493

 
906

 
33

 
1,432

Total investor real estate
 
2,529

 
3,682

 
539

 
6,750

 
 
$
8,177

 
$
27,278

 
$
10,387

 
$
45,842

 
 
Predetermined
Rate
 
Variable
Rate
 
 
(In millions)
Due after one year but within five years
 
$
5,364

 
$
21,915

Due after five years
 
6,204

 
4,182

 
 
$
11,568

 
$
26,097


62

Table of Contents


_________
(1) Excludes $126 million of small business credit card accounts.
(2) Excludes residential first mortgage, home equity, indirect, consumer credit card and other consumer loans.

PORTFOLIO CHARACTERISTICS
The following sections describe the composition of the portfolio segments and classes in Table 9 and explain variations in balances from the 2012 year-end. See Note 5 “Loans” and Note 6 “Allowance for Credit Losses” to the consolidated financial statements for additional discussion.
Regions has a diversified loan portfolio, in terms of product type, collateral and geography. At December 31, 2013, commercial loans represented 53 percent of total loans, net of unearned income, investor real estate loans represented 9 percent, residential first mortgage loans totaled 16 percent, home equity lending totaled 15 percent, and other consumer loans comprised the remaining 7 percent. Following is a discussion of risk characteristics of each loan type.
Loans, net of unearned income, totaled $74.6 billion at December 31, 2013, an increase of $614 million from year-end 2012 levels. Continued growth in commercial and industrial, and indirect auto loan portfolios, along with increased commercial investor real estate construction loans, more than offset declines in investor real estate mortgage, commercial real estate mortgage, residential first mortgage and home equity lending during 2013.
Commercial—The commercial portfolio segment includes commercial and industrial loans to commercial customers for use in normal business operations to finance working capital needs, equipment purchases and other expansion projects. Commercial and industrial loans increased $2.7 billion or 10% since year-end 2012 due to Regions’ integrated approach to specialized lending. Commercial also includes owner-occupied commercial real estate mortgage loans to operating businesses, which are loans for long-term financing of land and buildings, and are repaid by cash flow generated by business operations. These loans declined $600 million or 6% from year-end 2012 as a result of continued customer deleveraging. Owner-occupied construction loans are made to commercial businesses for the development of land or construction of a building where the repayment is derived from revenues generated from the business of the borrower. During 2013, total commercial loan balances increased approximately $2.1 billion, or 6%.
Investor Real Estate—Loans for real estate development are repaid through cash flow related to the operation, sale or refinance of the property. This portfolio segment includes extensions of credit to real estate developers or investors where repayment is dependent on the sale of real estate or income generated from the real estate collateral. A portion of Regions’ investor real estate portfolio segment is comprised of loans secured by residential product types (land, single-family and condominium loans) within Regions’ markets. Additionally, this category includes loans made to finance income-producing properties such as apartment buildings, office and industrial buildings, and retail shopping centers. The investor real estate loan segment declined $972 million from 2012 year-end balances primarily due to continued payoffs and pay downs.
Residential First Mortgage—Residential first mortgage loans represent loans to consumers to finance a residence. These loans are typically financed over a 15 to 30 year term and, in most cases, are extended to borrowers to finance their primary residence. These loans experienced an $800 million or 6% decline from year-end 2012, primarily due to customers continuing to pay down real estate debt and the transfer of $686 million of primarily accruing residential first mortgages classified as TDRs to loans held for sale late in 2013. At the end of 2012, Regions began retaining 10 and 15 year fixed-rate mortgage production on the balance sheet which has slowed the pace of decline. Approximately $664 million of these 10 and 15-year fixed rate loans were retained on the balance sheet during 2013.

Home Equity—Home equity lending includes both home equity loans and lines of credit. This type of lending, which is secured by a first or second mortgage on the borrower’s residence, allows customers to borrow against the equity in their home. Substantially all of this portfolio was originated through Regions’ branch network. During 2013, home equity balances decreased $506 million to $11.3 billion, driven by continued consumer deleveraging and refinancing.
Indirect—Indirect lending, which is lending initiated through third-party business partners, is largely comprised of loans made through automotive dealerships. This portfolio class increased $739 million from year-end 2012, reflecting continued growth from increased penetration of existing dealers and the expansion of the dealer network. Regions currently has 2,140 dealers in its network compared to just over 1,900 as of December 31, 2012.
Consumer Credit Card—During the second quarter of 2011, Regions completed the purchase of approximately $1.0 billion of existing Regions-branded consumer credit card accounts from FIA Card Services. The products are primarily open-ended variable interest rate consumer credit card loans. In the third quarter of 2012, Regions assumed the servicing of these loans from FIA Card Services. Consumer credit card balances increased $42 million to $948 million during 2013.

63

Table of Contents


Other Consumer—Other consumer loans include direct consumer installment loans, overdrafts and other revolving loans. Other consumer loans totaled $1.2 billion at December 31, 2013, relatively unchanged from prior year end.

CREDIT QUALITY
Regions believes that its loan portfolio is well diversified by product, client, and geography throughout its footprint. However, the loan portfolio may be exposed to certain concentrations of credit risk which exist in relation to individual borrowers or groups of borrowers, certain types of collateral, certain types of industries, certain loan products, or certain regions of the country.
Commercial
    
The commercial portfolio segment has generated the majority of the Company's loan growth in 2013, particularly commercial and industrial loans. The commercial portfolio segment made up approximately 53 percent of total loans at December 31, 2013, compared to 50 percent at December 31, 2012. The following table provides detail of Regions' commercial lending balances in selected industries as of December 31:

Table 11—Selected Industry Balances
 
2013
 
2012
 
Loans
 
% of Total
 
Loans
 
% of Total
 
(Dollars in millions)
Real estate
$
4,992

 
12.7
%
 
$
4,388

 
11.8
%
Healthcare
4,805

 
12.3

 
4,545

 
12.3

Manufacturing
3,831

 
9.8

 
3,838

 
10.4

Financial services
3,265

 
8.3

 
3,061

 
8.2

Wholesale goods
3,026

 
7.7

 
2,998

 
8.1

Energy and utilities
2,891

 
7.4

 
2,659

 
7.2

Religious, leisure, personal and non-profit services
2,352

 
6.0

 
2,417

 
6.5

Retail trade
2,286

 
5.8

 
2,048

 
5.5

Transportation and warehousing
2,220

 
5.7

 
2,225

 
6.0

Restaurant, accommodation and lodging
1,959

 
5.0

 
1,857

 
5.0

Educational services
1,579

 
4.0

 
1,503

 
4.0

Professional, scientific and technical services
1,449

 
3.7

 
1,398

 
3.8

Government and public sector
1,437

 
3.7

 
1,147

 
3.1

Administrative, support, waste and repair
1,192

 
3.0

 
1,401

 
3.8

Agriculture
859

 
2.2

 
778

 
2.1

Information
747

 
1.9

 
523

 
1.4

Other
328

 
0.8

 
285

 
0.8

 
$
39,218

 
100.0
%
 
$
37,071

 
100.0
%
Investor Real Estate
Due to the nature of the cash flows typically used to repay investor real estate loans, these loans are particularly vulnerable to weak economic conditions as experienced over the past several years. As a result, this loan type has a higher risk of non-collection than other loans.
The Company has made considerable efforts to de-risk its balance sheet. A primary focus has been reducing the Company's exposure in the investor real estate portfolio. Total investor real estate loans represented approximately 24 percent of total loans at December 31, 2008, and has been actively managed down to approximately 9 percent of total loans at December 31, 2013.

Home Equity
Total home equity lending represented approximately 15 percent or $11.3 billion of total loans at December 31, 2013 and 16 percent or $11.8 billion at December 31, 2012. Losses in this portfolio generally track overall economic conditions. The main source of economic stress has been in Florida, where residential property values have declined significantly while unemployment

64

Table of Contents


rates remain high. Losses in Florida where Regions is in a second lien position are higher than first lien losses. Substantially all of this portfolio was originated through Regions’ branch network.
The following tables provide details related to the home equity portfolio as of and for the years ended December 31:
Table 12—Selected Home Equity Portfolio Information
 
 
 
2013
 
 
Florida
 
All Other States
 
Total
 
 
1st Lien
 
2nd Lien
 
Total
 
1st Lien
 
2nd Lien
 
Total
 
1st Lien
 
2nd Lien
 
Total
 
 
(Dollars in millions)
Balance
 
$
1,849

 
$
2,133

 
$
3,982

 
$
4,149

 
$
3,163

 
$
7,312

 
$
5,998

 
$
5,296

 
$
11,294

Net charge-offs
 
18

 
57

 
75

 
17

 
32

 
49

 
35

 
89

 
124

Net charge-off %(1)
 
0.95
%
 
2.51
%
 
1.81
%
 
0.43
%
 
0.95
%
 
0.67
%
 
0.60
%
 
1.57
%
 
1.08
%
 
 
 
2012
 
 
Florida
 
All Other States
 
Total
 
 
1st Lien
 
2nd Lien
 
Total
 
1st Lien
 
2nd Lien
 
Total
 
1st Lien
 
2nd Lien
 
Total
 
 
(Dollars in millions)
Balance
 
$
1,870

 
$
2,433

 
$
4,303

 
$
3,752

 
$
3,745

 
$
7,497

 
$
5,622

 
$
6,178

 
$
11,800

Net charge-offs
 
33

 
113

 
146

 
29

 
59

 
88

 
62

 
172

 
234

Net charge-off %(1)
 
1.71
%
 
4.38
%
 
3.25
%
 
0.77
%
 
1.45
%
 
1.12
%
 
1.08
%
 
2.60
%
 
1.90
%
________
(1)
 Net charge-off percentages are calculated as a percent of average balances.
Net charge-offs were 1.08 percent of home equity loans in 2013 compared to 1.90 percent in 2012. Losses in Florida-based credits remained at elevated levels, but the related net charge-off percentage decreased significantly to 1.81 percent in 2013 from 3.25 percent in 2012. Improving underwriting standards and stabilizing home values in Florida are contributing to this improvement.
Of the $11.3 billion home equity portfolio at December 31, 2013, approximately $9.2 billion were home equity lines of credit and $2.1 billion were closed-end home equity loans (primarily originated as amortizing loans). Beginning in May 2009, new home equity lines of credit have a 10-year draw period and a 10-year repayment period. Previously, home equity lines of credit had a 20-year term with a balloon payment upon maturity or a 5-year draw period with a balloon payment upon maturity. The term “balloon payment” means there are no principal payments required until the balloon payment is due for interest-only lines of credit. As of December 31, 2013, none of Regions' home equity lines of credit have converted to mandatory amortization under the contractual terms. The majority of home equity lines of credit will either mature with a balloon payment or convert to amortizing status after fiscal year 2020.
Of the $9.2 billion of home equity lines of credit at December 31, 2013, approximately 91 percent require monthly interest-only payments while the remaining approximately 9 percent require a payment equal to 1.5 percent of the outstanding balance, which would include some principal repayment. At December 31, 2013, approximately 30 percent of borrowers were only paying the minimum amount due on their home equity line. In addition, approximately 57 percent of home equity lines of credit balances have the option to amortize either all or a portion of their balance. At December 31, 2013, approximately $295 million of home equity line of credit balances have elected this option.
Regions is unable to track payment status on first liens held by another institution, including payment status related to loan modifications. When Regions’ second lien position becomes delinquent, an attempt is made to contact the first lien holder and inquire as to the payment status of the first lien. However, Regions does not continuously monitor the payment status of the first lien position. Short sale offers and settlement agreements are often received by the home equity junior lien holders well before the loan balance reaches the delinquency threshold for charge-off consideration, potentially resulting in a full balance payoff/charge-off. Regions is presently monitoring the status of all first lien position loans that the Company owns or services and has a second lien, and is taking appropriate action when delinquent. Regions services the first lien on approximately 23 percent of the entire second lien home equity portfolio as of December 31, 2013. During 2012, Regions evaluated a means to monitor non-Regions-serviced first liens using a third-party service provider. While the data was not conclusive, there was no reason to believe that the results related to the non-Regions-serviced first liens would be significantly different than that of the portfolio which Regions services.

65

Table of Contents


Other Consumer Credit Quality Data
The Company calculates an estimate of the current value of property secured as collateral for both home equity and residential first mortgage lending products (“current LTV”). The estimate is based on home price indices compiled by a third party. The third party data indicates trends for Metropolitan Statistical Areas (“MSAs”). Regions uses the third party valuation trends from the MSAs in the Company's footprint in its estimate. The trend data is applied to the loan portfolios taking into account the age of the most recent valuation and geographic area.
The following table presents current LTV data for components of the residential first mortgage and home equity classes of the consumer portfolio segment. Current LTV data for the remaining loans in the portfolio is not available, primarily because some of the loans are serviced by others. Data may also not be available due to mergers and systems integrations. The amounts in the table represent the entire loan balance. For purposes of the table below, if the loan balance exceeds the current estimated collateral, the entire balance is included in the “Above 100%” category, regardless of the amount of collateral available to partially offset the shortfall. The balances in the "Above 100%" category as a percentage of the portfolio balances decreased in the residential first mortgage portfolio from 13 percent to 6 percent, while home equity declined from 17 percent to 13 percent, as of December 31, 2013.
Table 13—Estimated Current Loan to Value Ranges
 
 
 
December 31, 2013
 
December 31, 2012
 
 
Residential
First Mortgage
 
Home Equity
 
Residential
First Mortgage
 
Home Equity
 
 
 
1st Lien
 
2nd Lien
 
 
1st Lien
 
2nd Lien
 
 
(In millions)
Estimated current loan to value:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Above 100%
 
$
733

 
$
416

 
$
1,034

 
$
1,662

 
$
538

 
$
1,450

80% - 100%
 
2,050

 
737

 
1,294

 
2,610

 
766

 
1,468

Below 80%
 
8,899

 
4,646

 
2,501

 
8,248

 
4,082

 
2,595

Data not available
 
481

 
199

 
467

 
443

 
236

 
665

 
 
$
12,163

 
$
5,998

 
$
5,296

 
$
12,963

 
$
5,622

 
$
6,178


Regions qualitatively considers factors such as periodic updates of FICO scores, unemployment, home prices, and geography as credit quality indicators for consumer loans. FICO scores are obtained at origination as part of Regions' formal underwriting process. Refreshed FICO scores are obtained by the Company quarterly for all revolving accounts and home equity lines of credit and semi-annually for all other consumer loans. Regions considers FICO scores less than 620 to be indicative of higher credit risk and obtains additional collateral in most of these instances. The following table presents estimated current FICO score data for components of classes of the consumer portfolio segment. Current FICO data is not available for the remaining loans in the portfolio for various reasons; for example, if customers do not use sufficient credit, an updated score may not be available. Residential first mortgage and home equity balances with FICO scores below 620 declined to 7 percent of the combined portfolios for December 31, 2013, down 1 percent from December 31, 2012.
Table 14—Estimated Current FICO Score Ranges
 
 
 
December 31, 2013
 
 
Residential
First Mortgage
 
Home
Equity
 
Indirect
 
Consumer
Credit Card
 
Other
Consumer
 
 
 
1st Lien
 
2nd Lien
 
 
 
 
 
(In millions)
Below 620
 
$
886

 
$
324

 
$
322

 
$
312

 
$
38

 
$
87

620 - 680
 
1,022

 
533

 
527

 
470

 
130

 
142

681 - 720
 
1,341

 
725

 
672

 
511

 
216

 
177

Above 720
 
8,091

 
4,052

 
3,491

 
1,599

 
563

 
425

Data not available
 
823

 
364

 
284

 
183

 
1

 
330

 
 
$
12,163

 
$
5,998

 
$
5,296

 
$
3,075

 
$
948

 
$
1,161

 

66

Table of Contents


 
 
December 31, 2012
 
 
Residential
First Mortgage
 
Home
Equity
 
Indirect
 
Consumer
Credit Card
 
Other
Consumer
 
 
 
1st Lien
 
2nd Lien
 
 
 
 
 
(In millions)
Below 620
 
$
1,212

 
$
370

 
$
419

 
$
218

 
$
57

 
$
97

620 - 680
 
1,259

 
536

 
589

 
352

 
135

 
134

681 - 720
 
1,435

 
675

 
772

 
354

 
211

 
160

Above 720
 
8,214

 
3,508

 
4,053

 
1,085

 
494

 
383

Data not available
 
843

 
533

 
345

 
327

 
9

 
423

 
 
$
12,963

 
$
5,622

 
$
6,178

 
$
2,336

 
$
906

 
$
1,197


Allowance for Credit Losses
The allowance for credit losses ("allowance") consists of two components: the allowance for loan and lease losses and the reserve for unfunded credit commitments. The allowance represents management’s estimate of probable credit losses inherent in the loan and credit commitment portfolios as of period end. Regions determines its allowance in accordance with applicable accounting literature as well as regulatory guidance related to receivables and contingencies. Binding unfunded credit commitments include items such as letters of credit, financial guarantees and binding unfunded loan commitments. Additional discussion of the methodology used to calculate the allowance is included in Note 6 “Allowance for Credit Losses” to the consolidated financial statements, as well as related discussion in Management’s Discussion and Analysis.
The allowance for loan losses totaled $1.3 billion at December 31, 2013 and $1.9 billion at December 31, 2012. The allowance for loan losses as a percentage of net loans was 1.80 percent at December 31, 2013 and 2.59 percent at December 31, 2012. The reserve for unfunded credit commitments was $78 million at December 31, 2013 compared to $83 million at December 31, 2012. Net charge-offs as a percentage of average loans were 0.96 percent and 1.37 percent in 2013 and 2012, respectively. Net charge-offs were lower across most categories, particularly in the case of commercial investor real estate mortgage as a result of the ongoing portfolio de-risking and fundamental improvement in credit performance. Net charge-offs for residential first mortgage included $151 million related to the transfer of primarily accruing loans classified as troubled debt restructurings to held for sale late in 2013. The provision for loan losses totaled $138 million for the year ended December 31, 2013 compared to $213 million for the year ended December 31, 2012. Net charge-offs exceeded the provision for loan losses for 2013, primarily resulting from continued improving credit metrics such as lower levels of non-accrual and criticized and classified loans, as well as, problem loan resolutions and a continuing mix shift in loans out of higher risk investor real estate and into less risky commercial and industrial loans.
Management considers the current level of the allowance appropriate to absorb losses inherent in the loan and credit commitment portfolios. Management’s determination of the appropriateness of the allowance requires the use of judgments and estimations that may change in the future. Changes in the factors used by management to determine the appropriateness of the allowance or the availability of new information could cause the allowance to be increased or decreased in future periods. Management expects the allowance for credit losses to total loans ratio to vary over time due to changes in portfolio balances, economic conditions, loan mix and collateral values, or variations in other factors that may affect inherent losses. In addition, bank regulatory agencies, as part of their examination process, may require changes in the level of the allowance based on their judgments and estimates.
Management expects that net loan charge-offs in 2014 will continue to improve compared to 2013. Economic trends such as real estate valuations, interest rates and unemployment will impact the future levels of net charge-offs and provision and may result in volatility during 2014. Additionally, changes in circumstances related to individually large credits or certain portfolios may result in volatility. Details regarding the allowance and net charge-offs, including an analysis of activity from the previous year’s totals, are included in Table 15 “Allowance for Credit Losses.”


67

Table of Contents


The table below summarizes activity in the allowance for credit losses for the years ended December 31:
Table 15—Allowance for Credit Losses
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
2010
 
2009
 
(Dollars in millions)
Allowance for loan losses at January 1
$
1,919

 
$
2,745

 
$
3,185

 
$
3,114

 
$
1,826

Loans charged-off:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
186

 
203

 
294

 
429

 
384

Commercial real estate mortgage—owner-occupied
125

 
193

 
248

 
225

 
89

Commercial real estate construction—owner-occupied
1

 
8

 
8

 
25

 
19

Commercial investor real estate mortgage
69

 
226

 
685

 
879

 
590

Commercial investor real estate construction
1

 
46

 
195

 
565

 
488

Residential first mortgage
223

 
147

 
220

 
240

 
206

Home equity
159

 
266

 
353

 
432

 
442

Indirect
31

 
23

 
23

 
34

 
68

Consumer credit card
38

 
45

 
13

 

 

Other consumer
65

 
66

 
68

 
83

 
83

 
898

 
1,223

 
2,107

 
2,912

 
2,369

Recoveries of loans previously charged-off:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
45

 
61

 
36

 
33

 
28

Commercial real estate mortgage—owner-occupied
25

 
16

 
14

 
11

 
6

Commercial real estate construction—owner-occupied
3

 

 

 
1

 
1

Commercial investor real estate mortgage
35

 
36

 
27

 
14

 
8

Commercial investor real estate construction
5

 
9

 
6

 
10

 
4

Residential first mortgage
6

 
5

 
3

 
2

 
4

Home equity
35

 
32

 
25

 
18

 
27

Indirect
10

 
8

 
10

 
15

 
21

Consumer credit card
4

 
2

 

 

 

Other consumer
14

 
15

 
16

 
16

 
17

 
182

 
184

 
137

 
120

 
116

Net charge-offs:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
141

 
142

 
258

 
396

 
356

Commercial real estate mortgage—owner-occupied
100

 
177

 
234

 
214

 
83

Commercial real estate construction—owner-occupied
(2
)
 
8

 
8

 
24

 
18

Commercial investor real estate mortgage
34

 
190

 
658

 
865

 
582

Commercial investor real estate construction
(4
)
 
37

 
189

 
555

 
484

Residential first mortgage
217

 
142

 
217

 
238

 
202

Home equity
124

 
234

 
328

 
414

 
415

Indirect
21

 
15

 
13

 
19

 
47

Consumer credit card
34

 
43

 
13

 

 

Other consumer
51

 
51

 
52

 
67

 
66

 
716

 
1,039

 
1,970

 
2,792

 
2,253

Provision for loan losses
138

 
213

 
1,530

 
2,863

 
3,541

Allowance for loan losses at December 31
$
1,341

 
$
1,919

 
$
2,745

 
$
3,185

 
$
3,114

Reserve for unfunded credit commitments at January 1
$
83

 
$
78

 
$
71

 
$
74

 
$
74

Provision (credit) for unfunded credit losses
(5
)
 
5

 
7

 
(3
)
 

Reserve for unfunded credit commitments at December 31
$
78

 
$
83

 
$
78

 
$
71

 
$
74

Allowance for credit losses at December 31
$
1,419

 
$
2,002

 
$
2,823

 
$
3,256

 
$
3,188

Loans, net of unearned income, outstanding at end of period
$
74,609

 
$
73,995

 
$
77,594

 
$
82,864

 
$
90,674

Average loans, net of unearned income, outstanding for the period
$
74,924

 
$
76,035

 
$
80,673

 
$
86,660

 
$
94,523

Ratios:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Allowance for loan losses to loans, net of unearned income
1.80
%
 
2.59
%
 
3.54
%
 
3.84
%
 
3.43
%
Allowance for loan losses to non-performing loans, excluding loans held for sale
1.24x

 
1.14x

 
1.16x

 
1.01x

 
0.89x

Net charge-offs as percentage of:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Average loans, net of unearned income
0.96
%
 
1.37
%
 
2.44
%
 
3.22
%
 
2.38
%
Provision for loan losses
518.8
%
 
487.8
%
 
128.8
%
 
97.5
%
 
63.6
%


68

Table of Contents


Allocation of the allowance for loan losses by portfolio segment and class is summarized as follows:
Table 16—Allocation of the Allowance for Loan Losses
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
2010
 
2009
 
Allocation
Amount
 
% Loans
in Each
Category
 
Allocation
Amount
 
% Loans
in Each
Category
 
Allocation
Amount
 
% Loans
in Each
Category
 
Allocation
Amount
 
% Loans
in Each
Category
 
Allocation
Amount
 
% Loans
in Each
Category
 
(Dollars in millions)
Commercial and industrial
$
427

 
39.4
%
 
$
497

 
36.1
%
 
$
586

 
31.6
%
 
$
641

 
27.2
%
 
$
638

 
23.8
%
Commercial real estate mortgage—owner-occupied
271

 
12.8

 
342

 
13.6

 
427

 
14.4

 
395

 
14.5

 
328

 
13.3

Commercial real estate construction—owner-occupied
13

 
0.4

 
8

 
0.4

 
17

 
0.4

 
19

 
0.6

 
37

 
0.8

Total commercial
711

 
52.6

 
847

 
50.1

 
1,030

 
46.4

 
1,055

 
42.3

 
1,003

 
37.9

Commercial investor real estate mortgage
210

 
7.1

 
424

 
9.2

 
784

 
12.5

 
1,030

 
16.4

 
929

 
17.8

Commercial investor real estate construction
26

 
1.9

 
45

 
1.2

 
207

 
1.3

 
340

 
2.8

 
536

 
6.2

Total investor real estate
236

 
9.0

 
469

 
10.4

 
991

 
13.8

 
1,370

 
19.2

 
1,465

 
24.0

Residential first mortgage
119

 
16.3

 
254

 
17.5

 
282

 
17.8

 
295

 
18.0

 
213

 
17.2

Home equity
160

 
15.1

 
252

 
16.0

 
356

 
16.8

 
414

 
17.2

 
374

 
17.0

Indirect
39

 
4.1

 
20

 
3.2

 
17

 
2.4

 
17

 
1.9

 
26

 
2.7

Consumer credit card
43

 
1.3

 
45

 
1.2

 
37

 
1.3

 

 

 

 

Other consumer
33

 
1.6

 
32

 
1.6

 
32

 
1.5

 
34

 
1.4

 
33

 
1.2

Total consumer
394

 
38.4

 
603

 
39.5

 
724

 
39.8

 
760

 
38.5

 
646

 
38.1

 
$
1,341

 
100.0
%
 
$
1,919

 
100.0
%
 
$
2,745

 
100.0
%
 
$
3,185

 
100.0
%
 
$
3,114

 
100.0
%


69

Table of Contents


TROUBLED DEBT RESTRUCTURINGS (TDRs)
Residential first mortgage, home equity, consumer credit card, indirect and other consumer TDRs are consumer loans modified under the Customer Assistance Program. Commercial and investor real estate loan modifications are not the result of a formal program, but represent situations where modification was offered as a workout alternative. Renewals of classified commercial and investor real estate loans are considered to be TDRs, even if no reduction in interest rate is offered, because the existing terms are considered to be below market. More detailed information is included in Note 6 “Allowance for Credit Losses” to the consolidated financial statements. The following table summarizes TDRs for the periods ending December 31:
Table 17—Troubled Debt Restructurings
 
 
 
2013
 
2012
 
 
Loan
Balance
 
Allowance for
Loan Losses
 
Loan
Balance
 
Allowance for
Loan Losses
 
 
(In millions)
Accruing:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial
 
$
468

 
$
58

 
$
500

 
$
67

Investor real estate
 
511

 
46

 
873

 
112

Residential first mortgage
 
307

 
48

 
984

 
131

Home equity
 
361

 
23

 
391

 
35

Indirect
 
1

 

 

 

Consumer credit card
 
2

 

 

 

Other consumer
 
26

 

 
41

 
1

 
 
1,676

 
175

 
2,789

 
346

Non-accrual status or 90 days past due and still accruing:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial
 
156

 
48

 
291

 
83

Investor real estate
 
157

 
41

 
251

 
73

Residential first mortgage
 
156

 
24

 
201

 
27

Home equity
 
30

 
2

 
37

 
3

 
 
499

 
115

 
780

 
186

Total TDRs - Loans
 
$
2,175

 
$
290

 
$
3,569

 
$
532

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
TDRs- Held For Sale
 
579

 

 
25

 

Total TDRs
 
$
2,754

 
$
290

 
$
3,594

 
$
532

_________
Note: All loans listed in the table above are considered impaired under applicable accounting literature. The majority of TDRs held for sale at December 31, 2013 were comprised of residential first mortgage loans transfered during the fourth quarter.


70

Table of Contents


NON-PERFORMING ASSETS

The following table presents non-performing assets as of December 31:
Table 18—Non-Performing Assets
 
 
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
2010
 
2009
 
 
(Dollars in millions)
Non-performing loans:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
 
$
257

 
$
409

 
$
457

 
$
467

 
$
427

Commercial real estate mortgage—owner-occupied
 
303

 
439

 
590

 
606

 
560

Commercial real estate construction—owner-occupied
 
17

 
14

 
25

 
29

 
50

Total commercial
 
577

 
862

 
1,072

 
1,102

 
1,037

Commercial investor real estate mortgage
 
238

 
457

 
734

 
1,265

 
1,203

Commercial investor real estate construction
 
10

 
20

 
180

 
452

 
1,067

Total investor real estate
 
248

 
477

 
914

 
1,717

 
2,270

Residential first mortgage
 
146

 
214

 
250

 
285

 
180

Home equity
 
111

 
128

 
136

 
56

 
1

Total consumer
 
257

 
342

 
386

 
341

 
181

Total non-performing loans, excluding loans held for sale
 
1,082

 
1,681

 
2,372

 
3,160

 
3,488

Non-performing loans held for sale
 
82

 
89

 
328

 
304

 
317

Total non-performing loans(1)
 
1,164

 
1,770

 
2,700

 
3,464

 
3,805

Foreclosed properties
 
136

 
149

 
296

 
454

 
607

Total non-performing assets(1)
 
$
1,300

 
$
1,919

 
$
2,996

 
$
3,918

 
$
4,412

Accruing loans 90 days past due:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
 
$
6

 
$
19

 
$
28

 
$
9

 
$
24

Commercial real estate mortgage—owner-occupied
 
6

 
6

 
9

 
6

 
16

Commercial real estate construction—owner-occupied
 

 

 

 
1

 
2

Total commercial
 
12

 
25

 
37

 
16


42

Commercial investor real estate mortgage
 
6

 
11

 
13

 
5

 
22

Commercial investor real estate construction
 

 

 

 
1

 
8

Total investor real estate
 
6

 
11

 
13

 
6

 
30

Residential first mortgage(2)
 
142

 
220

 
270

 
351

 
349

Home equity
 
75

 
87

 
93

 
198

 
241

Indirect
 
5

 
3

 
2

 
2

 
6

Consumer credit card
 
12

 
14

 
14

 

 

Other consumer
 
4

 
3

 
4

 
4

 
8

Total consumer
 
238

 
327

 
383

 
555

 
604

 
 
$
256

 
$
363

 
$
433

 
$
577

 
$
676

Restructured loans not included in the categories above
 
$
1,676

 
$
2,789

 
$
2,850

 
$
1,483

 
$
1,608

Restructured loans held for sale not included in the categories above
 
$
545

 
$

 
$
21

 
$

 
$

Non-performing loans(1) to loans and non-performing loans held for sale
 
1.56
%
 
2.39
%
 
3.47
%
 
4.17
%
 
4.18
%
Non-performing assets(1) to loans, foreclosed properties and non-performing loans held for sale
 
1.74
%
 
2.59
%
 
3.83
%
 
4.69
%
 
4.82
%
_________
(1)
Excludes accruing loans 90 days past due.
(2)
Excludes residential first mortgage loans that are 100% guaranteed by the Federal Housing Administration (FHA) and also those 100% guaranteed by the Government National Mortgage Association (GNMA) where Regions has the right but not the obligation to repurchase. Total 90 days or more past due guaranteed loans excluded were $106 million at December 31, 2013, $87 million at December 31, 2012, $14 million at December 31, 2011, $8 million at December 31, 2010 and $12 million at December 31, 2009.
Non-performing assets totaled $1.3 billion at December 31, 2013, compared to $1.9 billion at December 31, 2012. Foreclosed properties, a subset of non-performing assets, totaled $136 million and $149 million at December 31, 2013 and December 31,

71

Table of Contents


2012, respectively. The decrease in non-performing assets and foreclosed properties during 2013 reflects the Company’s continuing efforts to work through problem assets and reduce the riskiest exposures.

Based on current expectations for the economy, management anticipates non-performing assets to continue to improve in 2014 as compared to 2013. Economic trends such as real estate valuations, interest rates and unemployment, as well as the level of disposition activity, will impact the future level of non-performing assets. Circumstances related to individually large credits could also result in volatility throughout 2014.
Loans past due 90 days or more and still accruing were $256 million at December 31, 2013, a decrease from $363 million at December 31, 2012.
At December 31, 2013, Regions had approximately $150-$250 million of potential problem commercial and investor real estate loans that were not included in non-accrual loans, but for which management had concerns as to the ability of such borrowers to comply with their present loan repayment terms. This is a likely estimate of the amount of commercial and investor real estate loans that may migrate to non-accrual status in the next quarter.
In order to arrive at the estimate of potential problem loans, personnel from geographic regions forecast certain larger dollar loans that may potentially be downgraded to non-accrual at a future time, depending on the occurrence of future events. These personnel consider a variety of factors, including the borrower’s capacity and willingness to meet the contractual repayment terms, make principal curtailments or provide additional collateral when necessary, and provide current and complete financial information including global cash flows, contingent liabilities and sources of liquidity. A probability weighting is assigned to the listing of loans due to the inherent level of uncertainty related to potential actions that a borrower or guarantor may take to prevent the loan from reaching problem status. Regions assigns the probability weighting based on an assessment of the likelihood that the necessary actions required to prevent problem loan status will occur. Additionally, for other loans (for example, smaller dollar loans), a factor based on trends and experience is applied to determine the estimate of potential future downgrades. Because of the inherent uncertainty in forecasting future events, the estimate of potential problem loans ultimately represents the estimated aggregate dollar amounts of loans as opposed to an individual listing of loans.
The majority of the loans on which the potential problem loan estimate is based are considered criticized and classified. Detailed disclosures for substandard accrual loans (as well as other credit quality metrics) are included in Note 6 “Allowance for Credit Losses” to the consolidated financial statements.

The following table provides an analysis of non-accrual loans (excluding loans held for sale) by portfolio segment for the years ended December 31:
Table 19—Analysis of Non-Accrual Loans
 
 
 
Non-Accrual Loans, Excluding Loans Held for Sale
2013
 
 
Commercial
 
Investor
Real Estate
 
Consumer(1)
 
Total
 
 
(In millions)
Balance at beginning of year
 
$
862

 
$
477

 
$
342

 
$
1,681

Additions
 
755

 
295

 
(71
)
 
979

Net payments/other activity
 
(387
)
 
(263
)
 

 
(650
)
Return to accrual
 
(195
)
 
(129
)
 

 
(324
)
Charge-offs on non-accrual loans(2)
 
(303
)
 
(66
)
 
(1
)
 
(370
)
Transfers to held for sale(3)
 
(108
)
 
(43
)
 
(13
)
 
(164
)
Transfers to foreclosed properties
 
(26
)
 
(17
)
 

 
(43
)
Sales
 
(21
)
 
(6
)
 

 
(27
)
Balance at end of year
 
$
577

 
$
248

 
$
257

 
$
1,082


72

Table of Contents


 
 
Non-Accrual Loans, Excluding Loans Held for Sale
2012
 
 
Commercial
 
Investor
Real Estate
 
Consumer(1)
 
Total
 
 
(In millions)
Balance at beginning of year
 
$
1,072

 
$
914

 
$
386

 
$
2,372

Additions
 
841

 
698

 
(30
)
 
1,509

Net payments/other activity
 
(348
)
 
(427
)
 

 
(775
)
Return to accrual
 
(101
)
 
(213
)
 

 
(314
)
Charge-offs on non-accrual loans(2)
 
(390
)
 
(261
)
 
(6
)
 
(657
)
Transfers to held for sale(3)
 
(120
)
 
(178
)
 
(4
)
 
(302
)
Transfers to foreclosed properties
 
(67
)
 
(28
)
 

 
(95
)
Sales
 
(25
)
 
(28
)
 
(4
)
 
(57
)
Balance at end of year
 
$
862

 
$
477

 
$
342

 
$
1,681

________
(1)
All net activity within the consumer portfolio segment other than sales and transfers to held for sale (including related charge-offs) is included as a single net number within the additions line, due to the relative immateriality of consumer non-accrual loans.
(2)
Includes charge-offs on loans on non-accrual status and charge-offs taken upon sale and transfer of non-accrual loans to held for sale.
(3)
Transfers to held for sale are shown net of charge-offs of $93 million and $163 million recorded upon transfer for the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

The following table provides an analysis of non-performing loans held for sale for the years ended December 31:
Table 20—Non-Performing Loans Held For Sale
 
 
 
2013
 
2012
 
 
(In millions)
Balance at beginning of year
 
$
89

 
$
328

Transfers in
 
164

 
302

Sales
 
(117
)
 
(470
)
Writedowns
 
(2
)
 
(9
)
Loans moved from held for sale/other activity
 
(40
)
 
(29
)
Transfers to foreclosed properties
 
(12
)
 
(33
)
Balance at end of year
 
$
82

 
$
89

For additional discussion, see Note 6 “Allowance for Credit Losses” to the consolidated financial statements.

Premises and Equipment
Premises and equipment are stated at cost, less accumulated depreciation and amortization, as applicable. Premises and equipment at December 31, 2013 decreased $63 million to $2.2 billion compared to year-end 2012. This decrease primarily resulted from depreciation expense on existing assets.
Goodwill
Goodwill totaled $4.8 billion at both December 31, 2013 and 2012 and was reallocated to the new reporting units during 2012. Refer to the “Critical Accounting Policies” section earlier in this report for detailed discussions of the Company’s methodology for testing goodwill for impairment. Refer to Note 1 “Summary of Significant Accounting Policies” and Note 9 “Intangible Assets” to the consolidated financial statements for the methodologies and assumptions used in Step One of the goodwill impairment test and further details on the reallocation. Additionally, Note 1 “Summary of Significant Accounting Policies” to the consolidated financial statements includes information related to the fair value measurements of certain assets and liabilities and the valuation methodology of such measurements, which is also used for testing goodwill for impairment.

73

Table of Contents


Mortgage Servicing Rights
Mortgage servicing rights at December 31, 2013 totaled $297 million compared to $191 million at December 31, 2012. The year-over-year increase of $106 million reflects organic growth, the increase in mortgage interest rates in 2013, and was due in part to the addition of $28 million related to a purchase of rights to service residential mortgage loans that was made during the first quarter of 2013. An analysis of mortgage servicing rights is presented in Note 7 “Servicing of Financial Assets” to the consolidated financial statements. The balances shown represent the right to service mortgage loans that are owned by other investors and are presented at fair value. Data and assumptions used in the fair value calculation, as well as certain sensitivity estimates, are also presented in Note 7.
Other Identifiable Intangible Assets
Other identifiable intangible assets totaled $295 million at December 31, 2013 compared to $345 million at December 31, 2012. The year-over-year decrease was due to amortization of core deposit intangibles and the purchased credit card intangibles. See Note 9 “Intangible Assets” to the consolidated financial statements for further information.

Foreclosed Properties
Other real estate and certain other assets acquired in foreclosure are reported at the lower of the investment in the loan or fair value of the property less estimated costs to sell. The following table summarizes foreclosed property activity for the years ended December 31:
Table 21—Foreclosed Properties
 
 
 
2013
 
2012
 
 
(In millions)
Balance at beginning of year
 
$
149

 
$
296

Transfer from loans
 
229

 
294

Valuation adjustments
 
(35
)
 
(66
)
Foreclosed property sold
 
(199
)
 
(370
)
Payments and other
 
(8
)
 
(5
)
 
 
(13
)
 
(147
)
Balance at end of year
 
$
136

 
$
149

_________
Note: Approximately 76 percent and 96 percent of the ending balances at December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively, relate to properties transferred into foreclosed properties during the corresponding calendar year.
Valuation adjustments are primarily recorded in other non-interest expense; adjustments are also recorded as a charge to the allowance for loan losses if incurred within 60 days after the date of transfer from loans. Valuation adjustments are primarily the cost of adjusting foreclosed properties to estimated fair value after these assets have been classified as foreclosed properties. Foreclosed property sold represents the net book value of the properties sold.
Other Assets
Other assets decreased $326 million to $5.8 billion as of December 31, 2013. Lower derivative assets, prepaid expense balances and deferred income taxes primarily drove the decrease. These declines were partially offset by additional investments in bank-owned life insurance and affordable housing.


74

Table of Contents



Deposits
Regions competes with other banking and financial services companies for a share of the deposit market. Regions’ ability to compete in the deposit market depends heavily on the pricing of its deposits and how effectively the Company meets customers’ needs. Regions employs various means to meet those needs and enhance competitiveness, such as providing a high level of customer service, competitive pricing and providing convenient branch locations for its customers. Regions also serves customers through providing centralized, high-quality banking services and alternative product delivery channels such as internet banking.
Deposits are Regions’ primary source of funds, providing funding for 89 percent of average interest-earning assets in 2013 and 88 percent of average interest-earning assets in 2012. Table 22 “Deposits” details year-over-year deposits on a period-ending basis. Total deposits at December 31, 2013 decreased approximately $3.0 billion compared to year-end 2012 levels. The decrease in deposits was primarily driven by the continued runoff of time deposits in the low interest rate environment as customers sought higher yields, as well as customers diversifying their deposits in response to the expiration of the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation's (FDIC) Transaction Account Guarantee (TAG) Program. The TAG Program fully insured non-interest-bearing transaction accounts beyond the $250 thousand deposit insurance limit, and expired on January 1, 2013.
Due to liquidity in the market, Regions has been able to steadily grow its low-cost customer deposits and reduce its total deposit costs from 49 basis points in 2011 to 30 basis points in 2012 and to 15 basis points in 2013. The following table summarizes deposits by category as of December 31:
Table 22—Deposits
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
(In millions)
Non-interest-bearing demand
$
30,083

 
$
29,963

 
$
28,209

Savings
6,050

 
5,760

 
5,159

Interest-bearing transaction
20,789

 
21,096

 
19,388

Money market—domestic
25,635

 
24,901

 
23,028

Money market—foreign
220

 
311

 
460

Low-cost deposits
82,777

 
82,031

 
76,244

Time deposits
9,608

 
13,443

 
19,378

Customer deposits
92,385

 
95,474

 
95,622

Corporate treasury time deposits
68

 

 
5

 
$
92,453

 
$
95,474

 
$
95,627

Within customer deposits, non-interest-bearing demand deposits increased $120 million to $30.1 billion. Non-interest-bearing deposits accounted for approximately 33 percent of total deposits at year-end 2013 compared to 31 percent at year-end 2012. Savings balances increased $290 million to $6.1 billion, generally reflecting continued consumer savings trends, spurred by economic uncertainty. Interest-bearing transaction accounts declined $307 million to $20.8 billion. Interest-bearing transaction deposits accounted for approximately 23 percent of total deposits at year-end 2013 compared to 22 percent at year-end 2012.
Domestic money market products, which exclude foreign money market accounts, are one of Regions’ most significant funding sources. These balances increased 3 percent in 2013 to $25.6 billion or 28 percent of total deposits, compared to 26 percent of total deposits in 2012 reflecting a shift in the mix of deposits.
Included in customer time deposits are certificates of deposit and individual retirement accounts. The balance of customer time deposits decreased 29 percent in 2013 to $9.6 billion compared to $13.4 billion in 2012. The decrease was primarily due to maturities with minimal reinvestment by customers as a result of the continued decline in rates offered on these products. Customer time deposits accounted for 10 percent of total deposits in 2013 compared to 14 percent in 2012. Table 23 “Maturity of Time Deposits of $100,000 or More” presents maturities of time deposits of $100,000 or more at December 31, 2013 and 2012.
Consistent with 2012, corporate treasury deposits, which are used mainly for overnight funding purposes, remained at low levels in 2013 as the Company continued to utilize customer-based funding and other sources. The Company’s choice of overnight funding sources is dependent on the Company’s particular funding needs and the relative attractiveness of each source.
The sensitivity of Regions’ deposit rates to changes in market interest rates is reflected in Regions’ average interest rate paid on interest-bearing deposits. The rate paid on interest-bearing deposits decreased to 0.21 percent in 2013 from 0.43 percent in 2012, driven by the expiration of time deposits, the positive mix shift to lower cost customer products, and continuation of the low interest rate environment throughout much of 2013.

75

Table of Contents



Table 23—Maturity of Time Deposits of $100,000 or More
 
2013
 
2012
 
(In millions)
Time deposits of $100,000 or more, maturing in:
 
 
 
3 months or less
$
455

 
$
1,002

Over 3 through 6 months
306

 
1,168

Over 6 through 12 months
567

 
900

Over 12 months
2,052

 
1,949

 
$
3,380

 
$
5,019


Short-Term Borrowings

See Note 11 “Short-Term Borrowings” to the consolidated financial statements for a summary of these borrowings at December 31, 2013 and 2012. Short-term borrowings totaled $2.2 billion at December 31, 2013, compared to $1.6 billion at December 31, 2012. The levels of these borrowings can fluctuate depending on the Company’s funding needs and the sources utilized, as well as a result of customers’ activity.
COMPANY FUNDING SOURCES
Federal funds purchased used for funding purposes totaled $11 million at December 31, 2013 compared to $21 million at December 31, 2012. In the near term, Regions expects the use of wholesale unsecured borrowings, such as Federal funds purchased, to remain low. Short-term secured borrowings, such as securities sold under agreements to repurchase and Federal Home Loan Bank ("FHLB") advances, are a core portion of Regions funding strategy and can fluctuate significantly on a day-to-day basis, depending on funding needs and which sources of funds are used to satisfy those needs. All such arrangements are considered typical of the banking industry and are accounted for as borrowings.
Due to the uncertainty and inconsistency of the short-term funding markets during the recession, Regions had taken an approach to maintain higher levels of cash at the Federal Reserve Bank. These higher levels of cash negated the need to occasionally borrow short-term funds to cover normal monthly cash flow needs. As the economy continues to improve, Regions has reduced the amount of excess cash held at the Federal Reserve Bank and will utilize short-term secured funding markets as needed to augment its cash position. The securities financing market and short-term FHLB advances continue to provide reliable funding at attractive rates. There were no short-term FHLB advances outstanding at December 31, 2013 or December 31, 2012. See the "Liquidity" section for further detail of Regions' borrowing capacity with the FHLB.
Table 24 provides selected information for certain short-term borrowings used for funding purposes as of and for the year ended December 31:

76

Table of Contents


Table 24—Selected Short-Term Borrowings Data  
 
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
 
(Dollars in millions)
Federal funds purchased:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance at year-end
 
$
11

 
$
21

 
$
18

Average outstanding (based on average daily balances)
 
19

 
21

 
19

Maximum amount outstanding at any month-end
 
29

 
28

 
22

Weighted average interest rate at year-end
 
0.2
%
 
0.1
%
 
0.1
 %
Weighted average interest rate on amounts outstanding during the year (based on average daily balances)
 
0.1
%
 
0.1
%
 
0.1
 %
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance at year-end
 
$

 
$

 
$
969

Average outstanding (based on average daily balances)
 
234

 
633

 
419

Maximum amount outstanding at any month-end
 
1,425

 
1,940

 
969

Weighted average interest rate at year-end
 
%
 
%
 
(0.2
)%
Weighted average interest rate on amounts outstanding during the year (based on average daily balances)
 
0.1
%
 
0.1
%
 
(0.6
)%
CUSTOMER-RELATED BORROWINGS
Short-term borrowings that are the result of customer activity related to investment opportunities totaled $2.2 billion and $1.6 billion at December 31, 2013 and December 31, 2012, respectively.
Repurchase agreements are also offered as short-term investment opportunities for commercial banking customers. At the end of each business day, customer balances are swept into the agreement account. In exchange for cash, Regions sells the customer securities with a commitment to repurchase them on the following business day. The repurchase agreements are collateralized to allow for market fluctuations. Securities from Regions Bank’s investment portfolio are used as collateral. From the customer’s perspective, the investment earns more than a traditional money market instrument. From Regions’ standpoint, the repurchase agreements are similar to deposit accounts, although they are not insured by the FDIC or guaranteed either directly by the United States or one of its agencies. Regions Bank does not manage the level of these investments on a daily basis as the transactions are initiated by the customers. The level of these borrowings can fluctuate significantly on a day-to-day basis.

Customer collateral reported as short-term borrowings was zero at December 31, 2013 and $125 million at December 31, 2012. These balances represent cash collateral posted by customers related to derivative transactions. Regions began netting cash collateral, subject to enforceable master netting agreements, against the net derivative asset or liability beginning in 2013.

Long-term borrowings

Regions’ long-term borrowings consist primarily of FHLB borrowings, senior notes, subordinated notes and other long-term notes payable. Total long-term borrowings decreased $1.0 billion to $4.8 billion at December 31, 2013. The decrease between years was the result of approximately $750 million in maturities of senior and subordinated notes, a tender offer for $350 million in senior notes and the redemption or extinguishment of $498 million of junior subordinated notes and $118 million of other long-term debt. Pre-tax losses on these extinguishments totaled $61 million, $29 million of which was not deductible for income tax purposes. These decreases were partially offset by a $750 million issuance of senior notes. The weighted-average interest rate on total long-term debt, including the effect of derivative instruments, was 4.8 percent, 4.7 percent and 3.3 percent for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011, respectively. See Note 12 “Long-Term Borrowings” to the consolidated financial statements for further discussion and detailed listing of outstandings and rates.
Other Liabilities
Other liabilities decreased $776 million to $2.2 billion as of December 31, 2013. The decrease was primarily driven by lower derivative liabilities and accrued employee benefit costs. The decrease in derivative liabilities was primarily due to Regions beginning to net cash collateral, subject to enforceable master netting agreements, against the net derivative asset or liability beginning in 2013. See Note 20 "Derivative Financial Instruments and Hedging Activities" for additional information.


77

Table of Contents


Ratings
Table 25 “Credit Ratings” reflects the debt ratings information of Regions Financial Corporation and Regions Bank by Standard and Poor's ("S&P"), Moody’s, Fitch and Dominion Bond Rating Service ("DBRS") as of December 31, 2013 and 2012.

Table 25—Credit Ratings
 
 
As of December 31, 2013
 
Standard  & Poor's
Moody’s
Fitch
DBRS
Regions Financial Corporation
 
 
 
 
Senior notes
BBB-
Ba1
BBB-
BBB
Subordinated notes
BB+
Ba2
BB+
BBBL
Regions Bank
 
 
 
 
Short-term debt
A-2
P-3
F3
R-2H
Long-term bank deposits
BBB
Baa3
BBB
BBBH
Long-term debt
BBB
Baa3
BBB-
BBBH
Subordinated debt
BBB-
Ba1
BB+
BBB
Outlook
Positive
Stable
Positive
Stable
 
As of December 31, 2012
 
Standard  & Poor's
Moody’s
Fitch
DBRS
Regions Financial Corporation
 
 
 
 
Senior notes
BBB-
Ba1
BBB-
BBB
Subordinated notes
BB+
Ba2
BB+
BBBL
Junior subordinated notes
BB
Ba3
B+
BBBL
Regions Bank
 
 
 
 
Short-term debt
A-2
P-3
F3
R-2H
Long-term bank deposits
BBB
Baa3
BBB
BBBH
Long-term debt
BBB
Baa3
BBB-
BBBH
Subordinated debt
BBB-
Ba1
BB+
BBB
Outlook
Stable
Stable
Positive
Stable

In general, ratings agencies base their ratings on many quantitative and qualitative factors, including capital adequacy, liquidity, asset quality, business mix, probability of government support, and level and quality of earnings. Any downgrade in credit ratings by one or more ratings agencies may impact Regions in several ways, including, but not limited to, Regions’ access to the capital markets or short-term funding, borrowing cost and capacity, collateral requirements, acceptability of its letters of credit, and funding of variable rate demand notes ("VRDNs"), thereby potentially adversely impacting Regions’ financial condition and liquidity. See the “Risk Factors” section of this Annual Report on Form 10-K for more information.

On June 20, 2013, S&P revised Regions' outlook from stable to positive while affirming its current ratings for both the holding company and bank. The outlook revision and affirmation reflects improvement in earnings performance, core capital position, and maintenance of a strong liquidity profile. In announcing their change in outlook, S&P also cited benefits of a strengthening economy and a more stable business position for Regions. This is another important step in returning Regions' credit ratings to more competitive levels.

With this revision, both S&P and Fitch now have positive outlooks on Regions. Regions continues to proactively work with the agencies to ensure they have a full and complete understanding of the progress the Company is making in restoring its financial performance.
During 2013, Regions redeemed all of its junior subordinated notes; therefore, the ratings table above has been adjusted accordingly.


78

Table of Contents


A security rating is not a recommendation to buy, sell or hold securities, and the ratings are subject to revision or withdrawal at any time by the assigning rating agency. Each rating should be evaluated independently of any other rating.

Stockholders' Equity
Stockholders’ equity was $15.8 billion at December 31, 2013 compared to $15.5 billion at December 31, 2012. During 2013, net income increased stockholders’ equity by $1.1 billion, while shares repurchased reduced equity by $340 million and cash dividends on common stock reduced equity by $138 million. Changes in accumulated other comprehensive income decreased equity by $384 million, primarily due to unrealized losses on securities available for sale.
On March 19, 2012, Regions issued 153 million shares of common stock at $5.90 per share. The proceeds from the sale, net of issuance costs, increased equity by approximately $875 million.
On April 4, 2012, Regions repurchased all 3.5 million shares of Series A preferred stock issued to the U.S. Treasury and in early May of 2012, Regions repurchased the related warrant from the U.S. Treasury. Therefore, there was $125 million in preferred dividends and discount accretion in 2012.
On November 1, 2012, Regions issued $500 million in depositary shares each representing a fractional ownership interest in a share of the Company’s 6.375% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series A, par value $1.00 per share. The net proceeds from the issuance increased equity by approximately $486 million. Cash dividends on preferred stock reduced equity by $32 million in 2013 and $4 million in 2012.
Regions increased its annual dividend to $0.10 per common share for 2013, compared to $0.04 per common share for both 2012 and 2011. Regions understands the importance of returning capital to shareholders. Management will continue to execute the capital planning process, including evaluation of the amount of the common stock dividend, with the Board of Directors and in conjunction with regulatory supervisors, subject to the Company’s results of operations.
As part of its 2013 Comprehensive Capital Analysis and Review ("CCAR") submission, Regions' proposed capital plans included up to $350 million in common share repurchases. The Federal Reserve did not object to these plans, and Regions' Board of Directors approved the share repurchase plan. The share repurchase authority granted by the Board of Directors was available from the beginning of the second quarter of 2013 and will continue through the first quarter of 2014. As of December 31, 2013, Regions had repurchased approximately 36 million shares of common stock at a total cost of approximately $340 million. These shares were immediately retired upon repurchase and therefore are not included in treasury stock.
Regions’ ratio of stockholders’ equity to total assets was 13.43 percent at December 31, 2013 and 12.77 percent at December 31, 2012. Regions’ ratio of tangible common stockholders’ equity (stockholder's equity less preferred stock, goodwill and other identifiable intangibles and the related deferred tax liability) to total tangible assets was 9.24 percent at December 31, 2013, compared to 8.63 percent at December 31, 2012 (see Table 2 “GAAP to Non-GAAP Reconciliation” for further discussion).
See Note 14 “Stockholders’ Equity and Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss)” for further information.

REGULATORY CAPITAL REQUIREMENTS
CURRENT CAPITAL RULES
Regions and Regions Bank are required to comply with regulatory capital requirements established by Federal and State banking agencies. These regulatory capital requirements involve quantitative measures of the Company’s assets, liabilities and certain off-balance sheet items, and also qualitative judgments by the regulators. Failure to meet minimum capital requirements can subject the Company to a series of increasingly restrictive regulatory actions. Currently, there are two basic measures of capital adequacy: a risk-based measure and a leverage measure. See Note 13 "Regulatory Capital Requirements and Restrictions" for further discussions of these measures and tabular presentation of the applicable holding company and bank regulatory capital requirements.
In recent years, the Federal Reserve and banking regulators began supplementing their assessment of the capital adequacy of a bank based on a variation of Tier 1 capital, known as Tier 1 common equity. This measure has been a key component of assessments of capital adequacy under the CCAR process. While not currently prescribed in amount by federal banking regulations (under Basel I), analysts and banking regulators have assessed Regions’ capital adequacy using the tangible common stockholders’ equity and/or the Tier 1 common equity measure. Because tangible common stockholders’ equity and Tier 1 common equity are not formally defined by GAAP or prescribed in amount by federal banking regulations (under Basel I), these measures are currently considered to be non-GAAP financial measures and other entities may calculate them differently than Regions’ disclosed

79

Table of Contents


calculations (see Table 2 “GAAP to Non-GAAP Reconciliation” for further details). The Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System assesses banks' capital levels in periods of stress against a minimum Tier 1 common (non-GAAP) capital level of 5 percent.
BASEL III AND THE NEW CAPITAL RULES

In July 2013, Regions' and Regions Bank's primary federal regulator, the Federal Reserve, published final rules (the “New Capital Rules”) establishing a new comprehensive capital framework for U.S. banking organizations. The New Capital Rules implement the Basel Committee's December 2010 framework known as “Basel III” for strengthening international capital standards as well as certain provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act. The New Capital Rules substantially revise the risk-based capital requirements applicable to bank holding companies and depository institutions, including the Company and the Bank, compared to the current U.S. risk-based capital rules. The New Capital Rules define the components of capital and address other issues affecting the numerator in banking institutions' regulatory capital ratios. The New Capital Rules also address risk weights and other issues affecting the denominator in banking institutions' regulatory capital ratios and replace the existing risk-weighting approach, which was derived from Basel I capital accords of the Basel Committee, with a more risk-sensitive approach based, in part, on the standardized approach in the Basel Committee's 2004 “Basel II” capital accords. The New Capital Rules also implement the requirements of Section 939A of the Dodd-Frank Act to remove references to credit ratings from the federal banking agencies' rules. The New Capital Rules are effective for Regions and Regions Bank on January 1, 2015 (subject to a phase-in period).

The New Capital Rules, among other things, (i) introduce a new capital measure called “Common Equity Tier 1” (“CET1”), (ii) specify that Tier 1 capital consist of CET1 and “Additional Tier 1 capital” instruments meeting specified requirements, (iii) define CET1 narrowly by requiring that most deductions/adjustments to regulatory capital measures be made to CET1 and not to the other components of capital and (iv) expand the scope of the deductions/adjustments to capital as compared to existing regulations.

Under the New Capital Rules, the initial minimum capital ratios as of January 1, 2015 will be as follows:

4.5% CET1 to risk-weighted assets.

6.0% Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets.

8.0% Total capital to risk-weighted assets.

The New Capital Rules also introduce a new capital conservation buffer designed to absorb losses during periods of economic stress. The capital conservation buffer is composed entirely of CET1, on top of these minimum risk-weighted asset ratios. In addition, the New Capital Rules provide for a countercyclical capital buffer applicable only to certain covered institutions. It is not expected that the countercyclical capital buffer will be applicable to Regions or Regions Bank. Banking institutions with a ratio of CET1 to risk-weighted assets above the minimum but below the capital conservation buffer (or below the combined capital conservation buffer and countercyclical capital buffer, when the latter is applied) will face constraints on dividends, equity repurchases and compensation based on the amount of the shortfall.
    
When fully phased-in on January 1, 2019, the New Capital Rules will require Regions and Regions Bank to maintain such additional capital conservation buffer of 2.5% of CET1, effectively resulting in minimum ratios of (i) CET1 to risk-weighted assets of at least 7%, (ii) Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets of at least 8.5%, and (iii) Total capital to risk-weighted assets of at least 10.5%.

The New Capital Rules provide for a number of deductions from and adjustments to CET1. These include, for example, the requirement that mortgage servicing rights, certain deferred tax assets and significant investments in non-consolidated financial entities be deducted from CET1 to the extent that any one such category exceeds 10% of CET1 or all such categories in the aggregate exceed 15% of CET1. Under current capital standards, the effects of accumulated other comprehensive income items included in capital are excluded for the purposes of determining regulatory capital ratios. Under the New Capital Rules, the effects of certain accumulated other comprehensive items are not excluded; however, non-advanced approaches banking organizations, including Regions and Regions Bank, may make a one-time permanent election to continue to exclude these items. Regions and Regions Bank expect to make this election in order to avoid significant variations in the level of capital depending upon the impact of interest rate fluctuations on the fair value of its securities portfolio. As previously mentioned, the New Capital Rules also preclude certain hybrid securities, such as trust preferred securities, as Tier 1 capital of bank holding companies, subject to phase-out. As of December 31, 2013, Regions did not have any remaining hybrid securities subject to disallowance.

Implementation of the deductions and other adjustments to CET1 will begin on January 1, 2015 and will be phased-in over a 4-year period (beginning at 40% on January 1, 2015 and an additional 20% per year thereafter). The implementation of the capital

80

Table of Contents


conservation buffer will begin on January 1, 2016 at the 0.625% level and be phased in over a 4-year period (increasing by that amount on each subsequent January 1, until it reaches 2.5% on January 1, 2019).

With respect to Regions Bank, the New Capital Rules also revise the “prompt corrective action” regulations pursuant to Section 38 of the Federal Deposit Insurance Act, by (i) introducing a CET1 ratio requirement at each level (other than critically undercapitalized), with the required CET1 ratio being 6.5% for well-capitalized status; (ii) increasing the minimum Tier 1 capital ratio requirement for each category, with the minimum Tier 1 capital ratio for well-capitalized status being 8% (as compared to the current 6%); and (iii) eliminating the current provision that provides that a bank with a composite supervisory rating of 1 may have a 3% leverage ratio and still be adequately capitalized. The New Capital Rules do not change the total risk-based capital requirement for any “prompt corrective action” category.

The New Capital Rules prescribe a standardized approach for risk weightings that expands the risk-weighting categories from the current four Basel I-derived categories (0%, 20%, 50% and 100%) to a much larger and more risk-sensitive number of categories, depending on the nature of the assets, generally ranging from 0% for U.S. government and agency securities, to 600% for certain equity exposures, and resulting in higher risk weights for a variety of asset categories. Specific changes to current rules impacting Regions' determination of risk-weighted assets include, among other things:

Applying a 150% risk weight instead of a 100% risk weight for certain high volatility commercial real estate acquisition, development and construction loans.

Assigning a 150% risk weight to exposures (other than secured exposures including residential mortgage exposures) that are 90 days or more past due (currently set at 100%).

Providing for a 20% credit conversion factor for the unused portion of a commitment with an original maturity of one year or less that is not unconditionally cancellable (currently set at 0%).

Providing for a risk weight, generally not less than 20% with certain exceptions, for securities lending transactions based on the risk weight category of the underlying collateral securing the transaction (currently set at between 20% and 100% for on balance sheet transactions).

Providing for a 100% risk weight for claims on securities firms (currently set at 20%).

Eliminating the current 50% cap on the risk weight for over-the-counter derivative exposures.

Replacing the existing Ratings Based Approach for certain asset-backed securities with a Simplified Supervisory Framework Approach ("SSFA") which results in risk weights ranging from 20% to 1,250%.

Applying a 250% risk weight to the portion of mortgage servicing rights and deferred tax assets that are includible in capital (currently set at 100%).

In addition, the New Capital Rules also provide more advantageous risk weights for derivatives and repurchase-style transactions cleared through a qualifying central counterparty and increase the scope of eligible guarantors and eligible collateral for purposes of credit risk mitigation. As of December 31, 2013, the increase in Regions' Basel III risk-weighted assets versus risk-weighted assets as calculated under Basel I was due primarily to:

Applying a 20% conversion factor to the unused portion of commitments of less than one year.

Applying a 250% risk weight to the portion of mortgage servicing rights and deferred tax assets that are includible in capital.

Applying a 150% risk weight to high volatility commercial real estate exposures.

The New Capital Rules do not address the proposed Liquidity Coverage Ratio Test and Net Stable Funding Ratio Test called for by the proposed Basel III framework. See the "Supervision and Regulation -- Capital Requirements -- Leverage Requirements" subsection of the "Business" section for more information on these proposed requirements.
Regions is currently evaluating the impact of the final U.S. rules implementing Basel III as well as any potential future SIFI surcharges for regional banks. The Company’s estimated CET1 ratio as of December 31, 2013, based on Regions’ current interpretation of the final Basel III requirements was approximately 10.58 percent and therefore exceeded the Basel III minimum

81

Table of Contents


of 7 percent for CET1. Because the Basel III capital calculations will not be fully phased-in until 2019, are not formally defined by GAAP, and because the calculations currently include the Company's interpretations of the requirements including informal feedback received through the regulatory process and are therefore likely to change as clarifying guidance becomes available, these measures are considered to be non-GAAP financial measures, and other entities may calculate them differently than Regions’ disclosed calculations (see Table 2 “GAAP to Non-GAAP Reconciliation” for further details).
LIQUIDITY COVERAGE RATIO
In January 2013, the Basel Committee published an update that included revisions to the LCR calculation. Also included in this update were provisions concerning, among other things, lower deposit run-off assumptions and full implementation on a phased-in schedule. On October 24, 2013, the Federal Reserve released an NPR (notice of proposed rulemaking) and introduced a "modified" LCR that will apply to banks including Regions, who are not internationally active and are between $50 billion and $250 billion in assets. Based on Regions' current understanding and interpretation of the rules for the calculation of the LCR, full implementation will still be based on a phased-in schedule but in a more condensed timeframe that is 2 years shorter than the Basel committee version. Starting in 2015, institutions will be required to be at a minimum compliance ratio of 80 percent, in 2016 the minimum would increase to 90 percent, and full compliance with the 100 percent minimum requirement must be reached in 2017. Regions continues to review these proposals and their impact on the calculation of the LCR. The Company anticipates being fully compliant with the LCR requirements upon finalization and implementation. However, should Regions’ cash position or investment mix change in the future, Regions’ ability to meet the liquidity coverage ratio may be impacted. The comment period on these proposed rules ended on January 31, 2014.

See the “Supervision and Regulation—Capital Requirements” subsection of the “Business” section and the “Risk Factors” section for more information.

OFF-BALANCE SHEET ARRANGEMENTS
Regions has certain interests in unconsolidated variable interest entities (i.e., Regions is not the primary beneficiary). Regions owned the common stock of subsidiary business trusts, which had issued mandatorily redeemable preferred capital securities (“trust preferred securities”). During the fourth quarter of 2012 and the first nine months of 2013, Regions redeemed all of its issued and outstanding trust preferred securities. These trusts met the definition of a variable interest entity of which Regions was not the primary beneficiary; the trusts’ only assets were junior subordinated debentures issued by Regions, which were acquired by the trusts using the proceeds from the issuance of the trust preferred securities and common stock. These junior subordinated debentures were also fully redeemed during 2013. Prior to the redemption, these junior subordinated debentures were included in long-term borrowings and Regions’ equity interests in the business trusts were included in other assets.

Also, Regions periodically invests in various limited partnerships that sponsor affordable housing projects, which are funded through a combination of debt and equity. Regions’ maximum exposure to loss as of December 31, 2013 was $863 million, which included $267 million in unfunded commitments to the partnerships. Additionally, Regions has short-term construction loans or letters of credit commitments with the partnerships totaling $227 million as of December 31, 2013. The funded portion of these loans and letters of credit was $110 million at December 31, 2013. The funded portion is included with loans on the consolidated balance sheets. See Note 2 “Variable Interest Entities” to the consolidated financial statements for further discussion.

EFFECTS OF INFLATION
The majority of assets and liabilities of a financial institution are monetary in nature; therefore, a financial institution differs greatly from most commercial and industrial companies, which have significant investments in fixed assets or inventories that are greatly impacted by inflation. However, inflation does have an important impact on the growth of total assets in the banking industry and the resulting need to increase equity capital at higher than normal rates in order to maintain an appropriate equity-to-assets ratio. Inflation also affects other expenses that tend to rise during periods of general inflation.
Management believes the most significant potential impact of inflation on financial results is a direct result of Regions’ ability to manage the impact of changes in interest rates. Management attempts to maintain an essentially balanced position between rate-sensitive assets and liabilities in order to minimize the impact of interest rate fluctuations on net interest income. However, this goal can be difficult to completely achieve in times of rapidly changing rate structure and is one of many factors considered in determining the Company’s interest rate positioning. The Company is moderately asset sensitive as of December 31, 2013. Refer to Table 26 “Interest Rate Sensitivity” for additional details on Regions’ interest rate sensitivity.


82

Table of Contents


EFFECTS OF DEFLATION
A period of deflation would affect all industries, including financial institutions. Potentially, deflation could lead to lower profits, higher unemployment, lower production and deterioration in overall economic conditions. In addition, deflation could depress economic activity and impair bank earnings through increasing the value of debt while decreasing the value of collateral for loans. If the economy experienced a severe period of deflation, then it could depress loan demand, impair the ability of borrowers to repay loans and sharply reduce bank earnings.
Management believes the most significant potential impact of deflation on financial results relates to Regions’ ability to maintain a sufficient amount of capital to cushion against future losses. However, the Company can utilize certain risk management tools to help it maintain its balance sheet strength even if a deflationary scenario were to develop.

RISK MANAGEMENT

Regions is exposed to various risks as part of the normal course of operations. The exposure to risk requires sound risk management practices that comprise an integrated and comprehensive set of programs and processes that apply to the entire Company. Accordingly, Regions has established a risk management framework to manage risks and provide reasonable assurance of the achievement of the Company’s strategic objectives.
The primary risk exposures identified and managed through the Company’s risk management framework are market risk (including related interest rate risk and prepayment risk), liquidity risk, credit risk, operational risk (including information security risk), legal risk, compliance risk, reputational risk, and strategic risk. Market risk is the risk that values of assets and liabilities or revenues will be adversely affected by changes in market conditions, such as interest rate movements (interest rate risk) and the associated impact on prepayments (prepayment risk). Interest rate risk is the risk to net interest income due to the impact of movements in interest rates. Prepayment risk is the risk that borrowers may repay their loans or other debt earlier than at their stated maturities. Liquidity risk is the risk that the Company will be unable to meet obligations as they come due in the normal course of business without undue hardship or incurring unacceptable losses. Credit risk is the risk of loss arising from a borrower or counterparty failing to meet a contractual obligation. Operational risk is the risk of loss resulting from inadequate or failed internal processes, people and systems, or external events. Legal risk reflects the inherent legal risk arising out of the daily banking and other operations of the Company that could result in disputes, threatened and/or actual litigation, civil monetary penalties, criminal penalties, enforcement actions, or reputational damage. Compliance risk is the risk of failure or perceived failure to comply with the laws, regulations and standards that govern the activities of the Company. Reputational risk is the risk that negative publicity regarding the Company’s conduct or business practices will adversely affect its profitability, operations or customer base, or result in litigation. Strategic risk is the risk to the Company due to uncertainty and actions (or inaction) related to strategic risk factors, including negative effects from business planning or decisions, environmental changes, competitive dynamics, or management of our resources and activities. Several of these primary risk exposures are expanded upon further within the remaining sections of Management's Discussion and Analysis.
Regions’ risk management framework is founded on three pillars, each of which is critical to ensuring that risks are properly identified, assessed, and managed:
Three Lines of Defense - All associates are risk owners and serve as the first line of defense in the identification and mitigation of risks. The Risk Management Group independently assesses Company and industry risks in support of the business groups and serves as the second line of defense. Assurance functions (Credit Review, Internal Audit, and Model Validation) serve as the third line of defense and play a key role in ensuring risk identification and mitigation.
Enterprise Risk Management Governance - Regions has established a corporate governance framework consisting of committees, working groups, processes and procedures that are collectively charged with identifying, measuring, mitigating, monitoring and reporting risks.
Continuous Improvement Cycle - Regions has established the continuous improvement cycle to drive its associates to targeted risk management levels by ensuring risks are identified, measured, mitigated, monitored and reported.
The Board of Directors provides the highest level of risk management governance. The principal risk management functions of the Board are to oversee processes for evaluating the adequacy of internal controls, risk management, financial reporting and compliance with laws and regulations. The Board has designated an Audit Committee of outside directors to focus on oversight of management's establishment and maintenance of appropriate disclosure controls and procedures over financial reporting. See the "Financial Disclosures and Internal Controls" section of Management's Discussion and Analysis for additional information. The Board has also designated a Risk Committee of outside directors to focus on Regions’ overall risk profile. The committee

83

Table of Contents


annually approves a Risk Appetite Statement that reflects core business principles and strategic vision and provides the foundations of corporate risk appetite, which is the aggregate amount of risk the Company is willing to accept in pursuit of its mission. By establishing boundaries around risk taking and business decisions, and by incorporating the needs and goals of its shareholders, regulators, customers and other stakeholders, the Company’s risk appetite is aligned with its priorities and goals.
The Risk Management Group, led by the Company’s Chief Risk Officer, ensures the consistent application of Regions’ risk management approach within the structure of the Company’s operating, capital and strategic plans. The primary activities of the Risk Management Group include:
Deciphering internal and external signals that point to possible risk issues for the Company;
Identifying risks and determining which Company areas and/or products will be affected;
Ensuring there are mechanisms in place to specifically determine how risks will affect the Company as a whole and the individual area and or product;
Assisting Business Groups in analyzing trends and ensuring Company areas have appropriate risk identification and mitigation processes in place; and
Reviewing the limits, policies, and procedures in place to ensure the continued appropriateness of risk controls.

As part of its ongoing assessment process, the Risk Management Group makes recommendations to management and the Risk Committee of the Board regarding adjustments to these controls as conditions or risk tolerances change. In addition, the Internal Audit division provides an independent assessment of the Company’s internal control structure and related systems and processes.
Management, with the assistance of the Risk Management Group, follows a formal process for identifying and documenting key risks facing each business group and determining how those risks can be controlled or mitigated, as well as how the controls can be monitored to ensure they are effective. The Risk Committee receives reports from management to ensure operations are within the parameters established by the Committee’s Risk Appetite Statement.
Some of the more significant processes used by management to manage and control risks are described in the remainder of this report. External factors beyond management’s control may result in losses despite the Risk Management Group’s efforts.
MARKET RISK—INTEREST RATE RISK
Regions’ primary market risk is interest rate risk, including uncertainty with respect to absolute interest rate levels as well as uncertainty with respect to relative interest rate levels, which is impacted by both the shape and the slope of the various yield curves that affect the financial products and services that the Company offers. To quantify this risk, Regions measures the change in its net interest income in various interest rate scenarios compared to a base case scenario. Net interest income sensitivity is a useful short-term indicator of Regions’ interest rate risk.
Sensitivity Measurement—Financial simulation models are Regions’ primary tools used to measure interest rate exposure. Using a wide range of sophisticated simulation techniques provides management with extensive information on the potential impact to net interest income caused by changes in interest rates. Models are structured to simulate cash flows and accrual characteristics of Regions’ balance sheet. Assumptions are made about the direction and volatility of interest rates, the slope of the yield curve, and the changing composition of the balance sheet that result from both strategic plans and from customer behavior. Among the assumptions are expectations of balance sheet growth and composition, the pricing and maturity characteristics of existing business and the characteristics of future business. Interest rate-related risks are expressly considered, such as pricing spreads, the lag time in pricing deposit accounts, prepayments and other option risks. Regions considers these factors, as well as the degree of certainty or uncertainty surrounding their future behavior.
The primary objective of asset/liability management at Regions is to coordinate balance sheet composition with interest rate risk management to sustain a reasonable and stable net interest income throughout various interest rate cycles. In computing interest rate sensitivity for measurement, Regions compares a set of alternative interest rate scenarios to the results of a base case scenario based on “market forward rates.” The standard set of interest rate scenarios includes the traditional instantaneous parallel rate shifts of plus 100 and 200 basis points. Regions also prepares a minus 50 basis points scenario, as minus 100 and 200 basis scenarios are of limited use in the current rate environment. Up-rate scenarios of greater magnitude are also analyzed, and are of increased importance as the current and historic low levels of interest rates increase the relative likelihood of a rapid and substantial increase in interest rates. Regions also includes simulations of gradual interest rate movements that may more realistically mimic potential interest rate movements. These gradual scenarios include curve steepening, flattening, and parallel movements of various magnitudes phased in over a six-month period, and include rate shifts of minus 50 basis points and plus 100 and 200 basis points.
Exposure to Interest Rate Movements—As of December 31, 2013, Regions was moderately asset sensitive to both gradual and instantaneous parallel yield curve shifts as compared to the base case for the measurement horizon ending December 2014.

84

Table of Contents


The estimated exposure associated with the parallel yield curve shift of minus 50 basis points in the table below reflects the combined impacts of movements in short-term and long-term rates. Long-term interest rate reductions will drive yields lower on certain fixed rate loans newly originated or renewed, and on prospective yields of certain investment portfolio purchases, as well as drive higher amortization of premium on existing securities in the investment portfolio. The decline in short-term interest rates (such as the Fed Funds rate and the rate of Interest on Excess Reserves) will lead to a reduction of yield on assets and liabilities contractually tied to such rates, but since rates have been at low levels for such an extended period, it is expected that declines in deposit costs will only partially offset the decline in asset yields.

Long-term interest rates have exhibited volatility over the second half of 2013 after rising significantly in the first half, but short-term rates have remained stable. As described above, with respect to sensitivity to long-term rates, the balance sheet is estimated to be asset sensitive. The primary factors are that higher long-term rates will drive higher rates on loans and securities newly originated or renewed, as well as induce a slower pace of premium amortization on certain securities within the investment portfolio. Current simulation models estimate that, as compared to the base case, net interest income over a 12 month horizon would respond favorably by approximately $102 million if long-term rates were to immediately and on a sustained basis exceed the base scenario by 100 basis points. Similarly, if long-term rates were to immediately and on a sustained basis underperform the base case by 50 basis points, then net interest income, as compared to the base case, would decline by approximately $99 million.

The table below summarizes Regions' positioning in various parallel yield curve shifts. The scenarios are inclusive of all interest rate risk hedging activities.

Table 26—Interest Rate Sensitivity
 
 
Estimated Annual Change
in Net Interest Income
December 31, 2013
 
(In millions)
Gradual Change in Interest Rates
 
+ 200 basis points
$
256

+ 100 basis points
136

- 50 basis points
(100
)
 
 
Instantaneous Change in Interest Rates
 
+ 200 basis points
$
311

+ 100 basis points
180

- 50 basis points
(136
)
Interest rate movements may also have an impact on the value of Regions’ securities portfolio, which can directly impact the carrying value of stockholders’ equity. Regions from time to time may hedge these price movements with derivatives (as discussed below).
Derivatives—Regions uses financial derivative instruments for management of interest rate sensitivity. The Asset and Liability Committee (“ALCO”), which consists of members of Regions’ senior management team, in its oversight role for the management of interest rate sensitivity, approves the use of derivatives in balance sheet hedging strategies. The most common derivatives Regions employs are forward rate contracts, Eurodollar futures contracts, interest rate swaps, options on interest rate swaps, interest rate caps and floors, and forward sale commitments. Derivatives are also used to offset the risks associated with customer derivatives, which include interest rate, credit and foreign exchange risks.
Forward rate contracts are commitments to buy or sell financial instruments at a future date at a specified price or yield. A Eurodollar futures contract is a future on a Eurodollar deposit. Eurodollar futures contracts subject Regions to market risk associated with changes in interest rates. Because futures contracts are cash settled daily, there is minimal credit risk associated with Eurodollar futures. Interest rate swaps are contractual agreements typically entered into to exchange fixed for variable (or vice versa) streams of interest payments. The notional principal is not exchanged but is used as a reference for the size of interest settlements. Interest rate options are contracts that allow the buyer to purchase or sell a financial instrument at a predetermined price and time. Forward sale commitments are contractual obligations to sell market instruments at a future date for an already agreed-upon price. Foreign currency contracts involve the exchange of one currency for another on a specified date and at a specified rate. These contracts are executed on behalf of the Company's customers and are used to manage fluctuations in foreign exchange rates. The Company is subject to the credit risk that another party will fail to perform.

85

Table of Contents


Regions has made use of interest rate swaps to effectively convert a portion of its fixed-rate funding position to a variable-rate position and, in some cases, to effectively convert a portion of its variable-rate loan portfolio to fixed-rate. Regions also uses derivatives to manage interest rate and pricing risk associated with its mortgage origination business. In the period of time that elapses between the origination and sale of mortgage loans, changes in interest rates have the potential to cause a decline in the value of the loans in this held-for-sale portfolio. Futures contracts and forward sale commitments are used to protect the value of the loan pipeline and loans held for sale from changes in interest rates and pricing.
Regions manages the credit risk of these instruments in much the same way as it manages credit risk of the loan portfolios by establishing credit limits for each counterparty and through collateral agreements for dealer transactions. For non-dealer transactions, the need for collateral is evaluated on an individual transaction basis and is primarily dependent on the financial strength of the counterparty. Credit risk is also reduced significantly by entering into legally enforceable master netting agreements. When there is more than one transaction with a counterparty and there is a legally enforceable master netting agreement in place, the exposure represents the net of the gain and loss positions with and collateral received from and/or posted to that counterparty. The “Credit Risk” section in this report contains more information on the management of credit risk.
Regions also uses derivatives to meet the needs of its customers. Interest rate swaps, interest rate options and foreign exchange forwards are the most common derivatives sold to customers. Other derivatives instruments with similar characteristics are used to hedge market risk and minimize volatility associated with this portfolio. Instruments used to service customers are held in the trading account, with changes in value recorded in the consolidated statements of operations.
The primary objective of Regions’ hedging strategies is to mitigate the impact of interest rate changes, from an economic perspective, on net interest income and the net present value of its balance sheet. The overall effectiveness of these hedging strategies is subject to market conditions, the quality of Regions’ execution, the accuracy of its valuation assumptions, counterparty credit risk and changes in interest rates. See Note 20 “Derivative Financial Instruments and Hedging Activities” to the consolidated financial statements for a tabular summary of Regions’ year-end derivatives positions and further discussion.
Regions accounts for mortgage servicing rights at fair market value with any changes to fair value being recorded within mortgage income. Regions enters into derivative and balance sheet transactions to mitigate the impact of market value fluctuations related to mortgage servicing rights. Derivative instruments entered into in the future could be materially different from the current risk profile of Regions’ current portfolio.

MARKET RISK—PREPAYMENT RISK
Regions, like most financial institutions, is subject to changing prepayment speeds on mortgage-related assets under different interest rate environments. Prepayment risk is a significant risk to earnings and specifically to net interest income. For example, mortgage loans and other financial assets may be prepaid by a debtor, so that the debtor may refinance its obligations at lower rates. As loans and other financial assets prepay in a falling rate environment, Regions must reinvest these funds in lower-yielding assets. Prepayments of assets carrying higher rates reduce Regions’ interest income and overall asset yields. Conversely, in a rising rate environment, these assets will prepay at a slower rate, resulting in opportunity cost by not having the cash flow to reinvest at higher rates. Prepayment risk can also impact the value of securities and the carrying value of equity. Regions’ greatest exposures to prepayment risks primarily rest in its mortgage-backed securities portfolio, the mortgage fixed-rate loan portfolio and the mortgage servicing asset, all of which tend to be sensitive to interest rate movements. Each of these assets is also exposed to prepayment risk due to factors which are not necessarily the result of interest rates, but rather due to changes in policies or programs related, either directly or indirectly, to the U.S. Government's governance over certain lending and financing within the mortgage market. Such policies can work to either encourage or discourage financing dynamics and represent a risk that is extremely difficult to forecast and may be the result of non-economic factors. The Company attempts to monitor and manage such exposures within reasonable expectations while acknowledging all such risks cannot be foreseen or avoided. Further, Regions has prepayment risk that would be reflected in non-interest income in the form of servicing income on loans sold. Regions actively monitors prepayment exposure as part of its overall net interest income forecasting and interest rate risk management. In particular, because current interest rates are relatively low, Regions is actively managing exposure to declining prepayments that are expected to coincide with increasing interest rates in both the loan and securities portfolio.

LIQUIDITY RISK

Liquidity is an important factor in the financial condition of Regions and affects Regions’ ability to meet the borrowing needs and deposit withdrawal requirements of its customers. Regions intends to fund obligations primarily through cash generated from normal operations. In addition to these obligations, Regions has obligations related to potential litigation contingencies. See Note 23 “Commitments, Contingencies and Guarantees” to the consolidated financial statements for additional discussion of the Company’s funding requirements.

86

Table of Contents


Assets, consisting principally of loans and securities, are funded by customer deposits, purchased funds, borrowed funds and stockholders’ equity. Regions’ goal in liquidity management is to satisfy the cash flow requirements of depositors and borrowers, while at the same time meeting the Company’s cash flow needs. The challenges of the recent recession and the recovery in the current market environment demonstrate the importance of having and using various sources of liquidity to satisfy the Company’s funding requirements.
In order to ensure an appropriate level of liquidity is maintained, Regions performs specific procedures including scenario analyses and stress testing at the bank, holding company, and affiliate levels. Regions updated its liquidity policy related to minimum holding company cash requirements during the fourth quarter of 2013. The new policy requires the holding company to maintain cash sufficient to cover the greater of (1) 18 months of debt service and other cash needs or (2) a minimum cash balance of $500 million. Compliance with the holding company cash requirements will be reported to the Risk Committee of the Board of Directors on a quarterly basis. Regions has similar minimum liquidity requirements for the Bank and subsidiaries. The Bank's funding and contingency planning does not currently include any reliance on unsecured sources. Risk limits are established within the Company's ALCO, which regularly reviews compliance with the established limits.

The securities portfolio is one of Regions’ primary sources of liquidity. Proceeds from maturities and principal and interest payments of securities provide a constant flow of funds available for cash needs (see Note 4 “Securities” to the consolidated financial statements). The agency guaranteed mortgage portfolio is another source of liquidity in various secured borrowing capacities.
Maturities in the loan portfolio also provide a steady flow of funds. Additional funds are provided from payments on consumer loans and one-to-four family residential first mortgage loans. In addition, liquidity needs can also be met by borrowing funds in state and national money markets, although Regions does not currently rely on unsecured wholesale market funding. Regions’ liquidity has been further enhanced by its relatively stable customer deposit base.
Regions elected to exit the FDIC's TAG program on July 1, 2010. The TAG program was a component of the Temporary Liquidity Guarantee Program, whereby the FDIC guaranteed all funds held at participating institutions beyond the $250,000 deposit insurance limit in qualifying transaction accounts. The decision to exit the program did not have a significant impact on liquidity. The Dodd-Frank Act permanently increased the FDIC coverage limit to $250,000. As a result of the Dodd-Frank Act, effective December 31, 2010, unlimited coverage for non-interest-bearing demand transaction accounts was provided until January 1, 2013. The expiration of unlimited coverage for non-interest-bearing demand transaction accounts did not have a significant impact on liquidity.
Regulation Q prohibited banks from paying interest on business checking accounts in accordance with the Glass-Steagall Act of 1933. However, the Dodd-Frank Act repealed Regulation Q. In July 2011, financial institutions, such as Regions, were allowed to offer interest on corporate checking accounts. Regions responded to these changes by enhancing its existing core interest-bearing products. However, due to the low interest rate environment and unlimited FDIC insurance available on non-interest-bearing balances until January 1, 2013, the Company did not experience, nor does it anticipate experiencing, significant migration of business customer balances from non-interest-bearing accounts to interest-bearing accounts.
As the economy continues to improve, Regions has been able to decrease the higher levels of excess cash held with the Federal Reserve Bank due to the uncertainty and inconsistency in the funding markets during the recession. The balance with the Federal Reserve Bank is the primary component of the balance sheet line item, “interest-bearing deposits in other banks.” Regions held approximately $2.3 billion in average excess cash on deposit with the Federal Reserve during 2013, down approximately 22 percent from average 2012 balances. Regions’ borrowing availability with the Federal Reserve Bank as of December 31, 2013, based on assets pledged as collateral on that date, was $22.2 billion.
Regions periodically accesses funding markets through sales of securities with agreements to repurchase. Repurchase agreements are also offered through a commercial banking sweep product as a short-term investment opportunity for customers. All such arrangements are considered typical of the banking industry and are accounted for as borrowings.
Regions’ financing arrangement with the FHLB adds additional flexibility in managing the Company's liquidity position. As of December 31, 2013, Regions’ borrowing availability from the FHLB totaled $9.6 billion. FHLB borrowing capacity is contingent on the amount of collateral pledged to the FHLB. Regions Bank and its subsidiaries have pledged certain residential first mortgage loans on one-to-four family dwellings and home equity lines of credit as collateral for the FHLB advances outstanding. Additionally, investment in FHLB stock is required in relation to the level of outstanding borrowings. Regions held $67 million in FHLB stock at December 31, 2013. The FHLB has been and is expected to continue to be a reliable and economical source of funding.
In February 2013, Regions filed a shelf registration statement with the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission. This shelf registration does not have a capacity limit and can be utilized by Regions to issue various debt and/or equity securities. The registration statement will expire in February 2016.

87

Table of Contents


Regions’ Bank Note program allows Regions Bank to issue up to $5 billion aggregate principal amount of bank notes outstanding at any one time. No issuances have been made under this program as of December 31, 2013. Notes issued under the program may be senior notes with maturities from 30 days to 15 years and subordinated notes with maturities from 5 years to 30 years. These notes are not deposits and they are not insured or guaranteed by the FDIC.
Regions may, from time to time, consider opportunistically retiring outstanding issued securities, including subordinated debt in privately negotiated or open market transactions for cash or common shares. Regulatory approval would be required for retirement of some instruments.

Table 27—Contractual Obligations
  
 
Payments Due By Period (1)
  
 
Less than 1
Year
 
1-3 Years
 
4-5 Years
 
More than 5
Years
 
Indeterminable
Maturity
 
Total
 
 
(In millions)
Deposits (2)
 
$
4,577

 
$
3,353

 
$
1,724

 
$
22

 
$
82,777

 
$
92,453

Short-term borrowings
 
2,182

 

 

 

 

 
2,182

Long-term borrowings
 
1,359

 
875

 
1,485

 
1,111

 

 
4,830

Lease obligations
 
140

 
241

 
165

 
364

 

 
910

Purchase obligations
 
50

 
59

 
16

 

 

 
125

Benefit obligations (3)
 
21

 
25

 
47

 
70

 

 
163

Commitments to fund low income housing partnerships (4)
 
604

 

 

 

 

 
604

Unrecognized tax benefits (5)
 

 

 

 

 
55

 
55

Indemnification obligation (6)
 

 
260

 

 

 

 
260

 
 
$
8,933

 
$
4,813

 
$
3,437

 
$
1,567

 
$
82,832

 
$
101,582

_________
(1)
See Note 23 “Commitments, Contingencies and Guarantees” to the consolidated financial statements for the Company’s commercial commitments at December 31, 2013.
(2)
Deposits with indeterminable maturity include non-interest bearing demand, savings, interest-bearing transaction accounts and money market accounts.
(3)
Amounts only include obligations related to the unfunded non-qualified pension plan and postretirement health care plan.
(4)
Commitments to fund low income housing partnerships do not have defined maturity dates. Therefore, they have been considered due on demand, maturing one year or less.
(5)
Includes liabilities for unrecognized tax benefits of $51 million and tax-related interest and penalties of $4 million. See Note 19 “Income Taxes” to the consolidated financial statements.
(6)
See Note 23 “Commitments, Contingencies and Guarantees” to the consolidated financial statements for a description of the indemnification obligation to Raymond James, and the rationale for the expected payment timeframe.



CREDIT RISK
Regions’ objective regarding credit risk is to maintain a high-quality credit portfolio that provides for stable credit costs with acceptable volatility through an economic cycle. Regions has a diversified loan portfolio in terms of product type, collateral and geography. See the “Credit Quality” section found earlier in this report for further information.
Management Process
Regions employs a credit risk management process with defined policies, accountability and regular reporting to manage credit risk in the loan portfolio. Credit risk management is guided by credit policies that provide for a consistent and prudent approach to underwriting and approvals of credits. Within the Credit Policy department, procedures exist that elevate the approval requirements as credits become larger and more complex. Generally, consumer credits and smaller commercial credits are centrally underwritten based on custom credit matrices and policies that are modified as appropriate. Larger commercial and investor real estate transactions are individually underwritten, risk-rated, approved and monitored.

88

Table of Contents


Responsibility and accountability for adherence to underwriting policies and accurate risk ratings lies in the individual business groups. For consumer and small business portfolios, the risk management process focuses on managing customers who become delinquent in their payments and managing performance of the credit scorecards, which are periodically adjusted based on actual credit performance. The credit risk management division works with commercial relationship teams to analyze and underwrite new business opportunities, manage the overall loan portfolio, and perform ongoing credit servicing activities utilizing a risk-based approach which incorporates quantitative and qualitative factors.
To ensure problem commercial credits are identified on a timely basis, several specific portfolio reviews occur each quarter to assess the larger adversely rated credits for accrual status and, if necessary, to ensure such individual credits are transferred to Regions’ Problem Asset Management Division, which specializes in managing distressed credit exposures.
There are also separate and independent commercial credit and consumer credit risk management organizational groups. These organizational units partner with the business line to assist in the processes described above, including the review and approval of new business and ongoing assessments of existing loans in the portfolio. Independent commercial and consumer credit risk management provides for more accurate risk ratings and the timely identification of problem credits, as well as oversight for the Chief Credit Officer on conditions and trends in the credit portfolios.
Credit quality and trends in the loan portfolio are measured and monitored regularly and detailed reports, by product, business unit and geography, are reviewed by business group personnel and the Chief Credit Officer. The Chief Credit Officer reviews summaries of these credit reports with executive management and the Board of Directors. Finally, the Credit Review department provides ongoing independent oversight of the credit portfolios to ensure policies are followed, credits are properly risk-rated and that key credit control processes are functioning as intended.

Risk Characteristics of the Loan Portfolio
In order to assess the risk characteristics of the loan portfolio, Regions considers the current U.S. economic environment and that of its primary banking markets, as well as risk factors within the major categories of loans. See Table 9 "Loan Portfolio" and the related discussion found earlier in this report for further information on the major categories of loans.

Economic Environment in Regions’ Banking Markets

One of the primary factors influencing the credit performance of Regions’ loan portfolio is the overall economic environment in the U.S. and the primary markets in which it operates. The “Great Recession” that began in December 2007 and ended in June 2009 took a severe toll on the U.S. economy, but by year-end 2013 many of the economic headwinds that had restrained the economy had diminished. Household balance sheets improved further due in part to continued low interest rates, continued housing market recovery and inventories of distressed properties having been greatly diminished in many markets, corporate balance sheets remained healthy, and by year-end 2013 consumer and business confidence had begun to improve. The economy overcame a significant fiscal drag - the cumulative effects of higher personal tax rates and cutbacks in federal government spending - that weighed down growth over the first half of the year. Additionally, the pace of economic growth accelerated meaningfully over the second half of the year, with annualized real GDP growth of 4.1 percent in the third quarter and 3.2 percent in the fourth quarter.

As such, the economy entered 2014 on firmer footing and the momentum established over the second half of 2013 is expected to be sustained. After deducting roughly 1.5 percent from top-line real GDP growth in 2013, fiscal drag is expected to be reduced in 2014 and deduct roughly 0.4 percent from top-line growth. At the same time, faster growth in private sector demand than seen in 2013 is expected to also contribute to improved growth. After growth of 1.9 percent in 2013, real GDP growth of approximately 3.0 percent is expected in 2014.

Still, it is important to note the economy is not yet fully healed from the Great Recession. As of December 2013, the level of non-farm payroll employment remained over one million jobs below the pre-recession peak. Moreover, while the unemployment rate stood at 6.7 percent as of December 2013, down from a cyclical peak of 10.0 percent in October 2009, a considerable portion of this decline has been due to a declining labor force participation rate as discouraged job seekers, many having been unemployed six months or more, exited the labor force. Further declines in the unemployment rate are expected due to the expiration of extended Unemployment Insurance benefits in the coming months, which could cause significant numbers of unemployed individuals to exit the labor market. Additionally, just under eight million adults are working part-time for economic reasons (for example, they would prefer a full-time job but can only find part-time employment) - such individuals are not unemployed but are underemployed. As such, the falling unemployment rate currently overstates the extent of improvement in the labor market. Should the rate of overall economic growth pick up as anticipated, it should lead to more genuine improvement in labor market conditions.

While the downside risks from fiscal policy seem diminished in 2014 relative to 2013, there is some degree of uncertainty pertaining to monetary policy, specifically the effects of the Federal Reserve reducing, and ultimately ending, its large-scale asset

89

Table of Contents


purchases. While monetary policy is expected to remain accommodative, market expectations of the timing of an initial hike in the Fed funds rate could be pulled forward, particularly in the context of an accelerating pace of economic growth and a rapidly falling unemployment rate. In such an environment, long-term interest rates would be expected to trend higher, but there could be an above-normal degree of volatility in interest rates, along the entire yield curve, as a result of uncertainty over the future course of the Fed funds rate. Moreover, the paring down and ultimate ending of the Fed’s large-scale asset purchases can be expected to contribute to volatility in international flows of capital, which in turn could contribute to economic stress in emerging market nations.

Within the Regions footprint, the pace of economic growth is proceeding roughly on par with that of the U.S. as a whole. Payroll employment is rising but still below its pre-recession peak. Those markets with exposure to energy exploration and production, durable goods manufacturing, and technology are faring the best, and across the footprint health care remains a key driver of job growth while the drag from job reductions in the state and local government sectors appears to have abated to a certain extent. Housing market activity appears to be picking up at a steady pace; while many Florida markets continue to see elevated inventories of distressed properties, those inventories are nonetheless being worked down which should ultimately pave the way for a faster pace of new single family construction.
In summation, we expect the pace of real GDP growth to accelerate to approximately 3.0 percent for 2014 as a whole, with firmer growth in private sector demand and a significantly smaller degree of fiscal drag, and we look for growth in 2015 to be slightly faster than in 2014.

Allowance for Credit Losses
The allowance for credit losses ("allowance") consists of two components: the allowance for loan and lease losses and the reserve for unfunded credit commitments. The allowance represents management’s estimate of probable credit losses inherent in the loan and credit commitment portfolios as of period end.
Allowance Process—Factors considered by management in determining the adequacy of the allowance include, but are not limited to: 1) detailed reviews of individual loans; 2) historical and current trends in gross and net loan charge-offs for the various classes of loans evaluated; 3) the Company’s policies relating to delinquent loans and charge-offs; 4) the level of the allowance in relation to total loans and to historical loss levels; 5) levels and trends in non-performing and past due loans; 6) collateral values of properties securing loans; 7) the composition of the loan portfolio, including unfunded credit commitments; 8) management’s analysis of current economic conditions; 9) migration of loans between risk rating categories; and 10) estimation of inherent credit losses in the portfolio.
Commercial and Consumer Credit Risk Management and Problem Asset Management are all involved in the credit risk management process to assess the accuracy of risk ratings, the quality of the portfolio and the estimation of inherent credit losses in the loan portfolio. This comprehensive process also assists in the prompt identification of problem credits. The Company has taken a number of measures to manage the portfolios and reduce risk, particularly in the more problematic portfolios. In addition, a strong Customer Assistance Program for consumer lending is in place which educates customers about options and initiates early contact with customers to discuss solutions when a loan first becomes delinquent.
In support of collateral values, Regions obtains updated valuations for non-performing loans on at least an annual basis. For loans that are individually identified for impairment in certain loan categories, those valuations are currently discounted from the most recent appraisal to consider continued declines in property values. The discounted valuations are utilized in the measurement of the level of impairment in the allowance calculation. For loans that are not individually identified for impairment and secured by real estate, Regions considers the impact of declines in real estate valuations in the loss given default estimates within the allowance calculation.
As a matter of business practice, Regions may require some form of credit support, such as a guarantee. Guarantees are legally binding and entered into simultaneously with the primary loan agreements. Regions underwrites the ability of each guarantor to perform under its guarantee in the same manner and to the same extent as would be required to underwrite the repayment plan of a direct obligor. This entails obtaining sufficient information on the guarantor, including financial and operating information, to sufficiently measure the guarantor’s ability to perform under the guarantee. Evaluation of guarantors’ ability and willingness to pay is considered as part of the risk rating process, which provides the basis for the allowance for loan losses for the commercial and investor real estate portfolio segments. In some cases, the credit support provided by the guarantor is integral to the risk rating. In concluding that the risk rating is appropriate, Regions considers a number of factors including whether underlying cash flow is adequate to service the debt, payment history, and whether there is appropriate guarantor support. Accordingly, Regions has concluded that the impact of credit support provided by guarantors has been appropriately considered in the calculation and assessment of the allowance for loan losses.

90

Table of Contents


For a discussion of the methodology used to calculate the allowance for credit losses refer to Note 1 “Summary of Significant Accounting Policies” and Note 6 “Allowance for Credit Losses” in the consolidated financial statements. Details regarding the allowance for credit losses, including an analysis of activity from the previous year’s total, are included in Table 15 “Allowance for Credit Losses.” Also, refer to Table 16 “Allocation of the Allowance for Loan Losses” for details pertaining to management’s allocation of the allowance for loan losses to each loan category.

Counterparty Risk
Counterparty risk within Regions Bank is the risk that the counterparty to any transaction could default or experience deterioration in its credit profile before the settlement of a financial transaction. Exposure may be to a financial institution (such as commercial banks, insurance companies, broker dealers, etc.) or a corporate client.
Regions has a centralized approach to approval, management, and monitoring of counterparty exposure. Financial Institution and Counterparty Credit, housed within Capital Markets Risk Management, is responsible for the independent credit risk management of financial institution counterparties and their affiliates. Market Risk Management is responsible for the suitability, measurement, and stress testing of counterparty exposures. Business Services Credit is responsible for the independent credit risk management of client side counterparties.
Financial institution exposure may result from a variety of transaction types generated in one or more departments of the Company. Exposure limits are established to manage the exposure generated by various areas of the Company. Counterparty client credit risk arises when Regions sells a risk management product to hedge risks in the client’s business. Exposures to counterparties are aggregated across departments and regularly reported to senior management.

INFORMATION SECURITY RISK
Operational risks comprise several elements, including information security risks. Information security risks for large financial institutions such as Regions have generally increased in recent years in part because of the proliferation of new technologies, the use of the internet and telecommunications technologies to conduct financial transactions, and the increased sophistication and activities of organized crime, hackers, terrorists, nation-states, activists and other external parties. Regions spends significant resources on operational and information security. Regions is a member of the Financial Services Information Sharing and Analysis Center ("FS-ISAC"). The FS-ISAC is a nonprofit organization and is funded entirely by its member firms and sponsors. Total membership exceeds 4,400 organizations primarily focused in the U.S. financial services sector. The overall objective of FS-ISAC is to protect the financial services sector against cyber and physical threats and risk. It acts as a trusted third party that provides anonymity to allow members to submit threat, vulnerability and incident information in a non-attributable and trusted manner so information that would normally not be shared is instead provided for the good of the membership. In addition to FS-ISAC, Regions is a member of BITS, the technology arm of the Financial Services Roundtable. BITS serves the financial community and its members by providing industry best practices on a variety of security and fraud topics. Regions also maintains a close working relationship with its regulators and law enforcement partners to keep them updated on pertinent risks.
Denial of service attacks, hacking or terrorist activities, could disrupt the Company's or the Company's customers' or other third parties' business operations. For example, during 2013, a group launched several denial of service attacks against a number of large financial services institutions, including Regions. These events did not result in a breach of Regions' client data, and account information remained secure; however, the attacks did adversely affect the performance of Regions Bank's website, www.regions.com, and, in some instances, temporarily prevented customers from accessing Regions Bank's secure websites. In addition, some outbound internet slowness existed. The 2013 events were all resolved during the same business day of the attack. In all cases, the attacks primarily resulted in inconvenience to employees and customers. Regions engages employees from all business groups, not just information technology, to combat these attacks.
Regions will continue to commit the resources necessary to mitigate these growing risks. In addition, Regions has contracts with vendors to provide denial of service mitigation and these vendors have also continued to commit the necessary resources to support Regions in the event of an attack.

FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE AND INTERNAL CONTROLS
Regions has always maintained internal controls over financial reporting, which generally include those controls relating to the preparation of the consolidated financial statements in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the U.S. Regions’ process for evaluating internal controls over financial reporting starts with understanding the risks facing each of its functions and areas, how those risks are controlled or mitigated, and how management monitors those controls to ensure that they

91

Table of Contents


are in place and effective. These risks, control procedures and monitoring tools are documented in a standard format. This format not only documents the internal control structures over all significant accounts, but also places responsibility on management for establishing feedback mechanisms to ensure that controls are effective.
Regions has also established processes to ensure appropriate disclosure controls and procedures are maintained. These controls and procedures as defined by the Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”) are generally designed to ensure that financial and non-financial information required to be disclosed in reports filed with the SEC is reported within the time periods specified in the SEC’s rules and forms, and that such information is communicated to management, including the Chief Executive Officer (“CEO”) and Chief Financial Officer (“CFO”), as appropriate, to allow timely decisions regarding required disclosure.
Regions’ Disclosure Review Committee, which includes representatives from the legal, risk management, accounting, investor relations, treasury and audit departments, meets quarterly to review recent internal and external events to determine whether all appropriate disclosures have been made in reports filed with the SEC. In addition, the CEO and CFO meet quarterly with the SEC Filings Review Committee, which includes senior representatives from accounting, legal, risk management, audit, treasury, the business groups, and administration. The SEC Filings Review Committee reviews certain reports to be filed with the SEC, including Forms 10-K and 10-Q and evaluates the adequacy and accuracy of the disclosures. As part of this process, certifications of internal control effectiveness are obtained from accounting, treasury, legal, audit, risk management, the business groups and administration. These certifications are reviewed and presented to the CEO and CFO as support of the Company’s assessment of internal controls over financial reporting. The Form 10-K is presented to the Audit Committee of the Board of Directors for approval, and the Forms 10-Q are reviewed by the Audit Committee. Financial results and other financial information are also reviewed with the Audit Committee on a quarterly basis.
As required by applicable regulatory pronouncements, the CEO and the CFO review and make various certifications regarding the accuracy of Regions’ periodic public reports filed with the SEC, as well as the effectiveness of disclosure controls and procedures and internal controls over financial reporting. With the assistance of the financial review committees noted in the previous paragraph, Regions will continue to assess and monitor disclosure controls and procedures and internal controls over financial reporting, and will make refinements as necessary.

COMPARISON OF 2012 WITH 2011—CONTINUING OPERATIONS
Regions reported net income available to common shareholders of $991 million, or $0.71 per diluted common share, in 2012 compared to a net loss available to common shareholders of $429 million, or ($0.34) per diluted share, in 2011. Regions reported income from continuing operations available to common shareholders of $1.1 billion, or $0.76 per diluted common share, in 2012 compared to a loss from continuing operations available to common shareholders of $25 million, or ($0.02) per diluted share, in 2011.
Net interest income from continuing operations was $3.3 billion in 2012 compared to $3.4 billion 2011. The net interest margin from continuing operations (taxable-equivalent basis) was 3.11 percent in 2012, compared to 3.07 percent during 2011. The decrease in net interest income resulted from a $4.4 billion decline in average interest earning assets. The margin improvement was driven primarily by mix shift from time deposits to lower cost deposit products, resulting in deposit costs decreasing to 0.30 percent in 2012 from 0.49 percent in 2011.
Non-interest income from continuing operations decreased $43 million to $2.1 billion in 2012 compared to 2011. The year-over-year decrease was due primarily to lower securities gains and service charges, partially offset by increased mortgage income, capital markets fee income and other income.
Service charges on deposit accounts decreased 16 percent in 2012 and totaled $985 million compared to $1.2 billion in 2011. The decrease was primarily driven by policy changes negatively impacting non-sufficient fund fees related to Regulation E, as well as a decline in interchange income as a result of debit interchange price controls implemented in the fourth quarter of 2011. During 2012, service charges on deposit accounts were also negatively impacted by a total of approximately $35 million in customer refunds resulting from a change in the Company’s non-sufficient funds policy.
In 2012, mortgage income increased $143 million, or 65 percent to $363 million. The increase reflects wider margins as a result of favorable market conditions, as well as an increase in originations driven by customers taking advantage of the opportunity to refinance under the extended Home Affordable Refinance Program, or HARP II. Mortgage originations totaled $8.0 billion in 2012 as compared to $6.3 billion in 2011. In 2012, refinancing encompassed 63 percent of mortgage originations versus 54 percent in 2011.
Regions reported net gains of $48 million from the sale of securities available for sale in 2012, compared to net gains of $112 million in 2011. Lower security gains during 2012 were due to lower volumes of securities sales resulting from the Company’s asset/liability management process.

92

Table of Contents


Credit card/bank card income increased $20 million in 2012 as compared to 2011. Credit card income is derived from activity related to the Regions-branded credit card amounts purchased from FIA Card Services in the second quarter of 2011 and any subsequent originations. Bank card income relates to commercial purchasing cards. The increase in 2012 is due to an entire year's worth of impact from the 2011 credit card portfolio purchase.

Non-interest expense from continuing operations decreased $336 million in 2012. Non-interest expense in 2011 included a $253 million goodwill impairment charge plus $75 million in branch consolidation and property and equipment charges. The decline in non-interest expense in 2012 included $61 million in net gains related to the sale of loans held for sale in excess of their carrying values, plus a reduction in other real estate owned expenses of $110 million partially offset by a $159 million increase in salaries and employee benefits. See Table 6 “Non-Interest Expense from Continuing Operations” for additional information.

Total salaries and employee benefits increased $159 million, or 10 percent, in 2012. The year-over-year increase was primarily due to higher pension costs, annual merit increases, restricted stock awards and incentive increases, including mortgage-related incentives, partially offset by a decline in headcount from 23,707 at December 31, 2011 to 23,427 at December 31, 2012.
Net occupancy expense decreased 2 percent to $382 million in 2012. Furniture and equipment expense decreased by $14 million to $261 million in 2012. Both of these decreases were primarily driven by branch consolidations.
Professional and legal fees are comprised of amounts related to legal, consulting and other professional fees. These fees decreased $61 million or 35 percent to $114 million in 2012, reflecting a decrease in the level of legal expenses.
OREO expense decreased $110 million to $52 million in 2012 compared to $162 million in 2011, primarily driven by the reduction in foreclosed properties balances along with lower valuation charges. Through Regions’ efforts to sell foreclosed properties, OREO balances decreased $147 million to $149 million in 2012 compared to $296 million in 2011.
Deposit administrative fees decreased $55 million to $162 million in 2012. Deposit administrative fees were impacted by a new assessment rule in 2011, which revised the deposit insurance assessment system for large institutions. The new rule changed the assessment base from deposits as the basis and utilizes a risk-based approach which calculates the assessment using average consolidated assets minus average tangible equity. Implementation of the new rule was effective beginning in the second quarter of 2011. The lower fees were a result of improved financial performance.

During the fourth quarter of 2012, the Company redeemed all issued and outstanding 8.875% Trust Preferred Securities issued by Regions Financing Trust III (“trust preferred securities”). The aggregate principal amount of the trust preferred securities was approximately $345 million. The Company recognized an $11 million loss on the early redemption of these securities.

On November 30, 2012, Regions entered into an agreement with a third party investor in Regions Asset Management Company, Inc., a real estate investment trust, pursuant to which the investment was fully redeemed. As a result, Regions incurred early termination costs of approximately $42 million.
Other miscellaneous expenses increased $43 million to $479 million in 2012. The primary drivers of the increase were mortgage repurchase expenses, amortization of intangible assets related to the credit card portfolio purchase and bank operational losses. Other miscellaneous expenses also include communications, postage, supplies, credit-related costs and business development services.
The Company’s income tax expense for 2012 was $482 million compared to a tax benefit of $28 million in 2011, resulting in an effective tax rate of 29.0 percent and (17.4) percent, respectively. The increase in income tax expense was primarily a result of positive consolidated pre-tax earnings.
At December 31, 2012, the allowance for loan losses totaled $1.9 billion or 2.59 percent of total loans, net of unearned income compared to $2.7 billion or 3.54 percent at year-end 2011. Net charge-offs totaled $1.0 billion, or 1.37 percent of average loans in 2012 compared to $2.0 billion, or 2.44 percent of average loans in 2011. Net charge-offs were lower across most major categories when comparing 2012 to the prior year. The provision for loan losses is used to maintain the allowance for loan losses at a level that in management’s judgment is appropriate to cover losses inherent in the portfolio at the balance sheet date. During 2012, the provision for loan losses was $213 million. This compares to a provision for loan losses of $1.5 billion in 2011. Net charge-offs exceeded the provision for loan losses during 2012 primarily from continued improving credit metrics, as well as an overall reduction in loan balances, problem loan resolutions and a continuing mix shift in loans out of higher risk investor real estate and into less risky commercial and industrial loans. Non-performing assets decreased from $3.0 billion at December 31, 2011, to $1.9 billion at December 31, 2012, reflecting management’s efforts to work through problem assets and reduce the riskiest exposures.


93

Table of Contents


Table 28—Quarterly Results of Operations
 
2013
 
2012
 
Fourth
Quarter
 
Third
Quarter
 
Second
Quarter
 
First
Quarter
 
Fourth
Quarter
 
Third
Quarter
 
Second
Quarter
 
First
Quarter
 
(In millions, except per share data)
Total interest income
$
917

 
$
911

 
$
907

 
$
911

 
$
948

 
$
964

 
$
994

 
$
997

Total interest expense
85

 
87

 
99

 
113

 
130

 
147

 
156

 
170

Net interest income
832

 
824

 
808

 
798

 
818

 
817

 
838

 
827

Provision for loan losses
79

 
18

 
31

 
10

 
37

 
33

 
26

 
117

Net interest income after provision for loan losses
753

 
806

 
777

 
788

 
781

 
784

 
812

 
710

Total non-interest income, excluding securities gains, net
526

 
492

 
489

 
486

 
524

 
521

 
495

 
512

Securities gains, net

 
3

 
8

 
15

 
12

 
12

 
12

 
12

Total non-interest expense
946

 
884

 
884

 
842

 
902

 
869

 
842

 
913

Income from continuing operations before income taxes
333

 
417

 
390

 
447

 
415

 
448

 
477

 
321

Income tax expense
92

 
124

 
122

 
114

 
138

 
136

 
126

 
82

Income from continuing operations
241

 
293

 
268

 
333

 
277

 
312

 
351

 
239

Discontinued operations:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Income (loss) from discontinued operations before income taxes
(25
)
 
(1
)
 
(2
)
 
4

 
(19
)
 
(19
)
 
4

 
(65
)
Income tax expense (benefit)
(11
)
 
(1
)
 
(1
)
 
2

 
(7
)
 
(8
)
 

 
(25
)
Income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of tax
(14
)
 

 
(1
)
 
2

 
(12
)
 
(11
)
 
4

 
(40
)
Net income
$
227

 
$
293

 
$
267

 
$
335

 
$
265

 
$
301

 
$
355

 
$
199

Income from continuing operations available to common shareholders
$
233

 
$
285

 
$
260

 
$
325

 
$
273

 
$
312

 
$
280

 
$
185

Net income available to common shareholders
$
219

 
$
285

 
$
259

 
$
327

 
$
261

 
$
301

 
$
284

 
$
145

Earnings per common share from continuing operations: (1)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Basic
$
0.17

 
$
0.21

 
$
0.19

 
$
0.23

 
$
0.19

 
$
0.22

 
$
0.20

 
$
0.14

Diluted
0.17

 
0.20

 
0.18

 
0.23

 
0.19

 
0.22

 
0.20

 
0.14

Earnings per common share: (1)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Basic
$
0.16

 
$
0.21

 
$
0.18

 
$
0.23

 
$
0.18

 
$
0.21

 
$
0.20

 
$
0.11

Diluted
0.16

 
0.20

 
0.18

 
0.23

 
0.18

 
0.21

 
0.20

 
0.11

Cash dividends declared per share
0.03

 
0.03

 
0.03

 
0.01

 
0.01

 
0.01

 
0.01

 
0.01

Market price: (2)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
High
$
10.13

 
$
10.52

 
$
9.71

 
$
8.44

 
$
7.72

 
$
7.73

 
$
6.98

 
$
6.69

Low
9.19

 
8.84

 
7.62

 
7.13

 
6.19

 
6.22

 
5.46

 
4.21

________
(1)
Quarterly amounts may not add to year-to-date amounts due to rounding.
(2)
High and low market prices are based on intraday sales prices.


94

Table of Contents


Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data

REPORT OF MANAGEMENT ON INTERNAL CONTROL OVER FINANCIAL REPORTING
We, as members of the Management of Regions Financial Corporation (the “Company”), are responsible for establishing and maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting. Regions’ internal control system was designed to provide reasonable assurance to the Company’s management and Board of Directors regarding the preparation and fair presentation of the Company’s financial statements for external purposes in accordance with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles. Internal control over financial reporting includes self-monitoring mechanisms, and actions are taken to correct deficiencies as they are identified.
All internal controls systems, no matter how well designed, have inherent limitations and may not prevent or detect misstatements in the Company’s financial statements, including the possibility of circumvention or overriding of controls. Therefore, even those systems determined to be effective can provide only reasonable assurance with respect to financial statement preparation and presentation. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.
Regions’ management assessed the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2013. In making this assessment, we used the criteria set forth by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (“COSO”) in its 1992 Internal Control—Integrated Framework. Based on our assessment, we believe and assert that, as of December 31, 2013, the Company’s internal control over financial reporting is effective based on those criteria.
Regions’ independent registered public accounting firm has issued an audit report on the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting. This report appears on the following page.
 
 
 
 
 
 
REGIONS FINANCIAL CORPORATION
 
 
 
by
/S/    O. B. GRAYSON HALL, JR.        
 
 
O. B. Grayson Hall, Jr.
President and Chief Executive Officer
 
 
 
by
/S/    DAVID J. TURNER, JR.        
 
 
David J. Turner, Jr.
Chief Financial Officer

95

Table of Contents


REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS AND STOCKHOLDERS OF REGIONS FINANCIAL CORPORATION
We have audited Regions Financial Corporation’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2013, based on criteria established in Internal Control-Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (1992 framework) (the COSO criteria). Regions Financial Corporation’s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting, and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting included in the accompanying Report of Management on Internal Control over Financial Reporting. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audit.
We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk, and performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.
A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.
Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

In our opinion, Regions Financial Corporation maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2013, based on the COSO criteria.

We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the consolidated balance sheets of Regions Financial Corporation and subsidiaries as of December 31, 2013 and 2012, and the related consolidated statements of operations, other comprehensive income (loss), changes in stockholders’ equity, and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2013 of Regions Financial Corporation and our report dated February 21, 2014, expressed an unqualified opinion thereon.

                            
Birmingham, Alabama
February 21, 2014



96

Table of Contents


REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS AND STOCKHOLDERS OF REGIONS FINANCIAL CORPORATION
We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Regions Financial Corporation and subsidiaries as of December 31, 2013 and 2012, and the related consolidated statements of operations, other comprehensive income (loss), changes in stockholders’ equity, and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2013. These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audits.
We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit also includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.
In our opinion, the financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the consolidated financial position of Regions Financial Corporation and subsidiaries at December 31, 2013 and 2012, and the consolidated results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2013, in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles.
We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), Regions Financial Corporation’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2013, based on criteria established in Internal Control-Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (1992 framework) and our report dated February 21, 2014, expressed an unqualified opinion thereon.
 
                            
Birmingham, Alabama
February 21, 2014


97

Table of Contents


REGIONS FINANCIAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
 
December 31
 
2013
 
2012
 
(In millions, except share data)
Assets
 
 
 
Cash and due from banks
$
1,661

 
$
1,979

Interest-bearing deposits in other banks
3,612

 
3,510

Trading account securities
111

 
116

Securities held to maturity (estimated fair value of $2,307 and $11, respectively)
2,353

 
10

Securities available for sale
21,485

 
27,244

Loans held for sale (includes $429 and $1,282 measured at fair value, respectively)
1,055

 
1,383

Loans, net of unearned income
74,609

 
73,995

Allowance for loan losses
(1,341
)
 
(1,919
)
Net loans
73,268

 
72,076

Other interest-earning assets
86

 
900

Premises and equipment, net
2,216

 
2,279

Interest receivable
313

 
344

Goodwill
4,816

 
4,816

Mortgage servicing rights at fair value
297

 
191

Other identifiable intangible assets
295

 
345

Other assets
5,828

 
6,154

Total assets
$
117,396

 
$
121,347

Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity
 
 
 
Deposits:
 
 
 
Non-interest-bearing
$
30,083

 
$
29,963

Interest-bearing
62,370

 
65,511

Total deposits
92,453

 
95,474

Borrowed funds:
 
 
 
Short-term borrowings:
 
 
 
Federal funds purchased and securities sold under agreements to repurchase
2,182

 
1,449

Other short-term borrowings

 
125

Total short-term borrowings
2,182

 
1,574

Long-term borrowings
4,830

 
5,861

Total borrowed funds
7,012

 
7,435

Other liabilities
2,163

 
2,939

Total liabilities
101,628

 
105,848

Stockholders’ equity:
 
 
 
Preferred stock, authorized 10 million shares:
 
 
 
Series A, non-cumulative perpetual, par value $1.00 (liquidation preference $1,000.00) per share, including related surplus, net of discount;
Issued—500,000 shares
450

 
482

Common stock, par value $.01 per share:
 
 
 
Authorized 3 billion shares
 
 
 
Issued including treasury stock—1,419,006,360 and 1,454,626,952 shares, respectively
14

 
15

Additional paid-in capital
19,216

 
19,652

Retained earnings (deficit)
(2,216
)
 
(3,338
)
Treasury stock, at cost—41,285,676 and 41,287,460 shares, respectively
(1,377
)
 
(1,377
)
Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss), net
(319
)
 
65

Total stockholders’ equity
15,768

 
15,499

Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity
$
117,396

 
$
121,347


See notes to consolidated financial statements.

98

Table of Contents


REGIONS FINANCIAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS
 
Year Ended December 31
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
(In millions, except per share data)
Interest income on:
 
 
 
 
 
Loans, including fees
$
3,005

 
$
3,178

 
$
3,444

Securities - taxable
603

 
681

 
758

Loans held for sale
29

 
33

 
36

Trading account securities
3

 
2

 
1

Other interest-earning assets
6

 
9

 
13

Total interest income
3,646

 
3,903

 
4,252

Interest expense on:
 
 
 
 
 
Deposits
135

 
284

 
472

Short-term borrowings
2

 
2

 
(1
)
Long-term borrowings
247

 
317

 
371

Total interest expense
384

 
603

 
842

Net interest income
3,262

 
3,300

 
3,410

Provision for loan losses
138

 
213

 
1,530

Net interest income after provision for loan losses
3,124

 
3,087

 
1,880

Non-interest income:
 
 
 
 
 
Service charges on deposit accounts
978

 
985

 
1,168

Mortgage income
236

 
363

 
220

Investment management and trust fee income
196

 
195

 
199

Securities gains (losses), net
26

 
48

 
112

Other
583

 
509

 
444

Total non-interest income
2,019

 
2,100

 
2,143

Non-interest expense:
 
 
 
 
 
Salaries and employee benefits
1,818

 
1,763

 
1,604

Net occupancy expense
365

 
382

 
388

Furniture and equipment expense
280

 
261

 
275

Goodwill impairment

 

 
253

Other
1,093

 
1,120

 
1,342

Total non-interest expense
3,556

 
3,526

 
3,862

Income from continuing operations before income taxes
1,587

 
1,661

 
161

Income tax expense (benefit)
452

 
482

 
(28
)
Income from continuing operations
1,135

 
1,179

 
189

Discontinued operations:
 
 
 
 
 
Loss from discontinued operations before income taxes
(24
)
 
(99
)
 
(408
)
Income tax benefit
(11
)
 
(40
)
 
(4
)
Loss from discontinued operations, net of tax
(13
)
 
(59
)
 
(404
)
Net income (loss)
$
1,122

 
$
1,120

 
$
(215
)
Net income (loss) from continuing operations available to common shareholders
$
1,103

 
$
1,050

 
$
(25
)
Net income (loss) available to common shareholders
$
1,090

 
$
991

 
$
(429
)
Weighted-average number of shares outstanding:
 
 
 
 
 
Basic
1,395

 
1,381

 
1,258

Diluted
1,410

 
1,387

 
1,258

Earnings (loss) per common share from continuing operations:
 
 
 
 
 
Basic
$
0.79

 
$
0.76

 
$
(0.02
)
Diluted
0.78

 
0.76

 
(0.02
)
Earnings (loss) per common share:
 
 
 
 
 
Basic
$
0.78

 
$
0.72

 
$
(0.34
)
Diluted
0.77

 
0.71

 
(0.34
)
Cash dividends declared per common share
0.10

 
0.04

 
0.04

See notes to consolidated financial statements.

99

Table of Contents


REGIONS FINANCIAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF COMPREHENSIVE INCOME (LOSS)
 
Year Ended December 31
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
(In millions)
Net income
$
1,122

 
$
1,120

 
$
(215
)
Other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax:
 
 
 
 
 
Unrealized losses on securities transferred to held to maturity:
 
 
 
 
 
Unrealized losses on securities transferred to held to maturity during the period (net of ($43), zero and zero tax effect, respectively)
(68
)
 

 

Less: amortization of unrealized losses on securities held to maturity (net of ($3), zero and zero tax effect, respectively)
(4
)
 

 

Net change in unrealized losses on securities transferred to held to maturity
(64
)
 

 

Unrealized gains (losses) on securities available for sale:
 
 
 
 
 
Unrealized holding gains (losses) arising during the period (net of ($268), $90 and $189 tax effect, respectively)
(441
)
 
145

 
317

Less: reclassification adjustments for securities gains (losses) realized in net income (net of $9, $17 and $39 tax effect, respectively)
17

 
31

 
73

Net change in unrealized gains (losses) on securities available for sale
(458
)
 
114

 
244

Unrealized gains (losses) on derivative instruments designated as cash flow hedges:
 
 
 
 
 
Unrealized holding gains (losses) on derivatives arising during the period (net of ($15), $31 and $123 tax effect, respectively)
(25
)
 
51

 
202

Less: reclassification adjustments for gains (losses) realized in net income (net of $33, $25 and $66 tax effect, respectively)
53

 
42

 
108

Net change in unrealized gains (losses) on derivative instruments
(78
)
 
9

 
94

Defined benefit pension plans and other post employment benefits:
 
 
 
 
 
Net actuarial gains (losses) arising during the period (net of $108, ($19) and ($106) tax effect, respectively)
171

 
(36
)
 
(177
)
Less: reclassification adjustments for amortization of actuarial loss and prior service cost realized in net income, and other (net of ($25), ($25) and ($16) tax effect, respectively)
(45
)
 
(47
)
 
(30
)
Net change from defined benefit pension plans
216

 
11

 
(147
)
Other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax
(384
)
 
134

 
191

Comprehensive income (loss)
$
738

 
$
1,254

 
$
(24
)
See notes to consolidated financial statements.

100

Table of Contents


REGIONS FINANCIAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY

 
Preferred Stock
 
Common Stock
 
Additional
Paid-In
Capital
 
Retained
Earnings
(Deficit)
 
Treasury
Stock,
At Cost
 
Accumulated
Other
Comprehensive
Income (Loss), Net
 
Total
 
Shares
 
Amount
 
Shares
 
Amount
 
 
 
 
 
 
(In millions, except share and per share data)
BALANCE AT JANUARY 1, 2011
4

 
$
3,380

 
1,256

 
$
13

 
$
18,896

 
$
(3,893
)
 
$
(1,402
)
 
$
(260
)
 
$
16,734

Net income (loss)

 

 

 

 

 
(215
)
 

 

 
(215
)
Net change in unrealized gains and losses on securities available for sale, net of tax and reclassification adjustment

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
244

 
244

Net change in unrealized gains and losses on derivative instruments, net of tax and reclassification adjustment

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
94

 
94

Net change from defined benefit pension plans, net of tax

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
(147
)
 
(147
)
Cash dividends declared—$0.04 per share

 

 

 

 
(51
)
 

 

 

 
(51
)
Preferred dividends:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
U.S. Treasury preferred stock dividends

 

 

 

 

 
(175
)
 

 

 
(175
)
Preferred stock transactions:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Discount accretion

 
39

 

 

 

 
(39
)
 

 

 

Common stock transactions:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Impact of stock transactions under compensation plans, net

 

 
3

 

 
10

 

 
5

 

 
15

BALANCE AT DECEMBER 31, 2011
4

 
$
3,419

 
1,259

 
$
13

 
$
18,855

 
$
(4,322
)
 
$
(1,397
)
 
$
(69
)
 
$
16,499

Net income

 

 

 

 

 
1,120

 

 

 
1,120

Net change in unrealized gains and losses on securities available for sale, net of tax and reclassification adjustment

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
114

 
114

Net change in unrealized gains and losses on derivative instruments, net of tax and reclassification adjustment

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
9

 
9

Net change from defined benefit pension plans, net of tax

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
11

 
11

Cash dividends declared—$0.04 per share

 

 

 

 
(54
)
 

 

 

 
(54
)
Preferred dividends:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
U.S. Treasury preferred stock dividends

 

 

 

 

 
(44
)
 

 

 
(44
)
Series A preferred stock dividends

 
(4
)
 

 

 

 

 

 

 
(4
)
Preferred stock transactions:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Discount accretion

 
10

 

 

 

 
(10
)
 

 

 

Repurchase of Series A preferred stock issued to the U.S. Treasury and associated accelerated accretion
(4
)
 
(3,429
)
 

 

 

 
(71
)
 

 

 
(3,500
)
Repurchase of warrant from the U.S. Treasury

 

 

 

 
(45
)
 

 

 

 
(45
)
Net proceeds from issuance of 500 thousand shares of Series A, noncumulative perpetual preferred stock, including related surplus
1

 
486

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
486

Common stock transactions:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net proceeds from issuance of 153 million shares of common stock

 

 
153

 
2

 
873

 

 

 

 
875

Impact of stock transactions under compensation plans, net

 

 
1

 

 
23

 
(11
)
 
20

 

 
32

BALANCE AT DECEMBER 31, 2012
1

 
$
482

 
1,413

 
$
15

 
$
19,652

 
$
(3,338
)
 
$
(1,377
)
 
$
65

 
$
15,499

Net income

 

 

 

 

 
1,122

 

 

 
1,122

Unrealized losses on securities transferred to held to maturity(1)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
(68
)
 
(68
)
Amortization of unrealized losses on securities transferred to held to maturity

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
4

 
4

Net change in unrealized gains and losses on securities available for sale, net of tax and reclassification adjustment

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
(458
)
 
(458
)
Net change in unrealized gains and losses on derivative instruments, net of tax and reclassification adjustment

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
(78
)
 
(78
)
Net change from defined benefit pension plans, net of tax

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
216

 
216

Cash dividends declared—$0.10 per share

 

 

 

 
(138
)
 

 

 

 
(138
)
Series A preferred stock dividends

 
(32
)
 

 

 

 

 

 

 
(32
)
Common stock transactions:


 


 


 


 


 


 


 


 


Impact of share repurchase

 

 
(36
)
 
(1
)
 
(339
)
 

 

 

 
(340
)
Impact of stock transactions under compensation plans, net

 

 
1

 

 
41

 

 

 

 
41

BALANCE AT DECEMBER 31, 2013
1

 
$
450

 
1,378

 
$
14

 
$
19,216

 
$
(2,216
)
 
$
(1,377
)
 
$
(319
)
 
$
15,768

_________
(1)
Represents unrealized losses on certain securities previously classified as available for sale securities that were transferred to held to maturity classification. Refer to Note 4 "Securities" for further details.

See notes to consolidated financial statements.

101

Table of Contents


REGIONS FINANCIAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
 
Year Ended December 31
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
(In millions)
Operating activities:
 
 
 
 
 
Net income
$
1,122

 
$
1,120

 
$
(215
)
Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash from operating activities:
 
 
 
 
 
Provision for loan losses
138

 
213

 
1,530

Impairment of goodwill

 

 
745

Depreciation, amortization and accretion, net
645

 
717

 
683

Provision for losses on other real estate, net
18

 
22

 
124

Securities (gains) losses, net
(26
)
 
(48
)
 
(112
)
Gain on disposition of business

 
(19
)
 

Deferred income tax expense (benefit)
379

 
434

 
(23
)
Originations and purchases of loans held for sale
(4,075
)
 
(6,321
)
 
(3,460
)
Proceeds from sales of loans held for sale
5,051

 
6,002

 
4,767

(Gain) loss on sale of loans, net
(113
)
 
(165
)
 
(89
)
(Gain) loss on early extinguishment of debt
61

 
11

 

(Gain) loss on sale of other assets
(24
)
 

 

Net change in operating assets and liabilities:
 
 
 
 
 
Trading account securities
5

 
187

 
(150
)
Other interest-earning assets
814

 
(181
)
 
134

Interest receivable
31

 
14

 
60

Other assets
681

 
809

 
1,107

Other liabilities
(915
)
 
(353
)
 
(366
)
Other
7

 
(1
)
 
18

Net cash from operating activities
3,799

 
2,441

 
4,753

Investing activities:
 
 
 
 
 
Proceeds from sales of securities available for sale
3,828

 
2,571

 
7,859

Proceeds from maturities of securities held to maturity
76

 
5

 
9

Proceeds from maturities of securities available for sale
5,406

 
6,844

 
5,848

Purchases of securities available for sale
(7,050
)
 
(11,571
)
 
(14,592
)
Proceeds from sales of loans
193

 
887

 
1,488

Purchases of loans
(978
)
 
(882
)
 
(1,884
)
Purchases of servicing rights
(28
)
 

 

Net change in loans
(1,386
)
 
2,478

 
2,132

Net purchases of premises and equipment
(186
)
 
(180
)
 
(201
)
Proceeds from disposition of business, net of cash transferred

 
855

 

Net cash from investing activities
(125
)
 
1,007

 
659

Financing activities:
 
 
 
 
 
Net change in deposits
(3,021
)
 
(153
)
 
1,013

Net change in short-term borrowings
608

 
(564
)
 
(870
)
Proceeds from long-term borrowings
750

 

 
1,001

Payments on long-term borrowings
(1,717
)
 
(2,201
)
 
(6,004
)
Cash dividends on common stock
(138
)
 
(54
)
 
(51
)
Cash dividends on preferred stock
(32
)
 
(48
)
 
(175
)
Net proceeds from issuance of Series A preferred stock

 
486

 

Net proceeds from issuance of common stock

 
875

 

Repurchase of common stock
(340
)
 

 

Repurchase of Series A preferred stock and warrant issued to the U.S. Treasury

 
(3,545
)
 

Net cash from financing activities
(3,890
)
 
(5,204
)
 
(5,086
)
Net change in cash and cash equivalents
(216
)
 
(1,756
)
 
326

Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year
5,489

 
7,245

 
6,919

Cash and cash equivalents at end of year
$
5,273

 
$
5,489

 
$
7,245


See notes to consolidated financial statements.

102

Table of Contents


REGIONS FINANCIAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
NOTE 1. SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES
Regions Financial Corporation (“Regions” or the “Company”) provides a full range of banking and bank-related services to individual and corporate customers through its subsidiaries and branch offices located primarily in Alabama, Arkansas, Florida, Georgia, Illinois, Indiana, Iowa, Kentucky, Louisiana, Mississippi, Missouri, North Carolina, South Carolina, Tennessee, Texas and Virginia. The Company is subject to competition from other financial institutions, is subject to the regulations of certain government agencies and undergoes periodic examinations by certain of those regulatory authorities.
The accounting and reporting policies of Regions and the methods of applying those policies that materially affect the consolidated financial statements conform with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States (“GAAP”) and with general financial services industry practices. In preparing the financial statements, management is required to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities as of the balance sheet dates and revenues and expenses for the periods presented. Actual results could differ from the estimates and assumptions used in the consolidated financial statements including, but not limited to, the estimates and assumptions related to the allowance for credit losses, fair value measurements, intangibles, mortgage servicing rights and income taxes.
Regions has evaluated all subsequent events for potential recognition and disclosure through the filing date of this Form 10-K.
Certain amounts in prior period financial statements have been reclassified to conform to the current period presentation, except as otherwise noted. These reclassifications are immaterial and have no effect on net income (loss), comprehensive income (loss), total assets or total stockholders’ equity as previously reported.
BASIS OF PRESENTATION AND PRINCIPLES OF CONSOLIDATION
The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of Regions, its subsidiaries and certain variable interest entities (“VIEs”). Significant intercompany balances and transactions have been eliminated. Regions considers a voting rights entity to be a subsidiary and consolidates it if Regions has a controlling financial interest in the entity. VIEs are consolidated if Regions has the power to direct the significant activities of the VIE that impact financial performance and has the obligation to absorb losses or the right to receive benefits that could potentially be significant (i.e., Regions is considered to be the primary beneficiary). The assessment of whether or not Regions is the primary beneficiary of a VIE is performed on an on-going basis. Investments in companies which are not VIEs, or where Regions is not the primary beneficiary of a VIE but in which Regions has significant influence over the operating and financing decisions, are accounted for using the equity method of accounting. These investments are included in other assets in the consolidated balance sheets at cost, adjusted to reflect the Company’s portion of income, loss, or dividends to the investee. The maximum potential exposure to losses relative to investments in VIEs is generally limited to the sum of the outstanding balance, future funding commitments and any related loans to the entity. Loans to these entities are underwritten in substantially the same manner as are other loans and are generally secured. Refer to Note 2 for additional disclosures regarding Regions’ significant VIEs.
Unconsolidated equity investments that do not meet the criteria to be accounted for under the equity method are accounted for under the cost method. Cost method investments are included in other assets in the consolidated balance sheets and dividends received or receivable from these investments are included as a component of other non-interest income in the consolidated statements of operations.

DISCONTINUED OPERATIONS
On January 11, 2012, Regions entered into an agreement to sell Morgan Keegan & Company, Inc. (“Morgan Keegan”) and related affiliates. The transaction closed on April 2, 2012. Results of operations for the entities sold are presented separately as discontinued operations for all periods presented on the consolidated statements of operations. Other expenses related to the transaction are also included in discontinued operations. See Note 3 and Note 23 for further discussion.
CASH EQUIVALENTS AND CASH FLOWS
Cash equivalents include cash and due from banks, interest-bearing deposits in other banks, and federal funds sold and securities purchased under agreements to resell. Cash flows from loans, either originated or acquired, are classified at that time according to management’s original intent to either sell or hold the loan for the foreseeable future. When management’s intent is to sell the loan, the cash flows of that loan are presented as operating cash flows. When management’s intent is to hold the loan for the foreseeable future, the cash flows of that loan are presented as investing cash flows.

103

Table of Contents


The following table summarizes supplemental cash flow information for the years ended December 31:
 
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
(In millions)
Cash paid (received) during the period for:
 
 
 
 
 
Interest on deposits and borrowings
$
416

 
$
644

 
$
919

Income taxes, net
54

 
80

 
(98
)
Non-cash transfers:
 
 
 
 
 
Loans held for sale and loans transferred to other real estate
227

 
297

 
532

Loans transferred to loans held for sale(1)
712

 
341

 
973

Loans held for sale transferred to loans
26

 
8

 

Properties transferred to held for sale
6

 

 
51

Reduction of indemnification reserves

 
51

 

_________
(1) During the fourth quarter of 2013, Regions transferred approximately $535 million of primarily accruing restructured residential first mortgage loans to loans held for sale.
SECURITIES PURCHASED UNDER AGREEMENTS TO RESELL AND SECURITIES SOLD UNDER AGREEMENTS TO REPURCHASE
Securities purchased under agreements to resell and securities sold under agreements to repurchase are treated as collateralized financing transactions. It is Regions’ policy to take possession of securities purchased under resell agreements either through direct delivery or a tri-party agreement.
TRADING ACCOUNT SECURITIES
Trading account securities, which are primarily held for employee benefit purposes as a funding mechanism for related liabilities, consist of debt and marketable equity securities and are carried at estimated fair value. See the “Fair Value Measurements” section below for discussion of determining fair value. Gains and losses, both realized and unrealized, related to continuing operations are included in other non-interest income.
SECURITIES
Management determines the appropriate accounting classification of debt and equity securities at the time of purchase, based on intent, and periodically re-evaluates such designations. Debt securities are classified as securities held to maturity when the Company has the intent and ability to hold the securities to maturity. Securities held to maturity are presented at amortized cost. Debt securities not classified as securities held to maturity or trading account securities and marketable equity securities not classified as trading account securities are classified as securities available for sale. Securities available for sale are presented at estimated fair value with changes in unrealized gains and losses, net of taxes, reported as a component of accumulated other comprehensive income (loss). See the “Fair Value Measurements” section below for discussion of determining fair value.
The amortized cost of debt securities classified as securities held to maturity and securities available for sale is adjusted for amortization of premiums and accretion of discounts to maturity, or in the case of mortgage-backed securities, over the estimated life of the security, using the interest method. Such amortization or accretion is included in interest income on securities. Realized gains and losses are included in net securities gains (losses). The cost of securities sold is based on the specific identification method.
The Company reviews its securities portfolio on a regular basis to determine if there are any conditions indicating that a security has other-than-temporary impairment. Factors considered in this determination include the length of time and the extent to which the market value has been below cost, the credit standing of the issuer, whether the Company expects to receive all scheduled principal and interest payments, Regions’ intent to sell and whether it is more likely than not that the Company will have to sell the security before its market value recovers. For debt securities, activity related to the credit loss component of other-than-temporary impairment is recognized in earnings, and the portion of other-than-temporary impairment related to all other factors is recognized in other accumulated comprehensive income (loss). Additionally, the Company recognizes impairment of available for sale equity securities when the cost basis is above the highest traded price within the past six months; the cost basis of the securities is adjusted to current fair value with the entire offset recorded in the statement of operations. Refer to Note 4 for further detail and information on securities.

104

Table of Contents


LOANS HELD FOR SALE
Regions’ loans held for sale generally include commercial loans, investor real estate loans and residential real estate mortgage loans. Loans held for sale are recorded at either estimated fair value, if the fair value option is elected, or the lower of cost or estimated fair value. Regions has elected to account for residential real estate mortgages originated with the intent to sell at fair value. Intent is established for these 15 and 30-year conforming residential real estate mortgage loans when Regions enters into an interest rate lock commitment. Gains and losses on these residential mortgage loans held for sale for which the fair value option has been elected are included in mortgage income. Regions also transfers certain commercial, investor real estate, and residential real estate mortgage portfolio loans to held for sale when management has the intent to sell in the near term. These held for sale loans are recorded at the lower of cost or estimated fair value. At the time of transfer, write-downs on the loans are recorded as charge-offs and a new cost basis is established. Any subsequent lower of cost or market adjustment is determined on an individual loan basis and is recognized as a valuation allowance with any charges included in other non-interest expense. Gains and losses on the sale of these loans are included in other non-interest expense when realized. See the “Fair Value Measurements” section below for discussion of determining estimated fair value.
LOANS
Loans that management has the intent and ability to hold for the foreseeable future or until maturity or payoff are considered loans held for investment (or portfolio loans). Loans held for investment are carried at the principal amount outstanding, net of premiums, discounts, unearned income and deferred loan fees and costs. Regions' loan balance is comprised of commercial, investor real estate and consumer loans. Interest income on all types of loans is accrued based on the contractual interest rate and the principal amount outstanding, except for those loans classified as non-accrual. Premiums and discounts on purchased loans and non-refundable loan origination and commitment fees, net of direct costs of originating or acquiring loans, are deferred and recognized over the estimated lives of the related loans as an adjustment to the loans’ effective yield, which is included in interest income on loans. See Note 5 for further detail and information on loans.
Regions engages in both direct and leveraged lease financing. The net investment in direct financing leases is the sum of all minimum lease payments and estimated residual values, less unearned income. Unearned income is recognized over the terms of the leases to produce a level yield. The net investment in leveraged leases is the sum of all lease payments (less non-recourse debt payments) and estimated residual values, less unearned income. Income from leveraged leases is recognized over the term of the leases based on the unrecovered equity investment.
Regions determines past due or delinquency status of a loan based on contractual payment terms.
Commercial and investor real estate loans are placed on non-accrual if any of the following conditions occur: 1) collection in full of contractual principal and interest is no longer reasonably assured (even if current as to payment status), 2) a partial charge-off has occurred, unless the loan has been brought current under its contractual terms (original or restructured terms) and the full originally contracted principal and interest is considered to be fully collectible, or 3) the loan is delinquent on any principal or interest for 90 days or more unless the obligation is secured by collateral having a net realizable value (estimated fair value less costs to sell) sufficient to fully discharge the obligation and the loan is in the legal process of collection. Factors considered regarding full collection include assessment of changes in borrower’s cash flow, valuation of underlying collateral, ability and willingness of guarantors to provide credit support, and other conditions.
Charge-offs on commercial and investor real estate loans are primarily based on the facts and circumstances of the individual loan and occur when available information confirms the loan is not fully collectible and the loss is reasonably quantifiable. Factors considered in making these determinations are the borrower’s and any guarantor’s ability and willingness to pay, the status of the account in bankruptcy court (if applicable), and collateral value. Commercial and investor real estate loan relationships of $250,000 or less are subject to charge-off or charge down to net realizable value at 180 days past due, based on collateral value.
Non-accrual and charge-off decisions for consumer loans are dictated by the Federal Financial Institutions Examination Council’s (“FFIEC”) Uniform Retail Credit Classification and Account Management Policy which establishes standards for the classification and treatment of consumer loans. Non-accrual status is driven by the charge-off process as follows. If a consumer loan secured by real estate in a first lien position (residential first mortgage or home equity) becomes 180 days past due, Regions evaluates the loan for non-accrual status and potential charge-off based on net loan to value exposure. For home equity loans in a second lien position, the evaluation is performed at 120 days past due. If a loan is secured by collateral having a net realizable value sufficient to fully discharge the obligation, then a partial write-down is not necessary and the loan remains on accrual status, provided it is in the process of legal collection. If a partial charge-off is necessary as a result of the evaluation, then the remaining balance is placed on non-accrual. Consumer loans not secured by real estate are charged-off in full at either 120 days past due for closed-end loans, 180 days past due for open-end loans other than credit cards or the end of the month in which the loan becomes 180 days past due for credit cards.

105

Table of Contents


When loans are placed on non-accrual status, the accrual of interest, amortization of loan premium, accretion of loan discount and amortization/accretion of deferred net loan fees/costs are discontinued. When a commercial or investor real estate loan is placed on non-accrual status, uncollected interest accrued in the current year is reversed and charged to interest income. Uncollected interest accrued from prior years on commercial and investor real estate loans placed on non-accrual status in the current year is charged against the allowance for loan losses. When a consumer loan is placed on non-accrual status, all uncollected interest accrued is reversed and charged to interest income due to immateriality. Interest collections on non-accrual loans are applied as principal reductions.
All loans on non-accrual status may be returned to accrual status and interest accrual resumed if both of the following conditions are met: 1) the loan is brought contractually current as to both principal and interest, and 2) future payments are reasonably expected to continue being received in accordance with the terms of the loan and repayment ability can be reasonably demonstrated.
ALLOWANCE FOR CREDIT LOSSES
Regions' allowance for credit losses (“allowance”) consists of two components: the allowance for loan and lease losses, which is recorded as a contra-asset to loans, and the reserve for unfunded credit commitments, which is recorded in other liabilities. The allowance is reduced by actual losses (charge-offs) and increased by recoveries, if any. Regions charges losses against the allowance in the period the loss is confirmed. All adjustments to the allowance for loan losses are charged directly to expense through the provision for loan losses. All adjustments to the reserve for unfunded credit commitments are recorded in other non-interest expense.
The allowance is maintained at a level believed appropriate by management to absorb probable credit losses inherent in the loan and unfunded credit commitment portfolios in accordance with GAAP and regulatory guidelines. Management’s determination of the appropriateness of the allowance is a quarterly process and is based on an evaluation and rating of the loan portfolio segments, historical loan loss experience, current economic conditions, collateral values of properties securing loans, levels of problem loans, volume, growth, quality and composition of the loan portfolio segments, regulatory guidance, and other relevant factors. Changes in any of these, or other factors, or the availability of new information, could require that the allowance be adjusted in future periods. Actual losses could vary from management’s estimates. Management attributes portions of the allowance to loans that it evaluates and determines to be impaired and to groups of loans that it evaluates collectively. However, the entire allowance is available to cover all charge-offs that arise from the loan portfolio.
CALCULATION OF ALLOWANCE FOR CREDIT LOSSES
Commercial and Investor Real Estate Components
Impaired Loans
Loans deemed to be impaired include non-accrual loans, excluding consumer loans, and all troubled debt restructurings (“TDRs”). Regions considers the current value of collateral, credit quality of any guarantees, guarantor’s liquidity and willingness to cooperate, the loan structure, and other factors when evaluating whether an individual loan is impaired. Other factors may include the industry and geographic region of the borrower, size and financial condition of the borrower, cash flow and leverage of the borrower and Regions’ evaluation of the borrower’s management. For non-accrual commercial and investor real estate loans (including TDRs) equal to or greater than $2.5 million, the allowance for loan losses is based on a note-level evaluation considering the facts and circumstances specific to each borrower. For these loans, Regions measures the level of impairment based on the present value of the estimated projected cash flows, the estimated value of the collateral or, if available, the observable market price. Regions generally uses the estimated projected cash flow method to measure impairment. For commercial and investor real estate accruing TDRs and non-accruing TDRs less than $2.5 million, the allowance for loan losses is based on a discounted cash flow analysis performed at the note level, where projected cash flows reflect credit losses based on statistical information (including historical default information) derived from loans with similar risk characteristics (e.g., credit quality indicator and product type) using probability of default (“PD”) and loss-given default (“LGD”) as described in the following paragraph. Beginning in the third quarter of 2013, for non-accrual commercial and investor real estate loans less than $2.5 million, the allowance for loan losses is based on the same discounted cash flow analysis as the accruing and non-accruing TDRs less than $2.5 million. This change in the estimation process did not have a material impact to the overall level of the allowance for loan losses or the provision for loan losses.
Non-Impaired Loans
For all other commercial and investor real estate loans, the allowance for loan losses is calculated at a pool level based on credit quality indicators and product type. Statistically determined PDs and LGDs are calculated based on historical default and loss information for similar loans. The historical default and loss information is measured over a relevant period for each loan pool. The pool level allowance is calculated using the PD and LGD estimates and is adjusted as appropriate based on additional analysis of long-term average loss experience compared to previously forecasted losses, external loss data and other risks identified

106

Table of Contents


from current economic conditions and credit quality trends. Various one year PD measurements are used in conjunction with life-of-loan LGD measurements to estimate incurred losses. As a result, losses are effectively covered over a two to three year period for loans that are currently in default and those estimated to default within the next twelve months.
Consumer Components
For consumer loans, the classes are segmented into pools of loans with similar risk characteristics. For most consumer loan pools, historical losses are the primary factor in establishing the allowance allocated to each pool. The twelve month loss rate is the basis for the allocation and it may be adjusted based on deteriorating trends, portfolio growth, or other factors determined by management to be relevant.

The allowance for loan losses for the residential first mortgage non-TDR pool is calculated based on a twelve-month historical loss rate segmented based on the following risk characteristics: past due and accrual status and further by geography, property use and amortization type for accruing, non-past due loans. The residential first mortgage non-TDR pool was segmented at this more granular level beginning in the first quarter of 2013 as part of the Company’s ongoing efforts to enhance the allowance calculation. The allowance for loan losses for residential first mortgage TDRs is calculated based on a discounted cash flow analysis on pools of homogeneous loans. Cash flows are projected using the restructured terms and then discounted at the original note rate. The projected cash flows assume a default rate, which is based on historical performance of residential first mortgage TDRs. The allowance for loan losses for the home equity pool is calculated based on a twelve-month historical loss rate segmented based on the following risk characteristics: lien position, TDR status, geography, nonaccrual and past due status, and refreshed FICO scores for accruing, non-past due loans. The home equity pool was segmented at this more granular level beginning in the first quarter of 2012 as part of the Company’s ongoing efforts to enhance the allowance calculation and in response to regulatory guidance issued during the first quarter of 2012.
Qualitative Factors
While quantitative allowance methodologies strive to reflect all risk factors, any estimate involves assumptions and uncertainties resulting in some level of imprecision. Imprecision exists in the estimation process due to the inherent time lag of obtaining information and variations between estimates and actual outcomes. Regions adjusts the allowance in consideration of quantitative and qualitative factors which may not be directly measured in the note-level or pooled calculations, including, but not limited to:

Credit quality trends,
Loss experience in particular portfolios,
Macroeconomic factors such as unemployment or real estate prices,
Changes in risk selection and underwriting standards,
Shifts in credit quality of consumer customers which is not yet reflected in the historical data.
Reserve for Unfunded Credit Commitments
In order to estimate a reserve for unfunded commitments, Regions uses a process consistent with that used in developing the allowance for loan losses. In the second quarter of 2012, the Company refined the methodology for estimation of the reserve for unfunded credit commitments. Before the change, the Company based the reserve for unfunded credit commitments on an analysis of the overall probability of funding and historical losses. Beginning with the second quarter of 2012, the reserve is based on an exposure at default (“EAD”) multiplied by a PD multiplied by an LGD. The EAD is estimated based on an analysis of historical funding patterns for defaulted loans in various categories. The PD and LGD align with the statistically-calculated parameters used to calculate the allowance for loan losses for various pools, which are based on credit quality indicators and product type. The methodology applies to commercial and investor real estate credit commitments and standby letters of credit that are not unconditionally cancellable.
Refer to Note 6 for further discussion regarding the calculation of the allowance for credit losses.
TROUBLED DEBT RESTRUCTURINGS
TDRs are loans in which the borrower is experiencing financial difficulty at the time of restructuring, and Regions has granted a concession to the borrower. TDRs are undertaken in order to improve the likelihood of recovery on the loan and may take the form of modifications made with the stated interest rate lower than the current market rate for new debt with similar risk, other modifications to the structure of the loan that fall outside of normal underwriting policies and procedures, or in limited circumstances forgiveness of principal and interest. TDRs can involve loans remaining on nonaccrual, moving to nonaccrual, or continuing on accrual status, depending on the individual facts and circumstances of the borrower. All loans with the TDR designation are considered to be impaired, even if they are accruing. See the “Calculation of Allowance For Credit Losses” section above for Regions’ allowance for loan losses methodology as related to TDRs.

107

Table of Contents


Under the clarified guidance issued in April 2011, a modification is refutably considered to be a concession if the borrower could not access similar financing at market terms, even if Regions concludes that the borrower will ultimately pay all contractual amounts owed. As a result of the new clarification, the amount of Regions’ reported TDRs increased in the third quarter of 2011. Regions’ original maturities of loans being modified are relatively short (2-3 years), and the renewed term is typically comparable to the original maturity. Accordingly, Regions considers these modifications to be significant delays in the payment. Also, extensions are considered for TDR determinations because the renewed term is significant to the term of the original note.
Modification Activity: Commercial and Investor Real Estate Portfolio Segments
Regions regularly modifies commercial and investor real estate loans in order to facilitate a workout strategy. Typical modifications include workout accommodations, such as renewals and forbearances. Also, for smaller-dollar commercial customers, Regions may periodically grant interest rate and other term concessions, similar to those under the consumer program as described below

Modification Activity: Consumer Portfolio Segment
Regions works to meet the individual needs of consumer borrowers to stem foreclosure through the Customer Assistance Program (“CAP”). Regions designed the program to allow for customer-tailored modifications with the goal of keeping customers in their homes and avoiding foreclosure where possible. Modification may be offered to any borrower experiencing financial hardship—regardless of the borrower’s payment status. Under the CAP, Regions may offer a short-term deferral, a term extension, an interest rate reduction, a new loan product, or a combination of these options. For loans restructured under the CAP, Regions expects to collect the original contractually due principal. The gross original contractual interest may be collectible, depending on the terms modified. The length of the CAP modifications ranges from temporary payment deferrals of three months to term extensions for the life of the loan. All such modifications are considered TDRs regardless of the term because they are concessionary in nature and because the customer documents a hardship in order to participate.
Modified loans are subject to policies governing accrual/non-accrual evaluation consistent with all other loans of the same product type as discussed in the "Loans" section above. Because the CAP program was designed to evaluate potential participants as early as possible in the life cycle of the troubled loan, many of the modifications are finalized without the borrower ever reaching the applicable number of days past due, and with the loans having never been placed on non-accrual. Accordingly, given the positive impact of the restructuring on the likelihood of recovery of cash flows due under the modified terms, accrual status continues to be appropriate for these loans.
If loans characterized as TDRs perform according to the restructured terms for a satisfactory period of time (generally six consecutive months), the TDR designation may be removed in a new calendar year if the loan yields a market rate. The market rate assessment must be made at the date of the modification considering the terms that would be offered to a new borrower with a similar credit profile. Given the types of concessions currently being granted under the CAP as described above, Regions does not expect that the market rate condition will be widely achieved; accordingly, Regions expects loans modified through the CAP to remain identified as TDRs for the remaining term of the loan.
PREMISES AND EQUIPMENT
Premises and equipment are stated at cost, less accumulated depreciation and amortization, as applicable. Land is carried at cost. Depreciation expense is computed using the straight-line method over the estimated useful lives of the assets. Leasehold improvements are amortized using the straight-line method over the estimated useful lives of the improvements (or the terms of the leases, if shorter). Generally, premises and leasehold improvements are depreciated or amortized over 7-40 years. Furniture and equipment are generally depreciated or amortized over 3-10 years. Premises and equipment are evaluated for impairment whenever events or circumstances indicate that the carrying value of the asset may not be recoverable. Maintenance and repairs are charged to non-interest expense in the consolidated statements of operations. Improvements that extend the useful life of the asset are capitalized to the carrying value and depreciated. See Note 8 for detail of premises and equipment.
Regions enters into lease transactions for the right to use assets. These leases vary in term and, from time to time, include incentives and/or rent escalations. Examples of incentives include periods of “free” rent and leasehold improvement incentives. Regions recognizes incentives and escalations on a straight-line basis over the lease term as a reduction of or increase to rent expense, as applicable, within net occupancy expense in the consolidated statements of operations.

INTANGIBLE ASSETS
Intangible assets include goodwill, which is the excess of cost over the fair value of net assets of acquired businesses, and other identifiable intangible assets. Other identifiable intangible assets include the following: 1) core deposit intangible assets, which are amounts recorded related to the value of acquired indeterminate-maturity deposits, 2) amounts capitalized related to the value of acquired customer relationships, and 3) amounts recorded related to employment agreements with certain individuals of

108

Table of Contents


acquired entities. Core deposit intangibles and most other identifiable intangibles are amortized on an accelerated basis over their expected useful lives.
The Company’s goodwill is tested for impairment on an annual basis in the fourth quarter, or more often if events or circumstances indicate that there may be impairment. Regions assesses the following indicators of goodwill impairment for each reporting period:

Recent operating performance,
Changes in market capitalization,
Regulatory actions and assessments,
Changes in the business climate (including legislation, legal factors and competition),
Company-specific factors (including changes in key personnel, asset impairments, and business dispositions), and
Trends in the banking industry.
Adverse changes in the economic environment, declining operations, or other factors could result in a decline in the implied fair value of goodwill. A goodwill impairment test includes two steps. Step One, used to identify potential impairment, compares the estimated fair value of a reporting unit with its carrying amount, including goodwill. If the estimated fair value of a reporting unit exceeds its carrying amount, goodwill of the reporting unit is considered not impaired. If the carrying amount of a reporting unit exceeds its estimated fair value, the second step of the goodwill impairment test is performed to measure the amount of impairment loss, if any. Step Two of the goodwill impairment test compares the implied estimated fair value of reporting unit goodwill with the carrying amount of that goodwill. If the carrying amount of goodwill for that reporting unit exceeds the implied fair value of that unit’s goodwill, an impairment loss is recognized in other non-interest expense in an amount equal to that excess.
For purposes of performing Step One of the goodwill impairment test, Regions uses both income and market approaches to value its reporting units. The income approach, which is the primary valuation approach, consists of discounting projected long-term future cash flows, which are derived from internal forecasts and economic expectations for the respective reporting units. The significant inputs to the income approach include expected future cash flows, the long-term target equity ratios, and the discount rate.
Regions utilizes the capital asset pricing model (“CAPM”) in order to derive the base discount rate. The inputs to the CAPM include the 20-year risk-free rate, 5-year beta for a select peer set, and the market risk premium based on published data. Once the output of the CAPM is determined, a size premium is added (also based on a published source) as well as a company-specific risk premium (based on business model and market perception of risk) for each reporting unit.
Regions uses the guideline public company method and the guideline transaction method as the two market approaches. The public company method applies a value multiplier derived from each reporting unit’s peer group to tangible book value (for Business Services and Consumer Services) or price to earnings (for Wealth Management) ratios and an implied control premium to the respective reporting unit. The control premium is evaluated and compared to similar financial services transactions considering the absolute and relative potential revenue synergies and cost savings. The transaction method applies a value multiplier to a financial metric of the reporting unit based on comparable observed purchase transactions in the financial services industry for the reporting unit (where available).

For purposes of performing Step Two of the goodwill impairment test, if applicable, Regions compares the implied estimated fair value of the reporting unit goodwill with the carrying amount of that goodwill. In order to determine the implied estimated fair value, a full purchase price allocation would be performed in the same manner as if a business combination had occurred. As part of the Step Two analysis, Regions estimates the fair value of all of the assets and liabilities of the reporting unit, including unrecognized assets and liabilities. The related valuation methodologies for certain material financial assets and liabilities are discussed in the “Fair Value Measurements” section below.
Other identifiable intangible assets, primarily core deposit intangibles and purchased credit card relationships, are reviewed at least annually (usually in the fourth quarter) for events or circumstances that could impact the recoverability of the intangible asset. These events could include loss of core deposits, significant losses of credit card accounts and/or balances, increased competition or adverse changes in the economy. To the extent other identifiable intangible assets are deemed unrecoverable, impairment losses are recorded in other non-interest expense and reduce the carrying amount of the asset.
Refer to Note 9 for further detail and discussion of the results of the goodwill and other identifiable intangibles impairment tests.
ACCOUNTING FOR TRANSFERS AND SERVICING OF FINANCIAL ASSETS
Regions accounts for transfers of financial assets as sales when control over the transferred assets is surrendered. Control is generally considered to have been surrendered when 1) the transferred assets are legally isolated from the Company or its

109

Table of Contents


consolidated affiliates, even in bankruptcy or other receivership, 2) the transferee has the right to pledge or exchange the assets with no conditions that constrain the transferee and provide more than a trivial benefit to the Company, and 3) the Company does not maintain the obligation or unilateral ability to reclaim or repurchase the assets. If these sale criteria are met, the transferred assets are removed from the Company’s balance sheet and a gain or loss on sale is recognized. If not met, the transfer is recorded as a secured borrowing, and the assets remain on the Company’s balance sheet, the proceeds from the transaction are recognized as a liability, and gain or loss on sale is deferred until the sale criterion are achieved.
Regions has elected to account for its servicing assets using the fair value measurement method. Under the fair value measurement method, servicing assets are measured at estimated fair value each period with changes in fair value recorded as a component of mortgage income. The fair value of mortgage servicing rights is calculated using various assumptions including future cash flows, market discount rates, expected prepayment rates, servicing costs and other factors. A significant change in prepayments of mortgages in the servicing portfolio could result in significant changes in the valuation adjustments, thus creating potential volatility in the carrying amount of mortgage servicing rights. The valuation method relies on an option-adjusted spread ("OAS") to consider prepayment risk and equate the asset's discounted cash flows to its market price. See the “Fair Value Measurements” section below for additional discussion regarding determination of fair value.
Refer to Note 7 for further information on servicing of financial assets.
FORECLOSED PROPERTY AND OTHER REAL ESTATE
Other real estate and certain other assets acquired in satisfaction of indebtedness (“foreclosure”) are carried in other assets at the lower of the recorded investment in the loan or estimated fair value less estimated costs to sell the property. At the date of transfer, when the recorded investment in the loan exceeds the property’s estimated fair value less costs to sell, write-downs are recorded as estimated charge-offs against the allowance. Regions allows a period of up to 60 days after the date of transfer to record finalized write-downs as charge-offs against the allowance in order to properly accumulate all related invoices and updated valuation information, if necessary. Subsequent to transfer, Regions obtains valuations from professional valuation experts and/or third party appraisers on at least an annual basis. See the “Fair Value Measurements” section below for additional discussion regarding determination of fair value. Subsequent to transfer and the additional 60 days, any further write-downs are recorded as other non-interest expense. Gain or loss on the sale of foreclosed property and other real estate is included in other non-interest expense. At December 31, 2013 and 2012, the carrying values of foreclosed properties were approximately $136 million and $149 million, respectively.
From time to time, assets classified as premises and equipment are transferred to held for sale for various reasons. These assets are carried in other assets at the lower of the recorded investment in the asset or fair value less estimated cost to sell based upon the property’s appraised value at the date of transfer. Any write-downs of property held for sale are recorded as other non-interest expense. At December 31, 2013 and 2012, the carrying values of premises and equipment held for sale were approximately $22 million and $20 million, respectively.
DERIVATIVE FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS AND HEDGING ACTIVITIES
The Company enters into derivative financial instruments to manage interest rate risk, facilitate asset/liability management strategies and manage other exposures. These instruments primarily include interest rate swaps, options on interest rate swaps, interest rate caps and floors, Eurodollar futures, forward rate contracts and forward sale commitments. All derivative financial instruments are recognized on the consolidated balance sheets as other assets or other liabilities, as applicable, at estimated fair value. Regions enters into master netting agreements with counterparties and/or requires collateral to cover exposures. In at least some cases, counterparties post collateral at a zero threshold regardless of credit rating.
Interest rate swaps are agreements to exchange interest payments based upon notional amounts. Interest rate swaps subject Regions to market risk associated with changes in interest rates, as well as the credit risk that the counterparty will fail to perform. Option contracts involve rights to buy or sell financial instruments on a specified date or over a period at a specified price. These rights do not have to be exercised. Some option contracts such as interest rate floors, involve the exchange of cash based on changes in specified indices. Interest rate floors are contracts to hedge interest rate declines based on a notional amount. Interest rate floors subject Regions to market risk associated with changes in interest rates, as well as the credit risk that the counterparty will fail to perform. Forward rate contracts are commitments to buy or sell financial instruments at a future date at a specified price or yield. Regions primarily enters into forward rate contracts on marketable instruments, which expose Regions to market risk associated with changes in the value of the underlying financial instrument, as well as the credit risk that the counterparty will fail to perform. Eurodollar futures are futures contracts on Eurodollar deposits. Eurodollar futures subject Regions to market risk associated with changes in interest rates. Because futures contracts are cash settled daily, there is minimal credit risk associated with Eurodollar futures. Forward sale commitments are sales of securities at a specified price at a future date. Forward sale commitments subject Regions to market risk associated with changes in interest rates, as well as the credit risk that the counterparty will fail to perform.

110

Table of Contents


Derivative financial instruments that qualify for hedge accounting are designated, based on the exposure being hedged, as either fair value or cash flow hedges.
Fair value hedge relationships mitigate exposure to the change in fair value of an asset, liability or firm commitment. Under the fair value hedging model, gains or losses attributable to the change in fair value of the derivative instrument, as well as the gains and losses attributable to the change in fair value of the hedged item, are recognized in other non-interest expense in the period in which the change in fair value occurs. Hedge ineffectiveness is recognized as other non-interest expense to the extent the changes in fair value of the derivative do not offset the changes in fair value of the hedged item. The corresponding adjustment to the hedged asset or liability is included in the basis of the hedged item, while the corresponding change in the fair value of the derivative instrument is recorded as an adjustment to other assets or other liabilities, as applicable.
Cash flow hedge relationships mitigate exposure to the variability of future cash flows or other forecasted transactions. For cash flow hedge relationships, the effective portion of the gain or loss related to the derivative instrument is recognized as a component of accumulated other comprehensive income (loss). Ineffectiveness is measured by comparing the change in fair value of the respective derivative instrument and the change in fair value of a “perfectly effective” hypothetical derivative instrument. Ineffectiveness will be recognized in earnings only if it results from an overhedge. The ineffective portion of the gain or loss related to the derivative instrument, if any, is recognized in earnings as other non-interest expense during the period of change. Amounts recorded in accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) are recognized in earnings in the period or periods during which the hedged item impacts earnings.
The Company formally documents all hedging relationships between hedging instruments and the hedged items, as well as its risk management objective and strategy for entering into various hedge transactions. The Company performs periodic assessments to determine whether the hedging relationship has been highly effective in offsetting changes in fair values or cash flows of hedged items and whether the relationship is expected to continue to be highly effective in the future.
When a hedge is terminated or hedge accounting is discontinued because the hedged item no longer meets the definition of a firm commitment, or because it is probable that the forecasted transaction will not occur by the end of the specified time period, the derivative will continue to be recorded as an other asset or other liability in the consolidated balance sheets at its estimated fair value, with changes in fair value recognized in capital markets fee income and other. Any asset or liability that was recorded pursuant to recognition of the firm commitment is removed from the consolidated balance sheets and recognized in other non-interest expense. Gains and losses that were unrecognized and accumulated in accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) pursuant to the hedge of a forecasted transaction are recognized immediately in other non-interest expense.
Derivative contracts related to continuing operations that do not qualify for hedge accounting are classified as other assets or liabilities with gains and losses related to the change in fair value recognized in capital markets fee income and other or mortgage income, as applicable, in the statements of operations during the period. These positions, as well as non-derivative instruments, are used to mitigate economic and accounting volatility related to customer derivative transactions, the mortgage pipeline and the fair value of of mortgage servicing rights. Derivative contracts that were related to Morgan Keegan activities are included in discontinued operations.
Regions enters into interest rate lock commitments, which are commitments to originate mortgage loans whereby the interest rate on the loan is determined prior to funding and the customers have locked into that interest rate. Accordingly, such commitments are recorded at estimated fair value with changes in fair value recorded in mortgage income. Regions also has corresponding forward sale commitments related to these interest rate lock commitments, which are recorded at fair value with changes in fair value recorded in mortgage income. See the “Fair Value Measurements” section below for additional information related to the valuation of interest rate lock commitments.
Regions enters into various derivative agreements with customers desiring protection from possible future market fluctuations. Regions manages the market risk associated with these derivative agreements in a trading portfolio. The contracts in this portfolio do not qualify for hedge accounting and are marked-to-market through earnings and included in other assets and other liabilities.
Concurrent with the election to use fair value measurement for mortgage servicing rights, Regions began using various derivative instruments to mitigate the impact of changes in the fair value of mortgage servicing rights in the statements of operations. This effort may involve the use of various derivative instruments, including, but not limited to, forwards, futures, swaps and options. These derivatives are carried at estimated fair value, with changes in fair value reported in mortgage income.
Refer to Note 20 for further discussion and details of derivative financial instruments and hedging activities.

111

Table of Contents


INCOME TAXES
The Company accounts for income taxes using the asset and liability method, which requires the recognition of deferred tax assets and liabilities for expected future tax consequences. Under this method, deferred tax assets and liabilities are determined by applying the federal and state tax rates to the differences between financial statement carrying amounts and the corresponding tax bases of assets and liabilities. Deferred tax assets are also recorded for any tax attributes, such as tax credit and net operating loss carryforwards. The net balance of deferred tax assets and liabilities is reported in other assets in the consolidated balance sheets. Any effect of a change in federal and state tax rates on deferred tax assets and liabilities is recognized in income tax expense in the period that includes the enactment date. The Company reflects the expected amount of income tax to be paid or refunded during the year as current income tax expense or benefit, as applicable.
The Company evaluates the realization of deferred tax assets based on all positive and negative evidence available at the balance sheet date. Realization of deferred tax assets is based on the Company’s judgments about relevant factors affecting their realization, including taxable income within any applicable carryback periods, future projected taxable income, reversal of taxable temporary differences and other tax-planning strategies to maximize realization of the deferred tax assets. A valuation allowance is recorded for any deferred tax assets that are not more-likely-than-not to be realized.
Income tax benefits generated from uncertain tax positions are accounted for using the recognition and cumulative-probability measurement thresholds. Based on the technical merits, if a tax benefit is not more-likely-than-not of being sustained upon examination, the Company records a liability for the recognized income tax benefit. If a tax benefit is more-likely-than-not of being sustained based on the technical merits, the Company utilizes the cumulative probability measurement and records an income tax benefit equivalent to the largest amount of tax benefit that is greater than 50 percent likely to be realized upon ultimate settlement with a taxing authority. The Company recognizes interest expense, interest income and penalties related to unrecognized tax benefits within current income tax expense.
Refer to Note 19 for further discussion regarding income taxes.
TREASURY STOCK
The purchase of the Company’s common stock is recorded at cost. At the date of retirement or subsequent reissuance, treasury stock is reduced by the cost of such stock with differences recorded in additional paid-in capital or retained earnings, as applicable.
SHARE-BASED PAYMENTS

Regions sponsors stock plans which most commonly include restricted stock (i.e., unvested common stock), restricted stock units, performance stock units and stock options. The Company accounts for share-based payments under the fair value recognition provisions whereby compensation cost is measured based on the estimated fair value of the award at the grant date and is recognized in the consolidated financial statements on a straight-line basis over the requisite service period for service-based awards. The fair value of restricted stock, restricted stock units or performance stock units is determined based on the closing price of Regions’ common stock on the date of grant. Historical data is also used to estimate future employee attrition, which is used to calculate an expected forfeiture rate. The fair value of stock options where vesting is based on service is estimated at the date of grant using a Black-Scholes option pricing model and related assumptions. Expected volatility considers implied volatility from traded options on the Company’s stock and, primarily, historical volatility of the Company’s stock. Regions considers historical data to estimate future option exercise behavior, which is used to derive an option’s expected term. The expected term represents the period of time that options are expected to be outstanding from the grant date. Historical data is also used to estimate future employee attrition, which is used to calculate an expected forfeiture rate. Groups of employees that have similar historical exercise behavior are reviewed and considered for valuation purposes. The risk-free rate is based on the U.S. Treasury yield curve in effect at the time of grant and the weighted-average expected life of the grant. Regions issues new common shares to settle stock options.
See Note 16 for further discussion and details of share-based payments.

REVENUE RECOGNITION
The largest source of revenue for Regions is interest income. Interest income is recognized using the interest method driven by nondiscretionary formulas based on written contracts, such as loan agreements or securities contracts. Credit-related fees, including letter of credit fees, finance charges and fees related to credit cards are recognized in non-interest income when earned. Regions recognizes commission revenue and exchange and clearance fees on a trade-date basis. Other types of non-interest revenues, such as service charges on deposits, interchange income on credit cards and trust revenues, are accrued and recognized into income as services are provided and the amount of fees earned are reasonably determinable.

112

Table of Contents


PER SHARE AMOUNTS
Earnings (loss) per common share computations are based upon the weighted-average number of shares outstanding during the period. Diluted earnings (loss) per common share computations are based upon the weighted-average number of shares outstanding during the period, plus the effect of outstanding stock options and stock performance awards if dilutive. If applicable, the diluted earnings (loss) per common share computation also assumes conversion of any outstanding convertible preferred stock and warrants, unless such an assumed conversion would be antidilutive. Refer to Note 15 for additional information.
FAIR VALUE MEASUREMENTS
Fair value guidance establishes a framework for using fair value to measure assets and liabilities and defines fair value as the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability (an exit price) as opposed to the price that would be paid to acquire the asset or received to assume the liability (an entry price). A fair value measure should reflect the assumptions that market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability, including the assumptions about the risk inherent in a particular valuation technique, the effect of a restriction on the sale or use of an asset and the risk of nonperformance. Required disclosures include stratification of balance sheet amounts measured at fair value based on inputs the Company uses to derive fair value measurements. These strata include:

Level 1 valuations, where the valuation is based on quoted market prices for identical assets or liabilities traded in active markets (which include exchanges and over-the-counter markets with sufficient volume),
Level 2 valuations, where the valuation is based on quoted market prices for similar instruments traded in active markets, quoted prices for identical or similar instruments in markets that are not active and model-based valuation techniques for which all significant assumptions are observable in the market, and
Level 3 valuations, where the valuation is generated from model-based techniques that use significant assumptions not observable in the market, but observable based on Company-specific data. These unobservable assumptions reflect the Company’s own estimates for assumptions that market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability. Valuation techniques typically include option pricing models, discounted cash flow models and similar techniques, but may also include the use of market prices of assets or liabilities that are not directly comparable to the subject asset or liability.
ITEMS MEASURED AT FAIR VALUE ON A RECURRING BASIS
Trading account securities, securities available for sale, certain mortgage loans held for sale, mortgage servicing rights, derivative assets and derivative liabilities are recorded at fair value on a recurring basis. Below is a description of valuation methodologies for these assets and liabilities.

Trading account securities and securities available for sale consist of U.S. Treasuries, obligations of states and political subdivisions, mortgage-backed securities (including agency securities), other debt securities and equity securities.

U.S. Treasuries are valued based on quoted market prices of identical assets on active exchanges (Level 1 measurements as described above) and also using data from third-party pricing services for similar securities as applicable. Pricing from these third party services is generally based on a market approach using observable inputs such as benchmark yields, reported trades, broker/dealer quotes, benchmark securities, bid and offers. These valuations are Level 2 measurements.
Mortgage-backed securities are valued primarily using data from third-party pricing services for similar securities as applicable. Pricing from these third-party services is generally based on a market approach using observable inputs such as benchmark yields, reported trades, broker/dealer quotes, benchmark securities, to be announced (“TBA”) prices, issuer spreads, bids and offers, monthly payment information, and collateral performance, as applicable. These valuations are Level 2 measurements. Where such comparable data is not available, the Company develops valuations based on assumptions that are not readily observable in the market place; these valuations are Level 3 measurements.
Obligations of states and political subdivisions are generally based on data from third-party pricing services. The valuations are based on a market approach using observable inputs such as benchmark yields, Municipal Securities Rulemaking Board (“MSRB”) reported trades, material event notices and new issue data. These valuations are Level 2 measurements. Where such comparable data is not available, the Company develops valuations based on assumptions that are not readily observable in the market place; these valuations are Level 3 measurements.
Other debt securities are valued based on Level 1, 2 and 3 measurements, depending on pricing methodology selected and are valued primarily using data from third-party pricing services. Pricing from these third-party pricing services is generally based on a market approach using observable inputs such as benchmark yields, reported trades, broker/dealer quotes, issuer spreads, benchmark securities, bids and offers, and Trade Reporting and Compliance Engine (“TRACE”) reported trades.
Equity securities are valued based on quoted market prices of identical assets on active exchanges; these valuations are Level 1 measurements.

113

Table of Contents


Regions’ trading account securities and the majority of securities available for sale are valued using third-party pricing services. To validate pricing related to investment securities held in the trading account securities portfolios, pricing received from third-party pricing services is compared to available market data for reasonableness and/or pricing information from other third-party pricing services.
To validate pricing related to liquid investment securities, which represent the vast majority of the available for sale portfolio (e.g., mortgage-backed securities), Regions compares price changes received from the pricing service to overall changes in market factors in order to validate the pricing received. To validate pricing received on less liquid investment securities in the available for sale portfolio, Regions receives pricing from third-party brokers/dealers on a sample of securities that are then compared to the pricing received. The pricing service uses standard observable inputs when available, for example: benchmark yields, reported trades, broker-dealer quotes, issuer spreads, benchmark securities, and bids and offers, among others. For certain security types, additional inputs may be used, or some inputs may not be applicable. It is not customary for Regions to adjust the pricing received for the available for sale portfolio. In the event that prices are adjusted, Regions classifies the measurement as a Level 3 measurement.

Mortgage loans held for sale consist of residential first mortgage loans held for sale that are valued based on traded market prices of similar assets where available and/or discounted cash flows at market interest rates, adjusted for securitization activities that include servicing value and market conditions, a Level 2 measurement. Regions has elected to measure certain mortgage loans held for sale at fair value by applying the fair value option (see additional discussion under the “Fair Value Option” section in Note 21).
Mortgage servicing rights consist of residential mortgage servicing rights and are valued using an option-adjusted spread valuation approach, a Level 3 measurement. The underlying assumptions and estimated values are periodically corroborated by values received from an independent third party. See Note 7 for information regarding the servicing of financial assets and additional details regarding the assumptions relevant to this valuation.
Derivative assets and liabilities, which primarily consist of interest rate contracts that include futures, options and swaps, are included in other assets and other liabilities (as applicable) on the consolidated balance sheets. Interest rate swaps are predominantly traded in over-the-counter markets and, as such, values are determined using widely accepted discounted cash flow models, which are Level 2 measurements. These discounted cash flow models use projections of future cash payments/receipts that are discounted at mid-market rates. The assumed cash flows are sourced from an assumed yield curve, which is consistent with industry standards and conventions. These valuations are adjusted for the unsecured credit risk at the reporting date, which considers collateral posted and the impact of master netting agreements. For options and futures contracts traded in over-the-counter markets, values are determined using discounted cash flow analyses and option pricing models based on market rates and volatilities, which are Level 2 measurements. Interest rate lock commitments on loans intended for sale, treasury locks and credit derivatives are valued using option pricing models that incorporate significant unobservable inputs, and therefore are Level 3 measurements.
ITEMS MEASURED AT FAIR VALUE ON A NON-RECURRING BASIS
From time to time, certain assets may be recorded at fair value on a non-recurring basis. These non-recurring fair value adjustments typically are a result of the application of lower of cost or fair value accounting or a write-down occurring during the period. For example, if the fair value of an asset in these categories falls below its cost basis, it is considered to be at fair value at the end of the period of the adjustment. In periods where there is no adjustment, the asset is generally not considered to be at fair value. The following is a description of the valuation methodologies used for certain assets that are recorded at fair value.
Foreclosed property and other real estate is carried in other assets at the lower of the recorded investment in the loan or fair value less estimated costs to sell the property. The fair value for foreclosed property that is based on either observable transactions of similar instruments or formally committed sale prices is classified as a Level 2 measurement. If no formally committed sale price is available, Regions also obtains valuations from professional valuation experts and/or third party appraisers. Updated valuations are obtained on at least an annual basis. Foreclosed property exceeding established dollar thresholds is valued based on appraisals. Appraisals are performed by third-parties with appropriate professional certifications and conform to generally accepted appraisal standards as evidenced by the Uniform Standards of Professional Appraisal Practice. Regions’ policies related to appraisals conform to regulations established by the Financial Institutions Reform, Recovery and Enforcement Act of 1989 and other regulatory guidance. Professional valuations are considered Level 2 measurements because they are based largely on observable inputs. Regions has a centralized appraisal review function that is responsible for reviewing all appraisals for compliance with banking regulations and guidelines as well as appraisal standards. Based on these reviews, Regions may make adjustments to the market value conclusions determined in the appraisals of real estate (either as other real estate or loans held for sale) when the appraisal review function determines that the valuation is based on inappropriate assumptions or where the conclusion is not sufficiently supported by the market data presented in the appraisal. Adjustments to the market value conclusions are discussed with the professional valuation experts and/or third party appraisers; the magnitude of the adjustments that are not mutually agreed upon is insignificant. In either event, adjustments, if made, must be based on sufficient information available to support an alternate

114

Table of Contents


opinion of market value. An estimated standard discount factor, which is updated at least annually, is applied to the appraisal amount for certain commercial and investor real estate properties when the recorded investment in the loan is transferred into foreclosed property. Internally adjusted valuations are considered Level 3 measurements as management uses assumptions that may not be observable in the market.
Loans held for sale for which the fair value option has not been elected are recorded at the lower of cost or fair value and therefore are reported at fair value on a non-recurring basis. The fair values for commercial loans held for sale that are based on formally committed loan sale prices or valuations performed using observable inputs are classified as a Level 2 measurement. If no formally committed sales price is available, a professional valuation is obtained, consistent with the process described above for foreclosed property and other real estate.
Certain residential first mortgage loans were transferred to held for sale status late in the fourth quarter of 2013. These loans were written down to their estimated fair value upon transfer based on estimated third-party valuations utilizing recent sales data for similar transactions. Broker opinion statements were also obtained as additional evidence to support the estimated third-party valuations. The discounts taken were intended to represent the perspective of a market participant, considering among other things, required investor returns which include liquidity discounts reflected in similar bulk transactions. These unobservable inputs are considered Level 3 measurements.
FAIR VALUE OF FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS
The following methods and assumptions were used by the Company in estimating fair values of financial instruments that are not disclosed above:
Cash and cash equivalents: The carrying amounts reported in the consolidated balance sheets and cash flows approximate the estimated fair values. Because these amounts generally relate to either currency or highly liquid assets, these are considered Level 1 valuations.
Securities held to maturity: The fair values of securities held to maturity are estimated in the same manner as the corresponding securities available for sale, which are measured at fair value on a recurring basis.
Loans, (excluding leases), net of unearned income and allowance for loan losses: A discounted cash flow method under the income approach is utilized to estimate the fair value of the loan portfolio. The discounted cash flow method relies upon assumptions about the amount and timing of principal and interest payments, principal prepayments, and estimates of principal defaults, loss given default, and current market rates (excluding credit). The loan portfolio is aggregated into categories based on loan type and credit quality. For each loan category, weighted average statistics, such as coupon rate, age, and remaining term are calculated. These are Level 3 valuations.
Other interest-earning assets: The carrying amounts reported in the consolidated balance sheets approximate the estimated fair values. While these instruments are not actively traded in the market, the majority of the inputs required to value them are actively quoted and can be validated through external sources. Accordingly, these are Level 2 valuations.
Deposits: The fair value of non-interest-bearing demand accounts, interest-bearing transaction accounts, savings accounts, money market accounts and certain other time deposit accounts is the amount payable on demand at the reporting date (i.e., the carrying amount). Fair values for certificates of deposit are estimated by using discounted cash flow analyses, based on market spreads to benchmark rates. These are Level 2 valuations.
Short-term and long-term borrowings: The carrying amounts of short-term borrowings reported in the consolidated balance sheets approximate the estimated fair values, and are considered Level 2 measurements as similar instruments are traded in active markets. The fair values of certain long-term borrowings are estimated using quoted market prices of identical instruments and are considered Level 1 measurements. If identical instruments are not available, fair values are estimated using quoted market prices for similar instruments and are considered Level 2 valuations. Otherwise, valuations are based on a combination of non-binding broker quotes and quoted prices for identical instruments in non-active markets and are considered Level 3 valuations.
Loan commitments and letters of credit: The estimated fair values for these off-balance sheet instruments are based on probabilities of funding to project future loan fundings, which are discounted using the loan methodology described above. The premiums/discounts are adjusted for the time value of money over the average remaining life of the commitments and the opportunity cost associated with regulatory requirements. Because the probabilities of funding and loan valuations are not observable in the market and are considered Company specific inputs, these are Level 3 valuations.
Indemnification obligation: The estimated fair value of the indemnification obligation was determined through the use of a present value calculation that takes into account the future cash flows that a market participant would expect to receive from holding the indemnification liability as an asset. Regions performed a probability-weighted cash flow analysis and discounted the

115

Table of Contents


result at a credit-adjusted risk free rate. Because the future cash flows and probability weights are Company-specific inputs, this is a Level 3 valuation.
See Note 21 for additional information related to fair value measurements.
RECENT ACCOUNTING PRONOUNCEMENTS AND ACCOUNTING CHANGES

In December 2011, the Financial Accounting Standards Board ("FASB") issued new accounting guidance that eliminates offsetting of financial instruments disclosure differences between GAAP and International Financial Reporting Standards ("IFRS"). New disclosures are required for recognized financial instruments, such as derivatives, repurchase agreements, and reverse repurchase agreements, that are either (1) offset on the balance sheet in accordance with the FASB's offsetting guidance or (2) subject to an enforceable master netting arrangement or similar agreement, regardless of whether they are offset in accordance with the FASB's offsetting guidance. The objective of the new disclosure requirements is to enable users of the financial statements to evaluate the effect or potential effect of netting arrangements on an entity's financial position, including the effect or potential effect of rights of setoff associated with certain financial instruments and derivative instruments. This amended guidance was applied retrospectively and was effective for fiscal years, and interim periods within those years, beginning on or after January 1, 2013. Regions adopted this guidance beginning with first quarter 2013 financial reporting. See Notes 11 and 20 for the newly-required disclosures.
In July 2012, the FASB issued new accounting guidance related to the impairment of indefinite-lived intangible assets. The guidance simplifies how entities test indefinite-lived intangible assets, other than goodwill, and is similar to the new qualitative impairment test for goodwill. The guidance allows entities to elect to first perform qualitative tests to determine the likelihood that the indefinite-lived intangible asset's fair value is less than its carrying value. If it is determined that it is more likely than not that the fair value of the indefinite-lived intangible asset is less than its carrying amount, the entity would then perform the first step of the impairment test. The guidance was effective for annual and interim impairment tests performed for fiscal years beginning after September 15, 2012. Regions adopted this guidance beginning with the first quarter 2013 financial reporting. The guidance did not have a material impact upon adoption.
In February 2013, the FASB issued new accounting guidance related to disclosure of significant amounts reclassified out of accumulated other comprehensive income by component and the respective line items of net income. The guidance was effective for fiscal periods beginning after December 15, 2012. Regions adopted this guidance beginning with the first quarter 2013 financial reporting. See Note 14 for the newly-required disclosure.

In July 2013, the FASB issued new accounting guidance to include the Fed Funds Effective Swap Rate as an appropriate benchmark interest rate in the accounting for fair value and cash flow hedges in the United States. The guidance is effective prospectively for qualifying new or redesignated hedging relationships entered into on or after July 17, 2013. The amended guidance did not have a material impact upon adoption.
FUTURE APPLICATION OF ACCOUNTING STANDARDS

In January 2014, the FASB issued new accounting guidance related to the accounting for investments in qualified affordable housing projects. The guidance allows the holder of low income housing tax credit ("LIHTC") investments to apply a proportional amortization method that would recognize the cost of the investment as a part of income tax expense, provided that the investment meets certain criteria. The guidance is silent regarding statement of financial position classification, although it would not be appropriate to classify the investment as a deferred tax asset. The decision to apply the proportional amortization method is an accounting policy election. Entities may also elect to continue to account for these investments using the equity method. The guidance will be applied retrospectively and is effective for fiscal years, and interim periods within those years, beginning after December 15, 2014. Early adoption is permitted. Regions is in the process of reviewing the potential impact the adoption of this guidance will have to its consolidated financial statements.

In January 2014, the FASB issued new accounting guidance regarding the reclassification of residential real estate collateralized consumer mortgage loans upon foreclosures. The guidance requires reclassification of a consumer mortgage loan to other real estate owned upon obtaining legal title to the residential property, which could occur either through foreclosure or through a deed in lieu of foreclosure or similar legal agreement. The existence of a borrower redemption right will not prevent the lender from reclassifying a loan to real estate once the lender obtains legal title to the property. In addition, entities are required to disclose the amount of foreclosed residential real estate properties and the recorded investment in residential real estate mortgage loans in the process of foreclosure on both an interim and annual basis. The guidance may be applied prospectively or on a modified retrospective basis in fiscal years, and interim periods within those fiscal years, beginning after December 15, 2014. Early adoption is permitted. Regions is in the process of reviewing the potential impact the adoption of this guidance will have to its consolidated financial statements.

116

Table of Contents



NOTE 2. VARIABLE INTEREST ENTITIES
Regions is involved in various entities that are considered to be VIEs, as defined by authoritative accounting literature. Generally, a VIE is a corporation, partnership, trust or other legal structure that either does not have equity investors with substantive voting rights or has equity investors that do not provide sufficient financial resources for the entity to support its activities. The following discusses the VIEs in which Regions has a significant interest.
Regions owned the common stock of subsidiary business trusts, which had issued mandatorily redeemable preferred capital securities (“trust preferred securities”) in the aggregate of approximately $1 billion at the time of issuance. The aggregate principal amount of trust preferred securities outstanding at December 31, 2012 was approximately $498 million. These trusts met the definition of a VIE of which Regions was not the primary beneficiary; the trusts’ only assets were junior subordinated debentures issued by Regions, which were acquired by the trusts using the proceeds from the issuance of the trust preferred securities and common stock. These junior subordinated debentures were all redeemed during 2013. Prior to the redemption, these junior subordinated debentures were included in long-term borrowings and Regions’ equity interests in the business trusts were included in other assets. Interest expense on the junior subordinated debentures was reported in interest expense on long-term borrowings.
Regions periodically invests in various limited partnerships that sponsor affordable housing projects, which are funded through a combination of debt and equity. These partnerships meet the definition of a VIE. Due to the nature of the management activities of the general partner, Regions is not the primary beneficiary of these partnerships and accounts for these investments in other assets on the consolidated balance sheets using the equity method. Regions reports its equity share of the partnership gains and losses as an adjustment to non-interest income. Regions reports its commitments to make future investments in other liabilities on the consolidated balance sheets. The Company also receives tax credits, which are reported as a reduction of income tax expense (or increase to income tax benefit). Additionally, Regions has short-term construction loans or letters of credit commitments with certain limited partnerships. The funded portion of the short-term loans and letters of credit is classified as commercial and industrial loans or investor real estate construction loans, as applicable, on the consolidated balance sheets. Regions also has long-term mortgage loans with certain limited partnerships. These long-term loans are classified as investor real estate mortgage loans in Note 5.
A summary of Regions’ equity method investments and related loans and letters of credit, representing Regions’ maximum exposure to loss as of December 31 is as follows:
 
 
2013
 
2012
 
(In millions)
Equity method investments included in other assets
$
863

 
$
774

Unfunded commitments included in other liabilities
267

 
197

Short-term construction loans and letters of credit commitments
227

 
165

Funded portion of short-term loans and letters of credit
110

 
82



117

Table of Contents


NOTE 3. DISCONTINUED OPERATIONS

On January 11, 2012, Regions entered into a stock purchase agreement to sell Morgan Keegan and related affiliates to Raymond James Financial, Inc. (“Raymond James”). The transaction closed on April 2, 2012. Regions Investment Management, Inc. (formerly known as Morgan Asset Management, Inc.) and Regions Trust were not included in the sale. In connection with the closing of the sale, Regions agreed to indemnify Raymond James for all litigation matters related to pre-closing activities. See Note 23 for related disclosure.
The following table represents the condensed results of operations for discontinued operations:
 
Year Ended December 31
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
(In millions, except per share data)
Interest income
$

 
$
8

 
$
37

Interest expense

 
1

 
6

Net interest income

 
7

 
31

Non-interest income:
 
 
 
 
 
Brokerage, investment banking and capital markets

 
233

 
938

Gain on sale

 
19

 

Other

 
12

 
57

Total non-interest income

 
264

 
995

Non-interest expense:
 
 
 
 
 
Salaries and employee benefits

 
171

 
644

Net occupancy expense

 
9

 
36

Furniture and equipment expense

 
8

 
30

Goodwill impairment

 

 
492

Professional and legal expenses
23

 
152

 
93

Other
1

 
30

 
139

Total non-interest expense
24

 
370

 
1,434

Income (loss) from discontinued operations before income taxes
(24
)
 
(99
)
 
(408
)
Income tax expense (benefit)
(11
)
 
(40
)
 
(4
)
Income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of tax
$
(13
)
 
$
(59
)
 
$
(404
)
Earnings (loss) per common share from discontinued operations:
 
 
 
 
 
Basic
$
(0.01
)
 
$
(0.04
)
 
$
(0.32
)
Diluted
$
(0.01
)
 
$
(0.04
)
 
$
(0.32
)


118

Table of Contents


NOTE 4. SECURITIES
The amortized cost, gross unrealized gains and losses, and estimated fair value of securities held to maturity and securities available for sale are as follows:

 
December 31, 2013
 
 
 
Recognized in OCI (1)
 
 
 
Not recognized in OCI
 
 
 
Amortized
Cost
 
Gross Unrealized Gains
 
Gross Unrealized Losses
 
Carrying Value
 
Gross
Unrealized
Gains
 
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
 
Estimated
Fair
Value
 
(In millions)
Securities held to maturity:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
U.S. Treasury securities
$
1

 
$

 
$

 
$
1

 
$

 
$

 
$
1

Federal agency securities
351

 

 
(15
)
 
336

 

 
(3
)
 
333

Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential agency
1,878

 

 
(81
)
 
1,797

 

 
(37
)
 
1,760

Commercial agency
227

 

 
(8
)
 
219

 

 
(6
)
 
213

 
$
2,457

 
$

 
$
(104
)
 
$
2,353

 
$

 
$
(46
)
 
$
2,307

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities available for sale:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
U.S. Treasury securities
$
56

 
$

 
$

 
$
56

 
 
 
 
 
$
56

Federal agency securities
88

 
1

 

 
89

 
 
 
 
 
89

Obligations of states and political subdivisions
5

 

 

 
5

 
 
 
 
 
5

Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential agency
15,664

 
183

 
(170
)
 
15,677

 
 
 
 
 
15,677

Residential non-agency
8

 
1

 

 
9

 
 
 
 
 
9

Commercial agency
947

 
4

 
(16
)
 
935

 
 
 
 
 
935

Commercial non-agency
1,232

 
12

 
(33
)
 
1,211

 
 
 
 
 
1,211

Corporate and other debt securities
2,855

 
44

 
(72
)
 
2,827

 
 
 
 
 
2,827

Equity securities
664

 
12

 

 
676

 
 
 
 
 
676

 
$
21,519

 
$
257

 
$
(291
)
 
$
21,485

 
 
 
 
 
$
21,485

_________
(1)
The gross unrealized losses recognized in other comprehensive income (OCI) on held to maturity securities resulted from a transfer of available for sale securities to held to maturity in the second quarter of 2013.
    

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 


119

Table of Contents


 
 
December 31, 2012
 
Amortized
Cost
 
Gross Unrealized Gains
 
Gross Unrealized Losses
 
Estimated
Fair
Value
 
(In millions)
Securities held to maturity:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
U.S. Treasury securities
$
2

 
$

 
$

 
$
2

Federal agency securities
2

 

 

 
2

Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential agency
6

 
1

 

 
7

 
$
10

 
$
1

 
$

 
$
11

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities available for sale:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
U.S. Treasury securities
$
50

 
$
2

 
$

 
$
52

Federal agency securities
550

 
4

 
(1
)
 
553

Obligations of states and political subdivisions
9

 

 

 
9

Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential agency
20,721

 
574

 
(18
)
 
21,277

Residential non-agency
12

 
1

 

 
13

Commercial agency
705

 
20

 

 
725

Commercial non-agency
1,055

 
43

 

 
1,098

Corporate and other debt securities
2,762

 
81

 
(8
)
 
2,835

Equity securities
679

 
4

 
(1
)
 
682

 
$
26,543

 
$
729

 
$
(28
)
 
$
27,244


During the second quarter of 2013, Regions transferred securities with a fair value of $2.4 billion from available for sale to held to maturity. Management determined it has both the positive intent and ability to hold these securities to maturity. The securities were reclassified at fair value at the time of transfer and represented a non-cash transaction. Accumulated other comprehensive income included net pre-tax unrealized losses of $111 million on the securities at the date of transfer. These unrealized losses and the offsetting OCI components are being amortized into net interest income over the remaining life of the related securities as a yield adjustment, resulting in no impact on future net income.
Equity securities in the tables above included the following amortized cost related to Federal Reserve Bank stock and Federal Home Loan Bank (“FHLB”) stock. Shares in the Federal Reserve Bank and FHLB are accounted for at amortized cost, which approximates fair value.
 
 
December 31, 2013
 
December 31, 2012
 
 
(In millions)
Federal Reserve Bank
 
$
472

 
$
484

Federal Home Loan Bank
 
67

 
73

Securities with carrying values of $12.5 billion and $11.8 billion at December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively, were pledged to secure public funds, trust deposits and certain borrowing arrangements.

120

Table of Contents


The amortized cost and estimated fair value of securities available for sale and securities held to maturity at December 31, 2013, by contractual maturity, are shown below. Expected maturities will differ from contractual maturities because borrowers may have the right to call or prepay obligations with or without call or prepayment penalties.
 
 
 
Amortized
Cost
 
Estimated
Fair Value
 
 
(In millions)
Securities held to maturity:
 
 
 
 
Due in one year or less
 
$
1

 
$
1

Due after one year through five years
 
1

 
1

Due after five years through ten years
 
350

 
332

Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
Residential agency
 
1,878

 
1,760

Commercial agency
 
227

 
213

 
 
$
2,457

 
$
2,307

Securities available for sale:
 
 
 
 
Due in one year or less
 
$
50

 
$
50

Due after one year through five years
 
1,080

 
1,094

Due after five years through ten years
 
1,511

 
1,470

Due after ten years
 
363

 
363

Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
Residential agency
 
15,664

 
15,677

Residential non-agency
 
8

 
9

Commercial agency
 
947

 
935

Commercial non-agency
 
1,232

 
1,211

Equity securities
 
664

 
676

 
 
$
21,519

 
$
21,485



121

Table of Contents


The following tables present gross unrealized losses and the related estimated fair value of securities available for sale and held to maturity at December 31, 2013 and for securities available for sale at December 31, 2012. There were no gross unrealized losses on debt securities held to maturity at December 31, 2012. For securities transferred to held to maturity from available for sale, the analysis in the tables below is comparing the securities' original amortized cost to its current estimated fair value. These securities are segregated between investments that have been in a continuous unrealized loss position for less than twelve months and twelve months or more.
 
 
 
December 31, 2013
 
 
Less Than Twelve
Months
 
Twelve Months or More
 
Total
 
 
Estimated
Fair
Value
 
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
 
Estimated
Fair
Value
 
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
 
Estimated
Fair
Value
 
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
 
 
(In millions)
Securities held to maturity:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Federal agency securities
 
$
190

 
$
(9
)
 
$
142

 
$
(8
)
 
$
332

 
$
(17
)
Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential agency
 
1,236

 
(77
)
 
521

 
(41
)
 
1,757

 
(118
)
Commercial agency
 
212

 
(15
)
 

 

 
212

 
(15
)
 
 
$
1,638

 
$
(101
)
 
$
663

 
$
(49
)
 
$
2,301

 
$
(150
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities available for sale:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
U.S. Treasury securities
 
$
15

 
$

 
$
1

 
$

 
$
16

 
$

Federal agency securities
 
3

 

 
9

 

 
12

 

Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential agency
 
6,153

 
(161
)
 
270

 
(9
)
 
6,423

 
(170
)
Commercial agency
 
610

 
(17
)
 

 

 
610

 
(17
)
Commercial non-agency
 
711

 
(30
)
 
62

 
(3
)
 
773

 
(33
)
All other securities
 
1,422

 
(58
)
 
209

 
(13
)
 
1,631

 
(71
)
 
 
$
8,914

 
$
(266
)
 
$
551

 
$
(25
)
 
$
9,465

 
$
(291
)
 
 
 
December 31, 2012
 
 
Less Than Twelve
Months
 
Twelve Months or More
 
Total
 
 
Estimated
Fair
Value
 
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
 
Estimated
Fair
Value
 
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
 
Estimated
Fair
Value
 
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
 
 
(In millions)
Securities available for sale:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Federal agency securities
 
$
350

 
$
(1
)
 
$

 
$

 
$
350

 
$
(1
)
Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential agency
 
1,777

 
(16
)
 
157

 
(2
)
 
1,934

 
(18
)
All other securities
 
884

 
(9
)
 

 

 
884

 
(9
)
 
 
$
3,011

 
$
(26
)
 
$
157

 
$
(2
)
 
$
3,168

 
$
(28
)

The number of individual securities in an unrealized loss position in the tables above increased from 378 at December 31, 2012 to 1,052 at December 31, 2013. The increase in the number of securities and the total amount of unrealized losses from year-end 2012 was primarily due to changes in interest rates. In some instances, spread widening also contributed to some degradation; however, there was no indication of an adverse change in credit on any of the underlying securities in the tables above. Management believes no individual unrealized loss represented an other-than-temporary impairment as of those dates. The Company does not intend to sell, and it is not more likely than not that the Company will be required to sell, the securities before the recovery of their amortized cost basis, which may be at maturity.
Credit-related impairment charges were immaterial for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011.

122

Table of Contents


Gross realized gains and gross realized losses on sales of securities available for sale for years ended December 31 are shown in the table below. The cost of securities sold is based on the specific identification method.
 
 
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
(In millions)
Gross realized gains
 
$
55

 
$
49

 
$
112

Gross realized losses
 
(29
)
 
(1
)
 

Securities gains, net
 
$
26

 
$
48

 
$
112

    
NOTE 5. LOANS
The following table presents the distribution of Regions' loan portfolio by segment and class, net of unearned income as of December 31:

 
2013
 
2012
 
(In millions)
Commercial and industrial
$
29,413

 
$
26,674

Commercial real estate mortgage—owner-occupied
9,495

 
10,095

Commercial real estate construction—owner-occupied
310

 
302

Total commercial
39,218

 
37,071

Commercial investor real estate mortgage
5,318

 
6,808

Commercial investor real estate construction
1,432

 
914

Total investor real estate
6,750

 
7,722

Residential first mortgage
12,163

 
12,963

Home equity
11,294

 
11,800

Indirect
3,075

 
2,336

Consumer credit card
948

 
906

Other consumer
1,161

 
1,197

Total consumer
28,641

 
29,202

Total loans, net of unearned income (1)
$
74,609

 
$
73,995

_________
(1)
Loans are presented net of unearned income, unamortized discounts and premiums and net deferred loan costs of $576 million and $756 million at December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively.
During 2013 and 2012, Regions purchased approximately $978 million and $882 million, respectively, in indirect loans from a third party.
During 2012, Regions sold approximately $184 million of securities-based commercial and industrial loans to Raymond James pursuant to the Morgan Keegan sale (see Note 3). These loans were made by Regions, but were originally referred through Morgan Keegan and were secured by customer assets held in custody at Morgan Keegan.
The loan portfolio is diversified geographically, primarily within Alabama, Arkansas, Florida, Georgia, Illinois, Indiana, Iowa, Kentucky, Louisiana, Mississippi, Missouri, North Carolina, South Carolina, Tennessee, Texas and Virginia.
The following tables include details regarding Regions’ investment in leveraged leases included within the commercial and industrial loan portfolio class as of and for the years ended December 31:
 
2013
 
2012
 
(In millions)
Rentals receivable
$
442

 
$
673

Estimated residuals on leveraged leases
304

 
312

Unearned income on leveraged leases
387

 
551


123

Table of Contents


 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
(In millions)
Pre-tax income from leveraged leases
$
45

 
$
43

 
$
46

Income tax expense on income from leveraged leases
37

 
35

 
45

The income above does not include leveraged lease termination gains of $39 million, $14 million and $8 million with related income tax expense of $33 million, $11 million and zero for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011, respectively.
At December 31, 2013, $14 billion in loans held by Regions were pledged to secure borrowings from the FHLB. At December 31, 2013, an additional $29 billion of loans held by Regions were pledged to the Federal Reserve Bank.
NOTE 6. ALLOWANCE FOR CREDIT LOSSES
Regions determines the appropriate level of the allowance on at least a quarterly basis. The methodology is described in Note 1 "Summary of Significant Accounting Policies."
ROLLFORWARD OF ALLOWANCE FOR CREDIT LOSSES
The following tables present analyses of the allowance for credit losses by portfolio segment for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011. The total allowance for loan losses and the related loan portfolio ending balances are then disaggregated to detail the amounts derived through individual evaluation and collective evaluation for impairment. Prior to the second quarter of 2013, only impaired loans with the amount of impairment measured at a note-level (i.e. non-accrual commercial and investor real-estate loans greater than or equal to $2.5 million) were reported as individually evaluated in the tables below. In the second quarter of 2013, Regions revised its presentation to also reflect all TDRs as individually evaluated for impairment through the use of a discounted cash flow analysis at a pool level as described in Note 1. The allowance for loan losses and the loan portfolio ending balances related to collectively evaluated loans included the remainder of the portfolio. Prior period amounts were reclassified to conform to this presentation.
Beginning in the third quarter of 2013, Regions revised its estimation process for non-accrual commercial and investor real-estate loans less than $2.5 million to utilize the same discounted cash flow analysis used for accruing and non-accruing TDRs less than $2.5 million as described in Note 1. This change in the estimation process did not have a material impact to the overall level of the allowance for loan losses or the provision for loan losses. As a result, the December 31, 2013 allowance for loan losses and the loan portfolio ending balances for loans individually evaluated for impairment reflect this revision in the tables below.


124

Table of Contents


 
 
2013
 
 
Commercial
 
Investor Real
Estate
 
Consumer
 
Total
 
 
(In millions)
Allowance for loan losses, January 1, 2013
 
$
847

 
$
469

 
$
603

 
$
1,919

Provision (credit) for loan losses
 
103

 
(203
)
 
238

 
138

Loan losses:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Charge-offs
 
(312
)
 
(70
)
 
(516
)
 
(898
)
Recoveries
 
73

 
40

 
69

 
182

Net loan losses
 
(239
)
 
(30
)
 
(447
)
 
(716
)
Allowance for loan losses, December 31, 2013
 
711

 
236

 
394

 
1,341

Reserve for unfunded credit commitments, January 1, 2013
 
69

 
10

 
4

 
83

Provision (credit) for unfunded credit losses
 
(6
)
 
2

 
(1
)
 
(5
)
Reserve for unfunded credit commitments, December 31, 2013
 
63

 
12

 
3

 
78

Allowance for credit losses, December 31, 2013
 
$
774

 
$
248

 
$
397

 
$
1,419

Portion of ending allowance for loan losses:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Individually evaluated for impairment
 
$
230

 
$
118

 
$
98

 
$
446

Collectively evaluated for impairment
 
481

 
118

 
296

 
895

Total allowance for loan losses
 
$
711

 
$
236

 
$
394

 
$
1,341

Portion of loan portfolio ending balance:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Individually evaluated for impairment
 
$
1,022

 
$
761

 
$
883

 
$
2,666

Collectively evaluated for impairment
 
38,196

 
5,989

 
27,758

 
71,943

Total loans evaluated for impairment
 
$
39,218

 
$
6,750

 
$
28,641

 
$
74,609




125

Table of Contents


 
 
2012
 
 
Commercial
 
Investor Real
Estate
 
Consumer
 
Total
 
 
(In millions)
Allowance for loan losses, January 1, 2012
 
$
1,030

 
$
991

 
$
724

 
$
2,745

Provision (credit) for loan losses
 
144

 
(295
)
 
364

 
213

Loan losses:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Charge-offs
 
(404
)
 
(272
)
 
(547
)
 
(1,223
)
Recoveries
 
77

 
45

 
62

 
184

Net loan losses
 
(327
)
 
(227
)
 
(485
)
 
(1,039
)
Allowance for loan losses, December 31, 2012
 
847

 
469

 
603

 
1,919

Reserve for unfunded credit commitments,
January 1, 2012
 
30

 
26

 
22

 
78

Provision (credit) for unfunded credit losses
 
39

 
(16
)
 
(18
)
 
5

Reserve for unfunded credit commitments, December 31, 2012
 
69

 
10

 
4

 
83

Allowance for credit losses, December 31, 2012
 
$
916

 
$
479

 
$
607

 
$
2,002

Portion of ending allowance for loan losses:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Individually evaluated for impairment*
 
$
214

 
$
211

 
$
196

 
$
621

Collectively evaluated for impairment*
 
633

 
258

 
407

 
1,298

Total allowance for loan losses
 
$
847

 
$
469

 
$
603

 
$
1,919

Portion of loan portfolio ending balance:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Individually evaluated for impairment*
 
$
1,047

 
$
1,257

 
$
1,653

 
$
3,957

Collectively evaluated for impairment*
 
36,024

 
6,465

 
27,549

 
70,038

Total loans evaluated for impairment
 
$
37,071

 
$
7,722

 
$
29,202

 
$
73,995



126

Table of Contents


 
 
2011
 
 
Commercial
 
Investor Real
Estate
 
Consumer
 
Total
 
 
(In millions)
Allowance for loan losses, January 1, 2011
 
$
1,055

 
$
1,370

 
$
760

 
$
3,185

Provision (credit) for loan losses
 
475

 
468

 
587

 
1,530

Loan losses:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Charge-offs
 
(550
)
 
(880
)
 
(677
)
 
(2,107
)
Recoveries
 
50

 
33

 
54

 
137

Net loan losses
 
(500
)
 
(847
)
 
(623
)
 
(1,970
)
Allowance for loan losses, December 31, 2011
 
1,030

 
991

 
724

 
2,745

Reserve for unfunded credit commitments,
January 1, 2011
 
32

 
16

 
23

 
71

Provision (credit) for unfunded credit losses
 
(2
)
 
10

 
(1
)
 
7

Reserve for unfunded credit commitments, December 31, 2011
 
30

 
26

 
22

 
78

Allowance for credit losses, December 31, 2011
 
$
1,060

 
$
1,017

 
$
746

 
$
2,823

Portion of ending allowance for loan losses:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Individually evaluated for impairment*
 
$
249

 
$
462

 
$
226

 
$
937

Collectively evaluated for impairment*
 
781

 
529

 
498

 
1,808

Total allowance for loan losses
 
$
1,030

 
$
991

 
$
724

 
$
2,745

Portion of loan portfolio ending balance:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Individually evaluated for impairment*
 
$
1,090

 
$
1,707

 
$
1,606

 
$
4,403

Collectively evaluated for impairment*
 
34,935

 
9,020

 
29,236

 
73,191

Total loans evaluated for impairment
 
$
36,025

 
$
10,727

 
$
30,842

 
$
77,594

_________
*As discussed above, prior period amounts have been reclassified to conform to the current period classification.
PORTFOLIO SEGMENT RISK FACTORS
The following describe the risk characteristics relevant to each of the portfolio segments.
Commercial—The commercial loan portfolio segment includes commercial and industrial loans to commercial customers for use in normal business operations to finance working capital needs, equipment purchases or other expansion projects. Commercial also includes owner-occupied commercial real estate loans to operating businesses, which are loans for long-term financing of land and buildings, and are repaid by cash flow generated by business operations. Owner-occupied construction loans are made to commercial businesses for the development of land or construction of a building where the repayment is derived from revenues generated from the business of the borrower. Collection risk in this portfolio is driven by the creditworthiness of underlying borrowers, particularly cash flow from customers’ business operations.
Investor Real Estate—Loans for real estate development are repaid through cash flow related to the operation, sale or refinance of the property. This portfolio segment includes extensions of credit to real estate developers or investors where repayment is dependent on the sale of real estate or income generated from the real estate collateral. A portion of Regions’ investor real estate portfolio segment is comprised of loans secured by residential product types (land, single-family and condominium loans) within Regions’ markets. Additionally, these loans are made to finance income-producing properties such as apartment buildings, office and industrial buildings, and retail shopping centers. Loans in this portfolio segment are particularly sensitive to valuation of real estate.
Consumer—The consumer loan portfolio segment includes residential first mortgage, home equity, indirect, consumer credit card, and other consumer loans. Residential first mortgage loans represent loans to consumers to finance a residence. These loans are typically financed over a 15 to 30 year term and, in most cases, are extended to borrowers to finance their primary residence. Home equity lending includes both home equity loans and lines of credit. This type of lending, which is secured by a first or second mortgage on the borrower’s residence, allows customers to borrow against the equity in their home. Real estate market values at the time the loan or line is secured directly affect the amount of credit extended. Additionally, changes in these values impact the depth of potential losses. Indirect lending, which is lending initiated through third-party business partners, is largely comprised of loans made through automotive dealerships. Consumer credit card includes Regions branded consumer credit card accounts.

127

Table of Contents


Other consumer loans include direct consumer installment loans and overdrafts. Loans in this portfolio segment are sensitive to unemployment and other key consumer economic measures.
CREDIT QUALITY INDICATORS
The following tables present credit quality indicators for the loan portfolio segments and classes, excluding loans held for sale, as of December 31, 2013 and 2012. Commercial and investor real estate loan portfolio segments are detailed by categories related to underlying credit quality and probability of default. Regions assigns these categories at loan origination and reviews the relationship utilizing a risk-based approach on, at minimum, an annual basis or at any time management becomes aware of information affecting the borrowers' ability to fulfill their obligations. Both quantitative and qualitative factors are considered in this review process. These categories are utilized to develop the associated allowance for credit losses.

Pass—includes obligations where the probability of default is considered low;

Special Mention—includes obligations that have potential weakness which may, if not reversed or corrected, weaken the credit or inadequately protect the Company’s position at some future date. Obligations in this category may also be subject to economic or market conditions which may, in the future, have an adverse effect on debt service ability;

Substandard Accrual—includes obligations that exhibit a well-defined weakness which presently jeopardizes debt repayment, even though they are currently performing. These obligations are characterized by the distinct possibility that the Company may incur a loss in the future if these weaknesses are not corrected; and

Non-accrual—includes obligations where management has determined that full payment of principal and interest is in doubt.
Substandard accrual and non-accrual loans are often collectively referred to as “classified”. Special mention, substandard accrual and non-accrual loans are often collectively referred to as “criticized and classified”. Classes in the consumer portfolio segment are disaggregated by accrual status.

 
 
2013
 
 
Pass
 
Special Mention
 
Substandard
Accrual
 
Non-accrual
 
Total
 
 
(In millions)
Commercial and industrial
 
$
28,282

 
$
395

 
$
479

 
$
257

 
$
29,413

Commercial real estate mortgage—owner-occupied
 
8,593

 
191

 
408

 
303

 
9,495

Commercial real estate construction—owner-occupied
 
264

 
25

 
4

 
17

 
310

Total commercial
 
$
37,139

 
$
611

 
$
891

 
$
577

 
$
39,218

Commercial investor real estate mortgage
 
$
4,479

 
$
269

 
$
332

 
$
238

 
$
5,318

Commercial investor real estate construction
 
1,335

 
47

 
40

 
10

 
1,432

Total investor real estate
 
$
5,814

 
$
316

 
$
372

 
$
248

 
$
6,750

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Accrual
 
Non-accrual
 
Total
 
 
 
 
 
 
(In millions)
Residential first mortgage
 
 
 
 
 
$
12,017

 
$
146

 
$
12,163

Home equity
 
 
 
 
 
11,183

 
111

 
11,294

Indirect
 
 
 
 
 
3,075

 

 
3,075

Consumer credit card
 
 
 
 
 
948

 

 
948

Other consumer
 
 
 
 
 
1,161

 

 
1,161

Total consumer
 
 
 
 
 
$
28,384

 
$
257

 
$
28,641

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$
74,609

 

128

Table of Contents


 
 
2012
 
 
Pass
 
Special
Mention
 
Substandard
Accrual
 
Non-accrual
 
Total
 
 
(In millions)
Commercial and industrial
 
$
25,225

 
$
560

 
$
480

 
$
409

 
$
26,674

Commercial real estate mortgage—owner-occupied
 
8,976

 
240

 
440

 
439

 
10,095

Commercial real estate construction—owner-occupied
 
278

 
3

 
7

 
14

 
302

Total commercial
 
$
34,479

 
$
803

 
$
927

 
$
862

 
$
37,071

Commercial investor real estate mortgage
 
$
5,089

 
$
435

 
$
827

 
$
457

 
$
6,808

Commercial investor real estate construction
 
733

 
98

 
63

 
20

 
914

Total investor real estate
 
$
5,822

 
$
533

 
$
890

 
$
477

 
$
7,722

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Accrual
 
Non-accrual
 
Total
 
 
 
 
 
 
(In millions)
Residential first mortgage
 
 
 
 
 
$
12,749

 
$
214

 
$
12,963

Home equity
 
 
 
 
 
11,672

 
128

 
11,800

Indirect
 
 
 
 
 
2,336

 

 
2,336

Consumer credit card
 
 
 
 
 
906

 

 
906

Other consumer
 
 
 
 
 
1,197

 

 
1,197

Total consumer
 
 
 
 
 
$
28,860

 
$
342

 
$
29,202

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$
73,995


AGING ANALYSIS
The following tables include an aging analysis of days past due (DPD) for each portfolio segment and class as of December 31, 2013 and 2012:
 
 
 
2013
 
 
Accrual Loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
30-59 DPD
 
60-89 DPD
 
90+ DPD
 
Total
30+ DPD
 
Total
Accrual
 
Non-accrual
 
Total
 
 
(In millions)
Commercial and industrial
 
$
29

 
$
14

 
$
6

 
$
49

 
$
29,156

 
$
257

 
$
29,413

Commercial real estate
mortgage—owner-occupied
 
30

 
26

 
6

 
62

 
9,192

 
303

 
9,495

Commercial real estate construction—owner-occupied
 

 

 

 

 
293

 
17

 
310

Total commercial
 
59

 
40

 
12

 
111

 
38,641

 
577

 
39,218

Commercial investor real estate mortgage
 
29

 
6

 
6

 
41

 
5,080

 
238

 
5,318

Commercial investor real estate construction
 
4

 
1

 

 
5

 
1,422

 
10

 
1,432

Total investor real estate
 
33

 
7

 
6

 
46

 
6,502

 
248

 
6,750

Residential first mortgage
 
130

 
74

 
248

 
452

 
12,017

 
146

 
12,163

Home equity
 
95

 
51

 
75

 
221

 
11,183

 
111

 
11,294

Indirect
 
39

 
11

 
5

 
55

 
3,075

 

 
3,075

Consumer credit card
 
8

 
5

 
12

 
25

 
948

 

 
948

Other consumer
 
14

 
5

 
4

 
23

 
1,161

 

 
1,161

Total consumer
 
286

 
146

 
344

 
776

 
28,384

 
257

 
28,641

 
 
$
378

 
$
193

 
$
362

 
$
933

 
$
73,527

 
$
1,082

 
$
74,609


129

Table of Contents


 
 
 
2012
 
 
Accrual Loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
30-59 DPD
 
60-89 DPD
 
90+ DPD
 
Total
30+ DPD
 
Total
Accrual
 
Non-accrual
 
Total
 
 
(In millions)
Commercial and industrial
 
$
27

 
$
23

 
$
19

 
$
69

 
$
26,265

 
$
409

 
$
26,674

Commercial real estate
mortgage—owner-occupied
 
49

 
28

 
6

 
83

 
9,656

 
439

 
10,095

Commercial real estate construction—owner-occupied
 

 

 

 

 
288

 
14

 
302

Total commercial
 
76

 
51

 
25

 
152

 
36,209

 
862

 
37,071

Commercial investor real estate mortgage
 
38

 
42

 
11

 
91

 
6,351

 
457

 
6,808

Commercial investor real estate construction
 
1

 
1

 

 
2

 
894

 
20

 
914

Total investor real estate
 
39

 
43

 
11

 
93

 
7,245

 
477

 
7,722

Residential first mortgage
 
149

 
86

 
307

 
542

 
12,749

 
214

 
12,963

Home equity
 
100

 
53

 
87

 
240

 
11,672

 
128

 
11,800

Indirect
 
31

 
9

 
3

 
43

 
2,336

 

 
2,336

Consumer credit card
 
7

 
7

 
14

 
28

 
906

 

 
906

Other consumer
 
19

 
5

 
3

 
27

 
1,197

 

 
1,197

Total consumer
 
306

 
160

 
414

 
880

 
28,860

 
342

 
29,202

 
 
$
421

 
$
254

 
$
450

 
$
1,125

 
$
72,314

 
$
1,681

 
$
73,995



130

Table of Contents


IMPAIRED LOANS
The following tables present details related to the Company’s impaired loans as of December 31, 2013 and 2012. Loans deemed to be impaired include all non-accrual commercial and investor real estate loans (including those less than $2.5 million), excluding leases, and all troubled debt restructurings ("TDRs"). Loans which have been fully charged-off do not appear in the tables below.
 
 
Non-accrual Impaired Loans 2013
 
 
 
 
 
Book Value(3)
 
 
 
 
 
Unpaid
 Principal
    Balance(1)
 
Charge-offs
and Payments
Applied(2)
 
Total
Impaired
Loans on
Non-accrual
Status
 
Impaired
Loans on
Non-accrual
Status with
No Related
Allowance
 
Impaired
Loans on
Non-accrual
Status with
Related
Allowance
 
Related
Allowance
for Loan
Losses
 
Coverage %(4)
 
(Dollars in millions)
Commercial and industrial
$
280

 
$
48

 
$
232

 
$
45

 
$
187

 
$
72

 
42.9
%
Commercial real estate mortgage—owner-occupied
343

 
40

 
303

 
54

 
249

 
92

 
38.5

Commercial real estate construction—owner-occupied
17

 

 
17

 

 
17

 
8

 
47.1

Total commercial
640

 
88

 
552

 
99

 
453

 
172

 
40.6

Commercial investor real estate mortgage
306

 
68

 
238

 
17

 
221

 
68

 
44.4

Commercial investor real estate construction
15

 
5

 
10

 

 
10

 
3

 
53.3

Total investor real estate
321

 
73

 
248

 
17

 
231

 
71

 
44.9

Residential first mortgage
112

 
37

 
75

 

 
75

 
12

 
43.8

Home equity
17

 

 
17

 

 
17

 
1

 
5.9

Total consumer
129

 
37

 
92

 

 
92

 
13

 
38.8

 
$
1,090

 
$
198

 
$
892

 
$
116

 
$
776

 
$
256

 
41.7
%
 

131

Table of Contents


 
 
Accruing Impaired Loans 2013
 
 
Unpaid
Principal
Balance(1)
 
Charge-offs
and Payments
Applied(2)
 
Book Value(3)
 
Related
Allowance for
Loan Losses
 
Coverage %(4)
 
 
(Dollars in millions)
Commercial and industrial
 
$
245

 
$
2

 
$
243

 
$
34

 
14.7
%
Commercial real estate mortgage—owner-occupied
 
209

 
7

 
202

 
23

 
14.4

Commercial real estate construction—owner-occupied
 
25

 

 
25

 
1

 
4.0

Total commercial
 
479

 
9

 
470

 
58

 
14.0

Commercial investor real estate mortgage
 
435

 
11

 
424

 
39

 
11.5

Commercial investor real estate construction
 
89

 

 
89

 
8

 
9.0

Total investor real estate
 
524

 
11

 
513

 
47

 
11.1

Residential first mortgage
 
397

 
8

 
389

 
60

 
17.1

Home equity
 
373

 

 
373

 
24

 
6.4

Indirect
 
1

 

 
1

 

 

Consumer credit card
 
2

 

 
2

 

 

Other consumer
 
26

 

 
26

 
1

 
3.8

Total consumer
 
799

 
8

 
791

 
85

 
11.6

 
 
$
1,802

 
$
28

 
$
1,774

 
$
190

 
12.1
%

 
Total Impaired Loans 2013
 
 
 
 
 
Book Value(3)
 
 
 
 
 
Unpaid
Principal
Balance(1)
 
Charge-offs
and Payments
Applied(2)
 
Total
Impaired
Loans
 
Impaired
Loans with No
Related
Allowance
 
Impaired
Loans with
Related
Allowance
 
Related
Allowance
for Loan
Losses
 
Coverage %(4)
 
(Dollars in millions)
Commercial and industrial
$
525

 
$
50

 
$
475

 
$
45

 
$
430

 
$
106

 
29.7
%
Commercial real estate mortgage—owner-
occupied
552

 
47

 
505

 
54

 
451

 
115

 
29.3

Commercial real estate construction—owner-occupied
42

 

 
42

 

 
42

 
9

 
21.4

Total commercial
1,119

 
97

 
1,022

 
99

 
923

 
230

 
29.2

Commercial investor real estate mortgage
741

 
79

 
662

 
17

 
645

 
107

 
25.1

Commercial investor real estate construction
104

 
5

 
99

 

 
99

 
11

 
15.4

Total investor real estate
845

 
84

 
761

 
17

 
744

 
118

 
23.9

Residential first mortgage
509

 
45

 
464

 

 
464

 
72

 
23.0

Home equity
390

 

 
390

 

 
390

 
25

 
6.4

Indirect
1

 

 
1

 

 
1

 

 

Consumer credit card
2

 

 
2

 

 
2

 

 

Other consumer
26

 

 
26

 

 
26

 
1

 
3.8

Total consumer
928

 
45

 
883

 

 
883

 
98

 
15.4

 
$
2,892

 
$
226

 
$
2,666

 
$
116

 
$
2,550

 
$
446

 
23.2
%


132

Table of Contents


_________
(1)
Unpaid principal balance represents the contractual obligation due from the customer and includes the net book value plus charge-offs and payments applied.
(2)
Charge-offs and payments applied represents cumulative partial charge-offs taken, as well as interest payments received that have been applied against the outstanding principal balance.
(3)
Book value represents the unpaid principal balance less charge-offs and payments applied; it is shown before any allowance for loan losses.
(4)
Coverage % represents charge-offs and payments applied plus the related allowance as a percent of the unpaid principal balance.

 
Non-accrual Impaired Loans 2012
 
 
 
 
 
Book Value(3)
 
 
 
 
 
Unpaid
Principal
Balance(1)
 
Charge-offs
and Payments
Applied(2)
 
Total
Impaired
Loans on
Non-accrual
Status
 
Impaired
Loans on
Non-accrual
Status with
No Related
Allowance
 
Impaired
Loans on
Non-accrual
Status with
Related
Allowance
 
Related
Allowance
for Loan
Losses
 
Coverage %(4)
 
(Dollars in millions)
Commercial and industrial
$
467

 
$
62

 
$
405

 
$
63

 
$
342

 
$
128

 
40.7
%
Commercial real estate mortgage—owner-occupied
503

 
64

 
439

 
44

 
395

 
148

 
42.1

Commercial real estate construction—owner-occupied
18

 
4

 
14

 
4

 
10

 
3

 
38.9

Total commercial
988

 
130

 
858

 
111

 
747

 
279

 
41.4

Commercial investor real estate mortgage
560

 
103

 
457

 
54

 
403

 
132

 
42.0

Commercial investor real estate construction
26

 
6

 
20

 
2

 
18

 
7

 
50.0

Total investor real estate
586

 
109

 
477

 
56

 
421

 
139

 
42.3

Residential first mortgage
152

 
55

 
97

 

 
97

 
13

 
44.7

Home equity
32

 
11

 
21

 

 
21

 
2

 
40.6

Total consumer
184

 
66

 
118

 

 
118

 
15

 
44.0

 
$
1,758

 
$
305

 
$
1,453

 
$
167

 
$
1,286

 
$
433

 
42.0
%
 

133

Table of Contents


 
 
Accruing Impaired Loans 2012
 
 
Unpaid
Principal
Balance(1)
 
Charge-offs
and Payments
Applied(2)
 
Book Value(3)
 
Related
Allowance for
Loan Losses
 
Coverage %(4)
 
 
(Dollars in millions)
Commercial and industrial
 
$
299

 
$
7

 
$
292

 
$
42

 
16.4
%
Commercial real estate mortgage—owner-occupied
 
213

 
4

 
209

 
25

 
13.6

Commercial real estate construction—owner-occupied
 
1

 

 
1

 

 

Total commercial
 
513

 
11

 
502

 
67

 
15.2

Commercial investor real estate mortgage
 
782

 
10

 
772

 
97

 
13.7

Commercial investor real estate construction
 
107

 

 
107

 
16

 
15.0

Total investor real estate
 
889

 
10

 
879

 
113

 
13.8

Residential first mortgage
 
1,101

 
13

 
1,088

 
144

 
14.3

Home equity
 
411

 
5

 
406

 
36

 
10.0

Indirect
 
2

 
1

 
1

 

 
50.0

Other consumer
 
40

 

 
40

 
1

 
2.5

Total consumer
 
1,554

 
19

 
1,535

 
181

 
12.9

 
 
$
2,956

 
$
40

 
$
2,916

 
$
361

 
13.6
%

 
Total Impaired Loans 2012
 
 
 
 
 
Book Value(3)
 
 
 
 
 
Unpaid
Principal
Balance(1)
 
Charge-offs
and Payments
Applied(2)
 
Total
Impaired
Loans
 
Impaired
Loans with No
Related
Allowance
 
Impaired
Loans with
Related
Allowance
 
Related
Allowance for
Loan Losses
 
Coverage %(4)
 
(Dollars in millions)
Commercial and industrial
$
766

 
$
69

 
$
697

 
$
63

 
$
634

 
$
170

 
31.2
%
Commercial real estate mortgage—owner-
occupied
716

 
68

 
648

 
44

 
604

 
173

 
33.7

Commercial real estate construction—owner-occupied
19

 
4

 
15

 
4

 
11

 
3

 
36.8

Total commercial
1,501

 
141

 
1,360

 
111

 
1,249

 
346

 
32.4

Commercial investor real estate mortgage
1,342

 
113

 
1,229

 
54

 
1,175

 
229

 
25.5

Commercial investor real estate construction
133

 
6

 
127

 
2

 
125

 
23

 
21.8

Total investor real estate
1,475

 
119

 
1,356

 
56

 
1,300

 
252

 
25.2

Residential first mortgage
1,253

 
68

 
1,185

 

 
1,185

 
157

 
18.0

Home equity
443

 
16

 
427

 

 
427

 
38

 
12.2

Indirect
2

 
1

 
1

 

 
1

 

 
50.0

Other consumer
40

 

 
40

 

 
40

 
1

 
2.5

Total consumer
1,738

 
85

 
1,653

 

 
1,653

 
196

 
16.2

 
$
4,714

 
$
345

 
$
4,369

 
$
167

 
$
4,202

 
$
794

 
24.2
%



134

Table of Contents


_________
(1)
Unpaid principal balance represents the contractual obligation due from the customer and includes the net book value plus charge-offs and payments applied.
(2)
Charge-offs and payments applied represents cumulative partial charge-offs taken, as well as interest payments received that have been applied against the outstanding principal balance.
(3)
Book value represents the unpaid principal balance less charge-offs and payments applied; it is shown before any allowance for loan losses.
(4)
Coverage % represents charge-offs and payments applied plus the related allowance as a percent of the unpaid principal balance.

The following table presents the average balances of total impaired loans and interest income for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011. Interest income recognized represents interest on accruing loans modified in a TDR. TDRs are considered impaired loans.
 
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
Average
Balance
 
Interest
Income
Recognized
 
Average
Balance
 
Interest
Income
Recognized
 
Average
Balance
 
Interest
Income
Recognized
 
(In millions)
Commercial and industrial
$
629

 
$
14

 
$
707

 
$
16

 
$
563

 
$
7

Commercial real estate mortgage—owner-occupied
579

 
11

 
737

 
11

 
761

 
5

Commercial real estate construction—owner-occupied
38

 
1

 
23

 

 
30

 

Total commercial
1,246

 
26

 
1,467

 
27

 
1,354

 
12

Commercial investor real estate mortgage
995

 
32

 
1,510

 
40

 
1,457

 
22

Commercial investor real estate construction
115

 
6

 
210

 
7

 
449

 
4

Total investor real estate
1,110

 
38

 
1,720

 
47

 
1,906

 
26

Residential first mortgage
1,114

 
38

 
1,157

 
39

 
1,086

 
41

Home equity
406

 
21

 
439

 
22

 
410

 
21

Indirect
2

 

 
2

 

 
2

 

Consumer credit card
1

 

 

 

 

 

Other consumer
32

 
2

 
47

 
3

 
61

 
4

Total consumer
1,555

 
61

 
1,645

 
64

 
1,559

 
66

Total impaired loans
$
3,911

 
$
125

 
$
4,832

 
$
138

 
$
4,819

 
$
104


In addition to the impaired loans detailed in the tables above, there were approximately $82 million in non-performing loans classified as held for sale at December 31, 2013, compared to $89 million at December 31, 2012. The loans are carried at an amount approximating a price which is expected to be recoverable through the loan sale market. During the year ended December 31, 2013, approximately $164 million in non-performing loans were transferred to held for sale; this amount is net of charge-offs of $93 million recorded upon transfer. At December 31, 2013 and 2012, non-accrual loans including loans held for sale totaled $1.2 billion and $1.8 billion, respectively.


TROUBLED DEBT RESTRUCTURINGS

The majority of Regions’ commercial and investor real estate TDRs are the result of renewals of classified loans at an interest rate that is not considered to be a market rate of interest. Consumer TDRs generally involve an interest rate concession. Accordingly, the financial impact of the modifications is best illustrated by the impact to the allowance calculation at the loan or pool level as a result of the loans being considered impaired due to their status as a TDR.

None of the modified consumer loans listed in the following TDR disclosures were collateral-dependent at the time of modification. At December 31, 2013, approximately $92 million in residential first mortgage TDRs were in excess of 180 days past due and were considered collateral-dependent. At December 31, 2013, approximately $10 million in home equity first lien TDRs were in excess of 180 days past due and $7 million in home equity second lien TDRs were in excess of 120 days past due, both categories of which were considered collateral-dependent.

135

Table of Contents


The following tables present loans modified in a TDR by portfolio segment and class, and the financial impact of those modifications for the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012. The tables include modifications made to new TDRs, as well as renewals of existing TDRs. Total commercial and investor real estate loans reported as new TDRs totaled approximately $589 million and $1.1 billion for the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively.
 

 
 
2013
 
 
 
 
 
 
Financial Impact
of Modifications
Considered TDRs
 
 
Number of
Obligors
 
Recorded
Investment
 
Increase in
Allowance at
Modification
 
 
(Dollars in millions)
Commercial and industrial
 
450
 
$
566

 
$
2

Commercial real estate mortgage—owner-occupied
 
384
 
311

 
4

Commercial real estate construction—owner-occupied
 
6
 
31

 

Total commercial
 
840
 
908

 
6

Commercial investor real estate mortgage
 
432
 
687

 
4

Commercial investor real estate construction
 
83
 
138

 

Total investor real estate
 
515
 
825

 
4

Residential first mortgage
 
1,044
 
182

 
21

Home equity
 
619
 
38

 
3

Consumer credit card
 
241
 
3

 

Indirect and other consumer
 
282
 
4

 

Total consumer
 
2,186
 
227

 
24

 
 
3,541
 
$
1,960

 
$
34

 
 
 
2012
 
 
 
 
 
 
Financial Impact
of Modifications
Considered TDRs
 
 
Number of
Obligors
 
Recorded
Investment
 
Increase in
Allowance at
Modification
 
 
(Dollars in millions)
Commercial and industrial
 
623
 
$
668

 
$
3

Commercial real estate mortgage—owner-occupied
 
424
 
391

 
4

Commercial real estate construction—owner-occupied
 
8
 
7

 

Total commercial
 
1,055
 
1,066

 
7

Commercial investor real estate mortgage
 
604
 
1,188

 
9

Commercial investor real estate construction
 
205
 
128

 
1

Total investor real estate
 
809
 
1,316

 
10

Residential first mortgage
 
1,394
 
289

 
37

Home equity
 
1,014
 
70

 
5

Indirect and other consumer
 
489
 
8

 

Total consumer
 
2,897
 
367

 
42

 
 
4,761
 
$
2,749

 
$
59


As described previously, the consumer modifications granted by Regions are rate concessions, and not forgiveness of principal. The majority of the commercial and investor real estate modifications are renewals where there is no reduction in interest rate or forgiveness of principal. Accordingly, Regions most often does not record a charge-off at the modification date. A limited number of 2012 modifications included above were A/B note restructurings, where the B-note was charged off. There were no charge-offs recorded for any loans modified during the year ended December 31, 2013.

136

Table of Contents



Defaulted TDRs
The following table presents TDRs by portfolio segment and class which defaulted during the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012, and which were modified in the previous twelve months (i.e., the twelve months prior to the default). For purposes of this disclosure, default is defined as 90 days past due and still accruing for the consumer portfolio segment, and placement on non-accrual status for the commercial and investor real estate portfolio segments. Consideration of defaults in the calculation of the allowance for loan losses is described in detail in Note 1 to the consolidated financial statements.
 
 
 
2013
 
2012
 
 
(In millions)
Defaulted During the Period, Where Modified in a TDR Twelve Months Prior to Default
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
 
$
33

 
$
114

Commercial real estate mortgage—owner-occupied
 
30

 
55

Commercial real estate construction—owner-occupied
 

 
1

Total commercial
 
63

 
170

Commercial investor real estate mortgage
 
92

 
186

Commercial investor real estate construction
 
26

 
24

Total investor real estate
 
118

 
210

Residential first mortgage
 
50

 
68

Home equity
 
5

 
18

Total consumer
 
55

 
86

 
 
$
236

 
$
466

Commercial and investor real estate loans which were on non-accrual status at the time of the latest modification are not included in the default table above, as they are already considered to be in default at the time of the restructuring. At December 31, 2013, approximately $101 million of commercial and investor real estate loans modified in a TDR during the year ended December 31, 2013 were on non-accrual status. Approximately 1.8 percent of this amount was 90 days or more past due.
At December 31, 2013, Regions had restructured binding unfunded commitments totaling $213 million where a concession was granted and the borrower was in financial difficulty.
NOTE 7. SERVICING OF FINANCIAL ASSETS
The fair value of mortgage servicing rights is calculated using various assumptions including future cash flows, market discount rates, expected prepayment rates, servicing costs and other factors. A significant change in prepayments of mortgages in the servicing portfolio could result in significant changes in the valuation adjustments, thus creating potential volatility in the carrying amount of mortgage servicing rights. The Company compares fair value estimates and assumptions to observable market data where available, and also considers recent market activity and actual portfolio experience.

The table below presents an analysis of mortgage servicing rights for the years ended December 31 under the fair value measurement method:
 
 
2013
 
2012
 
(In millions)
Carrying value, beginning of year
$
191

 
$
182

Additions
84

 
60

Increase (decrease) in fair value:
 
 
 
Due to change in valuation inputs or assumptions
55

 
(20
)
Economic amortization associated with borrower repayments
(33
)
 
(31
)
Carrying value, end of year
$
297

 
$
191


137

Table of Contents


On March 29, 2013, the Company completed a transaction to purchase the rights to service approximately $3 billion in residential mortgage loans. The mortgage servicing rights asset was increased by the purchase price of approximately $28 million in the first quarter of 2013.
Data and assumptions used in the fair value calculation, as well as the valuation’s sensitivity to rate fluctuations, related to mortgage servicing rights (excluding related derivative instruments) as of December 31 are as follows:
 
 
2013
 
2012
 
(Dollars in millions)
Unpaid principal balance
$
28,075

 
$
25,796

Weighted-average prepayment speed (CPR; percentage)
8.2
%
 
17.6
%
Estimated impact on fair value of a 10% increase
$
(11
)
 
$
(13
)
Estimated impact on fair value of a 20% increase
$
(21
)
 
$
(23
)
Option-adjusted spread (basis points)
895

 
754

Estimated impact on fair value of a 10% increase
$
(10
)
 
$
(4
)
Estimated impact on fair value of a 20% increase
$
(20
)
 
$
(9
)
Weighted-average coupon interest rate
4.5
%
 
4.9
%
Weighted-average remaining maturity (months)
279

 
276

Weighted-average servicing fee (basis points)
27.7

 
28.3

The sensitivity calculations above are hypothetical and should not be considered to be predictive of future performance. Changes in fair value based on adverse changes in assumptions generally cannot be extrapolated because the relationship of the change in assumption to the change in fair value may not be linear. Also, the effect of an adverse variation in a particular assumption on the fair value of the mortgage servicing rights is calculated without changing any other assumption, while in reality changes in one factor may result in changes in another, which may either magnify or counteract the effect of the change. The derivative instruments utilized by Regions would serve to reduce the estimated impacts to fair value included in the table above.
The following table presents servicing related fees, which includes contractually specified servicing fees, late fees and other ancillary income resulting from the servicing of mortgage loans for the years ended December 31:
 
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
(In millions)
Servicing related fees and other ancillary income
$
86

 
$
83

 
$
85

Loans are sold in the secondary market with standard representations and warranties regarding certain characteristics such as the quality of the loan, the absence of fraud, the eligibility of the loan for sale and the future servicing associated with the loan. Regions may be required to repurchase these loans at par, or make-whole or indemnify the purchasers for losses incurred when representations and warranties are breached.

Regions maintains a repurchase liability related to mortgage loans sold with representations and warranty provisions. This repurchase liability is reported in other liabilities on the consolidated balance sheets and reflects management’s estimate of losses based on historical repurchase and loss trends, as well as other factors that may result in anticipated losses different from historical loss trends. Adjustments to this reserve are recorded in other non-interest expense on the consolidated statements of operations. The table below presents an analysis of Regions’ repurchase liability related to mortgage loans sold with representations and warranty provisions for the years ended December 31:
 
 
2013
 
2012
 
(In millions)
Beginning balance
$
40

 
$
32

Additions
31

 
41

Losses
(32
)
 
(33
)
Ending balance
$
39

 
$
40

During 2013 and 2012, settled repurchase claims were related to one or more of the following alleged breaches: 1) underwriting guideline violations; 2) misrepresentation of income, assets or employment; or 3) missing or incorrect documents per investor guidelines. These claims stem primarily from the 2006—2008 vintages.

138

Table of Contents



NOTE 8. PREMISES AND EQUIPMENT
A summary of premises and equipment at December 31 is as follows:
 
 
 
2013
 
2012
 
 
(In millions)
Land
 
$
520

 
$
525

Premises and improvements
 
1,745

 
1,727

Furniture and equipment
 
1,000

 
1,010

Software
 
393

 
303

Leasehold improvements
 
396

 
396

Construction in progress
 
141

 
175

 
 
4,195

 
4,136

Accumulated depreciation and amortization
 
(1,979
)
 
(1,857
)
 
 
$
2,216

 
$
2,279


NOTE 9. INTANGIBLE ASSETS
GOODWILL
Goodwill allocated to each reportable segment at December 31 is presented as follows:
 
2013
 
2012
 
(In millions)
Business Services
$
2,552

 
$
2,552

Consumer Services
1,797

 
1,797

Wealth Management
467

 
467

 
$
4,816

 
$
4,816

There were no additions during 2013, 2012 or 2011. There were no impairment losses in either 2013 or 2012. There was $745 million in impairment losses in 2011.
As stated in Note 1, Regions evaluates each reporting unit’s goodwill for impairment on an annual basis in the fourth quarter, or more often if events or circumstances indicate that there may be impairment. Adverse changes in the economic environment, declining operations, or other factors could result in a decline in the implied fair value of goodwill. A goodwill impairment test includes two steps. Step One, used to identify potential impairment, compares the estimated fair value of a reporting unit with its carrying amount, including goodwill. If the estimated fair value of a reporting unit exceeds its carrying amount, goodwill of the reporting unit is considered not impaired. If the carrying amount of a reporting unit exceeds its estimated fair value, the second step of the goodwill impairment test is performed to measure the amount of impairment loss, if any. Step Two of the goodwill impairment test compares the implied estimated fair value of reporting unit goodwill with the carrying amount of that goodwill. If the carrying amount of goodwill for that reporting unit exceeds the implied fair value of that unit’s goodwill, an impairment loss is recognized in an amount equal to that excess.

During the fourth quarter of 2013, Regions assessed the indicators of goodwill impairment for all three reporting units as part of its annual impairment test, as of October 1, 2013, and through the date of the filing of this Annual Report. The indicators assessed included:

Recent operating performance,
Changes in market capitalization,
Regulatory actions and assessments,
Changes in the business climate (including legislation, legal factors, and competition),
Company-specific factors (including changes in key personnel, asset impairments, and business dispositions), and
Trends in the banking industry.
The results of the annual test indicated that the estimated fair value of each reporting unit exceeded its carrying amount as of the test date; therefore, the goodwill of each reporting unit is considered not impaired as of the testing date.

139

Table of Contents


Listed in the table below are assumptions used in estimating the fair value of each reporting unit for the December 31, 2013 annual period. The table includes the discount rates used in the income approach, the market multipliers used in the market approaches, and the public company method control premium applied to each reporting unit. These valuation approaches are described further in Note 1.
 
As of Fourth Quarter 2013
Business
Services
 
Consumer
Services
 
Wealth
Management
Discount rate used in income approach
12
%
 
12
%
 
12
%
Public company method market multiplier(1)
1.2
x
 
1.2
x
 
15.4
x
Transaction method market multiplier(2)
1.5
x
 
1.5
x
 
25.2
x
_________
(1)
For the Business Services and Consumer Services reporting units, these multipliers are applied to tangible book value. For the Wealth Management reporting unit, this multiplier is applied to earnings. In addition to the multipliers, a 30 percent control premium was assumed for the Business Services reporting unit, a 35 percent control premium was assumed for the Consumer Services reporting unit and a 30 percent control premium was assumed for the Wealth Management reporting unit based on current market factors. Because the control premium considers potential revenue synergies and cost savings for similar financial services transactions, reporting units operating in businesses that have greater barriers to entry tend to have greater control premiums.
(2)
For the Business Services and Consumer Services reporting units, these multipliers are applied to tangible book value. For the Wealth Management reporting unit, this multiplier is applied to earnings.
As of Fourth Quarter 2012
Business
Services
 
Consumer
Services
 
Wealth
Management
Discount rate used in income approach
14
%
 
13
%
 
13
%
Public company method market multiplier(1)
1.2
x
 
1.0
x
 
14.0
x
Transaction method market multiplier(2)
1.3
x
 
1.3
x
 
25.2
x
_________
(1)
For the Business Services and Consumer Services reporting units, these multipliers are applied to tangible book value. For the Wealth Management reporting unit, this multiplier is applied to earnings. In addition to the multipliers, a 20 percent control premium was assumed for the Business Services reporting unit, a 40 percent control premium was assumed for the Consumer Services reporting unit and a 30 percent control premium was assumed for the Wealth Management reporting unit based on current market factors. Because the control premium considers potential revenue synergies and cost savings for similar financial services transactions, reporting units operating in businesses that have greater barriers to entry tend to have greater control premiums.
(2)
For the Business Services and Consumer Services reporting units, these multipliers are applied to tangible book value. For the Wealth Management reporting unit, this multiplier is applied to earnings.
OTHER INTANGIBLES
Other intangibles consist of core deposit intangibles, purchased credit card relationship assets, and customer relationship and employment agreement assets.
A summary of core deposit intangible assets at December 31 is presented as follows:
 
 
 
2013
 
2012
 
 
(In millions)
Balance at beginning of year, net
 
$
176

 
$
259

Accumulated amortization, beginning of year
 
(835
)
 
(752
)
Amortization
 
(28
)
 
(83
)
Accumulated amortization, end of year
 
(863
)
 
(835
)
Balance at end of year, net
 
$
148

 
$
176

Regions’ core deposit intangible assets are being amortized to other non-interest expense on an accelerated basis over their expected useful lives.
A summary of Regions’ other intangible assets as of December 31 is presented as follows:
 

140

Table of Contents


 
 
2013
 
2012
 
 
(In millions)
Net Book Value
 
$
147

 
$
169

Current Year Amortization
 
26

 
27

These other intangible assets resulted from purchased credit card relationships, customer relationships and employment agreements related to various acquisitions and are being amortized to other non-interest expense primarily on an accelerated basis over a period ranging from 2 to 15 years.

The aggregate amount of amortization expense for core deposit intangible assets, credit card intangibles, and other intangible assets is estimated as follows:
 
 
Year Ended December 31
 
(In millions)
2014
$
50

2015
45

2016
40

2017
36

2018
30

Identifiable intangible assets other than goodwill are reviewed at least annually, usually in the fourth quarter, for events or circumstances that could impact the recoverability of the intangible asset. These events could include loss of core deposits, significant losses of credit card accounts and/or balances, increased competition or adverse changes in the economy. To the extent other identifiable intangible assets are deemed unrecoverable, impairment losses are recorded in other non-interest expense to reduce the carrying amount. Regions concluded that no impairment for core deposit intangibles or any other identifiable intangible assets occurred during 2013 or 2012.

NOTE 10. DEPOSITS
The following schedule presents a detail of interest-bearing deposits at December 31:
 
 
2013
 
2012
 
 
(In millions)
Savings
 
$
6,050

 
$
5,760

Interest-bearing transaction
 
20,789

 
21,096

Money market—domestic
 
25,635

 
24,901

Money market—foreign
 
220

 
311

Time deposits
 
9,608

 
13,443

Interest-bearing customer deposits
 
62,302

 
65,511

Corporate treasury time deposits
 
68

 

 
 
$
62,370

 
$
65,511

The aggregate amount of time deposits of $100,000 or more, including certificates of deposit of $100,000 or more, was $3.4 billion and $5.0 billion at December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

141

Table of Contents


At December 31, 2013, the aggregate amount of maturities of all time deposits (deposits with stated maturities, consisting primarily of certificates of deposit and individual retirement accounts ("IRAs")) were as follows:

 
 
 
December 31, 2013
 
(In millions)
2014
$
4,577

2015
1,751

2016
1,602

2017
1,025

2018
699

Thereafter
22

 
$
9,676


NOTE 11. SHORT-TERM BORROWINGS
Following is a summary of short-term borrowings at December 31:
 
 
 
2013
 
2012
 
 
(In millions)
Company funding sources:
 
 
 
 
Federal funds purchased
 
$
11

 
$
21

Customer-related borrowings:
 
 
 
 
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase
 
2,171

 
1,428

Customer collateral
 

 
125

 
 
2,171

 
1,553

 
 
$
2,182

 
$
1,574

COMPANY FUNDING SOURCES
The levels of federal funds purchased and securities sold under agreements to repurchase can fluctuate significantly on a day-to-day basis, depending on funding needs and which sources are used to satisfy those needs. All such arrangements are considered typical of the banking and brokerage industries and are accounted for as borrowings. Federal funds purchased had weighted-average maturities of 2 days at both December 31, 2013, and 2012. The weighted-average rate paid during 2013, 2012 and 2011 was 0.1% in each year.
At December 31, 2013, Regions could borrow a maximum amount of approximately $22.2 billion from the Federal Reserve Bank Discount Window. See Note 5 for loans pledged to the Federal Reserve Bank at December 31, 2013 and 2012.
CUSTOMER-RELATED BORROWINGS
Repurchase agreements are also offered as commercial banking products as short-term investment opportunities for customers. At the end of each business day, customer balances are swept into the agreement account. In exchange for cash, Regions sells the customer securities with a commitment to repurchase them on the following business day. The repurchase agreements are collateralized to allow for market fluctuations. Securities from Regions Bank’s investment portfolio are used as collateral. From the customer’s perspective, the investment earns more than a traditional money market instrument. From Regions’ standpoint, the repurchase agreements are similar to deposit accounts, although they are not insured by the FDIC or guaranteed by the United States or governmental agencies. Regions Bank does not manage the level of these investments on a daily basis as the transactions are initiated by the customers. The level of these borrowings can fluctuate significantly on a day-to-day basis.

Customer collateral decreased to zero at December 31, 2013 from $125 million at December 31, 2012. Customer collateral includes cash collateral posted by customers related to derivative transactions.


142

Table of Contents


OFFSETTING
Regions has certain securities sold under agreements to repurchase from time to time that are subject to enforceable master netting agreements which include full rights of setoff. Regions began netting cash collateral, subject to enforceable master netting agreements, against the net derivative asset or liability beginning in 2013. There were no such securities sold under agreements to repurchase that were subject to enforceable master netting agreements outstanding at either December 31, 2013 or 2012.

Regions also has enforceable master netting agreements with certain derivative counterparties. Refer to Note 20 for additional information.
 
 
 
 
 
NOTE 12. LONG-TERM BORROWINGS
Long-term borrowings at December 31 consist of the following:
 
 
2013
 
2012
 
 
(In millions)
Regions Financial Corporation (Parent):
 
 
 
 
4.875% senior notes due April 2013
 
$

 
$
250

7.75% senior notes due November 2014
 
349

 
696

5.75% senior notes due June 2015
 
498

 
497

2.00% senior notes due May 2018
 
748

 

7.75% subordinated notes due September 2024
 
100

 
100

6.75% subordinated debentures due November 2025
 
161

 
161

7.375% subordinated notes due December 2037
 
300

 
300

6.625% junior subordinated notes due May 2047
 

 
498

Other long-term debt
 

 
3

Valuation adjustments on hedged long-term debt
 
5

 
62

 
 
2,161

 
2,567

Regions Bank:
 
 
 
 
Federal Home Loan Bank advances
 
1,009

 
1,010

4.85% subordinated notes due April 2013
 

 
499

5.20% subordinated notes due April 2015
 
349

 
348

7.50% subordinated notes due May 2018
 
750

 
750

6.45% subordinated notes due June 2037
 
497

 
497

Other long-term debt
 
58

 
174

Valuation adjustments on hedged long-term debt
 
6

 
16

 
 
2,669

 
3,294

 
 
$
4,830

 
$
5,861

As of December 31, 2013, Regions had six issuances of subordinated notes totaling $2.2 billion, with stated interest rates ranging from 5.20% to 7.75%. All issuances of these notes are, by definition, subordinated and subject in right of payment of both principal and interest to the prior payment in full of all senior indebtedness of the Company, which is generally defined as all indebtedness and other obligations of the Company to its creditors, except subordinated indebtedness. Payment of the principal of the notes may be accelerated only in the case of certain events involving bankruptcy, insolvency proceedings or reorganization of the Company. In April of 2013, the $500 million, 4.85% subordinated notes issued by Regions Bank matured. The subordinated notes described above qualify as Tier 2 capital under Federal Reserve guidelines, subject to diminishing credit as the maturity date approaches. None of the subordinated notes are redeemable prior to maturity, unless there is an occurrence of a qualifying capital event.

On May 31, 2013, Regions redeemed its 6.625% Junior Subordinated Notes due 2047 totaling $498 million. Pretax losses on early extinguishment related to this redemption were $6 million.

On April 25, 2013, Regions launched a tender offer for a portion of its outstanding 7.75% Senior Notes due 2014 (the “2014 Notes”) and 5.75% Senior Notes due 2015 (the “2015 Notes” and, collectively with the 2014 Notes, the “Senior Notes”). Pursuant to the terms and conditions of the tender offer, Regions purchased $350 million aggregate principal amount of the 2014 Notes.

143

Table of Contents


The tender offer had an early tender premium for Senior Notes tendered by May 10, 2013. Pre-tax losses on early extinguishment related to this tender offer were $27 million. On April 26, 2013, the $250 million 4.875% parent company senior notes matured. On April 30, 2013, Regions issued $750 million of 2.00% parent company senior notes due May 15, 2018.

On June 25, 2013, Regions redeemed $100 million in long-term debt consisting of preferred stock issued by Union Planters Preferred Funding Corp., a subsidiary of Regions Bank. Pre-tax losses on early extinguishment related to this redemption were $24 million and were not deductible for income tax purposes. During the third quarter of 2013, Regions extinguished $18 million of other long-term debt which included a $3 million redemption of trust preferred securities. These actions resulted in pre-tax losses of $5 million and were not deductible for income tax purposes.

FHLB advances at December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011 had a weighted-average interest rate of 1.4 percent, 1.4 percent, and 1.0 percent, respectively, with maturities ranging from one to eighteen years. FHLB borrowing capacity is contingent upon the amount of collateral pledged to the FHLB. Regions has pledged certain loans as collateral for the FHLB advances outstanding. See Note 5 for loans pledged to the FHLB at December 31, 2013 and 2012. Additionally, membership in the FHLB requires an institution to hold FHLB stock. See Note 4 for the amount of FHLB stock held at December 31, 2013 and 2012. Regions’ borrowing availability with the FHLB as of December 31, 2013, based on assets available for collateral at that date, was $9.6 billion.
Regions uses derivative instruments, primarily interest rate swaps, to manage interest rate risk by converting a portion of its fixed-rate debt to a variable-rate. The effective rate adjustments related to these hedges are included in interest expense on long-term borrowings. The weighted-average interest rate on total long-term debt, including the effect of derivative instruments, was 4.8 percent, 4.7 percent, and 3.3 percent for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011, respectively. Further discussion of derivative instruments is included in Note 20.
The aggregate amount of contractual maturities of all long-term debt in each of the next five years and thereafter is as follows:
 
 
Year Ended December 31
 
 
Regions
Financial
Corporation
(Parent)
 
Regions
Bank
 
 
(In millions)
2014
 
$
357

 
$
1,002

2015
 
515

 
357

2016
 

 
3

2017
 

 
4

2018
 
728

 
753

Thereafter
 
561

 
550

 
 
$
2,161

 
$
2,669

In February 2013, Regions filed a shelf registration statement with the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission. This shelf registration does not have a capacity limit and can be utilized by Regions to issue various debt and/or equity securities. The registration statement will expire in February 2016.
Regions’ Bank Note program was modified by the Board of Directors in December 2013, and currently allows Regions Bank to issue up to $5 billion aggregate principal amount of bank notes outstanding at any one time. No issuances have been made under this program as of December 31, 2013. Notes issued under the program may be senior notes with maturities from 30 days to 15 years and subordinated notes with maturities from 5 years to 30 years. These notes are not deposits and they are not insured or guaranteed by the FDIC.

Regions may, from time to time, consider opportunistically retiring outstanding issued securities, including subordinated debt in privately negotiated or open market transactions for cash or common shares. Regulatory approval would be required for retirement of some securities.


144

Table of Contents


NOTE 13. REGULATORY CAPITAL REQUIREMENTS AND RESTRICTIONS
Regions and Regions Bank are required to comply with regulatory capital requirements established by Federal and state banking agencies. These regulatory capital requirements involve quantitative measures of the Company’s assets, liabilities and certain off-balance sheet items, and also qualitative judgments by the regulators. Failure to meet minimum capital requirements can subject the Company to a series of increasingly restrictive regulatory actions. Currently, there are two basic measures of capital adequacy: a risk-based measure and a leverage measure.
The risk-based capital requirements are designed to make regulatory capital requirements more sensitive to differences in credit and market risk profiles among banks and bank holding companies, to account for off-balance sheet exposure and interest rate risk, and to minimize disincentives for holding liquid assets. Assets and off-balance sheet items are assigned to broad risk categories, each with specified risk-weighting factors. The resulting capital ratios represent capital as a percentage of total risk-weighted assets and off-balance sheet items. Banking organizations that are considered to have excessive risk exposures are required to maintain higher levels of capital.
The current minimum standard for the ratio of total capital to risk-weighted assets is 8 percent. At least 50 percent of that capital level (which equates to a 4 percent minimum) must consist of common equity, undivided profits, qualifying trust preferred securities, non-cumulative perpetual preferred stock, senior perpetual preferred stock issued to the U.S. Treasury under the Capital Purchase Program, non-controlling interests relating to qualifying common or noncumulative perpetual preferred stock issued by a consolidated U.S. depository institution (or subsidiary thereof) or foreign bank subsidiary, less goodwill, disallowed deferred tax assets and certain other intangibles (“Tier 1 capital”). The remainder (“Tier 2 capital”) may consist of a limited amount of other preferred stock, mandatorily convertible securities, subordinated debt, and a limited amount of the allowance for loan and lease losses. The sum of Tier 1 capital and Tier 2 capital is “total risk-based capital” or total capital. However, under the Collins Amendment, which was passed as a section of the Dodd-Frank Act and implemented as part of the final U.S. Basel III framework released in July 2013, trust preferred securities will be eliminated as an element of Tier 1 capital. This disallowance of trust preferred securities is to be phased in for Regions from January 1, 2015 to January 1, 2016. During 2012 and 2013, Regions redeemed all of its outstanding trust preferred securities that were affected by the Collins Amendment. As of December 31, 2013, Regions had $450 million of preferred stock that was unaffected by the Collins Amendment.
The current minimum guidelines to be considered well capitalized for Total capital and Tier 1 capital are 10 percent and 6 percent, respectively. As of December 31, 2013 and 2012, the most recent notification from federal banking agencies categorized Regions and its significant subsidiaries as well capitalized under the regulatory framework.
The Company believes that no changes in conditions or events have occurred since December 31, 2013, which would result in changes that would cause Regions or Regions Bank to fall below the well capitalized level.
The banking regulatory agencies also have adopted regulations that supplement the risk-based guidelines to include a minimum ratio of 3 percent of Tier 1 capital to average assets less goodwill, disallowed deferred tax assets and certain other intangibles (the “Leverage ratio”). Under the current guidelines, depending upon the risk profile of the institution and other factors, the regulatory agencies may require a Leverage ratio of 1 percent to 2 percent above the minimum 3 percent level.


145

Table of Contents


The following tables summarize the applicable holding company and bank regulatory capital requirements. Regions’ capital ratios at December 31, 2013 and 2012 exceeded all current regulatory requirements.
 
 
 
December 31, 2013
 
Minimum
Requirement
 
To Be Well
Capitalized
 
 
Amount
 
Ratio
 
 
 
(Dollars in millions)
Tier 1 capital:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Regions Financial Corporation
 
$
11,258

 
11.68
%
 
4.00
%
 
6.00
%
Regions Bank
 
11,965

 
12.46

 
4.00

 
6.00

Total capital:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Regions Financial Corporation
 
$
14,200

 
14.73
%
 
8.00
%
 
10.00
%
Regions Bank
 
14,341

 
14.94

 
8.00

 
10.00

Leverage(1) :
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Regions Financial Corporation
 
$
11,258

 
10.03
%
 
3.00
%
 
5.00
%
Regions Bank
 
11,965

 
10.67

 
3.00

 
5.00

 _________
(1) The Leverage ratio requires an additional 100 to 200 basis-point cushion, in certain circumstances, of adjusted quarterly average assets.
 
 
December 31, 2012
 
Minimum
Requirement
 
To Be Well
Capitalized
 
 
Amount
 
Ratio
 
 
 
(Dollars in millions)
Tier 1 capital:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Regions Financial Corporation
 
$
11,134

 
12.00
%
 
4.00
%
 
6.00
%
Regions Bank
 
12,246

 
13.25

 
4.00

 
6.00

Total capital:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Regions Financial Corporation
 
$
14,272

 
15.38
%
 
8.00
%
 
10.00
%
Regions Bank
 
14,818

 
16.04

 
8.00

 
10.00

Leverage(1) :
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Regions Financial Corporation
 
$
11,134

 
9.65
%
 
3.00
%
 
5.00
%
Regions Bank
 
12,246

 
10.65

 
3.00

 
5.00

 _________
(1) The Leverage ratio requires an additional 100 to 200 basis-point cushion, in certain circumstances, of adjusted quarterly average assets.
Substantially all net assets are owned by subsidiaries. The primary source of operating cash available to Regions is provided by dividends from subsidiaries. Statutory limits are placed on the amount of dividends the subsidiary bank can pay without prior regulatory approval. In addition, regulatory authorities require the maintenance of minimum capital-to-asset ratios at banking subsidiaries. Under the Federal Reserve’s Regulation H, Regions Bank may not, without approval of the Federal Reserve, declare or pay a dividend to Regions if the total of all dividends declared in a calendar year exceeds the total of (a) Regions Bank’s net income for that year and (b) its retained net income for the preceding two calendar years, less any required transfers to additional paid-in capital or to a fund for the retirement of preferred stock. Under Alabama law, Regions Bank may not pay a dividend to Regions in excess of 90 percent of its net earnings until the bank’s surplus is equal to at least 20 percent of capital. Regions Bank is also required by Alabama law to seek the approval of the Alabama Superintendent of Banking prior to the payment of dividends if the total of all dividends declared by Regions Bank in any calendar year will exceed the total of (a) Regions Bank’s net earnings for that year, plus (b) its retained net earnings for the preceding two years, less any required transfers to surplus. The statute defines net earnings as “the remainder of all earnings from current operations plus actual recoveries on loans and investments and other assets, after deducting from the total thereof all current operating expenses, actual losses, accrued dividends on preferred stock, if any, and all federal, state and local taxes.” Regions Bank cannot, without approval from the Federal Reserve and the Alabama Superintendent of Banking, declare or pay a dividend to Regions unless Regions Bank is able to satisfy the criteria discussed in the preceding sentences. In addition to dividend restrictions, Federal statutes also prohibit unsecured loans from banking subsidiaries to the parent company.

In addition, Regions must adhere to various U.S. Department of Housing and Urban Development (“HUD”) regulatory guidelines including required minimum capital to maintain their Federal Housing Administration approved status. Failure to comply

146

Table of Contents


with the HUD guidelines could result in withdrawal of this certification. As of December 31, 2013, Regions was in compliance with HUD guidelines. Regions is also subject to various capital requirements by secondary market investors.

NOTE 14. STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY AND ACCUMULATED OTHER COMPREHENSIVE INCOME (LOSS)

On March 19, 2012, the Company issued 153 million shares of common stock at $5.90 per share, generating proceeds of approximately $875 million, net of issuance costs.
On November 14, 2008, Regions completed the sale of 3.5 million shares of its Fixed Rate Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series A, to the U.S. Treasury as part of the Capital Purchase Program (“CPP”). As part of its purchase of the preferred securities, the U.S. Treasury also received a warrant to purchase 48.3 million shares of Regions’ common stock. On April 4, 2012, Regions repurchased all 3.5 million shares of the Series A preferred stock issued to the U.S. Treasury Department under the CPP and in early May of 2012, Regions repurchased the warrant from the U.S. Treasury Department for $45 million.

On November 1, 2012, Regions issued 20 million depositary shares each representing a 1/40th ownership interest in a share of the Company’s 6.375% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series A, par value $1.00 per share (“Series A Preferred stock”), with a liquidation preference of $1,000 per share of Series A Preferred Stock (equivalent to $25 per depositary share). The issuance generated proceeds of approximately $486 million, net of issuance costs. The Board of Directors declared $32 million in cash dividends on this Series A Preferred Stock during 2013. Because the Company was in a retained deficit position, the preferred dividends were recorded as a reduction of preferred stock, including related surplus.
At December 31, 2012, Regions had 23 million common shares available for repurchase through open market transactions under an existing share repurchase authorization. On March 19, 2013, Regions' Board of Directors authorized a new $350 million common stock purchase plan, permitting repurchases from the beginning of the second quarter of 2013 through the end of the first quarter of 2014. The new plan replaced the prior share repurchase authorization. As of December 31, 2013, Regions had repurchased approximately 36 million shares of common stock at a total cost of approximately $340 million. These shares were immediately retired upon repurchase and therefore are not included in treasury stock.
The Board of Directors declared cash dividends on common stock of $0.10 for 2013, $0.04 for 2012 and $0.04 for 2011. Because the Company was in a retained deficit position, the common stock dividends were recorded as a reduction of additional-paid-in-capital.
Activity within the balances in accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) is shown in the following tables for the years ended December 31 as follows:
 
 
2013
 
Unrealized losses on securities transferred to held to maturity
 
Unrealized
gains (losses) on securities
available
for sale
 
Unrealized
gains (losses) on derivative
instruments
designated
as cash
flow hedges
 
Defined benefit pension plans and other post
employment
benefits
 
Accumulated
other
comprehensive
income (loss),
net of tax
 
(In millions)
Beginning of year
$

 
$
436

 
$
93

 
$
(464
)
 
$
65

Net change
(64
)
 
(458
)
 
(78
)
 
216

 
(384
)
End of year
$
(64
)
 
$
(22
)
 
$
15

 
$
(248
)
 
$
(319
)

147

Table of Contents




 
2012
 
Unrealized
gains (losses) on securities
available for sale
 
Unrealized
gains (losses) on derivative
instruments
designated
as cash
flow hedges
 
Defined
benefit
pension
plans and
other post
employment
benefits
 
Accumulated other
comprehensive
income (loss),
net of tax
 
(In millions)
Beginning of year
$
322

 
$
84

 
$
(475
)
 
$
(69
)
Net change
114

 
9

 
11

 
134

End of year
$
436

 
$
93

 
$
(464
)
 
$
65


 
2011
 
Unrealized
gains (losses) on securities
available for sale
 
Unrealized
gains (losses) on derivative
instruments
designated
as cash
flow hedges
 
Defined
benefit
pension
plans and
other post
employment
benefits
 
Accumulated other
comprehensive
income (loss),
net of tax
 
(In millions)
Beginning of year
$
78

 
$
(10
)
 
$
(328
)
 
$
(260
)
Net change
244

 
94

 
(147
)
 
191

End of year
$
322

 
$
84

 
$
(475
)
 
$
(69
)



148

Table of Contents


The following table presents amounts reclassified out of accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) for the year ended December 31, 2013:

Details about Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss) Components
Amount Reclassified from Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss)(1)
 
Affected Line Item in the Consolidated Statements of Operations
 
(In millions)
 
Unrealized losses on securities transferred to held to maturity:
 
 
 
 
$
(7
)
 
Net interest income
 
3

 
Tax (expense) or benefit
 
$
(4
)
 
Net of tax
Unrealized gains and (losses) on available-for-sale securities:
    
 
 
 
$
26

 
Securities gains, net
 
(9
)
 
Tax (expense) or benefit
 
$
17

 
Net of tax
 
 
 
 
Gains and (losses) on cash flow hedges:
 
 
 
Interest rate contracts
$
86

 
Net interest income
 
(33
)
 
Tax (expense) or benefit
 
$
53

 
Net of tax
 
 
 
 
Amortization of defined benefit pension items:
 
 
 
Prior-service cost
$
(1
)
 
(2) 
Actuarial gains/(losses)
(69
)
 
(2) 
 
(70
)
 
Total before tax
 
25

 
Tax (expense) or benefit
 
$
(45
)
 
Net of tax
 
 
 
 
Total reclassifications for the period
$
21

 
Net of tax
_________
(1) Amounts in parentheses indicate reductions to net income.
(2) These accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) components are included in the computation of net periodic pension cost and are included in salaries and employee benefits on the consolidated statements of operations (see Note 17 for additional details).


149

Table of Contents


NOTE 15. EARNINGS (LOSS) PER COMMON SHARE
The following table sets forth the computation of basic earnings (loss) per common share and diluted earnings (loss) per common share for the years ended December 31:
 
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
(In millions, except per share data)
Numerator:
 
 
 
 
 
Income from continuing operations
$
1,135

 
$
1,179

 
$
189

Preferred stock dividends and accretion
(32
)
 
(129
)
 
(214
)
Income (loss) from continuing operations available to common shareholders
1,103

 
1,050

 
(25
)
Loss from discontinued operations, net of tax
(13
)
 
(59
)
 
(404
)
Net income (loss) available to common shareholders
$
1,090

 
$
991

 
$
(429
)
Denominator:
 
 
 
 
 
Weighted-average common shares outstanding—basic
1,395

 
1,381

 
1,258

Potential common shares
15

 
6

 

Weighted-average common shares outstanding—diluted
1,410

 
1,387

 
1,258

Earnings (loss) per common share from continuing operations available to common shareholders(1):
 
 
 
 
 
Basic
$
0.79

 
$
0.76

 
$
(0.02
)
Diluted
0.78

 
0.76

 
(0.02
)
Loss per common share from discontinued operations(1):
 
 
 
 
 
Basic
(0.01
)
 
(0.04
)
 
(0.32
)
Diluted
(0.01
)
 
(0.04
)
 
(0.32
)
Earnings (loss) per common share(1):
 
 
 
 
 
Basic
0.78

 
0.72

 
(0.34
)
Diluted
0.77

 
0.71

 
(0.34
)
________
(1)
 Certain per share amounts may not appear to reconcile due to rounding.
In 2013 and 2012, diluted earnings per common share from continuing operations is calculated using a denominator of 1,410 million and 1,387 million shares, respectively, which includes 15 million and 6 million potential common shares, respectively. Basic and diluted weighted-average common shares outstanding for earnings per common share from continuing operations and in total are the same for 2011 due to the Company experiencing a net loss. For earnings per common share from discontinued operations, basic and diluted weighted-average common shares are the same for all periods presented due to the Company experiencing net losses.
The effect from the assumed exercise of 24 million and 36 million stock options for the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively, was not included in the above computations of diluted earnings per common share because such amounts would have had an antidilutive effect on earnings per common share.

NOTE 16. SHARE-BASED PAYMENTS

Regions administers long-term incentive compensation plans that permit the granting of incentive awards in the form of stock options, restricted stock awards, performance awards and stock appreciation rights. While Regions has the ability to issue stock appreciation rights, none have been issued to date. The terms of all awards issued under these plans are determined by the Compensation Committee of the Board of Directors; however, no awards may be granted after the tenth anniversary from the date the plans were initially approved by shareholders. Incentive awards usually vest based on employee service, generally within three years from the date of the grant. The contractual lives of options granted under these plans are typically ten years from the date of the grant.

On May 13, 2010, the shareholders of the Company approved the Regions Financial Corporation 2010 Long-Term Incentive Plan (“2010 LTIP”), which permits the Company to grant to employees and directors various forms of incentive compensation. These forms of incentive compensation are similar to the types of compensation approved in prior plans. The 2010 LTIP authorizes

150

Table of Contents


100 million common share equivalents available for grant, where grants of options count as one share equivalent and grants of full value awards (e.g., shares of restricted stock, restricted stock units and performance stock units) count as 2.25 share equivalents. Unless otherwise determined by the Compensation Committee of the Board of Directors, grants of restricted stock, restricted stock units, and performance stock units accrue dividends as they are declared by the Board of Directors, and the dividends are paid upon vesting of the award. Upon adoption of the 2010 LTIP, Regions closed all prior long-term incentive plans to new grants, and, accordingly, prospective grants must be made under the 2010 LTIP or a successor plan. All existing grants under prior long-term incentive plans were unaffected by adoption of the 2010 LTIP. The number of remaining share equivalents available for future issuance under the 2010 LTIP was approximately 53 million at December 31, 2013.
Grants of performance-based restricted stock typically have a three-year performance period, and shares vest within three years after the grant date. Restricted stock units typically have a vesting period of three years. Grantees of restricted stock awards or units must either remain employed with the Company for certain periods from the date of grant in order for shares to be released or issued or retire after meeting the standards of a retiree, at which time shares would be prorated and released. The terms of these plans generally stipulate that the exercise price of options may not be less than the fair market value of Regions’ common stock at the date the options are granted; however, under prior stock option plans, non-qualified options could be granted with a lower exercise price than the fair market value of Regions’ common stock on the date of grant. The contractual life of options granted under these plans are typically ten years from the date of grant. Regions issues new shares from authorized reserves upon exercise.
The following table summarizes the elements of compensation cost recognized in the consolidated statements of operations for the years ended December 31:

 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
(In millions)
Compensation cost of share-based compensation awards:
 
 
 
 
 
Restricted stock awards
$
35

 
$
23

 
$
10

Stock options
5

 
7

 
9

Cash-settled restricted stock units

 
3

 
3

Tax benefits related to compensation cost
(15
)
 
(12
)
 
(8
)
Compensation cost of share-based compensation awards, net of tax
$
25

 
$
21

 
$
14


STOCK OPTIONS
No stock option grants were made during 2013 or 2012. In 2011, Regions made stock option grants that vest based upon satisfaction of a service condition. The fair value of these stock options was estimated on the date of the grant using a Black-Scholes option pricing model and related assumptions. The stock options vest ratably over a three-year term.
The following table summarizes the weighted-average assumptions used and the weighted-average estimated fair values related to stock options granted in 2011.
 
2011
Expected option life
5.8 yrs

Expected volatility
75.5
%
Expected dividend yield
2.3
%
Risk-free interest rate
2.0
%
Fair value
$3.66
Refer to Note 1 for a discussion of the methodologies used to derive the underlying assumptions used in the Black-Scholes option pricing model.
The following table summarizes the activity for 2013, 2012 and 2011 related to stock options:

151

Table of Contents


 
 
 
Number of
Options
 
Weighted-
Average
Exercise
Price
 
Aggregate
Intrinsic Value
(In Millions)
 
Weighted-
Average
Remaining
Contractual
Term
Outstanding at December 31, 2010
 
54,999,626

 
$
24.41

 
$
11

 
4.76 yrs.
Granted
 
1,451,200

 
6.59

 
 
 
 
Exercised
 
(18,442
)
 
3.29

 
 
 
 
Canceled/Forfeited
 
(10,081,035
)
 
25.30

 
 
 
 
Outstanding at December 31, 2011
 
46,351,349

 
$
23.62

 
$
3

 
4.55 yrs.
Granted
 

 

 
 
 
 
Exercised
 
(338,182
)
 
4.07

 
 
 
 
Canceled/Forfeited
 
(7,754,963
)
 
27.06

 
 
 
 
Outstanding at December 31, 2012
 
38,258,204

 
$
23.09

 
$
11

 
3.99 yrs.
Granted
 

 

 
 
 
 
Exercised
 
(934,790
)
 
5.46

 
 
 
 
Canceled/Forfeited
 
(5,196,179
)
 
28.29

 
 
 
 
Outstanding at December 31, 2013
 
32,127,235

 
$
22.81

 
$
35

 
3.46 yrs.
Exercisable at December 31, 2013
 
31,657,014

 
$
23.05

 
$
34

 
3.40 yrs.


RESTRICTED STOCK AWARDS AND PERFORMANCE STOCK AWARDS
During 2013 and 2012, Regions made restricted stock grants that vest upon satisfaction of service conditions and restricted stock unit and performance stock unit grants that vest based upon satisfaction of service conditions and performance conditions. Dividend payments during the vesting period are deferred to the end of the vesting term. The fair value of these restricted shares, restricted stock units and performance stock units was estimated based upon the fair value of the underlying shares on the date of the grant. The valuation was not adjusted for the deferral of dividends.
Activity related to restricted stock awards and performance stock awards for 2013, 2012 and 2011 is summarized as follows:
 
 
Number of
Shares/Units
 
Weighted-Average
Grant Date
Fair Value
Non-vested at December 31, 2010
 
4,930,444

 
$
12.13

Granted
 
2,705,834

 
6.66

Vested
 
(1,206,373
)
 
23.36

Forfeited
 
(149,545
)
 
12.93

Non-vested at December 31, 2011
 
6,280,360

 
$
7.60

Granted
 
8,461,987

 
5.86

Vested
 
(2,047,900
)
 
10.12

Forfeited
 
(749,268
)
 
4.22

Non-vested at December 31, 2012
 
11,945,179

 
$
6.15

Granted
 
6,385,841

 
8.06

Vested
 
(1,584,532
)
 
7.03

Forfeited
 
(534,290
)
 
6.67

Non-vested at December 31, 2013
 
16,212,198

 
$
6.83

As of December 31, 2013, the pre-tax amount of non-vested stock options, restricted stock, restricted stock units and performance stock units not yet recognized was $44 million, which will be recognized over a weighted-average period of 1.82 years. No share-based compensation costs were capitalized during the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011.
Regions did not issue cash-settled restricted stock units during 2013. During 2012 and 2011, Regions issued approximately 259 thousand and 867 thousand of cash-settled restricted stock units, respectively.

152

Table of Contents



NOTE 17. EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLANS

PENSION AND OTHER POSTRETIREMENT BENEFITS

Regions has a defined-benefit pension plan qualified under the Internal Revenue Code covering only certain employees as the pension plan is closed to new entrants. Benefits under the pension plan are based on years of service and the employee’s highest five years of compensation during the last ten years of employment. Regions’ funding policy is to contribute annually at least the amount required by Internal Revenue Service minimum funding standards. Contributions are intended to provide not only for benefits attributed to service to date, but also for those expected to be earned in the future. Regions made no contribution to the plan during 2013.
The Company also sponsors a supplemental executive retirement program (the “SERP”), which is a non-qualified pension plan that provides certain senior executive officers defined benefits in relation to their compensation. Actuarially determined pension expense is charged to current operations using the projected unit credit method. All defined-benefit plans are referred to as “the plans” throughout the remainder of this footnote.
The following table sets forth the plans’ change in benefit obligation, plan assets and funded status, using a December 31 measurement date, and amounts recognized in the consolidated balance sheets at December 31:
 
 
Qualified Plan
 
Non-qualified Plans
 
Total
 
 
2013
 
2012
 
2013
 
2012
 
2013
 
2012
 
 
(In millions)
Change in benefit obligation
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Projected benefit obligation, beginning of year
 
$
2,004

 
$
1,841

 
$
163

 
$
145

 
$
2,167

 
$
1,986

Service cost
 
38

 
37

 
3

 
3

 
41

 
40

Interest cost
 
84

 
84

 
6

 
6

 
90

 
90

Actuarial (gains) losses
 
(269
)
 
119

 
2

 
16

 
(267
)
 
135

Benefit payments
 
(77
)
 
(74
)
 
(9
)
 
(7
)
 
(86
)
 
(81
)
Administrative expenses
 
(3
)
 
(3
)
 

 

 
(3
)
 
(3
)
Projected benefit obligation, end of year
 
$
1,777

 
$
2,004

 
$
165

 
$
163

 
$
1,942

 
$
2,167

Change in plan assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fair value of plan assets, beginning of year
 
$
1,749

 
$
1,494

 
$

 
$

 
$
1,749

 
$
1,494

Actual return on plan assets
 
143

 
191

 

 

 
143

 
191

Company contributions
 

 
141

 
9

 
7

 
9

 
148

Benefit payments
 
(77
)
 
(74
)
 
(9
)
 
(7
)
 
(86
)
 
(81
)
Administrative expenses
 
(3
)
 
(3
)
 

 

 
(3
)
 
(3
)
Fair value of plan assets, end of year
 
$
1,812

 
$
1,749

 
$

 
$

 
$
1,812

 
$
1,749

Funded status and accrued benefit cost at measurement date
 
$
35

 
$
(255
)
 
$
(165
)
 
$
(163
)
 
$
(130
)
 
$
(418
)
Amount recognized in the Consolidated Balance Sheets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other assets (liabilities)
 
$
35

 
$
(255
)
 
$
(165
)
 
$
(163
)
 
$
(130
)
 
$
(418
)
Pre-tax amounts recognized in Accumulated Other Comprehensive (Income) Loss:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net actuarial loss (gain)
 
$
374

 
$
721

 
$
36

 
$
34

 
$
410

 
$
755

Prior service cost (credit)
 

 

 
2

 
3

 
2

 
3

 
 
$
374

 
$
721

 
$
38

 
$
37

 
$
412

 
$
758




153

Table of Contents


The accumulated benefit obligation for the qualified plan was $1.8 billion and $2.0 billion as of December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively. Total plan assets exceeded the corresponding accumulated benefit obligation for the qualified plan as of December 31, 2013. As of December 31, 2012, the accumulated benefit obligation for the qualified plan exceeded all corresponding plan assets. The accumulated benefit obligation for the non-qualified plan was $165 million and $163 million as of December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively, which exceeded all corresponding plan assets for each period. Net periodic pension cost, which is recorded in salaries and benefits on the consolidated statements of operations, included the following components for the years ended December 31:
 
Qualified Plan
 
Non-qualified Plans
 
Total
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
(In millions)
Service cost
$
38

 
$
37

 
$
33

 
$
3

 
$
3

 
$
3

 
$
41

 
$
40

 
$
36

Interest cost
84

 
84

 
85

 
6

 
6

 
6

 
90

 
90

 
91

Expected return on plan assets
(132
)
 
(115
)
 
(121
)
 

 

 

 
(132
)
 
(115
)
 
(121
)
Amortization of actuarial loss
66

 
70

 
45

 
3

 
1

 

 
69

 
71

 
45

Amortization of prior service cost

 

 

 
1

 
1

 
1

 
1

 
1

 
1

Net periodic pension cost
$
56

 
$
76

 
$
42

 
$
13

 
$
11

 
$
10

 
$
69

 
$
87

 
$
52


The estimated amounts that will be amortized from accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) into net periodic benefit cost in 2014 are as follows:

 
 
Qualified Plan
 
Non-qualified Plans
 
 
(In millions)
Actuarial loss
 
$
21

 
$
2

Prior service cost
 

 
1

 
 
$
21

 
$
3


The weighted-average assumptions used to determine benefit obligations at December 31 are as follows:
 
 
Qualified Plan
 
Non-Qualified Plans
 
 
2013
 
2012
 
2013
 
2012
Discount rate
 
5.00
%
 
4.25
%
 
4.50
%
 
3.65
%
Rate of annual compensation increase
 
3.75
%
 
3.75
%
 
3.75
%
 
3.75
%

The weighted-average assumptions used to determine net periodic benefit cost for the years ended December 31 are as follows:
 
 
Qualified Plan
 
Non-qualified Plans
 
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
Discount rate
 
4.25
%
 
4.60
%
 
5.45
%
 
3.65
%
 
4.35
%
 
5.00
%
Expected long-term rate of return on plan assets
 
7.75
%
 
7.75
%
 
8.25
%
 
N/A

 
N/A

 
N/A

Rate of annual compensation increase
 
3.75
%
 
3.75
%
 
3.75
%
 
3.75
%
 
3.75
%
 
4.00
%
The expected long-term rate of return on qualified plan assets is based on an estimated reasonable range of probable returns. Management chose a point within the range based on the probability of achievement combined with incremental returns attributable to active management.


154

Table of Contents


The qualified pension plan’s investment strategy is continuing to shift from focusing on maximizing asset returns to minimizing funding ratio volatility, with an increase to the allocation to bonds. The target asset allocation is 51 percent equities, 32 percent fixed income securities and 17 percent in all other types of investments. Equity securities include investments in large and small/mid cap companies primarily located in the United States, international equities, and private equities. Fixed income securities include investments in corporate and government bonds, asset-backed securities and any other fixed income investments as allowed by respective prospectuses and other offering documents. Other types of investments may include hedge funds and real estate funds that follow several different strategies. Plan assets are highly diversified with respect to asset class, security and manager. Investment risk is controlled with plan assets rebalancing to target allocations on a periodic basis and continual monitoring of investment managers’ performance relative to the investment guidelines established with each investment manager.
The Regions’ qualified pension plan has a portion of its investments in Regions’ common stock. At December 31, 2013, the plan held 2,855,618 shares, which represents a total market value of approximately $28 million, or approximately 2 percent of plan assets.


155

Table of Contents


The following table presents the fair value of Regions’ qualified pension plans’ financial assets as of December 31:
 
 
2013
 
2012
 
 
Level 1
 
Level 2
 
Level 3
 
Fair Value
 
Level 1
 
Level 2
 
Level 3
 
Fair Value
 
 
(In millions)
Cash and cash equivalents
 
$
30

 
$

 
$

 
$
30

 
$
31

 
$

 
$

 
$
31

Fixed income securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
U.S. Treasury and federal agency securities
 

 
135

 

 
135

 

 
130

 

 
130

Mortgage-backed securities
 

 
5

 

 
5

 

 
8

 

 
8

Collateralized mortgage obligations
 

 
2

 

 
2

 

 
3

 

 
3

Obligations of states and political subdivisions
 

 
1

 

 
1

 

 
1

 

 
1

Corporate bonds
 

 
171

 

 
171

 

 
167

 

 
167

Unit investment trusts
 

 
53

 

 
53

 

 

 

 

Total fixed income securities
 
$

 
$
367

 
$

 
$
367

 
$

 
$
309

 
$

 
$
309

Equity securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Domestic
 
271

 

 

 
271

 
253

 

 

 
253

International
 
16

 

 

 
16

 
5

 

 

 
5

Total common stock
 
$
287

 
$

 
$

 
$
287

 
$
258

 
$

 
$

 
$
258

Mutual funds:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Domestic
 
101

 

 

 
101

 
347

 

 

 
347

International
 

 

 

 

 
1

 

 

 
1

Total mutual funds
 
$
101

 
$

 
$

 
$
101

 
$
348

 
$

 
$

 
$
348

Collective investment trust funds:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fixed income fund
 

 
227

 

 
227

 

 
221

 

 
221

Common stock fund
 

 
186

 

 
186

 

 
40

 

 
40

International fund
 

 
228

 

 
228

 

 
208

 

 
208

 
 
$

 
$
641

 
$

 
$
641

 
$

 
$
469

 
$

 
$
469

International hedge funds
 
$

 
$
90

 
$

 
$
90

 
$

 
$
84

 
$

 
$
84

Real estate funds
 
$

 
$

 
$
225

 
$
225

 
$

 
$

 
$
203

 
$
203

Private equity funds
 
$

 
$

 
$
70

 
$
70

 
$

 
$

 
$
46

 
$
46

Other assets
 
$

 
$

 
$
1

 
$
1

 
$

 
$

 
$
1

 
$
1

 
 
$
418

 
$
1,098

 
$
296

 
$
1,812

 
$
637

 
$
862

 
$
250

 
$
1,749



156

Table of Contents


For all investments, the plan attempts to use quoted market prices of identical assets on active exchanges, or Level 1 measurements. Where such quoted market prices are not available, the plan typically employs quoted market prices of similar instruments (including matrix pricing) and/or discounted cash flows to estimate a value of these securities, or Level 2 measurements. Level 2 discounted cash flow analyses are typically based on market interest rates, prepayment speeds and/or option adjusted spreads. Level 3 measurements include discounted cash flow analyses based on assumptions that are not readily observable in the market place. Such assumptions include projections of future cash flows, including loss assumptions, and discount rates.
Investments held in the plan consist of cash and cash equivalents, fixed income securities (U.S. Treasury, federal agency securities, mortgage-backed securities, collateralized mortgage obligations, obligations of states and political subdivisions and corporate bonds), equity securities (primarily common stock and mutual funds), collective trust funds, hedge funds, real estate funds, private equity and other assets and are recorded at fair value on a recurring basis. See Note 1 for a description of valuation methodologies related to U.S. Treasuries, federal agency securities, mortgage-backed securities, obligations of states and political subdivisions and equity securities. The methodology described in Note 1 for other debt securities is applicable to corporate bonds.
Mutual funds are valued based on quoted market prices of identical assets on active exchanges; these valuations are Level 1 measurements. Collective trust funds, international hedge funds, real estate funds, private equity funds and other assets are valued based on net asset value or the valuation of the limited partner’s portion of the equity of the fund. Third party fund managers provide these valuations based primarily on estimated valuations of underlying investments. These funds are included in either Level 2 or Level 3, based on the nature of the underlying investments and on redemption restrictions.
The following table illustrates a rollforward for qualified pension plan financial assets measured at fair value on a recurring basis using significant unobservable inputs (Level 3) for the years ended December 31:
Fair Value Measurements Using
Significant Unobservable Inputs
Year Ended December 31, 2013
(Level 3 measurements only)
 
 
Real estate
funds
 
Private equity
funds
 
Other assets
 
 
 
 
(In millions)
 
 
Beginning balance, January 1, 2013
 
$
203

 
$
46

 
$
1

Actual return on plan assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net appreciation (depreciation) in fair value of investments
 
21

 
11

 

Purchases, sales, issuances, and settlements, net
 
1

 
13

 

Ending balance, December 31, 2013
 
$
225

 
$
70

 
$
1

The amount of total gains (losses) for the period attributable to the change in unrealized gains (losses) relating to assets still held at December 31, 2013:
 
$
21

 
$
11

 
$


Fair Value Measurements Using
Significant Unobservable Inputs
Year Ended December 31, 2012
(Level 3 measurements only)
 
 
Real estate
funds
 
Private equity
funds
 
Other assets
 
 
(In millions)
Beginning balance, January 1, 2012
 
$
186

 
$
26

 
$
1

Actual return on plan assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net appreciation (depreciation) in fair value of investments
 
15

 
(2
)
 

Purchases, sales, issuances, and settlements, net
 
2

 
22

 

Ending balance, December 31, 2012
 
$
203

 
$
46

 
$
1

The amount of total gains (losses) for the period attributable to the change in unrealized gains (losses) relating to assets still held at December 31, 2012:
 
$
15

 
$
(2
)
 
$


157

Table of Contents





Information about the expected cash flows for the qualified pension plan are as follows:
 
 
Qualified Plan
 
 
(In millions)
Expected Employer Contributions:
 
 
2014
 
$

Expected Benefit Payments:
 
 
2014
 
$
82

2015
 
85

2016
 
88

2017
 
91

2018
 
95

2019-2022
 
539

OTHER PLANS
Regions has a defined-contribution 401(k) plan that includes a Company match of eligible employee contributions. Eligible employees include those who have been employed for one year and have worked a minimum of 1,000 hours. The Company match is initially invested in Regions common stock. In 2013 and 2012, Regions provided an automatic 2 percent cash 401(k) contribution to eligible employees regardless of whether or not they were contributing to the 401(k) plan. To receive this contribution, employees must be employed at the end of the year and not actively accruing a benefit in the Regions’ pension plan. Eligible employees who are already contributing to the 401(k) plan will continue to receive up to a 4 percent Company match plus the automatic 2 percent cash contribution. During 2011, the match totaled 100 percent of the eligible employee pre-tax contribution (up to 6 percent of compensation). Regions’ match to the 401(k) plan on behalf of employees totaled $34 million, $29 million and $42 million in 2013, 2012 and 2011, respectively. Regions’ cash contribution was approximately $14 million for 2013 and $12 million for 2012. Regions’ 401(k) plan held 36 million shares of Regions common stock at both December 31, 2013 and 2012. The 401(k) plan received approximately $3 million in dividends on Regions common stock for the year ended December 31, 2013, and $1 million in dividends for the years ended December 31, 2012 and 2011.

Regions also sponsors defined-benefit postretirement health care plans that cover certain retired employees. For these certain employees retiring before normal retirement age, the Company currently pays a portion of the costs of certain health care benefits until the retired employee becomes eligible for Medicare. Certain retirees, participating in plans of acquired entities, are offered a Medicare supplemental benefit. The plan is contributory and contains other cost-sharing features such as deductibles and co-payments. Retiree health care benefits, as well as similar benefits for active employees, are provided through a self-insured program in which Company and retiree costs are based on the amount of benefits paid. The Company’s policy is to fund the Company’s share of the cost of health care benefits in amounts determined at the discretion of management. Postretirement life insurance is also provided to a grandfathered group of employees and retirees. The assumed health care cost trend rate for postretirement medical benefits was 6.7 percent for 2013 and is assumed to decrease gradually to 4.5 percent by 2027 and remain at that level thereafter. A one-percentage point change in assumed health care cost trend rates would have an immaterial effect on total service cost and interest cost components as well as the related postretirement obligations. There was no material impact from other postretirement benefits on the consolidated statements of operations for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011. The projected benefit obligation for these plans was $23 million and $29 million as of December 31, 2013 and 2012 respectively.

NOTE 18. OTHER NON-INTEREST INCOME AND EXPENSE
The following is a detail of other non-interest income from continuing operations for the years ended December 31:

158

Table of Contents


 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
(In millions)
Insurance commissions and fees
$
114

 
$
109

 
$
106

Capital markets fee income and other
87

 
83

 
36

Bank-owned life insurance
82

 
81

 
83

Credit card / bank card income
75

 
85

 
65

Commercial credit fee income
65

 
68

 
80

Net loss from affordable housing
(49
)
 
(49
)
 
(69
)
Other miscellaneous income
209

 
132

 
143

 
$
583

 
$
509

 
$
444

The following is a detail of other non-interest expense from continuing operations for the years ended December 31:
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
(In millions)
Professional and legal expenses
$
132

 
$
114

 
$
175

Deposit administrative fee
125

 
162

 
217

Outside services
106

 
82

 
62

Marketing
98

 
87

 
62

Loss on early extinguishment of debt
61

 
11

 

Regulatory charge
58

 

 

Credit/checkcard expenses
41

 
64

 
50

Amortization of core deposit intangible
28

 
83

 
95

Other real estate owned expense
16

 
52

 
162

Branch consolidation and property and equipment charges
5

 

 
75

(Gain)/loss on loans held for sale, net
(30
)
 
(61
)
 
1

Other miscellaneous expenses
453

 
526

 
443

 
$
1,093

 
$
1,120

 
$
1,342


NOTE 19. INCOME TAXES
The components of income tax expense (benefit) from continuing operations for the years ended December 31 were as follows:
 
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
(In millions)
Current income tax expense (benefit):
 
 
 
 
 
Federal
$
88

 
$
(20
)
 
$
2

State
19

 
16

 
1

Total current expense (benefit)
$
107

 
$
(4
)
 
$
3

Deferred income tax expense (benefit):
 
 
 
 
 
Federal
$
356

 
$
383

 
$
1

State
(11
)
 
103

 
(32
)
Total deferred expense (benefit)
$
345

 
$
486

 
$
(31
)
Total income tax expense (benefit)
$
452

 
$
482

 
$
(28
)
Note: The table above does not include income tax expense (benefit) from discontinued operations of $(11) million, $(40) million, $(4) million in 2013, 2012 and 2011, respectively. The deferred income tax expense (benefit) reflected in discontinued operations was $34 million, ($52) million and $8 million in 2013, 2012 and 2011, respectively.

Income tax expense (benefit) does not reflect the tax effects of unrealized gains and losses on securities available for sale, unrealized gains and losses on derivative instruments and the net change from defined benefit plans. Refer to Note 14 for additional information on stockholders’ equity and accumulated other comprehensive income (loss).

159

Table of Contents


The income tax effects resulting from stock transactions under the Company’s compensation plans were a decrease to stockholders’ equity of zero, $6 million and $7 million in 2013, 2012 and 2011, respectively. The income tax effects of these transactions reduced the Company’s deferred tax asset $5 million, $6 million and $7 million in 2013, 2012 and 2011, respectively.
Income taxes from continuing operations for financial reporting purposes differs from the amount computed by applying the statutory federal income tax rate of 35 percent for the years ended December 31, as shown in the following table:

 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
(Dollars in millions)
Tax on income from continuing operations computed at statutory federal income tax rate
$
555

 
$
582

 
$
56

Increase (decrease) in taxes resulting from:
 
 
 
 
 
State income tax, net of federal tax effect
5

 
77

 
(20
)
Affordable housing credits and other credits
(108
)
 
(108
)
 
(107
)
Lease financing
38

 
24

 
24

Bank-owned life insurance
(33
)
 
(32
)
 
(34
)
Tax-exempt income from obligations of states and political subdivisions
(32
)
 
(29
)
 
(21
)
Regulatory charge
20

 

 
(17
)
Goodwill impairment

 

 
89

Federal audit settlement

 
(61
)
 

Other, net
7

 
29

 
2

Income tax expense (benefit)
$
452

 
$
482

 
$
(28
)
Effective tax rate
28.5
%
 
29.0
%
 
(17.4
)%
            
Note: The table above relates to income taxes from continuing operations. In 2011, a regulatory settlement was finalized and a portion was determined to be deductible for income tax purposes. This settlement resulted in a $27 million income tax benefit to discontinued operations. In addition, the $492 million goodwill impairment reflected in 2011 discontinued operations resulted in a $14 million income tax benefit.

Significant components of the Company’s net deferred tax asset at December 31 are listed below:
 
2013
 
2012
 
(In millions)
Deferred tax assets:
 
 
 
Allowance for loan losses
$
539

 
$
757

Unrealized gains and losses included in stockholders’ equity
196

 

Accrued expenses
191

 
219

State net operating loss carryfowards, net of federal tax effect
176

 
187

Employee benefits and deferred compensation
109

 
64

Federal tax credit carryforwards
74

 
177

Other
96

 
115

Total deferred tax assets
1,381

 
1,519

Less: valuation allowance
(36
)
 
(70
)
Total deferred tax assets less valuation allowance
1,345

 
1,449

Deferred tax liabilities:
 
 
 
Lease financing
413

 
344

Goodwill and intangibles
188

 
191

Mortgage servicing rights
96

 
62

Fixed assets
15

 
17

Unrealized gains and losses included in stockholders’ equity

 
37

Other
21

 
35

Total deferred tax liabilities
733

 
686

Net deferred tax asset
$
612

 
$
763


160

Table of Contents


The following table provides details of the Company’s tax carryforwards at December 31, 2013, including the expiration dates, any related valuation allowance and the amount of taxable earnings necessary to fully realize each net deferred tax asset balance:

 
Expiration Dates
 
Deferred Tax
Asset Balance
 
Valuation
Allowance
 
Net Deferred Tax
Asset Balance
 
Pre-Tax
Earnings
Necessary to
Realize (1)
General business credits-federal
2031-2033
 
$
64

 
$

 
$
64

 
$ N/A

Alternate minimum tax credits-federal
None(2)
 
10

 

 
10

 
N/A

Net operating losses-states
2014-2018
 
72

 
(8
)
 
64

 
1,515

Net operating losses-states
2019-2025
 
55

 
(13
)
 
42

 
999

Net operating losses-states
2026-2033
 
49

 
(10
)
 
39

 
992

Other credits-states
2014-2018
 
8

 
(5
)
 
3

 
N/A

                
(1)
N/A indicates that credits are not measured on a pre-tax basis.
(2)
Alternative minimum tax credits can be carried forward indefinitely.
Of the $612 million net deferred tax asset, $222 million relates to net operating losses and tax carryforwards of which $109 million expires before 2026 (as detailed in the table above). The remaining $390 million of net deferred tax assets do not have a set expiration date at December 31, 2013.
The Company’s determination of the realization of the net deferred tax asset is based on its assessment of all available positive and negative evidence. At December 31, 2013, the Company is no longer in a three-year cumulative loss position and therefore, does not have this negative evidence to consider in assessing the realization of its net deferred tax asset. Additional positive evidence supporting the realization of the deferred tax assets at December 31, 2013 includes the reversal of taxable temporary differences that will offset approximately $752 million of the gross deferred tax asset and generation of taxable income for the two prior tax years.
The Company believes that a portion of the state net operating loss carryforwards and state tax credit carryforwards will not be realized due to the length of certain state carryforward periods. Accordingly, a valuation allowance has been established in the amount of $36 million against such benefits at December 31, 2013 compared to $70 million at December 31, 2012. The valuation allowance decrease of $34 million was principally due to the Company’s determination that certain state net operating loss carryforwards are more likely than not to be realized.
A reconciliation of the beginning and ending amount of unrecognized tax benefits (“UTBs”) is as follows:
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
(In millions)
Balance at beginning of year
$
55

 
$
94

 
$
93

Additions based on tax positions related to the current year
2

 
24

 
6

Additions based on tax positions taken in a prior period
4

 
11

 
10

Reductions based on tax positions taken in a prior period
(10
)
 
(63
)
 
(10
)
Settlements

 
(11
)
 
(3
)
Expiration of statute of limitations

 

 
(2
)
Balance at end of year
$
51

 
$
55

 
$
94

The Company is currently under examination by the Internal Revenue Service for the tax years 2010, 2011 and 2012. With few exceptions, the Company is no longer subject to state and local income tax examinations for tax years before 2008. Currently, there are disputed tax positions taken in previously filed tax returns with certain states, including positions regarding investment and intellectual property subsidiaries. The Company continues to evaluate these positions and intends to defend proposed adjustments made by these tax authorities. The Company does not anticipate that the ultimate resolution of these examinations will result in a material change to its business, financial position, results of operations or cash flows.
As a result of the potential resolution of certain federal and state income tax positions, it is reasonably possible that the UTBs could decrease as much as $29 million during the next twelve months, since resolved items will be removed from the balance whether their resolution results in payment or recognition in earnings.

161

Table of Contents



As of December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011, the balance of the Company’s UTBs that would reduce the effective tax rate, if recognized, was $34 million, $40 million and $80 million, respectively. The remainder of the UTB balance has indirect tax benefits in other jurisdictions or is the tax effect of temporary differences.
During 2013, 2012 and 2011, income tax expense (benefit) includes interest expense, interest income and penalties related to income taxes, before the impact of any applicable federal and state deductions, of $2 million, zero and ($2) million, respectively. As of December 31, 2013 and December 31, 2012, the Company recognized a liability of $4 million and $1 million respectively, for interest and penalties related to income taxes, before the impact of any applicable federal and state deductions.

NOTE 20. DERIVATIVE FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS AND HEDGING ACTIVITIES
The following tables present the notional amount and estimated fair value of derivative instruments on a gross basis as of December 31, 2013 and 2012. Beginning in the third quarter of 2013, Regions began to include the value of accrued interest in the estimated fair value of derivatives designated as hedging relationships. Prior period amounts have been adjusted to conform to this presentation.
 
2013
 
2012
 
Notional
Amount
 
Estimated Fair Value
 
Notional
Amount
 
Estimated Fair Value
 
Gain(1)
 
Loss(1)
 
Gain(1)
 
Loss(1)
 
(In millions)
Derivatives in fair value hedging relationships:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate swaps
$
4,241

 
$
70

 
$
29

 
$
5,388

 
$
113

 
$
1

Derivatives in cash flow hedging relationships:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate swaps
5,800

 
5

 
80

 
1,000

 
2

 

Total derivatives designated as hedging instruments
$
10,041

 
$
75

 
$
109

 
$
6,388

 
$
115

 
$
1

Derivatives not designated as hedging instruments:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate swaps
$
46,591

 
$
1,078

 
$
1,142

 
$
46,054

 
$
1,746

 
$
1,775

Interest rate options
2,865

 
9

 
4

 
3,274

 
25

 
4

Interest rate futures and forward commitments
13,357

 
9

 
2

 
43,908

 
10

 
13

Other contracts
2,535

 
48

 
44

 
2,213

 
31

 
32

Total derivatives not designated as hedging instruments
$
65,348

 
$
1,144

 
$
1,192

 
$
95,449

 
$
1,812

 
$
1,824

Total derivatives
$
75,389

 
$
1,219

 
$
1,301

 
$
101,837

 
$
1,927

 
$
1,825

_________
(1)
Derivatives in a net gain position are recorded as other assets and derivatives in a net loss position are recorded as other liabilities on the consolidated balance sheets.
HEDGING DERIVATIVES
Derivatives entered into to manage interest rate risk and facilitate asset/liability management strategies are designated as hedging derivatives. Derivative financial instruments that qualify in a hedging relationship are classified, based on the exposure being hedged, as either fair value hedges or cash flow hedges. Additional information regarding accounting policies for derivatives is described in Note 1 "Summary of Significant Accounting Policies."

FAIR VALUE HEDGES
Fair value hedge relationships mitigate exposure to the change in fair value of an asset, liability or firm commitment.
Regions enters into interest rate swap agreements to manage interest rate exposure on the Company’s fixed-rate borrowings, which includes long-term debt and certificates of deposit. These agreements involve the receipt of fixed-rate amounts in exchange for floating-rate interest payments over the life of the agreements. Regions enters into interest rate swap agreements to manage interest rate exposure on certain of the Company's fixed-rate available for sale securities. These agreements involve the payment

162

Table of Contents


of fixed-rate amounts in exchange for floating-rate interest receipts. Regions also enters into forward sale commitments to hedge changes in the fair value of available-for-sale securities.
CASH FLOW HEDGES
Cash flow hedge relationships mitigate exposure to the variability of future cash flows or other forecasted transactions.
Regions enters into interest rate swap agreements to manage overall cash flow changes related to interest rate risk exposure on LIBOR-based loans. The agreements effectively modify the Company’s exposure to interest rate risk by utilizing receive fixed/pay LIBOR interest rate swaps.
Regions issues long-term fixed-rate debt for various funding needs. Regions may enter into receive LIBOR/pay fixed forward starting swaps to hedge risks of changes in the projected quarterly interest payments attributable to changes in the benchmark interest rate (LIBOR) during the time leading up to the probable issuance date of the new long-term fixed-rate debt.
Regions enters into interest rate option contracts to protect cash flows through the maturity date of the hedging instrument on designated one-month LIBOR floating-rate loans from adverse extreme market interest rate changes.
Regions purchases Eurodollar futures to hedge the variability in future cash flows based on forecasted resets of one-month LIBOR-based floating-rate loans due to changes in the benchmark interest rate.
Regions recognized an unrealized after-tax gain of $63 million and $92 million in accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) at December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively, related to terminated cash flow hedges of loan and debt instruments which will be amortized into earnings in conjunction with the recognition of interest payments through 2017. Regions recognized pre-tax income of $47 million and $28 million during the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively related to the amortization of cash flow hedges of loan and debt instruments.
Regions expects to reclassify out of accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) and into earnings approximately $111 million in pre-tax income due to the receipt or payment of interest payments on all cash flow hedges within the next twelve months. Included in this amount is $50 million in pre-tax net gains related to the amortization of discontinued cash flow hedges. The maximum length of time over which Regions is hedging its exposure to the variability in future cash flows for forecasted transactions is approximately seven years as of December 31, 2013.


163

Table of Contents


The following tables present the effect of hedging derivative instruments on the consolidated statements of operations for the years ended December 31:
 
Gain or (Loss) Recognized in Income on Derivatives
 
Location of Amounts Recognized in Income on Derivatives and Related Hedged Item
Gain or (Loss) Recognized in Income on Related Hedged Item
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
(In millions)
 
 
(In millions)
Fair Value Hedges:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate swaps on:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Debt/CDs
$
57

 
$
104

 
$
173

 
Interest expense
$
8

 
$
12

 
$
15

Debt/CDs
(76
)
 
(50
)
 
(74
)
 
Other non-interest expense
66

 
41

 
89

Securities available for sale
(6
)
 

 

 
Interest expense

 

 

Securities available for sale
33

 

 

 
Other non-interest expense
(33
)
 

 

Forward commitments on:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities available for sale

 

 
(46
)
 
Other non-interest expense

 

 
46

Total
$
8

 
$
54

 
$
53

 
 
$
41

 
$
53

 
$
150


 
Effective Portion(3)
 
Gain or (Loss) Recognized in AOCI(1)
 
Location of Amounts Reclassified from AOCI into Income
Gain or (Loss) Reclassified from AOCI into Income(2)
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
(In millions)
 
 
(In millions)
Cash Flow Hedges:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate swaps
$
(87
)
 
$

 
$
92

 
Interest income on loans
$
101

 
$
82

 
$
183

Forward starting swaps
9

 
9

 
2

 
Interest expense on debt
(15
)
 
(15
)
 
(11
)
Interest rate options

 

 
(2
)
 
Interest income on loans

 

 
4

Eurodollar futures

 

 
1

 
Interest income on loans

 

 
(2
)
Total
$
(78
)
 
$
9

 
$
93

 
 
$
86

 
$
67

 
$
174

____
(1) After-tax
(2) Pre-tax
(3) All cash flow hedges were highly effective for all periods presented, and the change in fair value attributed to hedge ineffectiveness was not material.
 

DERIVATIVES NOT DESIGNATED AS HEDGING INSTRUMENTS
The Company maintains a derivatives trading portfolio of interest rate swaps, option contracts, and futures and forward commitments used to meet the needs of its customers. The portfolio is used to generate trading profit and to help clients manage market risk. The Company is subject to the credit risk that a counterparty will fail to perform. The Company is also subject to market risk, which is evaluated by the Company and monitored by the asset/liability management process. Separate derivative contracts are entered into to reduce overall market exposure to pre-defined limits. The contracts in this portfolio do not qualify for hedge accounting and are marked-to-market through earnings and included in other assets and other liabilities.
Regions enters into interest rate lock commitments, which are commitments to originate mortgage loans whereby the interest rate on the loan is determined prior to funding and the customers have locked into that interest rate. At December 31, 2013 and 2012, Regions had $267 million and $775 million, respectively, in total notional amount of interest rate lock commitments. Regions manages market risk on interest rate lock commitments and mortgage loans held for sale with corresponding forward sale commitments, which are recorded at fair value with changes in fair value recorded in mortgage income. At December 31, 2013 and 2012, Regions had $636 million and $1.9 billion, respectively, in total notional amount related to these forward sale commitments.

164

Table of Contents


Regions has elected to account for mortgage servicing rights at fair market value with any changes to fair value being recorded within mortgage income. Concurrent with the election to use the fair value measurement method, Regions began using various derivative instruments, in the form of forward rate commitments, futures contracts, swaps and swaptions to mitigate the consolidated statements of operations effect of changes in the fair value of its mortgage servicing rights. As of December 31, 2013 and 2012, the total notional amount related to these contracts was $3.4 billion and $4.7 billion, respectively.
The following table presents the location and amount of gain or (loss) recognized in income on derivatives not designated as hedging instruments in the consolidated statements of operations for the years ended December 31:
 
Derivatives Not Designated as Hedging Instruments
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
(In millions)
Capital markets fee income and other (1):
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate swaps
$
25

 
$
29

 
$
11

Interest rate options
2

 
(1
)
 
(3
)
Interest rate futures and forward commitments
1

 
(1
)
 
(1
)
Other contracts
14

 
10

 
11

Total capital markets fee income and other
42

 
37

 
18

Mortgage income:
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate swaps
(32
)
 
28

 
80

Interest rate options
(18
)
 
7

 
2

Interest rate futures and forward commitments
(3
)
 
35

 
18

Total mortgage income
(53
)
 
70

 
100

 
$
(11
)
 
$
107

 
$
118

____
(1) Capital markets fee income and other is included in Other income on the consolidated statements of operations.

Credit risk, defined as all positive exposures not collateralized with cash or other assets, at December 31, 2013 and 2012, totaled approximately $453 million and $713 million, respectively. This amount represents the net credit risk on all trading and other derivative positions held by Regions.

CREDIT DERIVATIVES
Regions has both bought and sold credit protection in the form of participations on interest rate swaps (swap participations). These swap participations, which meet the definition of credit derivatives, were entered into in the ordinary course of business to serve the credit needs of customers. Credit derivatives, whereby Regions has purchased credit protection, entitle Regions to receive a payment from the counterparty when the customer fails to make payment on any amounts due to Regions upon early termination of the swap transaction and have maturities between 2014 and 2020. Credit derivatives whereby Regions has sold credit protection have maturities between 2014 and 2020. For contracts where Regions sold credit protection, Regions would be required to make payment to the counterparty when the customer fails to make payment on any amounts due to the counterparty upon early termination of the swap transaction. Regions bases the current status of the prepayment/performance risk on bought and sold credit derivatives on recently issued internal risk ratings consistent with the risk management practices of unfunded commitments.
Regions’ maximum potential amount of future payments under these contracts as of December 31, 2013 was approximately $44 million. This scenario would only occur if variable interest rates were at zero percent and all counterparties defaulted with zero recovery. The fair value of sold protection at December 31, 2013 and 2012 was immaterial. In transactions where Regions has sold credit protection, recourse to collateral associated with the original swap transaction is available to offset some or all of Regions’ obligation.

165

Table of Contents


CONTINGENT FEATURES
Certain of Regions’ derivative instrument contracts with broker-dealers contain provisions allowing those broker-dealers to terminate the contracts in the event that Regions’ and/or Regions Bank’s credit ratings fall below specified ratings from certain major credit rating agencies. During the fourth quarter of 2010, Regions and Regions Bank experienced ratings downgrades from major credit rating agencies such that certain ratings for Regions and Regions Bank were below investment grade. As a result of these ratings downgrades, certain of Regions Bank's broker-dealer counterparties could have terminated these contracts at their discretion. In lieu of terminating these contracts, Regions Bank and certain of its broker-dealer counterparties amended the contracts such that Regions Bank was required to post additional collateral in the cumulative amount of $195 million as of December 31, 2010. During 2012, both Moody’s Investor Service ("Moody's) and Standard and Poor's ("S&P") upgraded certain credit ratings for both Regions and Regions Bank. As a result of the upgrade, the additional collateral posted was $61 million at December 31, 2013.
Some of these contracts with broker-dealers still contain credit-related termination provisions and/or credit-related provisions regarding the posting of collateral. At December 31, 2013, the net fair value of such contracts containing credit-related termination provisions that were in a liability position was $290 million, for which Regions had posted collateral of $334 million. At December 31, 2013, the net fair value of contracts that do not contain credit-related termination provisions that were in a liability position was $207 million, for which Regions had posted collateral of $223 million. Other derivative contracts with broker-dealers do not contain any credit-related provisions. These counterparties require complete overnight collateralization.
The aggregate fair value of all derivative instruments with any credit-risk-related contingent features that were in a liability position on December 31, 2013 and 2012, was $364 million and $499 million, respectively, for which Regions had posted collateral of $409 million and $641 million, respectively, in the normal course of business.
OFFSETTING
Regions engages in derivatives transactions with dealers and customers. These derivatives transactions are subject to enforceable master netting agreements, which include a right of setoff by the non-defaulting or non-affected party upon early termination of the derivatives transaction. The following table presents the Company's gross derivative positions, including collateral posted or received, as of December 31, 2013 and 2012. Beginning in the third quarter of 2013, Regions began including the total fair value of all derivatives in the following table and separately reporting amounts subject to and not subject to offsetting. Prior period amounts have been adjusted to conform to this presentation.
 
Offsetting Derivative Assets
 
Offsetting Derivative Liabilities
 
2013
 
2012
 
2013
 
2012
 
(In millions)
Gross amounts subject to offsetting
$
1,165

 
$
1,900

 
$
1,257

 
$
1,820

Gross amounts not subject to offsetting
54

 
27

 
44

 
5

Gross amounts recognized
1,219

 
1,927

 
1,301

 
1,825

Gross amounts offset in the consolidated balance sheets(1)
774

 
1,095

 
1,233

 
1,095

Net amounts presented in the consolidated balance sheets
445

 
832

 
68

 
730

Gross amounts not offset in the consolidated balance sheets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Financial instruments
10

 
11

 

 

Cash collateral received/posted(1)

 
88

 
24

 
678

Net amounts
$
435

 
$
733

 
$
44

 
$
52


166

Table of Contents


_________
(1)
Cash collateral totals are for netting counterparties only. In 2013, Regions began netting cash collateral received and posted against the net derivative asset or liability. At December 31, 2013, gross amounts of derivative assets and liabilities offset in the consolidated balance sheets presented above include cash collateral received of $42 million and cash collateral posted of $501 million, respectively. The cash collateral posted does not include the additional collateral posted in the form of an independent amount of $61 million. At December 31, 2012, cash collateral received and posted was not offset in the consolidated balance sheets. At December 31, 2012, the gross amounts of derivative assets and liabilities not offset in the consolidated balance sheets presented above include cash collateral received of $55 million and cash collateral posted of $827 million, respectively. The cash collateral posted includes the additional collateral posted in the form of an independent amount of $185 million.

Gross amounts of derivatives not subject to offsetting are primarily comprised of derivatives cleared through central clearing houses and interest rate lock commitments to originate mortgage loans. Regions does not have a legal opinion as to whether the clearing house contracts are master netting agreements, and therefore has not offset them on its consolidated balance sheets.

Regions also has enforceable master netting agreements associated with certain securities sold under agreements to repurchase. Refer to Note 11 for additional information regarding the offsetting of those financial instruments.

NOTE 21. FAIR VALUE MEASUREMENTS
Fair value guidance establishes a framework for using fair value to measure assets and liabilities and defines fair value as the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability (an exit price) as opposed to the price that would be paid to acquire the asset or received to assume the liability (an entry price). A fair value measure should reflect the assumptions that market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability, including the assumptions about the risk inherent in a particular valuation technique, the effect of a restriction on the sale or use of an asset and the risk of nonperformance. Required disclosures include stratification of balance sheet amounts measured at fair value based on inputs the Company uses to derive fair value measurements. These strata include:

Level 1 valuations, where the valuation is based on quoted market prices for identical assets or liabilities traded in active markets (which include exchanges and over-the-counter markets with sufficient volume),

Level 2 valuations, where the valuation is based on quoted market prices for similar instruments traded in active markets, quoted prices for identical or similar instruments in markets that are not active and model-based valuation techniques for which all significant assumptions are observable in the market, and

Level 3 valuations, where the valuation is generated from model-based techniques that use significant assumptions not observable in the market, but observable based on Company-specific data. These unobservable assumptions reflect the Company’s own estimates for assumptions that market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability. Valuation techniques typically include option pricing models, discounted cash flow models and similar techniques, but may also include the use of market prices of assets or liabilities that are not directly comparable to the subject asset or liability.
See Note 1 for a description of valuation methodologies for assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring and non-recurring basis. Regions rarely transfers assets and liabilities measured at fair value between Level 1 and Level 2 measurements. There were no such transfers during the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, or 2011. Trading account securities and securities available for sale may be periodically transferred to or from Level 3 valuation based on management’s conclusion regarding the best method of pricing for an individual security. Such transfers are accounted for as if they occur at the beginning of a reporting period.


167

Table of Contents


Beginning in the third quarter of 2013, Regions began to include the value of accrued interest in the estimated fair value of derivatives designated as hedging relationships. Prior period amounts have been adjusted to conform to this presentation. The following tables present assets and liabilities measured at estimated fair value on a recurring basis and non-recurring basis as of December 31:
 
 
2013
 
 
2012
 
Level 1
 
Level 2
 
Level 3
 
Total
Estimated Fair Value
 
 
Level 1
 
Level 2
 
Level 3
 
Total
Estimated Fair Value
 
(In millions)
Recurring fair value measurements
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trading account securities
$
111

 
$

 
$

 
$
111

 
 
$
116

 
$

 
$

 
$
116

Securities available for sale:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
U.S. Treasury securities
$
56

 
$

 
$

 
$
56

 
 
$
52

 
$

 
$

 
$
52

Federal agency securities

 
89

 

 
89

 
 

 
553

 

 
553

Obligations of states and political subdivisions

 
5

 

 
5

 
 

 
9

 

 
9

Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential agency

 
15,677

 

 
15,677

 
 

 
21,277

 

 
21,277

Residential non-agency

 

 
9

 
9

 
 

 

 
13

 
13

Commercial agency

 
935

 

 
935

 
 

 
725

 

 
725

Commercial non-agency

 
1,211

 

 
1,211

 
 

 
1,098

 

 
1,098

Corporate and other debt securities

 
2,825

 
2

 
2,827

 
 

 
2,833

 
2

 
2,835

Equity securities(1)
137

 

 

 
137

 
 
125

 

 

 
125

Total securities available for sale
$
193

 
$
20,742

 
$
11

 
$
20,946

 
 
$
177

 
$
26,495

 
$
15

 
$
26,687

Mortgage loans held for sale
$

 
$
429

 
$

 
$
429

 
 
$

 
$
1,282

 
$

 
$
1,282

Mortgage servicing rights
$

 
$

 
$
297

 
$
297

 
 
$

 
$

 
$
191

 
$
191

Derivative assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate swaps
$

 
$
1,153

 
$

 
$
1,153

 
 
$

 
$
1,861

 
$

 
$
1,861

Interest rate options

 
4

 
5

 
9

 
 

 
3

 
22

 
25

Interest rate futures and forward commitments

 
9

 

 
9

 
 

 
10

 

 
10

Other contracts

 
48

 

 
48

 
 

 
31

 

 
31

Total derivative assets
$

 
$
1,214

 
$
5

 
$
1,219

 
 
$

 
$
1,905

 
$
22

 
$
1,927

Derivative liabilities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate swaps
$

 
$
1,251

 
$

 
$
1,251

 
 
$

 
$
1,776

 
$

 
$
1,776

Interest rate options

 
4

 

 
4

 
 

 
4

 

 
4

Interest rate futures and forward commitments

 
2

 

 
2

 
 

 
13

 

 
13

Other contracts

 
44

 

 
44

 
 

 
32

 

 
32

Total derivative liabilities
$

 
$
1,301

 
$

 
$
1,301

 
 
$

 
$
1,825

 
$

 
$
1,825

Nonrecurring fair value measurements
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Loans held for sale
$

 
$

 
$
596

 
$
596

 
 
$

 
$

 
$
51

 
$
51

Foreclosed property and other real estate

 
49

 
18

 
67

 
 

 
41

 
40

 
81

_________
(1) Excludes Federal Reserve Bank and Federal Home Loan Bank Stock totaling $472 million and $67 million at December 31, 2013 and $484 million and $73 million at December 31, 2012, respectively.




168

Table of Contents


Assets and liabilities in all levels could result in volatile and material price fluctuations. Realized and unrealized gains and losses on Level 3 assets represent only a portion of the risk to market fluctuations in Regions’ consolidated balance sheets. Further, derivatives included in Levels 2 and 3 are used by the Asset and Liability Management Committee of the Company in a holistic approach to managing price fluctuation risks.

The following tables illustrate a rollforward for all assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis using significant unobservable inputs (Level 3) for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011, respectively. The tables do not reflect the change in fair value attributable to any related economic hedges the Company used to mitigate the interest rate risk associated with these assets and liabilities. The net changes in realized gains (losses) included in earnings related to Level 3 assets and liabilities held at December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011 are not material.
 
 
 Year Ended December 31, 2013
 
 
 
Total Realized /
Unrealized
Gains or Losses
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Opening Balance January 1, 2013
 
Included
in
Earnings
 
Included
in Other
Compre-
hensive
Income
(Loss)
 
Purchases
 
Sales
 
Issuances
 
Settlements
 
Transfers
into
Level 3
 
Transfers
out of
Level 3
 
Closing
Balance
December 31, 2013
 
(In millions)
Level 3 Instruments Only
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities available for sale:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential non-agency MBS
$
13

 

  

 

 

 

 
(4
)
 

 

 
$
9

Corporate and other debt securities
2

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
2

Total securities available for sale
$
15

 

  

 

 

 

 
(4
)
 

 

 
$
11

Mortgage servicing rights
$
191

 
22

(a)  

 
84

 

 

 

 

 

 
$
297

Total interest rate options derivatives, net
$
22

 
77

(a)  

 

 

 

 
(94
)
 

 

 
$
5

_________
(a) Included in mortgage income.

169

Table of Contents



 
 Year Ended December 31, 2012
 
Opening
Balance
January 1,
2012
 
Total Realized /
Unrealized
Gains or Losses
 
Purchases
 
Sales
 
Issuances
 
Settlements
 
Transfers
into
Level 3
 
Transfers
out of
Level 3
 
Disposition of Morgan Keegan
 
Closing
Balance
December 31, 2012
 
Included
in Earnings
 
Included
in Other
Compre-
hensive
Income
(Loss)
 
 
(In millions)
 
 
Level 3 Instruments Only
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trading account assets: (c)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Obligations of states and political subdivisions
$
139

 
(3
)
 

 
4

 

 

 
(16
)
 

 

 
(124
)
 
$

Commercial agency MBS
51

 
2

  

 
368

 

 

 
(317
)
 

 

 
(104
)
 

Other securities
1

 
4

  

 
2,248

 

 

 
(2,240
)
 

 

 
(13
)
 

Total trading account assets (d)
$
191

 
3

(a)  

 
2,620

 

 

 
(2,573
)
 

 

 
(241
)
 
$

Securities available for sale:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Obligations of states and political subdivisions
$
20

 

  
(2
)
 

 
(16
)
 

 
(2
)
 

 

 

 
$

Residential non-agency MBS
16

 

  

 

 

 

 
(3
)
 

 

 

 
13

Commercial non-agency MBS

 

  
1

 
104

 

 

 

 

 
(105
)
 

 

Corporate and other debt securities

 

  

 

 

 

 

 
3

 
(1
)
 

 
2

Total securities available for sale
$
36

 

  
(1
)
 
104

 
(16
)
 

 
(5
)
 
3

 
(106
)
 

 
$
15

Mortgage servicing rights
$
182

 
(51
)
(b)  

 
60

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
$
191

Trading account liabilities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial agency MBS
$
5

 

  

 
37

 

 

 

 

 

 
(42
)
 
$

Other securities
2

 

  

 
12

 

 

 
(4
)
 

 

 
(10
)
 

Total trading account liabilities (d)
$
7

 

  

 
49

 

 

 
(4
)
 

 

 
(52
)
 
$

Total interest rate options derivatives, net
$
13

 
240

(b) 

 

 

 

 
(231
)
 

 

 

 
$
22

_________
(a)
Included in discontinued operations, on a net basis.
(b)
Included in mortgage income.
(c)
Income from trading account assets primarily represents gains/(losses) on disposition, which inherently includes commissions on security transactions during the period.
(d)
All amounts related to trading account assets and trading account liabilities are related to Morgan Keegan (see Note 3 for discussion of the sale of Morgan Keegan).


170

Table of Contents


 
Year Ended December 31, 2011
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Opening
Balance
January 1,
2011
 
Total Realized /
Unrealized
Gains or Losses
 
Purchases
 
Sales
 
Issuances
 
Settlements
 
Transfers
into
Level 3
 
Transfers
out of
Level 3
 
Closing
Balance
December 31, 2011
 
Included
in Earnings
 
Included
in Other
Compre-
hensive
Income
(Loss)
 
 
(In millions)
Level 3 Instruments Only
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trading account assets (d):
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Obligations of states and political subdivisions
$
165

 
(17
)
 

 
56

 

 

 
(65
)
 

 

 
$
139

Commercial agency MBS
54

 
8

 

 
1,352

 

 

 
(1,364
)
 
1

 

 
51

Other securities
10

 
18

 

 
8,051

 

 

 
(8,078
)
 

 

 
1

Total trading account assets (e)
$
229

 
9

(a)  

 
9,459

 

 

 
(9,507
)
 
1

 

 
$
191

Securities available for sale:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Obligations of states and political subdivisions
$
17

 

 
6

 

 

 

 
(3
)
 

 

 
$
20

Residential non-agency MBS
22

 
1

 
(1
)
 

 
(3
)
 

 
(3
)
 

 

 
16

Total securities available for sale
$
39

 
1

(c) 
5

 

 
(3
)
 

 
(6
)
 

 

 
$
36

Mortgage servicing rights
$
267

 
(147
)
(b) 

 
62

 

 

 

 

 

 
$
182

Trading account liabilities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial agency MBS
$
6

 

 

 

 

 

 
(1
)
 

 

 
$
5

Other securities
4

 

 

 
(56
)
 

 

 
54

 

 

 
2

Total trading account liabilities (e)
$
10

 

 

 
(56
)
 

 

 
53

 

 

 
$
7

Derivatives, net:

 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

 
 
 
 
 


Interest rate options
$
3

 
123

(b) 

 

 

 

 
(113
)
 

 

 
$
13

Interest rate futures and forward commitments
5

 

 

 

 

 

 
(5
)
 

 

 

Total derivatives, net
$
8

 
123

 

 

 

 

 
(118
)
 

 

 
$
13

_________
(a)
Included in discontinued operations, on a net basis.
(b)
Included in mortgage income.
(c)
Included in other non-interest income.
(d)
Income from trading account assets primarily gains/(losses) on disposition, which inherently includes commissions on security transactions during the period.
(e)
All amounts related to trading account assets and trading account liabilities are related to Morgan Keegan (see Note 3 for discussion of the sale of Morgan Keegan).

The following table presents the fair value adjustments related to non-recurring fair value measurements for the years ended December 31:
 
 
 
2013
 
2012
 
(In millions)
Loans held for sale
 
$
(248
)
 
$
(174
)
Foreclosed property and other real estate
 
(35
)
 
(66
)

171

Table of Contents


The following tables present detailed information regarding assets and liabilities measured at fair value using significant unobservable inputs (Level 3) as of December 31, 2013 and 2012. The tables include the valuation techniques and the significant unobservable inputs utilized. The range of each significant unobservable input as well as the weighted average within the range utilized at December 31, 2013 and 2012 are included. Following the tables are a description of the valuation technique and the sensitivity of the technique to changes in the significant unobservable input.
 
 
December 31, 2013
 
Level 3
Estimated Fair Value at
December 31, 2013
 
Valuation
Technique
 
Unobservable
Input(s)
 
Quantitative Range of
Unobservable Inputs and
(Weighted-Average)
 
(Dollars in millions)
Recurring fair value measurements:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities available for sale:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential non-agency MBS
$9
 
Discounted cash flow
 
Spread to LIBOR
 
5.4% - 49.9% (14.9%)
 
 
 
 
 
Weighted-average prepayment speed (CPR; percentage)
 
8.6% - 13.1% (10.0%)
 
 
 
 
 
Probability of default
 
1.3%
 
 
 
 
 
Loss severity
 
38.4%
Corporate and other debt securities
$2
 
Market comparable
 
Evaluated quote on same issuer/comparable bond
 
99.0% - 100.0% (99.6%)
 
 
 
 
 
Comparability adjustments
 
0.96%
Mortgage servicing rights(a)
$297
 
Discounted cash flow
 
Weighted-average prepayment speed (CPR; percentage)
 
6.9% - 24.8% (8.2%)
 
 
 
 
 
Option-adjusted spread (percentage)
 
7.0% - 23.6% (9.0%)
Derivative assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate options
$5
 
Discounted cash flow
 
Weighted-average prepayment speed (CPR; percentage)
 
6.9% - 24.8% (8.2%)
 
 
 
 
 
Option-adjusted spread (percentage)
 
7.0% - 23.6% (9.0%)
 
 
 
 
 
Pull-through
 
10.8% - 99.7% (32.2%)
Nonrecurring fair value measurements:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Loans held for sale
$61
 
Commercial loans held for sale are valued based on multiple data points, including discount to appraised value of collateral based on recent market activity for sales of similar loans
 
Appraisal comparability adjustment (discount)
 
1.0% - 99.0% (30.6%)
 
$535
 
Residential first mortgage loans held for sale not carried at fair value on a recurring basis are valued based on estimated third-party valuations utilizing recent sales data for similar transactions
 
Estimated third-party valuations utilizing available sales data for similar transactions (discount to par)
 
17.0% - 26.0% (23.5%)
Foreclosed property and other real estate
$18
 
 Discount to appraised value of property based on recent market activity for sales of similar properties
 
 Appraisal comparability adjustment (discount)
 
30.0% - 100.0% (32.8%)
_________
(a) See Note 7 for additional disclosures related to assumptions used in the fair value calculation for mortgage servicing rights.



172

Table of Contents


 
December 31, 2012
 
Level 3
Estimated Fair Value at
December 31, 2012
 
Valuation
Technique
 
Unobservable
Input(s)
 
Quantitative Range of
Unobservable Inputs and
(Weighted-Average)
 
(Dollars in millions)
Recurring fair value measurements:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities available for sale:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential non-agency MBS
$13
 
Discounted cash flow
 
Spread to LIBOR
 
5.4% - 69.9% (16.9%)
 
 
 
 
 
Weighted-average prepayment speed (CPR; percentage)
 
7.6% - 30.3% (12.2%)
 
 
 
 
 
Probability of default
 
0.2% - 1.2% (1.0%)
 
 
 
 
 
Loss severity
 
39.3% - 100.0% (48.1%)
Corporate and other debt securities
$2
 
Market comparable
 
Evaluated quote on same issuer/comparable bond
 
99.1% - 100.0% (99.6%)
 
 
 
 
 
Comparability adjustments
 
1.0%
Mortgage servicing rights(a)
$191
 
Discounted cash flow
 
Weighted-average prepayment speed (CPR; percentage)
 
4.7% - 25.9% (17.6%)
 
 
 
 
 
Option-adjusted spread (percentage)
 
1.0% - 23.6% (7.5%)
Derivative assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate options
$22
 
Discounted cash flow
 
Weighted-average prepayment speed (CPR; percentage)
 
4.7% - 25.9% (17.6%)
 
 
 
 
 
Option-adjusted spread (percentage)
 
1.0% - 23.6% (7.5%)
 
 
 
 
 
Pull-through
 
55.7% - 98.8% (76.9%)
Nonrecurring fair value measurements:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Loans held for sale
$51
 
Commercial loans held for sale utilize multiple data points, including discount to appraised value of collateral based on recent market activity for sales of similar loans
 
Appraisal comparability adjustment (discount)
 
8.0% - 94.0% (46.3%)
Foreclosed property and other real estate
$40
 
 Discount to appraised value of property based on recent market activity for sales of similar properties
 
 Appraisal comparability adjustment (discount)
 
35.0% - 100.0% (36.2%)
_________
(a) See Note 7 for additional disclosures related to assumptions used in the fair value calculation for mortgage servicing rights.

RECURRING FAIR VALUE MEASUREMENTS USING SIGNIFICANT UNOBSERVABLE INPUTS
Securities available for sale
Mortgage-backed securities: residential non-agency—The fair value reported in this category relates to retained interests in legacy securitizations. Significant unobservable inputs include the spread to LIBOR, constant prepayment rate, probability of default, and loss severity in the event of default. Significant increases in any of these inputs in isolation would result in significantly lower fair value measurement. Generally, a change in the assumption used for the probability of default is accompanied by a directionally similar change in the assumption used for loss severity and a directionally opposite change in the assumption used for prepayment rates.
Corporate and other debt securities—Significant unobservable inputs include evaluated quotes on comparable bonds for the same issuer and management-determined comparability adjustments. Changes in the evaluated quote on comparable bonds would result in a directionally similar change in the fair value of the corporate and other debt securities.

173

Table of Contents


Mortgage Servicing Rights
The significant unobservable inputs used in the fair value measurement of mortgage servicing rights ("MSR") are option adjusted spreads (“OAS”) and prepayment speed. This method requires generating cash flow projections over multiple interest rate scenarios and discounting those cash flows at a risk adjusted rate. Additionally, the impact of prepayments and changes in the OAS are based on a variety of underlying inputs such as servicing costs. Increases or decreases to the underlying cash flow inputs will have a corresponding impact on the value of the MSR asset. The net change in unrealized gains (losses) included in earnings related to MSRs held at period end are disclosed as the changes in valuation inputs or assumptions included in the MSR rollforward table in Note 7. See Note 7 for these amounts and additional disclosures related to assumptions used in the fair value calculation for MSRs.
Derivative assets
Interest rate options—These instruments are interest rate lock agreements made in the normal course of originating residential mortgage loans. Significant unobservable inputs in the fair value measurement are OAS, prepayment speeds, and pull-through. The impact of OAS and prepayment speed inputs in the valuation of these derivative instruments are consistent with the MSR discussion above. Pull-through is an estimate of the number of interest rate lock commitments that will ultimately become funded loans. Increases or decreases in the pull-through assumption will have a corresponding impact on the value of these derivative assets.
NON-RECURRING FAIR VALUE MEASUREMENTS USING SIGNIFICANT UNOBSERVABLE INPUTS
Loans held for sale
Commercial loans held for sale are valued based on multiple data points indicating the fair value for each loan. The primary data point for loans held for sale is a discount to the appraised value of the underlying collateral, which considers the return required by potential buyers of the loans. Management establishes this discount or comparability adjustment based on recent sales of loans secured by similar property types. As liquidity in the market increases or decreases, the comparability adjustment and the resulting asset valuation are impacted.
Residential first mortgage loans transferred to held for sale were valued based on estimated third-party valuations utilizing recent sales data from similar transactions. Broker opinion statements were also obtained as additional evidence to support the third-party valuations. The discounts taken were intended to represent the perspective of a market participant, considering among other things, required investor returns which include liquidity discounts reflected in similar bulk transactions.
Foreclosed property and other real estate
Foreclosed property and other real estate are valued based on offered quotes as available. If no sales contract is pending for a specific property, management establishes a comparability adjustment to the appraised value based on historical activity considering proceeds for properties sold versus the corresponding appraised value. Increases or decreases in realization for properties sold impact the comparability adjustment for similar assets remaining on the balance sheet.

FAIR VALUE OPTION
Regions has elected the fair value option for FNMA and FHLMC eligible fifteen and thirty-year residential mortgage loans originated with the intent to sell. During the fourth quarter of 2012, Regions began the process of retaining ten and fifteen-year residential mortgage loans on its balance sheet. These elections allow for a more effective offset of the changes in fair values of the loans and the derivative instruments used to economically hedge them without the burden of complying with the requirements for hedge accounting. Regions has not elected the fair value option for other loans held for sale primarily because they are not economically hedged using derivative instruments. Fair values of mortgage loans held for sale are based on traded market prices of similar assets where available and/or discounted cash flows at market interest rates, adjusted for securitization activities that include servicing values and market conditions, and are recorded in loans held for sale in the consolidated balance sheets.

174

Table of Contents


The following table summarizes the difference between the aggregate fair value and the aggregate unpaid principal balance for mortgage loans held for sale measured at fair value at December 31:
 
 
2013
 
2012
 
Aggregate
Fair Value
 
Aggregate
Unpaid
Principal
 
Aggregate Fair
Value Less
Aggregate
Unpaid
Principal
 
Aggregate
Fair Value
 
Aggregate
Unpaid
Principal
 
Aggregate Fair
Value Less
Aggregate
Unpaid
Principal
 
(In millions)
Mortgage loans held for sale, at fair value
$
429

 
$
424

 
$
5

 
$
1,282

 
$
1,235

 
$
47

Interest income on mortgage loans held for sale is recognized based on contractual rates and is reflected in interest income on loans held for sale in the consolidated statements of operations. The following table details net gains resulting from changes in fair value of these loans which were recorded in mortgage income in the consolidated statements of operations for the years presented. These changes in fair value are mostly offset by economic hedging activities. An immaterial portion of these amounts was attributable to changes in instrument-specific credit risk.
 
 
 
2013
 
2012
 
 
(In millions)
Net gains (losses) resulting from changes in fair value
 
$
(42
)
 
$
18


The carrying amounts and estimated fair values, as well as the level within the fair value hierarchy, of the Company’s financial instruments as of December 31, 2013 are as follows:
 
 
2013
 
Carrying
Amount
 
Estimated
Fair
Value(1)
 
Level 1
 
Level 2
 
Level 3
 
(In millions)
Financial assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash and cash equivalents
$
5,273

 
$
5,273

 
$
5,273

 
$

 
$

Trading account securities
111

 
111

 
111

 

 

Securities held to maturity
2,353

 
2,307

 
1

 
2,306

 

Securities available for sale
21,485

 
21,485

 
193

 
21,281

 
11

Loans held for sale
1,055

 
1,055

 

 
429

 
626

Loans (excluding leases), net of unearned income and allowance for loan losses(2)(3)
71,594

 
66,167

 

 

 
66,167

Other interest-earning assets
86

 
86

 

 
86

 

Derivative assets
1,219

 
1,219

 

 
1,214

 
5

Financial liabilities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Derivative liabilities
1,301

 
1,301

 

 
1,301

 

Deposits
92,453

 
92,460

 

 
92,460

 

Short-term borrowings
2,182

 
2,182

 

 
2,182

 

Long-term borrowings
4,830

 
5,085

 

 

 
5,085

Loan commitments and letters of credit
117

 
621

 

 

 
621

Indemnification obligation
260

 
243

 

 

 
243


175

Table of Contents


_________
(1)
Estimated fair values are consistent with an exit price concept. The assumptions used to estimate the fair values are intended to approximate those that a market participant would use in a hypothetical orderly transaction. In estimating fair value, the Company makes adjustments for interest rates, market liquidity and credit spreads as appropriate.
(2)
The estimated fair value of portfolio loans assumes sale of the loans to a third-party financial investor. Accordingly, the value to the Company if the loans were held to maturity is not reflected in the fair value estimate. In the current whole loan market, financial investors are generally requiring a higher rate of return than the return inherent in loans if held to maturity. The fair value discount at December 31, 2013 was $5.4 billion or 7.6 percent.
(3)
Excluded from this table is the lease carrying amount of $1.7 billion at December 31, 2013.

The carrying amounts and estimated fair values, as well as the level within the fair value hierarchy, of the Company's financial instruments as of December 31, 2012 are as follows:
 
 
2012
 
Carrying
Amount
 
Estimated
Fair
Value(1)
 
Level 1
 
Level 2
 
Level 3
 
(In millions)
Financial assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash and cash equivalents
$
5,489

 
$
5,489

 
$
5,489

 
$

 
$

Trading account securities
116

 
116

 
116

 

 

Securities held to maturity
10

 
11

 
2

 
9

 

Securities available for sale
27,244

 
27,244

 
177

 
27,052

 
15

Loans held for sale
1,383

 
1,383

 

 
1,282

 
101

Loans (excluding leases), net of unearned income and allowance for loan losses(2)(3)
70,574

 
63,961

 

 

 
63,961

Other interest-earning assets
900

 
900

 

 
900

 

Derivative assets
1,915

 
1,915

 

 
1,893

 
22

Financial liabilities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Derivative liabilities
1,825

 
1,825

 

 
1,825

 

Deposits
95,474

 
95,528

 

 
95,528

 

Short-term borrowings
1,574

 
1,574

 

 
1,574

 

Long-term borrowings
5,861

 
6,138

 
1,037

 

 
5,101

Loan commitments and letters of credit
121

 
667

 

 

 
667

Indemnification obligation
345

 
329

 

 

 
329

_________
(1)
Estimated fair values are consistent with an exit price concept. The assumptions used to estimate the fair values are intended to approximate those that a market participant would use in a hypothetical orderly transaction. In estimating fair value, the Company makes adjustments for interest rates, market liquidity and credit spreads as appropriate.
(2)
The estimated fair value of portfolio loans assumes sale of the loans to a third-party financial investor. Accordingly, the value to the Company if the loans were held to maturity is not reflected in the fair value estimate. In the current whole loan market, financial investors are generally requiring a higher rate of return than the return inherent in loans if held to maturity. The fair value discount at December 31, 2012 was $6.6 billion or 9.4 percent.
(3)
Excluded from this table is the lease carrying amount of $1.5 billion at December 31, 2012.


176

Table of Contents


NOTE 22. BUSINESS SEGMENT INFORMATION

Each of Regions’ reportable segments is a strategic business unit that serves specific needs of Regions’ customers based on the products and services provided. The segments are based on the manner in which management views the financial performance of the business. The Company has three reportable segments: Business Services, Consumer Services and Wealth Management, with the remainder split between Discontinued Operations and Other. During the third quarter of 2012, Regions reorganized its internal management structure and, accordingly, its segment reporting structure. Historically, Regions’ primary business segment was Banking/Treasury, representing the Company’s banking network (including the Consumer and Commercial Banking function along with the Treasury function). Other segments included Investment Banking/Brokerage/Trust and Insurance. During the second quarter of 2012, Regions consummated the sale of Morgan Keegan (the primary component of Investment Banking/Brokerage/Trust). Shortly thereafter, Regions announced organizational changes to better integrate and execute the Company’s strategic priorities across all business groups and geographies. As a result, Regions revised its reportable segments. During the current year, minor reclassifications were made among the segments to more appropriately present management's current view of the segments. Prior periods’ information has been reclassified to conform to the current periods’ presentation.

The Business Services segment represents the Company’s commercial banking functions including commercial and industrial, commercial real estate and investor real estate lending. This segment also includes equipment lease financing. Business Services customers include corporate, middle market, small business and commercial real estate developers and investors. Corresponding deposit products related to these types of customers are included in this segment.

The Consumer Services segment represents the Company’s branch network, including consumer banking products and services related to residential first mortgages, home equity lines and loans, indirect loans, consumer credit cards and other consumer loans, as well as the corresponding deposit relationships. These services are also provided through alternative channels such as the internet and telephone banking.

The Wealth Management segment offers individuals, businesses, governmental institutions and non-profit entities a wide range of solutions to help protect, grow and transfer wealth. Offerings include credit related products, trust and investment management, asset management, retirement and savings solutions, estate planning and commercial insurance products.

Discontinued Operations includes all brokerage and investment activities associated with Morgan Keegan. As discussed in Note 3, Regions closed the sale of Morgan Keegan and related entities on April 2, 2012.

Other includes the Company’s Treasury function, the securities portfolio, wholesale funding activities, interest rate risk management activities and other corporate functions that are not related to a strategic business unit. Also within Other are certain reconciling items in order to translate the segment results that are based on management accounting practices into consolidated results. Management accounting practices utilized by Regions as the basis of presentation for segment results include the following:

Net interest income is presented based upon a funds transfer pricing (“FTP”) approach, for which market-based funding charges/credits are assigned within the segments. By allocating a cost or a credit to each product based on the FTP framework, management is able to more effectively measure the net interest margin contribution of its assets/liabilities by segment. The summation of the interest income/expense and FTP charges/credits for each segment is its designated net interest income. The variance between the Company’s cumulative FTP charges and cumulative FTP credits is offset in Other.
Provision for loan losses is allocated to each segment based on actual net charge-offs that have been recognized by the segment. The difference between the consolidated provision for loan losses and the segments’ net charge-offs is reflected in Other.
Income tax expense (benefit) is calculated for Business Services, Consumer Services and Wealth Management based on a consistent federal and state statutory rate. Discontinued Operations reflects the actual income tax expense (benefit) of its results. Any difference between the Company’s consolidated income tax expense (benefit) and the segments’ calculated amounts is reflected in Other.
Management reporting allocations of certain expenses are made in order to analyze the financial performance of the segments. These allocations consist of operational and overhead cost pools and are intended to represent the total costs to support a segment.

177

Table of Contents


The following tables present financial information for each reportable segment for the year ended December 31:
 
 
2013
 
 
Business
Services
 
Consumer
Services
 
Wealth
Management
 
Other
 
Continuing
Operations
 
Discontinued
Operations
 
Consolidated
 
 
(In millions)
Net interest income (loss)
 
$
1,867

 
$
1,840

 
$
176

 
$
(621
)
 
$
3,262

 
$

 
$
3,262

Provision (credit) for loan losses
 
265

 
430

 
21

 
(578
)
 
138

 

 
138

Non-interest income
 
521

 
1,081

 
378

 
39

 
2,019

 

 
2,019

Non-interest expense
 
986

 
1,933

 
444

 
193

 
3,556

 
24

 
3,580

Income (loss) before income taxes
 
1,137

 
558

 
89

 
(197
)
 
1,587

 
(24
)
 
1,563

Income tax expense (benefit)
 
432

 
212

 
34

 
(226
)
 
452

 
(11
)
 
441

Net income (loss)
 
$
705

 
$
346

 
$
55

 
$
29

 
$
1,135

 
$
(13
)
 
$
1,122

Average assets
 
$
50,020

 
$
29,004

 
$
3,024

 
$
35,757

 
$
117,805

 
$

 
$
117,805

 
 
2012
 
 
Business
Services
 
Consumer
Services
 
Wealth
Management
 
Other
 
Continuing
Operations
 
Discontinued
Operations
 
Consolidated
 
 
(In millions)
Net interest income (loss)
 
$
2,008

 
$
1,850

 
$
191

 
$
(749
)
 
$
3,300

 
$
7

 
$
3,307

Provision (credit) for loan losses
 
557

 
454

 
29

 
(827
)
 
213

 

 
213

Non-interest income
 
478

 
1,217

 
338

 
67

 
2,100

 
264

 
2,364

Non-interest expense
 
918

 
1,999

 
424

 
185

 
3,526

 
370

 
3,896

Income (loss) before income taxes
 
1,011

 
614

 
76

 
(40
)
 
1,661

 
(99
)
 
1,562

Income tax expense (benefit)
 
384

 
233

 
29

 
(164
)
 
482

 
(40
)
 
442

Net income (loss)
 
$
627

 
$
381

 
$
47

 
$
124

 
$
1,179

 
$
(59
)
 
$
1,120

Average assets
 
$
48,799

 
$
29,712

 
$
3,394

 
$
40,277

 
$
122,182

 
$
713

 
$
122,895

 
 
2011
 
 
Business
Services
 
Consumer
Services
 
Wealth
Management
 
Other
 
Continuing
Operations
 
Discontinued
Operations
 
Consolidated
 
 
(In millions)
Net interest income (loss)
 
$
1,976

 
$
1,791

 
$
234

 
$
(591
)
 
$
3,410

 
$
31

 
$
3,441

Provision (credit) for loan losses
 
1,325

 
567

 
77

 
(439
)
 
1,530

 

 
1,530

Non-interest income
 
519

 
1,209

 
345

 
70

 
2,143

 
995

 
3,138

Non-interest expense
 
1,110

 
1,963

 
418

 
118

 
3,609

 
942

 
4,551

Goodwill impairment
 

 

 
253

 

 
253

 
492

 
745

Income (loss) before income taxes
 
60

 
470

 
(169
)
 
(200
)
 
161

 
(408
)
 
(247
)
Income tax expense (benefit)
 
23

 
179

 
32

 
(262
)
 
(28
)
 
(4
)
 
(32
)
Net income (loss)
 
$
37

 
$
291

 
$
(201
)
 
$
62

 
$
189

 
$
(404
)
 
$
(215
)
Average assets
 
$
51,058

 
$
30,255

 
$
4,310

 
$
41,096

 
$
126,719

 
$
3,254

 
$
129,973



178

Table of Contents


NOTE 23. COMMITMENTS, CONTINGENCIES AND GUARANTEES
COMMERCIAL COMMITMENTS
Regions issues off-balance sheet financial instruments in connection with lending activities. The credit risk associated with these instruments is essentially the same as that involved in extending loans to customers and is subject to Regions’ normal credit approval policies and procedures. Regions measures inherent risk associated with these instruments by recording a reserve for unfunded commitments based on an assessment of the likelihood that the guarantee will be funded and the creditworthiness of the customer or counterparty. Collateral is obtained based on management’s assessment of the creditworthiness of the customer.
Credit risk associated with these instruments as of December 31 is represented by the contractual amounts indicated in the following table:
 
 
2013
 
2012
 
(In millions)
Unused commitments to extend credit
$
41,885

 
$
38,160

Standby letters of credit
1,629

 
1,872

Commercial letters of credit
36

 
27

Liabilities associated with standby letters of credit
37

 
37

Assets associated with standby letters of credit
38

 
37

Reserve for unfunded credit commitments
78

 
83

Unused commitments to extend credit—To accommodate the financial needs of its customers, Regions makes commitments under various terms to lend funds to consumers, businesses and other entities. These commitments include (among others) credit card and other revolving credit agreements, term loan commitments and short-term borrowing agreements. Many of these loan commitments have fixed expiration dates or other termination clauses and may require payment of a fee. Since many of these commitments are expected to expire without being funded, the total commitment amounts do not necessarily represent future liquidity requirements.
Standby letters of credit—Standby letters of credit are also issued to customers which commit Regions to make payments on behalf of customers if certain specified future events occur. Regions has recourse against the customer for any amount required to be paid to a third party under a standby letter of credit. Historically, a large percentage of standby letters of credit expired without being funded. The contractual amount of standby letters of credit represents the maximum potential amount of future payments Regions could be required to make and represents Regions’ maximum credit risk.
Commercial letters of credit—Commercial letters of credit are issued to facilitate foreign or domestic trade transactions for customers. As a general rule, drafts will be drawn when the goods underlying the transaction are in transit.
LEASE COMMITMENTS
Regions and its subsidiaries lease land, premises and equipment under cancelable and non-cancelable leases, some of which contain renewal options under various terms. The leased properties are used primarily for banking purposes. Total rental expense on operating leases for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011 was $165 million, $170 million and $197 million, respectively.

The approximate future minimum rental commitments as of December 31, 2013, for all non-cancelable leases with initial or remaining terms of one year or more are shown in the following table. Included in these amounts are all renewal options reasonably assured of being exercised.
 
 
Premises
 
Equipment
 
Total
 
(In millions)
2014
$
106

 
$
34

 
$
140

2015
102

 
28

 
130

2016
96

 
15

 
111

2017
84

 
7

 
91

2018
72

 
2

 
74

Thereafter
363

 
1

 
364

 
$
823

 
$
87

 
$
910



179

Table of Contents


LEGAL CONTINGENCIES

Regions, its affiliates and subsidiaries, and current and former officers, directors and employees, are sometimes collectively referred to as Regions and certain Related Persons. Regions and its subsidiaries are subject to loss contingencies related to litigation, claims, investigations and legal and administrative cases and proceedings arising in the ordinary course of business. Regions evaluates these contingencies based on information currently available, including advice of counsel. Regions establishes accruals for those matters when a loss contingency is considered probable and the related amount is reasonably estimable. Any accruals are periodically reviewed and may be adjusted as circumstances change. Some of Regions' exposure with respect to loss contingencies may be offset by applicable insurance coverage. In determining the amounts of any accruals or estimates of possible loss contingencies however, Regions does not take into account the availability of insurance coverage.

In addition, as previously discussed, Regions has agreed to indemnify Raymond James for all legal matters resulting from pre-closing activities in conjunction with the sale of Morgan Keegan and recorded an indemnification obligation at fair value in the second quarter of 2012. The indemnification obligation had a carrying amount of approximately $260 million and an estimated fair value of approximately $243 million as of December 31, 2013 (see Note 21).

When it is practicable, Regions estimates possible loss contingencies, whether or not there is an accrued probable loss. When Regions is able to estimate such possible losses, and when it is reasonably possible Regions could incur losses, in excess of amounts accrued, Regions is required to make a disclosure of the aggregate estimation. Regions currently estimates that it is reasonably possible that it may experience losses in excess of what Regions has accrued in an aggregate amount up to approximately $100 million as of December 31, 2013, with it also being reasonably possible that Regions could incur no losses in excess of amounts accrued. However, as available information changes, the matters for which Regions is able to estimate, as well as the estimates themselves will be adjusted accordingly. The legal contingencies included in the reasonably possible estimate include those that are subject to the indemnification agreement with Raymond James.
Assessments of litigation and claims exposures are difficult due to many factors that involve inherent unpredictability. Those factors include the following: the varying stages of the proceedings, particularly in the early stages; unspecified, unsupported, or uncertain damages; damages other than compensatory such as punitive damages; a matter presenting meaningful legal uncertainties, including novel issues of law; multiple defendants and jurisdictions; whether discovery has begun or not or discovery is not complete; whether or not meaningful settlement discussions have commenced; and whether the claim involves a class action and if so, how the class is defined. There are numerous factors that result in a greater degree of complexity in class-action lawsuits as compared to other types of litigation. Due to the many intricacies involved in class-action lawsuits at the early stages of these matters, obtaining clarity on a reasonable estimate is difficult which may call into question its reliability. As a result of some of these factors, Regions may be unable to estimate reasonably possible losses with respect to some of the matters disclosed below. The aggregated estimated amount provided above therefore may not include an estimate for every matter disclosed below.
Beginning in December 2007, Regions and certain of its affiliates were named in class-action lawsuits filed in federal and state courts on behalf of investors who purchased shares of certain Regions Morgan Keegan Select Funds (the “Funds”) and stockholders of Regions. These cases have been consolidated into class-actions and stockholder derivative actions for the open-end and closed-end Funds. The Funds were formerly managed by Regions Investment Management, Inc. (“Regions Investment Management”). Regions Investment Management no longer manages these Funds, which were transferred to Hyperion Brookfield Asset Management (“Hyperion”) in 2008. Certain of the Funds have since been terminated by Hyperion. The complaints contain various allegations, including claims that the Funds and the defendants misrepresented or failed to disclose material facts relating to the activities of the Funds. Plaintiffs have requested equitable relief and unspecified monetary damages. These cases are in various stages and no classes have been certified. Settlement discussions are ongoing in certain cases, and the Court has granted final approval of a settlement in the closed-end Funds class-action and shareholder derivative case. Certain of the shareholders in these Funds and other interested parties have entered into arbitration proceedings and individual civil claims, in lieu of participating in the class actions. These lawsuits and proceedings are subject to the indemnification agreement with Raymond James discussed above.
In October 2010, a purported class-action lawsuit was filed by Regions’ stockholders in the U.S. District Court for the Northern District of Alabama against Regions and certain former officers of Regions ("the 2010 Claim"). The 2010 Claim alleges violations of the federal securities laws, including allegations that statements that were materially false and misleading were included in filings made with the Securities and Exchange Commission ("SEC"). The plaintiffs have requested equitable relief and unspecified monetary damages. On June 7, 2011, the trial court denied Regions’ motion to dismiss the 2010 Claim. On June 14, 2012, the trial court granted class certification. The Eleventh Circuit Court of Appeals is reviewing the trial court’s grant of class-action certification. The case is now stayed pending that review.
In December 2009, Regions and certain Related Persons were named in a consolidated shareholder derivative action filed in Jefferson County, Alabama. The complaint alleges mismanagement, waste of corporate assets, breach of fiduciary duty and unjust enrichment relating to bonuses and other benefits received by executive management. Plaintiffs requested equitable relief

180

Table of Contents


and unspecified monetary damages. The case was dismissed with prejudice on December 6, 2012. Plaintiffs' motion to alter, amend or vacate that judgment was denied on March 25, 2013. Plaintiffs appealed the order of dismissal to the Alabama Supreme Court on April 18, 2013. The dismissal was affirmed by the Alabama Supreme Court on February 14, 2014.
In July 2006, Morgan Keegan and a former Morgan Keegan analyst were named as defendants in a lawsuit filed by a Canadian insurance and financial services company and its American subsidiary in the Circuit Court of Morris County, New Jersey. Plaintiffs made claims under a civil Racketeer Influenced and Corrupt Organizations (“RICO”) statute, for commercial disparagement, tortious interference with contractual relationships, tortious interference with prospective economic advantage and common law conspiracy. Plaintiffs allege that defendants engaged in a multi-year conspiracy to publish and disseminate false and defamatory information about plaintiffs to improperly drive down plaintiffs’ stock price, so that others could profit from short positions. Plaintiffs allege that defendants’ actions damaged their reputations and harmed their business relationships. Plaintiffs allege a number of categories of damages they sustained, including lost insurance business, lost financings and increased financing costs, increased audit fees and directors and officers insurance premiums and lost acquisitions, and have requested monetary damages. On September 12, 2012, the trial court dismissed the case with prejudice. Plaintiffs have filed an appeal. This matter is subject to the indemnification agreement with Raymond James.
The SEC and states of Missouri and Texas are investigating alleged securities law violations by Morgan Keegan in the underwriting and sale of certain municipal bonds. An enforcement action was brought by the Missouri Secretary of State on April 4, 2013, seeking monetary penalties and other relief that was dismissed and refiled on November 21, 2013. A civil action was brought by institutional investors of the bonds on March 19, 2012, seeking a return of their investment and unspecified compensatory and punitive damages. A class action was brought on behalf of retail purchasers of the bonds on September 4, 2012, seeking unspecified compensatory and punitive damages. Several claims by individual investors and investor groups are also pending. These actions are in the early stages. These matters are also subject to the indemnification agreement with Raymond James.
Regions is involved in information-gathering requests and investigations (both formal and informal) as well as reviews, examinations and proceedings by various governmental regulatory agencies, law enforcement authorities and self-regulatory bodies regarding Regions’ business, business practices and policies as well as the conduct of persons with whom it does business. Additional inquiries will arise from time to time. In connection with those inquiries, Regions receives document requests, subpoenas and other requests for information. The inquiries, including those described below, could develop into administrative, civil or criminal proceedings or enforcement actions that could result in consequences that have a material effect on Regions' consolidated financial position, results of operations or cash flows as a whole. Such consequences could include adverse judgments, findings, settlements, penalties, fines, orders, injunctions, restitution, or alterations in our business practices, and could result in additional expenses and collateral costs, including reputational damage.
During the fourth quarter of 2013, Regions recorded a non-tax deductible charge of $58 million related to previously disclosed inquiries from government authorities concerning matters from 2009. Regions is in discussions with its banking supervisors to resolve their inquiries on these matters. In addition, the Board of Directors is conducting investigations regarding certain of the matters raised in these inquiries.
In 2013, Regions received a subpoena from the Office of Inspector General of the U.S. Department of Housing and Urban Development as part of an industry-wide investigation regarding loan origination and servicing practices. Many institutions have settled these matters on terms that included large monetary penalties, including, in some cases, civil money penalties under applicable banking laws. The investigation concerning Regions' practices is in the very early stages, and the Company cannot predict the ultimate outcome, however it is possible that this investigation may result in Regions payment of a monetary penalty which may adversely affect results of operations. Regions is cooperating with this inquiry.
While the final outcome of litigation and claims exposures or of any inquiries is inherently unpredictable, management is currently of the opinion that the outcome of pending and threatened litigation and inquiries will not have a material effect on Regions’ business, consolidated financial position, results of operations or cash flows as a whole. However, in the event of unexpected future developments, it is reasonably possible that an adverse outcome in any of the matters discussed above could be material to Regions’ business, consolidated financial position, results of operations or cash flows for any particular reporting period of occurrence.

181

Table of Contents


GUARANTEES
INDEMNIFICATION OBLIGATION
As discussed in Note 3, on April 2, 2012 (“Closing Date”), Regions closed the sale of Morgan Keegan and related affiliates to Raymond James. In connection with the sale, Regions agreed to indemnify Raymond James for all legal matters related to pre-closing activities, including matters filed subsequent to the Closing Date that relate to actions that occurred prior to closing. Losses under the indemnification include legal and other expenses, such as costs for judgments, settlements and awards associated with the defense and resolution of the indemnified matters. The maximum potential amount of future payments that Regions could be required to make under the indemnification is indeterminable due to the indefinite term of some of the obligations. However, Regions expects the majority of ongoing legal matters to be resolved within approximately two years.

As of the Closing Date, the fair value of the indemnification obligation, which includes defense costs and unasserted claims, was approximately $385 million, of which approximately $256 million was recognized as a reduction to the gain on sale of Morgan Keegan. The fair value was determined through the use of a present value calculation that takes into account the future cash flows that a market participant would expect to receive from holding the indemnification liability as an asset. Regions performed a probability-weighted cash flow analysis and discounted the result at a credit-adjusted risk free rate. The fair value of the indemnification liability includes amounts that Regions had previously determined meet the definition of probable and reasonably estimable. Adjustments to the indemnification obligation are recorded within professional and legal expenses within discontinued operations (see Note 3). As of December 31, 2013, the carrying value of the indemnification obligation was approximately $260 million.
VISA INDEMNIFICATION
As a member of the Visa USA network, Regions, along with other members, indemnified Visa USA against litigation. On October 3, 2007, Visa USA was restructured and acquired several Visa affiliates. In conjunction with this restructuring, Regions' indemnification of Visa USA was modified to cover specific litigation (“covered litigation”).
A portion of Visa's proceeds from its initial public offering ("IPO") was escrowed to fund the covered litigation. During the first quarter of 2013, Visa made a settlement payment related to the covered litigation which reduced Regions' share of the escrow account to approximately zero compared to $22 million at December 31, 2012. Regions made a corresponding adjustment to reduce its liability to approximately zero compared to $22 million at December 31, 2012. The balances related to the escrow and the corresponding liability remain approximately zero as of December 31, 2013. To the extent that the amount available under the escrow arrangement, or subsequent fundings of the escrow account via reductions in the class B share conversion ratio, is insufficient to fully resolve the covered litigation, Visa is expected to enforce the indemnification obligations of Visa USA's members for any excess amount. At this time, Regions has concluded that it is not probable that covered litigation exposure will exceed the class B share value.


182

Table of Contents


NOTE 24. PARENT COMPANY ONLY FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Presented below are condensed financial statements of Regions Financial Corporation:
Balance Sheets
 
 
 
December 31
 
 
2013
 
2012
 
 
(In millions)
Assets
 
 
 
 
Interest-bearing deposits in other banks
 
$
1,222

 
$
857

Loans to subsidiaries
 
11

 
1

Securities available for sale
 
20

 
29

Premises and equipment, net
 
22

 
23

Investments in subsidiaries:
 
 
 
 
Banks
 
16,356

 
16,955

Non-banks
 
265

 
246

 
 
16,621

 
17,201

Other assets
 
340

 
484

Total assets
 
$
18,236

 
$
18,595

Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity
 
 
 
 
Short-term borrowings
 
$

 
$
70

Long-term borrowings
 
2,161

 
2,567

Other liabilities
 
307

 
459

Total liabilities
 
2,468

 
3,096

Stockholders’ equity:
 
 
 
 
Preferred stock
 
450

 
482

Common stock
 
14

 
15

Additional paid-in capital
 
19,216

 
19,652

Retained earnings (deficit)
 
(2,216
)
 
(3,338
)
Treasury stock, at cost
 
(1,377
)
 
(1,377
)
Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss), net
 
(319
)
 
65

Total stockholders’ equity
 
15,768

 
15,499

Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity
 
$
18,236

 
$
18,595


183

Table of Contents


Statements of Operations
 
 
 
Year Ended December 31
 
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
 
(In millions)
Income:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Dividends received from subsidiaries
 
$
1,520

 
$
950

 
$

Service fees from subsidiaries
 
160

 
141

 
129

Interest from subsidiaries
 
3

 
4

 
10

Other
 
1

 
2

 
(5
)
 
 
1,684

 
1,097

 
134

Expenses:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Salaries and employee benefits
 
180

 
154

 
133

Interest
 
104

 
165

 
173

Net occupancy expense
 
10

 
10

 
9

Furniture and equipment expense
 
2

 
3

 
5

Professional and legal fees
 
21

 
17

 
20

Other
 
143

 
85

 
64

 
 
460

 
434

 
404

Income (loss) before income taxes and equity in undistributed earnings (loss) of subsidiaries
 
1,224

 
663

 
(270
)
Income tax benefit
 
(117
)
 
(122
)
 
(121
)
Income (loss) from continuing operations
 
1,341

 
785

 
(149
)
Discontinued operations:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Loss from discontinued operations before income taxes
 
(24
)
 
(114
)
 
(6
)
Income tax benefit
 
(11
)
 
(38
)
 

Loss from discontinued operations, net of tax
 
(13
)
 
(76
)
 
(6
)
Income (loss) before equity in undistributed earnings (loss) of subsidiaries and preferred dividends
 
1,328

 
709

 
(155
)
Equity in undistributed earnings (loss) of subsidiaries:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Banks
 
(221
)
 
387

 
317

Non-banks
 
15

 
24

 
(377
)
 
 
(206
)
 
411

 
(60
)
Net income (loss)
 
1,122

 
1,120

 
(215
)
Preferred stock dividends and accretion
 
(32
)
 
(129
)
 
(214
)
Net income (loss) available to common shareholders
 
$
1,090

 
$
991

 
$
(429
)

184

Table of Contents



Statements of Cash Flows
 
 
 
Year Ended December 31
 
 
2013
 
2012
 
2011
 
 
(In millions)
Operating activities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net income (loss)
 
$
1,122

 
$
1,120

 
$
(215
)
Adjustments to reconcile net cash from operating activities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Equity in undistributed (earnings) loss of subsidiaries
 
206

 
(411
)
 
60

Depreciation, amortization and accretion, net
 
1

 
5

 
7

Loss on sale of premises and equipment
 

 

 
16

Loss on early extinguishment of debt
 
32

 
11

 

Gain on disposition of business
 

 
(19
)
 

Net change in operating assets and liabilities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trading account securities
 

 
20

 
6

Other assets
 
122

 
(90
)
 
(26
)
Other liabilities
 
(152
)
 
242

 
79

Other
 
(21
)
 
138

 
(3
)
Net cash from operating activities
 
1,310

 
1,016

 
(76
)
Investing activities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Investment in subsidiaries
 
(6
)
 
2

 
(110
)
Principal (advances) payments on loans to subsidiaries
 
(10
)
 

 
35

Net sales of premises and equipment
 

 

 
21

Proceeds from sales and maturities of securities available for sale
 
4

 
15

 
34

Purchases of securities available for sale
 
(5
)
 
(14
)
 
(28
)
Proceeds from disposition of business, net of cash transferred
 

 
855

 

Net cash from investing activities
 
(17
)
 
858

 
(48
)
Financing activities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net change in short-term borrowings
 
(70
)
 
70

 

Proceeds from long-term borrowings
 
750

 

 

Payments on long-term borrowings
 
(1,098
)
 
(1,298
)
 
(1,001
)
Net proceeds from issuance of Series A preferred stock
 

 
486

 

Net proceeds from issuance of common stock
 

 
875

 

Repurchase of common stock
 
(340
)
 

 

Repurchase of Series A preferred stock and warrant issued to the U.S. Treasury
 

 
(3,545
)
 

Cash dividends on common stock
 
(138
)
 
(54
)
 
(51
)
Cash dividends on preferred stock
 
(32
)
 
(48
)
 
(175
)
Net cash from financing activities
 
(928
)
 
(3,514
)
 
(1,227
)
Net change in cash and cash equivalents
 
365

 
(1,640
)
 
(1,351
)
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year
 
857

 
2,497

 
3,848

Cash and cash equivalents at end of year
 
$
1,222

 
$
857

 
$
2,497



185

Table of Contents


Item 9. Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure
Not Applicable.
Item 9A. Controls and Procedures
    
Based on an evaluation, as of the end of the period covered by this Form 10-K, under the supervision and with the participation of Regions’ management, including its Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, the Chief Executive Officer and the Chief Financial Officer have concluded that Regions’ disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Rule 13a-15(e) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934) are effective. During the fourth fiscal quarter of the year ended December 31, 2013, there have been no changes in Regions’ internal control over financial reporting that have materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, Regions’ control over financial reporting.
The Report of Management on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting is included in Item 8. of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
 
Item 9B. Other Information
Not Applicable.


186

Table of Contents


PART III
Item 10. Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance

Information about the Directors and Director nominees of Regions included in Regions’ Proxy Statement for the Annual Meeting of Stockholders to be held on April 24, 2014 (the “Proxy Statement”) under the caption “ELECTION OF DIRECTORS—Who Are This Year's Nominees?” and the information incorporated by reference pursuant to Item 13. below are incorporated herein by reference. Information on Regions’ executive officers is included below.
Information regarding Regions’ Audit Committee included under the caption “CORPORATE GOVERNANCE—Committee Composition—Audit Committee” of the Proxy Statement is incorporated herein by reference.
Information regarding late filings under Section 16(a) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 included in the Proxy Statement under the caption “OWNERSHIP OF REGIONS COMMON STOCK—Section 16(a) Beneficial Ownership Reporting Compliance” is incorporated herein by reference.
Information regarding Regions’ Code of Ethics for Senior Financial Officers included in the Proxy Statement under the caption “CORPORATE GOVERNANCE—Policies Relating to Transactions with Related Persons and Code of Conduct — Code of Conduct for Senior Financial Officers” is incorporated herein by reference.
Information included in the Proxy Statement under the caption "CORPORATE GOVERNANCE—Family Relationships" is incorporated herein by reference.

Executive officers of the registrant as of December 31, 2013, are as follows:

Executive Officer
 
Age
 
Position and
Offices Held with
Registrant and Subsidiaries
 
Executive
Officer
Since*
O. B. Grayson Hall, Jr.
 
56
 
Chairman, President and Chief Executive Officer of registrant and Regions Bank. Director of registrant and Regions Bank. Previously President and Chief Executive Officer; President and Chief Operating Officer; and Vice Chairman and Head of General Banking Group.
 
1993
David B. Edmonds
 
60
 
Senior Executive Vice President and Chief Administrative Officer of registrant and Regions Bank. Previously Head of Human Resources Group.
 
1994
David J. Turner, Jr.
 
50
 
Senior Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of registrant and Regions Bank. Previously Director of Internal Audit Division.
 
2010
Fournier J. “Boots” Gale, III
 
69
 
Senior Executive Vice President, General Counsel and Corporate Secretary of registrant and Regions Bank. Previously a founding partner of Maynard Cooper & Gale PC in Birmingham, Alabama.
 
2011
C. Matthew Lusco
 
56
 
Senior Executive Vice President and Chief Risk Officer of registrant and Regions Bank. Previously managing partner of KPMG LLP’s offices in Birmingham, Alabama and Memphis, Tennessee.
 
2011
John B. Owen
 
52
 
Senior Executive Vice President and Head of Business Groups of registrant and Regions Bank. Director and Chairman, Regions Insurance Group, Inc. Previously Head of Consumer Services Group; and Head of Operations and Technology Group. Prior to joining Regions, served as Chief Executive Officer for Assurant Specialty Property.
 
2009
John C. Asbury
 
48
 
Senior Executive Vice President and Head of Business Services Group of registrant and Regions Bank. Director, Regions Equipment Finance Corporation; Manager, RFC Financial Services Holding LLC and Regions Securities LLC. Prior to joining Regions, held senior management positions at Bank of America.
 
2010

187

Table of Contents


Executive Officer
 
Age
 
Position and
Offices Held with
Registrant and Subsidiaries
 
Executive
Officer
Since*
Brett D. Couch
 
50
 
Senior Executive Vice President and East Region President of Regions Bank. Director, Regions Investment Services, Inc. Previously Florida Region President; Mississippi President; and West Florida Area Executive.
 
2010
Barb Godin
 
60
 
Senior Executive Vice President and Chief Credit Officer of registrant and Regions Bank. Previously served in senior management roles in credit and risk management.
 
2010
C. Keith Herron
 
49
 
Senior Executive Vice President and Head of Strategic Planning and Execution of registrant and Regions Bank. Director, Regions Investment Services, Inc. Previously Midsouth Region President; Middle Tennessee Area Executive; East Tennessee Area Executive; North Alabama Area Executive; and Head of Credit Review.
 
2010
Ellen S. Jones
 
55
 
Senior Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer for Business Operations and Support of registrant and Regions Bank. Director, Regions Insurance Group, Inc., Manager, RFC Financial Services Holding LLC and Regions Securities LLC. Prior to joining Regions, held senior finance leadership positions at Bank of America.
 
2010
David R. Keenan
 
46
 
Senior Executive Vice President and Director of Human Resources of registrant and Regions Bank. Previously served in senior management roles in Human Resources.
 
2010
Scott M. Peters
 
52
 
Senior Executive Vice President and Head of Consumer Services Group of registrant and Regions Bank. Previously Chief Marketing Officer.
 
2010
William D. Ritter
 
43
 
Senior Executive Vice President and Head of Wealth Management Group of registrant and Regions Bank. Director, Regions Insurance Group, Inc. Previously Central Region President; and North Central Alabama Area Executive.
 
2010
Cynthia M. Rogers
 
57
 
Senior Executive Vice President and Head of Operations and Technology Group of registrant and Regions Bank. Director, Regions Insurance Group, Inc. Previously Head of Bank Operations.
 
2010
Ronald G. Smith
 
53
 
Senior Executive Vice President and Mid-America Region President of Regions Bank. Director, Regions Insurance Group, Inc. Previously Southwest Region President; and Mississippi/North Louisiana Area President.
 
2010
John M. Turner, Jr.
 
52
 
Senior Executive Vice President and South Region President of Regions Bank. Previously Central Region President. Prior to joining Regions, served as President of Whitney National Bank and Whitney Holding Corporation.
 
2011

*
The years indicated are those in which the individual was first deemed to be an executive officer of registrant, including its predecessor companies.


188

Table of Contents


Item 11. Executive Compensation

All information presented under the captions “COMPENSATION DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS,” “COMPENSATION OF EXECUTIVE OFFICERS,” “COMPENSATION COMMITTEE REPORT,” “CORPORATE GOVERNANCE—Compensation Committee Interlocks and Insider Participation” and “—Relationship of Compensation Policies and Practices to Risk Management” and "ELECTION OF DIRECTORS—How are Directors Compensated?" of the Proxy Statement are incorporated herein by reference.
 
Item 12. Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters
    
All information presented under the caption “OWNERSHIP OF REGIONS COMMON STOCK” of the Proxy Statement is incorporated herein by reference.
Equity Compensation Plan Information
The following table gives information about the common stock that may be issued upon the exercise of options, warrants and rights under all of Regions’ existing equity compensation plans as of December 31, 2013.
 
Plan Category
 
Number of Securities
to be Issued Upon
Exercise of
Outstanding Options,
Warrants and Rights (a)
 
 
 
Weighted Average
Exercise Price of
Outstanding Options,
Warrants and Rights
 
Number of Securities
Remaining Available for
Future Issuance Under  Equity
Compensation Plans
(Excluding Securities
Reflected in First Column)
 
 
Equity Compensation Plans Approved by Stockholders
 
10,687,231

 
  
 
$
12.57

 
52,784,895

 
(b) 
Equity Compensation Plans Not Approved by Stockholders
 
21,440,004

 
(c) 
 
$
27.91

 

 
  
Total
 
32,127,235

 
  
 
$
22.81

 
52,784,895

 
  
 
(a)
Does not include outstanding restricted stock awards.
(b)
Consists of shares available for future issuance under the Regions Financial Corporation 2010 Long Term Incentive Plan. In 2010, all prior long-term incentive plans were closed to new grants.
(c)
Consists of outstanding stock options issued under plans assumed in connection with the Regions-AmSouth merger, which were previously approved by AmSouth stockholders but not pre-merger Regions stockholders. In each instance, the number of shares subject to option and the exercise price of outstanding options have been adjusted to reflect the applicable exchange ratio. See Note 16 “Share Based Payments” to the consolidated financial statements included in Regions’ Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2013. Does not include 102,323 shares issuable pursuant to outstanding rights under AmSouth deferred compensation plans assumed by Regions.

Item 13. Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence
    
All information presented under the captions “CORPORATE GOVERNANCE—Transactions with Directors," "—Other Business Relationships and Transactions,” “—Policies Relating to Transactions with Related Persons and Code of Conduct” and “—Director Independence” of the Proxy Statement are incorporated herein by reference.

Item 14. Principal Accounting Fees and Services

All information presented under the caption “RATIFICATION OF SELECTION OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM” of the Proxy Statement is incorporated herein by reference.


189

Table of Contents


PART IV

Item 15. Exhibits, Financial Statement Schedules

(a) 1. Consolidated Financial Statements. The following reports of independent registered public accounting firm and consolidated financial statements of Regions and its subsidiaries are included in Item 8. of this Form 10-K:
 
 
 
Reports of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm;
 
Consolidated Balance Sheets—December 31, 2013 and 2012;
 
Consolidated Statements of Operations—Years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011;
 
Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income (Loss)—Years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011;
 
Consolidated Statements of Changes in Stockholders’ Equity—Years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011; and
 
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows—Years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011.
 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
2. Consolidated Financial Statement Schedules.  The following consolidated financial statement schedules are included in Item 8. of this Form 10-K:
None. The Schedules to consolidated financial statements are not required under the related instructions or are inapplicable.
(b) Exhibits.  The exhibits indicated below are either included or incorporated by reference as indicated.
 
SEC Assigned
Exhibit Number
Description of Exhibits
 
 
3.1
Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to Form 10-Q Quarterly Report filed by registrant on August 6, 2012.
 
 
3.2
Certificate of Designations incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.3 to Form 8-A filed by registrant on November 1, 2012.
 
 
3.3
Bylaws as restated, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.2 to Form 8-K Current Report filed by registrant on May 14, 2010.
 
 
4.1
Instruments defining the rights of security holders, including indentures. The registrant hereby agrees to furnish to the Commission upon request copies of instruments defining the rights of holders of long-term debt of the registrant and its consolidated subsidiaries; no issuance of debt exceeds 10 percent of the assets of the registrant and its subsidiaries on a consolidated basis.
 
 
4.2
Deposit Agreement, dated as of November 1, 2012, by and among Regions Financial Corporation, Computershare Trust Company, N.A., as depositary, Computershare Inc., and the holders from time to time of the depositary receipts described therein, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to Form 8-A filed by registrant on November 1, 2012.
 
 
4.3
Form of depositary receipt representing the Depositary Shares incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.2 to Form 8-A filed by registrant on November 1, 2012.
 
 
4.4
Form of Stock Certificate representing the Preferred Stock, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.3 to Form 8-A filed by registrant on November 1, 2012.

190

Table of Contents


SEC Assigned
Exhibit Number
Description of Exhibits
 
 
10.1*
Regions Financial Corporation 2010 Long Term Incentive Plan, incorporated by reference to Appendix B to Regions Financial Corporation’s Proxy Statement dated April 1, 2010, for the Regions Annual Meeting of Shareholders held May 13, 2010.
 
 
10.2*
Amendment, effective August 31, 2010, to Regions Financial Corporation 2010 Long Term Incentive Plan, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to Form 10-Q Quarterly Report filed by registrant on November 3, 2010.
 
 
10.3*
Form of director restricted stock award agreement and grant notice under Regions Financial Corporation 2010 Long Term Incentive Plan, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to Form 10-Q Quarterly Report filed by registrant on August 4, 2010.
 
 
10.4*
Form of director restricted stock award agreement and grant notice under Regions Financial Corporation 2010 Long Term Incentive Plan, incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.9 to Form 10-Q Quarterly Report filed by registrant on August 4, 2011.
 
 
10.5*
Form of employee restricted stock award agreement and grant notice under Regions Financial Corporation 2010 Long Term Incentive Plan, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to Form 10-Q Quarterly Report filed by registrant on August 4, 2010.
 
 
10.6*
Form of stock option grant agreement under Regions Financial Corporation 2010 Long Term Incentive Plan, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.5 to Form 10-K Annual Report filed by registrant on February 24, 2011.
 
 
10.7*
Form of 2009-2010 Annual Salary Stock Unit Award Agreement, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to Form 8-K Current Report filed by registrant on December 11, 2009, File No. 000-50831.
 
 
10.8*
Form of 2011 Annual Salary Stock Unit Award Agreement, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to Form 8-K Current Report filed by registrant on February 25, 2011.
 
 
10.9*
Form of TARP Restricted Stock Award Agreement, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to Form 8-K Current Report filed by registrant on February 25, 2011.
 
 
10.10*
Form of 2012 Annual Salary Stock Unit Award Agreement, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.10 to Form 10-K Annual Report filed by registrant on February 24, 2012.
 
 
10.11*
Form of Notice and Form of Restricted Stock Unit Award Agreement, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to Form 8-K Current Report filed by registrant on May 25, 2012.
 
 
10.12*
Form of Notice and Form of Performance Stock Unit Award Agreement, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to Form 8-K Current Report filed by registrant on May 25, 2012.
 
 
10.13*
Form of Notice and Form of Performance Unit Award Agreement, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.4 to Form 8-K Current Report filed by registrant on May 25, 2012.
 
 
10.14*
Form of Notice and Form of Restricted Stock Unit Award Agreement, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to Form 10-Q Quarterly Report filed by registrant on May 8, 2013.
 
 
10.15*
Form of Notice and Form of Performance Stock Unit Award Agreement, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to Form 10-Q Quarterly Report filed by registrant on May 8, 2013.

191

Table of Contents


SEC Assigned
Exhibit Number
Description of Exhibits
 
 
10.16*
Form of Notice and Form of Performance Unit Award Agreement, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.4 to Form 10-Q Quarterly Report filed by registrant on May 8, 2013.
 
 
10.17*
AmSouth Bancorporation 2006 Long Term Incentive Compensation Plan, incorporated by reference to Appendix C to AmSouth Bancorporation’s Proxy Statement dated March 10, 2006, for the AmSouth Annual Meeting of Shareholders held April 20, 2006, File No. 1-7476.
 
 
10.18*
Form of stock option grant agreement under AmSouth Bancorporation 2006 Long Term Incentive Compensation Plan, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.3 to Form 8-K Current Report filed by registrant on April 30, 2007, File No. 000-50831.
 
 
10.19*
Form of performance-based stock option grant agreement and award notice under AmSouth Bancorporation 2006 Long Term Incentive Compensation Plan, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.4 to Form 10-Q Quarterly Report filed by registrant on May 11, 2009, File No. 000-50831.
 
 
10.20*
Regions Financial Corporation 2006 Long Term Incentive Plan, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 to Form 8-K Current Report filed by registrant on May 23, 2006, File No. 000-50831.
 
 
10.21*
Amendment to Regions Financial Corporation 2006 Long Term Incentive Plan, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.5 to Form 10-Q Quarterly Report filed by registrant on May 7, 2008, File No. 000-50831.
 
 
10.22*
Form of stock option grant agreement under Regions Financial Corporation 2006 Long Term Incentive Plan, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 to Form 8-K Current Report filed by registrant on April 30, 2007, File No. 000-50831.
 
 
10.23*
Form of performance-based stock option grant agreement and award notice under Regions Financial Corporation 2006 Long Term Incentive Plan, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to Form 10-Q Quarterly Report filed by registrant on May 11, 2009, File No. 000-50831.
 
 
10.24*
Form of performance-based restricted stock agreement and award notice under AmSouth Bancorporation 2006 Long Term Incentive Compensation Plan and Regions Financial Corporation 2006 Long Term Incentive Plan, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.5 to Form 10-Q Quarterly Report filed by registrant on May 11, 2009, File No. 000-50831.
 
 
10.25*
Form of performance-based restricted stock agreement and award notice applicable to the non-employee members of the Board of Directors under the Regions Financial Corporation 2006 Long Term Incentive Plan, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to Form 8-K Current Report filed by registrant on April 22, 2009, File No. 000-50831.
 
 
10.26*
Form of director stock option grant agreement under Regions Financial Corporation 2006 Long Term Incentive Plan, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.45 to Form 10-K Annual Report filed by registrant on February 27, 2008, File No. 000-50831.

192

Table of Contents


SEC Assigned
Exhibit Number
Description of Exhibits
 
 
10.27*
Form of 2009 LTI cash award agreement under the Regions Financial Corporation 2006 Long Term Incentive Plan, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.19 to Form 10-K Annual Report filed by registrant on February 24, 2011.
 
 
10.28*
AmSouth Bancorporation 1996 Long Term Incentive Compensation Plan, as amended, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to Form 10-Q Quarterly Report filed by AmSouth Bancorporation on November 9, 2004, File No. 1-7476.
 
 
10.29*
Amendment Number 1 to the AmSouth Bancorporation 1996 Long Term Incentive Compensation Plan, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to Form 10-Q Quarterly Report filed by AmSouth Bancorporation on May 9, 2006, File No. 1-7476.
 
 
10.30*
Form of stock option grant agreement under AmSouth Bancorporation 1996 Long Term Incentive Compensation Plan, incorporated by reference as Exhibit 10.2 to Form 8-K Current Report filed by AmSouth Bancorporation on February 11, 2005, File No. 1-7476.
 
 
10.31*
AmSouth Bancorporation Amended and Restated Stock Option Plan for Outside Directors, incorporated by reference to Appendix E to AmSouth Bancorporation’s Proxy Statement dated March 10, 2004, for the Annual Meeting of Shareholders held April 15, 2004, File No. 1-7476.
 
 
10.32*
Form of stock option grant agreement under AmSouth Bancorporation Amended and Restated Stock Option Plan for Outside Directors, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to Form 8-K Current Report filed by AmSouth Bancorporation on April 26, 2005, File No. 1-7476.
 
 
10.33*
Amended and Restated Regions Financial Corporation Directors’ Deferred Stock Investment Plan, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.27 to Form 10-K Annual Report filed by registrant on February 25, 2009, File No. 000-50831.
 
 
10.34*
Amended and Restated Regions Financial Corporation Deferred Compensation Plan for Former Directors of AmSouth Bancorporation (formerly named Deferred Compensation Plan for Directors of AmSouth Bancorporation), incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.30 to Form 10-K Annual Report filed by registrant on February 25, 2009, File No. 000-50831.
 
 
10.35*
First American Corporation Directors’ Deferred Compensation Plan, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10-a to Form 10-Q Quarterly Report filed by AmSouth Bancorporation on April 30, 2002, File No. 1-7476.
 
 
10.36*
Amendment Number 2 to First American Corporation Directors’ Deferred Compensation Plan, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to Form 10-Q Quarterly Report filed by registrant on November 9, 2007, File No. 000-50831.
 
 
10.37*
Amendment Number 3 to First American Corporation Directors’ Deferred Compensation Plan, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.42 to Form 10-K Annual Report filed by registrant on February 21, 2013.
 
 
10.38*
Form of deferred compensation agreement implementing deferred compensation arrangements with certain directors who were formerly directors of Union Planters Corporation, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.19 to Form 10-K Annual Report filed by registrant on March 14, 2005, File No. 000-50831.

193

Table of Contents


SEC Assigned
Exhibit Number
Description of Exhibits
 
 
10.39*
AmSouth Bancorporation Deferred Compensation Plan, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.13 to Form 10-K Annual Report filed by AmSouth Bancorporation on March 15, 2005, File No. 1-7476.
 
 
10.40*
Amendment Number 1 to AmSouth Bancorporation Deferred Compensation Plan effective November 4, 2006, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.59 to Form 10-K Annual Report filed by registrant on March 1, 2007, File No. 000-50831.
 
 
10.41*
Amendment Number 2 to AmSouth Bancorporation Deferred Compensation Plan, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.36 to Form 10-K Annual Report filed by registrant on February 25, 2009, File No. 000-50831.
 
 
10.42*
Form of Change-in-Control Agreement for executive officers O. B. Grayson Hall, Jr., David B. Edmonds and John B. Owen, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 of Form 8-K Current Report filed by registrant on October 3, 2007, File No. 000-50831.
 
 
10.43*
Form of Change-in-Control Agreement for executive officer Fournier J. Gale, III, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.10 of Form 10-Q Quarterly Report filed by registrant on August 4, 2011.
 
 
10.44*
Form of Change-in-Control Agreement for executive officers C. Matthew Lusco and John M. Turner, Jr., incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.11 of Form 10-Q Quarterly Report filed by registrant on August 4, 2011.
 
 
10.45*
Form of Change-in-Control Agreement with executive officers Brett D. Couch, Barbara Godin, C. Keith Herron, David R. Keenan, Scott M. Peters, Cynthia M. Rogers, Ronald G. Smith and David J. Turner, Jr., incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.48 to Form 10-K Annual Report filed by registrant on February 24, 2011.
 
 
10.46*
Form of Change-in-Control Agreement with executive officers John C. Asbury, Ellen S. Jones and William D. Ritter, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.49 to Form 10-K Annual Report filed by registrant on February 24, 2011.
 
 
10.47*
Form of Amendment to Change-in-Control Agreement with executive officers O. B. Grayson Hall, Jr., David B. Edmonds, David J. Turner, Jr., John B. Owen, Brett D. Couch, Barbara Godin, C. Keith Herron, David R. Keenan, Scott M. Peters, Cynthia M. Rogers, Ronald G. Smith, John C. Asbury, Ellen S. Jones and William D. Ritter, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.52 to Form 10-K Annual Report filed by registrant on February 21, 2013.
 
 
10.48*
Regions Financial Corporation Supplemental 401(k) Plan (Restated as of January 1, 2014) (encompassing through Amendment No. Seven).
 
 
10.49*
Regions Financial Corporation Post 2006 Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan (Restated as of January 1, 2014) (encompassing through Amendment No. Three).
 
 
10.50*
Form of Indemnification Agreement for Directors of AmSouth Bancorporation, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to Form 8-K Current Report filed by AmSouth Bancorporation on April 20, 2006, File No. 1-7476.
 
 
10.51*
Form of Aircraft Time Sharing Agreement, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to Form 10-Q Quarterly Report filed by registrant on November 4, 2009, File No. 000-50831.

194

Table of Contents


SEC Assigned
Exhibit Number
Description of Exhibits
 
 
10.52*
Amendment to Aircraft Time Sharing Agreement by and between Regions Financial Corporation and O.B. Grayson Hall, Jr., incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.63 to Form 10-K Annual Report filed by registrant on February 21, 2013.
 
 
10.53*
Regions Financial Corporation Use of Corporate Aircraft Policy, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.64 to Form 10-K Annual Report filed by registrant on February 21, 2013.
 
 
10.54*
Regions Financial Corporation Amended and Restated Management Incentive Plan, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to Form 8-K Current report filed by registrant on May 25, 2012.
 
 
10.55*
Regions Financial Corporation Executive Incentive Plan, incorporated by reference to Appendix A to Proxy Statement filed by registrant on March 26, 2013 and approved by the stockholders at the annual meeting held May 16, 2013.
 
 
12
Computation of Ratio of Earnings to Fixed Charges.
 
 
21
List of subsidiaries of registrant.
 
 
23
Consent of independent registered public accounting firm.
 
 
24
Powers of Attorney.
 
 
31.1
Certifications of Chief Executive Officer pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
 
 
31.2
Certifications of Chief Financial Officer pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
 
 
32
Certifications pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
 
 
101
Interactive Data File
 
 
  
* Compensatory plan or agreement.
Copies of exhibits not included herein may be obtained free of charge, electronically through Regions’ website at www.regions.com or through the SEC’s website at www.sec.gov or upon request to:
Investor Relations
Regions Financial Corporation
1900 Fifth Avenue North
Birmingham, Alabama 35203
(205) 326-5807



195

Table of Contents


SIGNATURES
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by undersigned thereunto duly authorized.
 
 
 
 
 
DATE:
February 21, 2014
 
Regions Financial Corporation
 
 
 
 
 
By:
/S/    O. B. Grayson Hall, Jr.       
 
 
 
O. B. Grayson Hall, Jr.
Chairman, President and Chief Executive Officer
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated
Signature
 
Title
Date
 
 
 
 
/S/    O. B. GRAYSON HALL, JR.        
 
Chairman, President and Chief Executive Officer, and Director (principal executive officer)
February 21, 2014
O. B. Grayson Hall, Jr.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/S/    DAVID J. TURNER, JR.        
 
Senior Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer (principal financial officer)
February 21, 2014
David J. Turner, Jr.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/S/    HARDIE B. KIMBROUGH, JR.        
 
Executive Vice President and Controller (principal accounting officer)
February 21, 2014
Hardie B. Kimbrough, Jr.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
*
 
Director
February 21, 2014

George W. Bryan
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
*
 
Director
February 21, 2014

Carolyn H. Byrd
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
*
 
Director
February 21, 2014

David J. Cooper, Sr.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
*
 
Director
February 21, 2014
Don DeFosset
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
*
 
Director
February 21, 2014
Eric C. Fast
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
*
 
Director
February 21, 2014
John D. Johns
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

196

Table of Contents


Signature
 
Title
Date
 
 
 
 
*
 
Director
February 21, 2014
James R. Malone
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
*
 
Director
February 21, 2014
Ruth Ann Marshall
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
*
 
Director
February 21, 2014
Susan W. Matlock
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
*
 
Director
February 21, 2014
John E. Maupin, Jr.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
*
 
Director
February 21, 2014
Charles D. McCrary
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
*
 
Director
February 21, 2014
John R. Roberts
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
*
 
Director
February 21, 2014
Lee J. Styslinger III
 
 
 
 
*
Fournier J. Gale, III, by signing his name hereto, does sign this document on behalf of each of the persons indicated above pursuant to powers of attorney executed by such persons and filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission.
 
 
 
 
By:
/S/    FOURNIER J. GALE, III        
 
Fournier J. Gale, III
 
Attorney in Fact


 


197